PROGRESSIVE
EXERCISE THERAPY
IN REHABILITATION AND PHYSICAL
EDUCATION
BY
John H. C. Colson FCSP FSRG DipTRG Di...
362 downloads
2298 Views
14MB Size
Report
This content was uploaded by our users and we assume good faith they have the permission to share this book. If you own the copyright to this book and it is wrongfully on our website, we offer a simple DMCA procedure to remove your content from our site. Start by pressing the button below!
Report copyright / DMCA form
PROGRESSIVE
EXERCISE THERAPY
IN REHABILITATION AND PHYSICAL
EDUCATION
BY
John H. C. Colson FCSP FSRG DipTRG DipCOT Remedial Therapy Representative, NHS Health Advisory Service. Formerly Director of
Rehabilitation and Principal, School of Remedial Gymnastics and Recreational Therapy,
Pinderfields General Hospital
and
Frank W. Collison MSRG Head Remedial Gymnast and Clinical Supervisor, Rehabilitation Department,
Pinderfields General Hospital. Formerly Head Remedial Gymnast, Orseu Hospital
FOURTH EDITION
WRIGHT -PSG BRISTOL . LONDON . BOSTON 1983
© J. H. C. Colson, 18 The Russets, Sandal, Wakefield, West Yorks, WF26JF, and F. W. Collison, 10 Castle Crescent, Sandal, Wakefield, West Yorks, WF27HX. 1983
All Rights Reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise, without the prior permission of the Copyright owners. II
i! i
I Published by: John Wright & Sons Ltd, 823-825 Bath Road, Bristol BS45NU, England John Wright PSG Inc., 545 Great Road, Littleton, Massachusetts 01460, USA. First edition 1958 Japanese edition 1966
Second edition 1969
Spanish edition 1974
Third edition 1975
Dutch edition 1981
Fourth edition 1983
British Library Cataloguing in Publicatilm Data
Colson, John H. C.
Progressive exercise therapy in rehabilitation
and physical education.
1. Exercise therapy I. Title II. Collison, Frank W.
61S.8'24 RM72S
ISBN o7236066SX Library of Congress Catalog Card Number: 82-S0781
,.,.." .. Gr.- Brimin by
............ s.:.. {Printing) Ltd, at The Stonebridge Press, Bristol BS4 SNU
and 7HX.
1,
I in a mical, yright
w
The Wise,jor Cure, on Exercise depend.
DRYDEN.
PREFACE The first edition of this book appeared in 1958. Its main aim was to emphasize the importance of progression in exercise therapy and to provide a compre hensive collection of free exercises for all parts of the body, graded and progressed (as the original preface had it) in strength and mobility from the simplest to the most strenuous movement. Since that time two other editions have appeared and the book has been translated into Japanese, Spanish and Dutch. From comments received from students and therapists it is clear that the practical slant of the book has been appreciated. Indeed, it has been heartening to receive so many letters from different countries offering criticism, encouragement and suggestions for future editions. This new edition of Progressive Exercise Therapy, written in collaboration with my friend and former colleague, Frank Collison, has not only been completely revised, but expanded to include new sections on assisted and resisted exercises, functional movement, progressive circuit training and exercises to music. In addition, the section devoted to the exercise therapy of various clinical conditions (which illustrates the way in which the exercise vocabulary may be used when planning treatment programmes) has been rewritten to bring it into line with modem practice. Running the risk of criticism we have included a chapter on the re-educational measures which may be used in the treatment of total hip replacement when the low friction Charnley prosthesis is employed. Unfortunately, the addition of so much new material has meant the deletion of the sections on recreational therapy in the treatment of the mentally handicapped and the mentally ill, which appeared in the previous edition. Limitation of space has also meant that it has not been possible to include any reference to the important role played by neurophysiological techniques in modern exercise therapy. We owe much to the late John M. P. Clark, Emeritus Professor of Orthopaedic Surgery, University of Leeds, not only for his constant en couragement and advice but for his truly superb teaching at ward rounds and clinics. For 'Pasco' exercise therapy was the straight and narrow path to recovery after injury or disease, and progression the keynote of success. vii
viii
IIII
'Iii
IIII 'II
PREFACE
Our sincere thanks are due to the surgeons who have given us so much practical help. Mr J. F. Patrick FRCS, Mr A. E. Rainey FRCS, and Mr C. Robertson FRCS, of the Orthopaedic Department, Pinderfields General Hospital, Wakefield, Yorkshire, were always willing to guide us on technical matters during the preparation of the chapters on orthopaedic procedures. Mr C. Denley Clark FRCS and Mr G. Bird FRCS gave us generous support when we were involved in the revision of the section on the use of exercise therapy after abdominal surgery. It is also a great pleasure to acknowledge the help given by the nursing staff of the orthopaedic and general surgical wards at Pinderfields General Hospital. Their appreciation of the value of early movement, and their detailed understanding of modern surgical techniques and equipment, have made for the closest cooperation during practical sessions of exercise therapy. Our grateful thanks are due also to Mr John V. Gough MCSP DipTP, for his advice and help when investigating the use of the myometer in recording muscle strength. It is also a great pleasure to acknowledge the outstanding help given by Mr Robbie Blake MCSP DipTP during the many months of preparing the revised text of this book. He has listened, commented and criticized in a most useful and constructive way. The staff of the Wakefield and District Postgraduate Medical Centre gave us valuable help with the checking of references and the compiling of the bibliography; they also made available the resources of their information service. We are grateful to the team concerned and in particular to Mrs Cecily A. Miller, BA DipLib ALA, head of information services. Finally, we must thank our Editor, Dr Sue Passmore, for her interest in the book and her enthusiasm for the subject matter. Our thanks must also be extended to our publishers, John Wright & Sons, for their support and cooperation over many years. John Colson Frank Collison
1. 2. 3. 4.
PART 1 IntroductOi Free Exerd Assisted Ell Resisted fu
PART 5. Movemenll 6. Moving fro
PARl 7. Head and} 8. Trunk Exel 9. Breathing I 10. Pelvic 11001 11. Shoulder g 12. Combined, Exercises 13. Elbow Exel 14. Forearm, " 15. Hip Exercil 16. Knee Exere 17. Ankle and ]
PART .. 18. Constructic:
Specific]
19. Exercise TI 20. Interverteb
have given us so much
Rainey PRCS, and Mr
:at,
Pinderfields General
to guide us on technical
Irtbopaedic procedures. we us generous support 11 OIl the use of exercise
i¥en by the nursing staff Pinderfields General r movement, and their IS and equipment, have iDos of exercise therapy . • MCSP DipTP, for : myometer in recording IWIedge the outstanding iDa the many months of 1Ialed, commented and
II:
Medical Centre gave Id the compiling of the :cs of their information particular to Mrs Cecily
III:
CONTENTS 1. 2. 3. 4.
PART 2 FUNCTIONAL MOVEMENTS 5. Movements on the Bed or Floor 6. Moving from Sitting and Standing
mces.
interest in the lor thanks must also be • for their support and
R, for her
John Colson Frank Collison
PART 1 SPECIFIC EXERCISE THERAPY Introductory Free Exercises Assisted Exercises Resisted Exercises
7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17.
PART 3 PROGRESSIVE EXERCISES Head and Neck Exercises Trunk Exercises Breathing Exercises Pelvic floor Exercises Shoulder girdle Exercises Combined Shoulder joint and Shoulder girdle Exercises Elbow Exercises Forearm, Wrist and Hand Exercises Hip Exercises Knee Exercises Ankle and Foot Exercises
PART 4 APPLIED EXERCISE THERAPY 18. Construction and Use of Tables of Specific Exercises 19. Exercise Therapy after Abdominal Surgery 20. Intervertebral Disc Lesions of Lumbar Spine ix
3 7 13 21
45 54
61 69 109 115 118 120 139 143 154 164 171
181 184 212
x
CONTENTS
21. Total Hip Replacement 22. Meniscectomy
PART 1
221
232
PART 5 GENERAL EXERCISE THERAPY 23. Progressive Circuit Training 24. Exercises to Music
247
256
APPENDICES , ,I'
1. Starting Positions 2. Gymnastic Terminology
261
273
Bibliography
277
Index
279
SPECIF THERA
,II: I.
..
221 232
PART 1
::::ISE THERAPY 247
256
261 273
277
279
SPECIFIC EXERCISE THERAPY
1. Introductory
Specific or local exercises consist of active movements that are designed to restore function. General exercises, on the other hand, are those that provide movement for the body as a whole. Specific exercises are used to strengthen particular muscle groups, mobilize certain joints or re-educate neuromuscular coordination, and are of great value in the treatment of injuries and disorders of the locomotor system where certain muscle groups and joints are affected and the rest are comparatively normal, e.g. in fractures and other bone and joint injuries, orthopaedic conditions, thoracic diseases and postoperative abdominal conditions. Specific exercises are not sufficient in themselves to bring about perfect functional recovery, however, for muscles and joints were never intended by nature to act as individualists. For the best results specific exercises must be combined with general exercises, so as to coordinate the movements of the affected part with the rest of the locomotor system. It is also often necessary to combine treatment by exercises with passive therapy, occupational therapy and various recreational activities-games, swimming, walking and cycling.
TYPES OF SPECIFIC EXERCISES Specific exercises consist of free movements, assisted movements and resisted movements. The movements, and the various techniques used to achieve progression, are considered in detail in the next three chapters.
BASIC PRINCIPLES OF SPECIFIC EXERCISES All types of specific exercises must conform to certain basic principles: 1. They must be performed in a smooth and rhythmical manner, so that they do not subject muscles and joints to sudden unexpected stresses and strains. 2. They must be based on sound starting positions. 3. They must provide smooth progression from the stage of extreme weakness to the stage of full use against the stresses of normal working conditions.
3
4
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
standing, sitting steadier til than sitting. The nearer tb steadier is the position. In some instances additio to be enlarged in the directic standing is a steadier positic: arms are moved in the sagi cause the centre of gravity CI backwards. This is partia movements are performed. upwards. In stride standing not only by essential small I unnecessary movements ill moving forwards and back1
In addition, all exercises that aim to strengthen weak muscles should provide as wide a range of movement as possible.
I II i~iI
IIPi'
IIIII!: ,111'1
Principle of Rhythm Muscular contraction must be followed by relaxation, and the relaxation period must be complete and long enough to allow normal circulatory conditions to be restored. This principle applies particularly to exercises which are used to redevelop weak muscles after trauma or disuse. It is based on the fact that the efficiency of a muscle depends largely on the condition of its local circulation. If this is good, the breakdown products of contraction are quickly carried away; if it is poor, the products tend to accumulate and produce early fatigue. To conform to the principle of rhythm in practice the therapist must give as much emphasis to the relaxation period at the end of an exercise as to the actual muscle work itself. Thus, in using an exercise like Fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards (Fig. la, p. 8), to strengthen the extensor muscles of the thoracolumbar spine, the following type of coaching might be used. 'Bend back the head-tum out the arms so that the palms face forward lift the chest from the floor as far as you can ... A little more ... Now "hold" the position for a moment ... Lower the trunk down carefully; let the arms tum in ... Now tum the head and flop out completely. Let everything go ... .' After a few seconds' pause the exercise is repeated. It is worth comparing this technique with that often used for the same type of exercise. 'Lift-! Hold the position! Lower ... Rest ... Lift-!' The instructions for relaxation and the restarting of the exercise almost merge into one another and completely negate the principle of rhythm.
Sound Starting Position The starting position from which each exercise is performed should facilitate the work of the muscles, and be suitable for the particular phase of recovery reached by the patient.
Strengthening and Mobilizing To strengthen weak muscles or to mobilize stiff joints the starting positions of the exercises should be as steady as possible, so as to give the working muscles a firm origin from which to work. The larger the base of support the steadier will be the position of the body. For example, stride standing is steadier than
Developing Coordination In developing neuromUSCU chosen so as gradually to iI e.g. toe standing and stand
Principle of progr cs ; .
•
The method of progressioo to redevelop strength, Ie ordination. One method aI csercises: progression in til: periods of time.
Wide Range Movemad Except in the early phase csercises which aim at sue of movement as possible; ~ this way it is more likely t movement will be exercise from the action of certain I raponsible for particular muscle in part of its range fibres will be brought inti The classic example of 1
tAPY
:hen weak muscles should
Dtion, and the relaxation allow normal circulatory s particularly to exercises mona or disuse. It is based largely on the condition of products of contraction are s tend to accumulate and
ia: the therapist must give _ of an exercise as to the lise like Fixed prone lying; . .ds (Fig. la, p. 8), to IIIJbar spine, the following t the palms face forward little more ... Now "hold" own carefully; let the arms Idy. Let everything go... .' d. ften used for the same type • . Rest . . . Lift-!' The ~cxercise almost merge into of rhythm.
performed should facilitate articular phase of recovery
DIS the starting positions of o give the working muscles ase of support the steadier Ie standing is steadier than
INTRODUCTORY
5
standing, sitting steadier than stride standing and lying a steadier position than sitting. The nearer the centre of gravity to the base of support, the steadier is the position. In some instances additional stability is achieved by arranging for the base to be enlarged in the direction of the movement. For example, walk-forwards standing is a steadier position than stride standing for exercises in which the arms are moved in the sagittal plane, because the movements of the arms cause the centre of gravity of the body to be constantly shifted forwards and backwards. This is particularly evident when vigorous wide range arm movements are performed, such as Arm swinging forwards and forwards upwards. In stride standing the compensatory balancing required is achieved not only by essential small movements of the ankle joints but very often by unnecessary movements in the lumbar spine, with the head and pelvis moving forwards and backwards alternately.
Developing Coordination In developing neuromuscular coordination the starting position should be chosen so as gradually to increase the difficulty of maintaining the balance, e.g. toe standing and standing with one knee raised forwards.
Principle of Progression The method of progression used depends on whether an exercise is designed to redevelop strength, restore mobility or redevelop neuromuscular co ordination. One method of progression, however, is common to all types of exercises: progression in time. That is, performing the exercise for increasing periods of time.
Wide Range Movements Except in the early phase of recovery when the muscles are very weak, all exercises which aim at strengthening muscles should provide as wide a range of movement as possible, and each movement should be taken to its limit. In this way it is more likely that all the fibres of the muscle responsible for the movement will be exercised normally. This is important, because it appears from the action of certain muscles that individual groups of muscle fibres are responsible for particular ranges of movement. In other words, exercising a muscle in part of its range of movement does not necessarily mean that all its fibres will be brought into action. The classic example of this is the vastus medialis muscle. The lower fibres 'contract particularly during the terminal phase of extension of the knee joint
6
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
to retain the patella in its groove on the patellar surface of the femur .. .' (Williams and Warwick, 1980). Therefore, failure to extend the knee to its full extent when exercising the quadriceps femoris muscle group means that although the vastus lateralis and rectus femoris sections are exercised fully the vastus medialis is inadequately exercised. See also p. 23.
2. Free el
REFERENCE Ilil'lIl
'!lIIII; 11'11
~ IHI!; 111'i!
WiIliams P. L. and Warwick R. (1980) Gray's Anatomy, 36th ed. London, Churchill Livingstone.
Free exercises are perform resistance (beyond tbat exc are controlled by gymnast functional movements and I of physical education. Free movements are not the gymnastic type of mm mediate and final phases. Il other form of remedial exc on his own efforts, are part DOt require specialized eq1 apparatus.
1. PROGRESSION IN !
Progression in strength is c disease, because without I useless. On the other hand wirh full function under d
Methods ofPro~
There are seven main meIl 1. By increasing the le.J:I8 ..we:ment so tbat the CCD fRIm the moving joint tb:I fmm.fixed prone lying is III spine and hips when the all tiiIb (d. Fig. la and b). 1 II:Id in streuh position (Pi A modification of this . ...... rotator muscles in tl .z. (Lq IoUJering siderrJays f • • single lever. In Fig. 26
IlDiRAPY
!!liar surface of the femur .. .'
lihue to extend the knee to its
2. Free exercises
DOris muscle group means that
lis sections are exercised fully
. SN also p. 23.
IIIII!:V. 36th ed. London, Churchill
Free exercises are performed by the patient without external assistance or resistance (beyond that exerted by gravity), although in some instances they are controlled by gymnastic apparatus. They consist of simple, everyday functional movements and gymnastic exercises drawn from the main systems of physical education. Free movements are not confined to anyone phase of recovery, although the gymnastic type of movement is reserved more especially for the inter mediate and final phases. In general, they are employed more often than any other form of remedial exercises. This is because they make the patient rely on his own efforts, are particularly suitable f~r group and class work, and do not require specialized equipment beyond the normal type of gymnasium apparatus.
1. PROGRESSION IN STRENGTH Progression in strength is of great importance in the treatment of injury and disease, because without muscle strength range of movement is relatively useless. On the other hand, strength without range is frequently compatible with full function under the stresses imposed by heavy occupations.
Methods of Progression
There are seven main methods of progressing the strength of free exercises:
1. By increasing the length of the weight arm ofthe lever, i.e. arranging the movement so that the centre of gravity of the moving part is further away from the moving joint than before. For example, Trunk bending backwards from fixed prone lying is harder work for the extensors of the thoracolumbar spine and hips when the arms are placed in neck rest than when they are by the sides (cf. Fig. la and b). The exercise is made more difficult if the arms are held in stretch position (Fig. lc). A modification of this type of progression is used in strengthening the spinal rotator muscles in the pelvic rotation exercise shown in Fig. 2. In Fig. 2a (Leg lowering sideways from half-crook half-leg lift lying) the raised leg acts as a single lever. In Fig. 2b (slow Leg swinging from side to side from vertical leg 7
8
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
FRI
a
Fig. 3. Progression in strength: cI muscles by the accessory flexor PII 1 111 1111' 111 1111 ,
b
!1!liili liill' ,!:I
Fig. 1. Progression in strength: increasing the length of the weight arm of the lever.
abdominals. They work strongly groups produce extension of the I Extension is associated, after SOlD In general, the most difficult stlI the arms stretched sideways inya the arms makes it difficult for the junction, and he has to use his ab bring about additional flexion of I 3. By increasing the range ofIDI from angle-hanging (Fig. 4b) is .. the high reach grasp crook lying po difficult still when it is performed (Fig. 4c).
4. By the addition of subsidiary the work of the main muscle gI'OU!
a
b
Fig. 2. Progression in strength: rotator muscles of thoracic spine. The combined weight of the two-leg lever in b is a strong progression on the single-leg lever of a.
lift lying) the combined weight of the two levers forms a strong progression on the single-lever system of the first exercise. It should be noted that the pelvic rotation exercise, Knee swinging from side to side from yard crook lying (Fig. 128, p. 100), is basically a mobility exercise and is therefore not included in this group. 2. By 'cutting out' the help given to the prime mover muscles by accessory muscles. For example, Lying; high Leg raising to touch the floor overhead with the toes is harder work for the abdominal muscles when the arms are in reach (Fig. 3b) or stretch position than when they are by the sides (Fig. 3a). In the latter position the accessory flexor muscles of the thoracolumbar spine (latis simus dorsi, teres major and pectoralis major) come into action to assist the
IlERAPY
9
FREE EXERCISES
b Fig. 3. Progression in strength: eliminating the help given to the abdominal muscles by the accessory flexor muscles of the thoracolumbar spine.
IIgtb of the weight arm of the
abdominals. They work strongly in inner range, and the first two muscle groups produce extension of the shoulder joint in addition to spinal flexion. Extension is associated, after some 15°, with shoulder girdle movement. In general, the most difficult starting position for this exercise is lying with the arms stretched sideways in yard position. This is because the position of the arms makes it difficult for the performer to pivot at the thoracocervical junction, and he has to use his abdominal muscles strongly in an attempt to bring about additional flexion of the thoracolumbar spine. 3. By increasing the range of movement. For example, spanning performed from angle-hanging (Fig. 4b) is harder work than when it is performed from the high reach grasp crook lying position (Fig. 4a). The exercise is made more difficult still when it is performed from stretch grasp back support long sitting (Fig.4c). 4. By the addition of subsidiary movements to an exercise, so as to increase the work of the main muscle group. For example, Prone lying; Trunk bending
rthoracic spine. The combined
JIC!SSion on the single-leg lever
:n forms a strong progression a'cise, Knee swinging from side is basicalJy a mobility exercise Ie mover
muscles by accessory
ro touch the floor overhead with Ics when the arms are in reach ~ by
the sides (Fig. 3a). In the Ie thoracolumbar spine (latis come into action to assist the
Fig. 4. Progression in strength: increasing the range of movement in spanning.
10
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
backwards with Arm turning outwards and single Leg raising backwards (Fig. 5) is harder work for the extensors of the thoracolumbar spine than the same exercise without leg movements. Raising both legs backwards at the same time (instead of one leg in turn) makes the exercise more difficult still.
llililim illllill
'illl'l: :!llilll
!ll lIi
'I:
3. By introducing prolonged ing the range of flexion of a stiI the knee and hip joints of the all producing pain. He artempa completely, so as to allow the knee. He then contracts the b flexed to the limit of pain, 'boll allows the hamstrings to relax s1 before the knee joint is extend
Fig. 5. Progression in strength: subsidiary movements are added to the exercise
to increase the work of the main muscle group.
5. By using first static and then dynamic muscle work. For example, (a) Half lying; single Quadriceps contractions, and (b) Half lying (thighs supported by folded pillow or shaped wooden block, with knees flexed to about 30°); single Knee stretching. 6. By altering the rhythm of the movement. Slow, controlled movements require more effort from the muscles than the same movements performed at a quicker rate. 7. By altering the effect of gravity on the moving part, i.e. arranging for the movement to be performed with gravity stresses eliminated, and later against the resistance of gravity. Thus, in strengthening the rotators of the thoracic spine: (a) Stride sitting; Trunk turning, and (b) Stride lying; Trunk turning with single Arm carrying across the chest (Fig. 129, p. 101).
2. PROGRESSION IN RANGE From the viewpoint of function, range of movement is undoubtedly second ary in importance to muscle strength. In the restoration of stiff joints after trauma, however, very little headway would be made without employing specific mobility exercises.
Methods of Progression There are three main methods of progressing the range of free mobility exercises: 1. By altering the rhythm of the movement. For example, rhythmical swingings are used in place of slow movements. 2. By adding a series of small rhythmical pressing movements to the end of the main movement, e.g. Stride standing; Trunk bending from side to side with rhythmical pressing to three counts in position.
3. PROGRESSION IN CO
The main methods of prop applicable to all parts of the bo lower limbs and trunk.
General Methods of Prop" 1. Giving movements of II smaller joints later, e.g. shoull finger movementS. 2. Increasing the precisio performed. 3. Combining movements 4 Arm raising sideways. An extJ: performing asymmetrical JI101 and forwards.
Methods Applicable to l.oI 1. Diminishing the size of maintenance of balance becon ally this is done by (a) bringiJ the heels from the floor (toe rn Standing; single Knee raising;. such as a balance bench rib 0 2. Increasing the difficulti position by (a) placing the am the centre of gravity of the hoc the balance, e.g. Balance hal) raising sideways-upwards; and which (because of psychologi, ably (Fig. 6).
FREE EXERCISES
ismg backwards (Fig. 5) spine than the same -=lwards at the same JOJ:e difficult still. I:
11
3. By introducing prolonged tension movements. For example, in increas ing the range of flexion of a stiff knee joint, the patient lies on his back with the knee and hip joints of the affected limb flexed as much as possible without producing pain. He attempts to relax the quadriceps femoris muscle completely, so as to allow the lower leg to hang as a dead weight from the knee. He then contracts the hamstring muscles strongly until the knee is flexed to the limit of pain, 'holds' the position for several seconds, and then allows the hamstrings to relax slowly. This procedure is repeated several times before the knee joint is extended.
.aided to the exercise
art. For example, (a)
3. PROGRESSION IN COORDINATION
lying (thighs supported wi to about 30° ); single
The main methods of progression may be divided into those that are applicable to all parts of the body, and those that are chiefly applicable to the lower limbs and trunk.
DDntrolled movements IftIDeIlts performed at
r, ie. arranging for the
.ed, and later against oators of the thoracic it:; Trunk turning with
General Methods of Progression 1. Giving movements of the large JOints first, and movements of the smaller joints later, e.g. shoulder movements require less coordination than finger movements. 2. Increasing the precision with which a controlled movement is performed. 3. Combining movements of different joints, e.g. Knee full bending with Arm raising sideways. An extension of this form of progression consists of performing asymmetrical movements, e.g. opposite Arm swinging sideways and forwards .
.undoubtedly second
ion of stiff joints after
Ie without employing
mge of free mobility
example, rhythmical
wements to the end of
rfrom side to side with
Methods Applicable to Lower Limbs and Trunk 1. Diminishing the size of the accustomed base of support, so that the maintenance of balance becomes a matter of concentrated attention. Gener ally this is done by (a) bringing the feet together (close standing); (b) raising the heels from the floor (toe standing); (c) raising one foot from the floor, e.g. Standing,' single Knee raising; and (d) standing or walking on a narrow surface such as a balance bench rib or beam. 2. Increasing the difficulties of assuming or maintaining the balance position by (a) placing the arms in a higher positon (e.g. stretch), so as to raise the centre of gravity of the body; (b) moving the free joints, and so disturbing the balance, e.g. Balance half standing (beam); single Knee raising with Arm raising sideways-upwards; and (c) increasing the height of the apparatus used, which (because of psychological factors) disturbs the equilibrium consider ably (Fig. 6).
12
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
3. Assisted
llilill!~ iillilil 1,,),111
y.
b
Fig. 6. Progression in coordination: increasing the difficulty of maintaining the balance position by raising the height of the apparatus used.
.1.llllil'!1
, ! ~j~ 'I
l~ilW
Jl~
Rhythmical Hopping and Skipping Rhythmical hopping and skipping exercises which demand considerable balance are extremely useful in promoting coordination. For example: (a) Hopping with alternate Toe placing forwards and sideways (Fig. 7); (b) Running
...La
t
.I
d
Fig. 7. Progression in coordination: Hopping with alternate Toe placing forwards and sideways.
1. ASSISTED ACTIVE EXEJ Assisted active exercises are tl assistance of the therapist or som weight-and-pulley circuit. They me body. levers are too weak 1 .tequately. They are also used i The assistance or external fon: muscle action. It should be suit muscles, but must not be allowe will result. Whatever type of assistance i secure the best possible worm eliminate any muscle work ot:hel desired movement. Thus the me out the movement, and the bod Four examples of different tl here: (a) Lying; flexion of the Hip,
on the spot with high Knee raising, stopping in position on one leg at a given command; (c) Skipping; skip jump with rebound, moving forwards, backwards, right and left, 6 counts in each direction; and (d) Skipping: hopping with a rebound and alternate Knee stretching (Fig. 8).
Fig. 8. Progression in coordination: Skipping-hopping with a rebound and alternate Knee stretching.
Fig. 9. Assisted active exercise: 11
(b) Sitting (chair); elevation pulley circuit (Fig. 10).
3. Assisted exercises
,. :IiBicuIty of maintaining the IbIS used.
hich demand considerable dination. For example: (a) ifarN.uts (Fig. 7); (b) Running
-.1 d
ith alternate Toe placing
1. ASSISTED ACTIVE EXERCISES Assisted active exercises are those performed by the patient with the assistance of the therapist or some outside force, such as a cord and pulley or weight-and-pulley circuit. They are used when the muscles acting on one of the body levers are too weak to bring about movement or to control it adequately. They are also used in the restoration of mobility. The assistance or external force employed is applied in the direction of the muscle action. It should be sufficient to give adequate help to the working muscles, but must not be allowed to exceed this level or a passive movement will result. Whatever type of assistance is used the underlying objective must be to secure the best possible working conditions for the weak muscles and to eliminate any muscle work other than that which is necessary to achieve the desired movement. Thus the moving part must be supported fully through out the movement, and the body stabilized by a sound starting position. Four examples of different types of assisted active movements are given here: (a) Lying; flexion of the Hip and Knee with therapist's assistance (Fig. 9).
IIIIition on one leg at a given
Jt1fling forwards, backwards, , Skipping: lwpping with a
L
in coordination:
: with a rebound littetching.
Fig. 9. Assisted active exercise: flexion ofhip and knee with therapist'S assistance.
(b) Sitting (chair); elevation of the Arm through abduction with cord and pulley ct"rcuit (Fig. 10). 13
14
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
1. AUTO-ASSISTED A ~
active (n:nsiI of the larger joinb
_
,.aM 55 is due to tbicb:a In They are only a f AN»iCi) and are reserved I ~. ,ai..dio:ated in the treaII
~..
.
to,
t
,
•
.-
l
}....
...........
-",.,,~ ",
/
I
L__ ...II
t
J
I I
l-al tracbing and supcn
I I I I I
..
paIk:y circuit, but iu
i-.6:d corirely by the
J
Iw
!il~: Fig. 10. Assisted active exercise with cord and pulley circuit: elevation of arm through abduction. Fig. 11. Assisted active exercise with weight-and-pulley circuit: abduction of shoulder joint.
(c) Stride standing; assisted abduction of the Shoulder joint with weight-and pulley circuit (Fig. II). (d) Sitting on stool or bench in pool (the water level with the top of the shoulders),' buoyancy-assisted abduction of the Shoulder joint (Fig. 12).
n sIIows an autIH
. . die tnce.. FC- I· .... cord. aDd puDc ad IDI paIk:y c:iJ
Fig. 12. Buoyancy-assisted abduction of shoulder joint. (Illustration reproduced from 'Basic hydrotherapy', Physiotherapy (1981), 67, 258-262, by kind per
mission of the author, Anne Golland MCSP, and the Editor of the Journal.)
Progression As the strength of the muscles improves the degree of assistance provided must be gradually diminished.
II'
-
d
.m.: (n:mic:
-.., 2·
... ~
ASSISTED EXERCISES
15
2. AUTO·ASSISTED ACTIVE (TENSION) EXERCISES Auto-assisted active (tension) exercises are used to restore the mobility of some of the larger joints-in particular, the knee and shoulder-where stiffness is due to thickenings and adhesions within the joints and their capsules. They are only employed in the intermediate and late phases of recovery and are reserved for joints which are free from effusion. They are contraindicated in the treatment of elbow injuries. The exercises resemble assisted active movements carried out with a cord and pulley circuit, but include a stressing or tension element which is controlled entirely by the patient. They are extremely valuable, but need careful teaching and supervision.
I
I I I I f I
I I
+
w
ley circuit: elevation of arm
puIIey circuit: abduction of
.JJer joint with weight-and
rr level with the top of the K Shoulder joint (Fig. 12). Fig. 13. Auto-assisted'active (tension) exercise: flexion ofthe knee joint. The cir cuit may be used to restore the range of flexion from 0 to 130°. In practice it has been found best to use the combined circuits shown in Fig. 14 to restore the first 40-60° offlexion. Note the simple device used to raise the head end of the plinth and prevent it moving forwards when the patient is exercising, and the series of hooks arranged on a wall-mounted upright: they allow easy adjustment of the circuit's angle of pull. The foot and ankle straps shown are made from soft leather. Each set consists of a circular foot cuff and adjustable ankle strap. The cuff and strap are connected by a leather 'cord' which carries a free-moving galvanized ring. The ends of the circuit cord are looped through these rings.
iDL. (Illustration reproduced 67, 258-262, by kind per lie Editor of the Journal.)
~
of assistance provided
Fig. 13 shows an auto-assisted active (tension) circuit arranged to assist flexion of the knee. Fig. 14 demonstrates the use of combined weight-and pulley and cord and pulley circuits in the restoration of knee flexion. The simple cord and pulley circuit shown in Fig. 10 can be used to bring about auto-assisted active (tension) movements of the shoulder joint.
Exercise Technique In performing an auto-assisted active (tension) exercise the patient should
16
ASSIST
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
little or no pain; and (c) a range of 5 is complete loss of movement. In performing auto-assisted activ work in the inner part of the first nil is usually small. He should avoid I lCICtions. Indeed, exercising in 1 aretching. Evidence of over-tIa iacreasing pain, and in stationary c
L
!il~ ,lll
Fig. 14. Auto-assisted active flexion of the knee joint: combined cord and pulley and weight-and-pulley circuits. The combined circuits offer a smooth and effective means of restoring the first 60° of flexion. The resistance weight used should be sufficient to counterbalance the lower leg. From the starting position demonstrated the patient flexes the stiff knee joint (R), simultaneously extend ing the sound knee joint (L). The movements must be synchronized so that the cord and pulley circuit is kept under even tension throughout. When the stiff joint reaches the point when assistance is required the patient reinforces the prime mover muscles by a small movement of extension of the sound joint which exerts increased tension on the cord and pulley circuit. Mter 'holding' the final position for a moment the patient allows the resistance weight to extend the stiff knee joint, and slackens off the extensor muscles of the sound knee so that it returns to its original starting position.
adjust the length of the circuit cord, so that it is reasonably taut and therefore responsive to movement. He then moves the affected limb in the required direction, simultaneously moving the other limb in the opposite direction so as to keep the cord taut. When the affected limb enters the stiff painless zone of movement (see below) and reaches the point when assistance is required, the patient endeavours to take the movement still further with the prime mover muscles, and at the same time reinforces them by further tension on the cord with the sound limb. On reaching the painful limit he 'holds' the position for a moment, and then returns the limbs to their starting position by a reversal of the previous movements. Throughout, the exercise should be performed smoothly and fairly slowly.
1. SUSPENSION AND SUPPCl Suspension and supported exercil w:Iopment of weak muscles and tIM indirect assistance to the wodl :md gravity stresses.
.er
&.spension Exercises
III suspension exercises the parts 0 .., canvas slings attached by adjUSll points, so that a certain degree of ell: 1IIis way the body is relieved of I ~ement is attempted on a horizll plinth. Metal or wooden runners fill die suspension unit.
~Fixation
Tbt: overhead attachment point ofl
IIIe joint to be exercised. When IDI -...: horizontal plane, the prime IIlO'II JIIIIt is gravity-free and therefore \111 for varying the type of activity usc:cl 10 assist mobility and promote the slow controlled movements to inc method of arranging axial fixatio :movements of the hip.
Co-axial Fixation Zones of Movement With regard to the tension aspect of the exercises it is worth noting that there are three ranges or zones of movement in a stiff joint: (a) a range of free and painless movement, which is generally the largest; (b) a range of stiffness with
Axial fixation can be modified tc assistance for individual muscle gr cords is then moved to one side 0 muscles of the hip are to be resil
r
ASSISTED EXERCISES
17
little or no pain; and (c) a range of stiffness and pain. Beyond this range there is complete loss of movement. In performing auto-assisted active (tension) movements the patient should work in the inner part of the first range, and through the second range, which is usually small. He should avoid the third range, for it is this that sets up reactions. Indeed, exercising in this zone is the equivalent of forcible stretching. Evidence of over-treatment will be found in swelling and increasing pain, and in stationary or diminishing movement.
IIIIbincd cord and pulley iIs offer a smooth and ~ raistance weight used _ the staning position simultaneously extend I!JIICbronized so that the 1IIghout. When the stiff c .-bent reinforces the .. al the sound joint alit.. After 'bolding' the KIe weight to extend the lie: sound knee so that it
oably taut and therefore :d limb in the required lie opposite directipn so
,
of movement (see required, the patient c prime mover muscles, OIl on the cord with the Ids' the position for a lJOSition by a reversal of ~ should be performed
lODe
Suspension Exercises In suspension exercises the parts of the body to be exercised are supported by canvas slings attached by adjustable-length cords to an overhead point or points, so that a certain degree of elevation is achieved (see Figs. 15 and 16). In this way the body is relieved of the frictional stresses encountered when movement is attempted on a horizontal supporting surface, such as a bed or plinth. Metal or ~ooden runners fitted to the cords ensure easy adjustment of the suspension unit.
Axial Fixation The overhead attachment point of the cords is positioned immediately above the joint to be exercised. When movement is initiated it occurs throughout the horizontal plane, the prime mover muscles being indirectly assisted as the part is gravity-free and therefore weightless. This allows considerable scope for varying the type of activity used-from rhythmical swinging movements, to assist mobility and promote the circulation in the region of the joint, to slow controlled movements to increase muscle strength. Fig. 15 shows the method of arranging axial fixation to promote abduction and adduction movements of the hip.
Co-axial Fixation
MJdb noting that there
:(II) a range of free and
I DOge of stiffness
3. SUSPENSION AND SUPPORTED EXERCISES Suspension and supported exercises are widely used in the early rede velopment of weak muscles and the restoration of mobility. In general, they offer indirect assistance to the working muscles by freeing them of frictional and gravity stresses.
with
Axial fixation can be modified to produce some degree of resistance or assistance for individual muscle groups. The overhead fixation point of the cords is then moved to one side of the joint. For example, if the abductor muscles of the hip are to be resisted, the fixation point is sited over the
18
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
M
it~~~j
i~l:
Fig. 15. Suspension exercise: axial fixation used to promote abduction and
adduction movements of the hip joint. The overhead attachment point of the suspension cords is positioned immediately above the joint.
adductors of the joint; automatically, this causes the lower limb to assume an adducted position when at rest. When the abductors are activated the lower limb rises slightly into abduction (in the form of a pendular movement) with gravity offering resistance. Gravity will also return the limb to the adducted position passively if the abductors are relaxed completely; this can be used as an early form of assisted movement for the adductors. Conversely, if the return movement is con trolled actively the abductors will work excentrically against gravity.
Vertical Fixation The overhead fixation point of the cord and sling unit is positioned directly over the centre of gravity of the part to be supported, Le. over the junction of the upper and middle one-thirds. Vertical suspension has a stabilizing effect on the part supported; move ment is restricted to small-range pendular movements. Because of this, vertical fixation is used to give support rather than to encourage movement (Fig. 16). It is sometimes employed as a means of achieving either local or general relaxation; short tension springs are incorporated into the overhead aspect of the cord and sling unit or units to provide 'buoyancy'.
JIiir- 16. Suspension e:urcisc:; • 61: 1IIJPC!l" arm, while axial SIB ovabead anacbmeDt poiII III: jaioL I_t: radial aspect aI . . . tissues from pressure m'
On occasions, too, tbI: • bed-head, serves as !lllpmtions have the disadva
comprehensive account j lladmiques for the trunk, is
ASSISTED EXERCISES
- - abduction and ~ point of the
.-Iimb to assume an i..m.ted the l~er "'movement) ~ith
I
\
.... pasively if'the ~fOnn of assisted I~t is con aravity .
,r r
~directly ~ the junction of
19
Fig. 16. Suspension exercise: vertical fixation used to provide finn support for the upper ann, while axial suspension promotes movement of the elbow joint. The overhead attachment point of the axial suspension unit is sited directly over the joint. Inset: radial aspect of hand and wrist, showing felt cuff used to protect soft tissues from pressure of self-locking sling.
Suspension Equipment In the physiotherapy department overhead fixation points for suspension work are usually provided by a rectangular-shaped grill of strong 5 cm metal mesh, which is sited over a plinth and roughly approximates to its surface area. The grill is securely fastened to the ceiling joists, with a 1·5 m clearance between plinth top and mesh. Where ceiling fixation is not possible a free-standing tubular steel suspen sion frame (originated by the late Mrs O. F. Guthrie-Smith) can be used in conjunction with a plinth to provide the necessary suspension points. In the ward situation the adjustable overhead cross-bars of the orthopaedic framework of a modem variable-height bed are often used to provide fixation points. On occasions, too, the hook end of a 'monkey pole', securely fastened to the bed-head, serves as a useful fixation point. Unfortunately, both adaptations have the disadvantage of reducing the length of the suspension cords, which restricts the range of movement achieved by the patient. A comprehensive account of all forms of suspension movement, including techniques for the trunk, is included in Hollis's Practical Exercise Therapy (1981).
20
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Progression When axial fixation is used to strengthen weak muscles a natural progression consists of introducing a simple weight-and-pulley circuit to provide the working muscles with graduated resistance. Free exercises of the appropriate grade can be used to supplement this training. They can also be used to provide progression in mobility.
'~I: I!
4. Resis
Supported Exercises Supported exercises take place in the horizontal plane and are -similar to axial suspension movements. The affected part of ilie body is supported by the buoyancy of water, a highly polished re-education board or ball-bearing skates. The prime mover muscles are indirectly assisted by the counter balancing of all gravity stresses. When a polished board is used movement can take place in an oblique plane by tilting the board to the required angle. In this way it is possible to use gravity to give assistance or resistance to the prime movers.
"
Progression By free exercises of the appropriate grade.
REFERENCE Hollis M. (1981) Practical Exercise Therapy, 2nd ed. Oxford, Blackwell Scientific Publications.
II should diminish ......,.....r, so as to coa.i of exerting thf:ir I shorten their foo brief period of COlI
....uica1Iy, weight-aD . . main muscle p ~. it is usually liD: it is more usecl
liM lillg muscles is obta
IItUI'al progression
4. Resisted exercises
lit to provide the of the appropriate
D
also be used to
md are -similar to ly is supported by !I'd or ball-bearing I by the counter-
lace in an oblique 'aJ it is possible to
lOVers.
Blackwell Scientific
Resisted exercises are those in which the prime mover muscles work against the resistance of some outside force. Resistance may be provided by (a) Apparatus: weight-and-pulley circuits, weights, springs and elastic substances; (b) Malleable materials; (c) Water; (d) the Therapist; and (e) the Patient. In applying resistance to muscles four rules must be observed: 1. It must be given smoothly from the beginriing to the end of the movement. 2. Whenever possible it should be applied to the moving part so that it exerts pressure on the surface of the skin facing the direction of the movement. In this way the exteroceptors are stimulated and movement is facilitated. 3. It should diminish gradually from the beginning to the end of the movement, so as to conform to the physiological principle that muscles are capable of exerting their greatest force when they are fully extended, and that as they shorten their force diminishes. 4. A brief period of complete relaxation should follow each muscular effort.
1. WEIGIIT-AND-PULLEY RESISTANCE Theoretically, weight-and-pulley resistance is capable of being applied to any of the main muscle groups, including those of the trunk. In practice, however, it is usually limited to the muscles of the upper and lower limbs: on average, it is more used for the knee extensors than for any other muscle group. With a weight-and-pulley circuit the leverage of resistance decreases as the line of application of the force approaches the fulcrum. In other words, the maximum effect of a given resistance on muscles is obtained when it is arranged at right angles to the long axis of the moving limb; the nearer the force is applied in line with the long axis the less is the resistance offered to the muscles. Figs. 17 and 18 indicate the principle of diminishing resistance as applied to the extensor muscles of the knee. Figs. 18 and 19 show how relaxation for the working muscles is obtained in the starting and finishing positions by the use 21
22
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
F'
POWIII.R.
---:rI1L,J •,
A:
~ a
RESJS1
Fig. 17. To illustrate the principle ofdecreasing resistance as applied to the quadriceps femoris muscle. A = the distance of the force, or line of application of the resis tance, from the fulcrum F. The leverage of resistance decreases as the line of app lication of the force approaches the fulcrum.
:RIIi1""
ill~lil ~I!:ii
':all II
'~!:il
~ "'-'
,
"
c
b
lit!
of a relaxation stop (RS). The stop consists of one of the wooden runners of the lower pulley circuit. Sometimes a rectangular-shaped piece of wood provided with three holes for the cord is employed as a relaxation stop. See inset, Fig. 22, p. 25. When used with very heavy weights, however, this type of stop tends to shift along the cord when it strikes the pulley sheave at the end of a movement.
'
-~--;
\',
, <:~~'~i... :.'
_,_
.;-~-=;;;;:;:;;
Resisted exercise:
e:.r:IaII
,,- 0+. -shaped weight-and-puJIq
..... ~ slighdy backwards, as II . , or foam rubber, is ge:neraIIJ
component of the quad! the last 10 to 20 per cal ~~jnes knee stability, but knee movement (Williams lilt....ification consists of atIlIII: llaposition that it lies immediab as shown in Fig. 21. Th ' _••w.ically increases the resiI
RS
b Fig. 18. Diagrammatic representation of a simple method of applying weight
and-pulley resistance to the quadriceps femoris muscle. RS represents the relaxation stop which frees the muscle from resistance 'pull' in the resting position.
RESISTED EXERCISES
23
illustrate the principle
g resistance as applied
riceps femoris muscle. of the force, or IJication of the resi s L the fulcrum F. The resistance decreases as r application of the aches the fulcrum.
IlUlce
C
lie
wooden runners of
ided with three holes
F~.22,p. 25.VVhen p tends to shift along r. movement.
Fig. 19. Resisted exercise: extension of the knee joint using a simple triangular-shaped weight-and-pulley circuit. The surface of the fixation bench should slope slightly backwards, as shown; in addition a wooden wedge, covered with felt orfoam rubber, is generally used under the thigh. Note the relaxation stop RS.
The triangular-shaped weight-and-pulley circuit for the extensors of the
bee needs a high ceiling (at least 4·2m) for the overhead pulley; otherwise
me patient's
shoulder obstructs the main connecting cord. An alternative of circuit which can be used when the ceiling height is limited is shown ill Fig. 20. It has the disadvantage of needing a third pulley, which increases frictional resistance. Both circuits can be modified to give specific resistance to the vastus medialis component of the quadriceps femoris muscle, which is active throughout the last 10 to 20 per cent of knee extension. Vastus medialis not cnIy determines knee stability, but is particularly responsible for the inner range of knee movement (VVilliams and VVarwick, 1980). The modification consists of attaching an additional pulley to the floor in such a position that it lies immediately beneath the ankle when the knee joint is extended, as shown in Fig. 21. The altered direction of pull achieved in this way automatically increases the resistance offered to the quadriceps action in full knee extension. The disadvantage of the modified circuit is that resistance is offered only throughout the last 30" of knee extension, and the important middle range of movement is neglected. To overcome this difficulty a special piece of _ apparatus (known as the 'Constant-resistance-through-range Apparatus' or type
Lof applying weight :. RS represents the «pull' in the resting
24
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
RESISTED
that if the disc were replaced b resistance could be increased ta. the vastus medialis more, or to i1 as dictated by needs' (Butler_ circuits are 3D groups of the elbow and sb to give resistance to the abd be used to provide resistance fOl' Ihe elevators of the shoulder gin:
-j.11
l~
Fig. 20. An alternative type of weight-and-pulley circuit for the quadriceps femoris muscle. It is used when ceiling height is limited and the triangular circuit cannot be employed.
J;ir. 22. A weight-and-pulley circuit 81: 8DSCles of the shoulder joint. The cin:l ... the muscles of the elbow and the c
Fig. 21. Schematic representation of a simple method ofmodifying a weight-and pulley circuit to give specific resistance to the vastus medialis component of the quadriceps femoris muscle.
'CRTRA') has been designed to give constant resistance throughout the entire range of knee flexion and extension with very low friction. This piece of apparatus formed part of a comparative study of three types of apparatus used for strengthening the quadriceps femoris muscle dynami cally (Butler and Kepson, 1980). The apparatus (consisting of a bench which incorporates a lever system linked by a large wooden disc to the weight load) was found to be effective both for exercise and testing purposes. Trials have
Weight-and-pulley resistance can suspension in providing early groups of the hip joint, in part systems can also be used iI:
RESISTED EXERCISES
25
shown that if the disc were replaced by another shape, for example elliptical, 'the resistance could be increased towards the end of range of quadriceps to work the vastus medialis more, or to increase the resistance at any part of the range as dictated by needs' (Butler and Kepson, 1980). Weight-and-pulley circuits are an effective means of redeveloping the muscle groups of the elbow and shoulder joints. Fig. 22 shows a circuit arranged to give resistance to the abductors of the shoulder. The circuit can also be used to provide resistance for the flexors and extensors of the elbow, and the elevators of the shoulder girdle.
ir
cin::uiI Cor the quadriceps ; ;. 1iIaiIal and the triangular / ,
I
/
Fig. 22. A weight-and-pulley circuit arranged to give resistance to the abductor
~of_' ~
weigh'-""' component of the
!
i
~~oe throughout the
•w:ry low friction.
....ati:ve study of three types
bq. femoris muscle dynami
I (omsisting of a bench which
IOdc:n disc to the weight load)
lISting purposes. Trials have
muscles of the shoulder ;pint. The circuit can also be used to provide resistance for the muscles of the elbow and the elevators of the shoulder girdle.
Weight-and-pulley resistance can be combined most successfully with axial suspension in providing early strengthening exercises for the main muscle groups of the hip joint, in particular the abductors and extensors. The combined systems can also be used in much the same way with the shoulder muscles.
Equipment· Weight-and-pulley circuits can be constructed without much difficulty or expense, as indicated by the examples illustrated here. They can be rigged up in the gymnasium or, preferably, in a special pulley room. In designing or arranging a weight-and-pulley circuit it is important to remember that the patient must not only be able to observe the moving
26
·~illl 'I~
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
weight throughout the exercise but reach it without difficulty, so that he is capable of adjusting the amount of resistance used and feels fully involved in his treatment programme. Both these factors are of considerable psycho logical value. Shaped canvas sandbags with metal eyelets or rings for the weight hook make convenient weights. Bags graded in weight between 125 g and 5 kg are necessary (p. 28). Sometimes metal weights are used instead; they are placed in an open-topped canvas bag equipped with strong metal rings for the weight hook. Using separate lengths of cord over individual pulley sheaves, as shown in Figs. 19 and 22, instead of utilizing one long length of cord for the entire circuit, is economical. When they show signs of fraying and wear, which add to frictional resistance, these short lengths of cord can be replaced quickly by disconnecting the runners. Specialized pieces of weight-and-pulley equipment which provide a variety of resisted movements for different muscle groups are available from a number of manufacturers of physiotherapy equipment. Most are highly priced. The 'Quadriceps Bench' manufactured by the Nottingham Medical Equipment Company has been designed to give resistance to the knee extensors through a leverage system rather than by the employment of a weight-and-pulley circuit. The resistance force is applied to the lower leg by means of a padded cross bar which is attached to a swinging arm fitted with removable weights. The cross bar can be positioned along the arm at any point between ankle and knee. This form of adjustment enables the apparatus to be used after injuries where the stability of the lower third of the tibia does not allow a resistance force to be applied to the ankle region, as is usual.
RESISl
-yw," """""'w a
Fig. 23. Schematic representation cl Ruioris muscle in sitting. The resisa of the knee extension movement becI Iioe of pull of the weight and the III
lying position, it decreases from are made within an arc of 91 la'Pendicu1ar distance between till: decreases, e.g. straight leg rail to the foot, and .fJ.exiou ~ elbow and a dumb-beD I
2. RESISTANCE BY WEIGHTS Resistance by weights is a simple and effective method of strengthening muscles. It is capable of being applied to any of the main muscle groups, but in practice (as with weight-and-pulley resistance) is used chiefly for the muscles of the limbs. The equipment required ranges from metal discs of a known weight, which are employed with weight boots, dumb-bells and barbells, to bags of sand or shot. The weight marked on each bag should represent the combined weight of contents and cover. Weight resistance has the disadvantage that, when it is applied to the muscle groups of the limbs in the standing and sitting positions, it incr:eases from the beginning to the end of all movements made within an arc of 90° from the vertical plane; this is because the perpendicular distance between the line of pull of the weight and the moving joint increases (Fig. 23). On the other hand, when weight resistance is applied to the muscles of the limbs in
wrights are used to provir • loaded weight rod is held i
py
27
RESISTED EXERCISES
difficulty, so that he is IIIld feels fully involved in of considerable psycho
lit
t
,w
,F
,!
I
i
!F POWER
iap for the weight hook I:lWI:liI:D 125 g and 5 kg are .~ they are placed . . . mr:ral rings for the ~ sheaves,
as shown in
l1li f'I cord for the entire
,... . wear, which add _ be Iq)laced quickly by
_which provide a variety . . Be available from a . . . . . Most are highly
N«tingham Medical n:sisDmce to the knee lit' the employment of a !I6:d to the low"er.l~g by ~ arm fitted \Vith.. iId . . . . the arm at any ••ReD.bles the apparatus alhird of the tibia does Ik n:gioo. as is usual.
lie ~
~ of strengthening ~ muscle
I is
groups, but used chiefly for the
~ weight, which •
to bags of sand or the combined weight
lien it is applied to the . . positions, it incr,eases . . within an arc of 90° Iiadar distance between ~ (Fig. 23). On the :lIIIIScles of the limbs in
;
----r--..t··~w i .. 1
I
:
~ I
,
I
w
i
;
'
1 ! ,
'
:
a b c Fig. 23. Schematic representation of weight resistance applied to the quadriceps femoris muscle in sitting. The resistance increases from the beginning to the end of the knee extension movement because the perpendicular distance between the line of pull of the weight and the moving joint increases.
the lying position, it decreases from the beginning to the end of all movements which are made within an arc of 90° from the horizontal plane, because the perpendicular distance between the line of pull of the weight and the moving joint decreases, e.g. straight leg raising through 50° with a loaded weight boot attached to the foot, and flexion of the shoulder joint through 90° with extended elbow and a dumb-bell held in the hand. In applying weight resistance to the muscles of the trunk the saml;' factors hold good. Compare Trunk raising forwards (barbell held at chest level) from fixed lying, and Trunk lowering forwards (barbell held behind neck) from stride standing. In the first example the resistance decreases and in the second it increases .
Equipment When the muscles of the lower limb are exercised a light alloy weight boot (e.g. Variweight boot) is worn on the foot with a short rod positioned in the slots provided in the sole plate; the metal discs are held securely in place on the rod by two collars with adjustable screws. Fig. 24 shows a loaded weight boot in position for the start of resisted knee extension. The weight rod is positioned directly under the ankle. In calculating the weight to be used for resistance it is essential to know both the weight of the boot and straps, and the rod. The Variweight boot and straps weigh 500 g, and the rod and collars 454 g. Although metal rods are obtainable as standard equipment it is cheaper to use short lengths of gas piping. These improvised rods provide extremely strong and lightweight forms of support for the weight discs. The straps and buckles (or Velcro fastenings) securing the weight boot to the foot must be inspected regularly. After considerable use the straps and Velcro grips often fail to hold the boot firmly in place, and must be renewed. When weights are used to provide resistance for the muscles of the upper limb a loaded weight rod is held in the hand; alternatively, a dumb-bell is used.
28
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Resisted trunk movements necessitate either the use of a barbell or a canvas bag (containing sandbag or metal weights) which is positioned on the chest or back and held in place by long straps.
·i!li
RESISTEI
Ia progressing exercises where wei! ...::d the therapist has to bear in min liiKreasing muscle strength and byp and atrophied muscles and ttau comparatively low repetitions US! Jllr:irtraining programmes, although i ~es, have frequently to be modd 1IIm:aful. On the other hand, if the ,.. repetitions at a comparative!] idlievi.ng muscle hypertrophy; the n endurance rather than the develoJ h is difficult, if not impossible, to I all conditions and all phases oj techniques that have been fc
'II
Fig. 24. The starting position for resisted knee extension when a weight boot is used. Some form of support should be employed to relieve the knee ligaments of strain in the resting position: here a wall-bar stool has been used for this purpose. Ideally the surface of the fixation bench should have a slight backward slope, and a wedge-shaped pad should be used under the thigh or thighs.
Canvas-covered sandbags are available in different sizes and shapes; they can also be made up fairly easily. In general, the bags need to be capable of being strapped in position without difficulty. The saddle type of bag, which consists of a firm strip of canvas with slots at either end for weights, is particularly useful. When used for leg exercises from lying (e.g. straight leg raising) it is often modified by the addition of a canvas loop attached to the front edge. In positioning the bag the saddle area is placed over the anterior aspect of the ankle and the loop slipped over the foot. This provides a sound anchorage during movement. Flat, rectangular-shaped PVC-covered sandbags can also be strapped in position without difficulty. In general, the shaped canvas sandbag, with a metal ring or eyelet incorporated into the upper end, is limited to use in activities where it can be suspended easily. Whatever type of bag is used a fairly wide range of weights is necessary, e.g. 125 g, 250 g, 0·5 kg, 1 kg, 2 kg, 3 kg and 5 kg. 'Portabell' weighted bands are sometimes used in place of weight bags, and have the advantage of being extremely easy to apply. The bands incorporate pockets filled with lead shot, and are held in place round a limb with Velcro fastenings. Two weights of band are available: It lb and 2t lb.
to exercise weak muscles. createst weight which they CIIl ..-uDed rate without marked diso as the '10 Repetition M.ui as the 'Minimum Exercise 1 the fuSt,day of treatment exerci~eweight for a peri ba1f-way through the session. 1f2minutes, rests until his musdel for another 2 minutes.
in direct proportion to Ii wa:k.ly to ascertain if it may ....asion in time is brought each day until the patienl ... 15 minutes before the «the rest pause naturally 4
fa barbell or a canvas iooed on the chest or
.... weight boot is ~1Ioec ligaments of IIa:o used for this ~. slight backward liP O£ thighs.
a and shapes; they
IICd to be capable of ~~
of bag, which for weights, is ~ (e.g. straight leg ~ attached to the d over the anterior is provides a sound ~
IIso be strapped in • sandbag, with a I limited to use in
,:iglns is necessary,
ofweight bags, and : bands incorporate a limb with Velcro
Ztlb.
RESISTED EXERCISES
29
STRENGTH PROGRESSION TECHNIQUES In progressing£X~rcises where weight or weight-and-pulley resistance is used the therapist has to bear in mind the fact that although he is aiming at increasing muscle strength and hypertrophy he is dealing in general with weak and atrophied muscles and traumatized joints. The very heavy weights and comparatively low repetitions used by bodybuilders and weight-lifters in their training programmes, although ideal for boosting the strength of normal muscles, have frequently to be modified considerably or they may well prove harmful. On the other hand, if the weights used are kept to a very low figure, with repetitions at a comparatively high level, there is little chance of achieving muscle hypertrophy; the technique will promote the development of endurance rather than the development of strength. It is difficult, if not impossible, to give a foolproof technique of progression for all conditions and all phases of recovery. It is possible, however, to describe techniques that have been found valuable over a considerable period of time.
Early Technique It is safe to exercise weak muscles against an initial resistance of 25 per cent of the greatest weight which they can lift ten times in succession at a normal controlled rate without marked discomfort or fatigue. This ten-times weight is known as the '10 Repetition Maximum' or 'lORM'. The smaller weight is known as the 'Minimum Exercise Weight'. On the first day of treatment the muscles are exercised against the minimum exercise weight for a period of 4 minutes, a brief rest pause being taken half-way through the session. Thus the patient exercises continuously for 2 minutes, rests until his muscles feel capable of exercising again, and then exercises for another 2 minutes. Progression in strength is achieved very gradually by increasing the mini mum exercise weight by 125 or 250 g, when the patient finds that he has grown accustomed to the weight he has been lifting, and the effort no longer tires the muscles to any appreciable extent. Some measure of fatigue is, of course, unavoidable if the weight used is of the degree necessary to achieve muscle hypertrophy. The weight increase is continued in this way until the resistance employed is found to be approximately 50 per cent of the 10 Repetition Maximum (which will also have increased). The minimum exercise weight is then kept at this level until treatment is discontinued, the actual weight used being increased in direct proportion to the 10 RM. This weight must be checked twice weekly to ascertain if it may be increased. Progression in time is brought about by increasing the exercise time by 1 minute each day until the patient is exercising with the minimum exercise weight for 15 minutes before the rest pause, and 15 minutes after it. The length of the rest pause naturally depends on the degree of muscle fatigue.
30
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
101
On occasions it is extremely helpful if two exercise periods are organized daily, provided that they are adequately spaced to avoid undue fatigue. A morning and afternoon session is ideal, although often difficult to achieve. It is important that the patient should be encouraged to participate fully in his training programme. Whenever possible (and this will obviously depend on his intelligence and attitude towards recovery) he should not only be responsible for increasing resistance levels, but keep his own check on the weights used and the number of minutes for which he exercises each day. All this prevents the exercise regime from becoming tedious and automatic. A realistic way of persuading patients to maintain records of their own progress is to install a wall-mounted blackboard in the gymnasium or pulley room for this purpose.
e!!lnl
~III 'ill
~! l
More Advanced Technique When the muscles have reached a satisfactory state of redevelopment a more advanced exercise technique, which combines both power and endurance training, may be used; it can also be used in cases where a more strenuous initial exercise programme can be tolerated. This form of training has the advantage of preparing the muscles for normal working conditions: short periods of activity against maximum stresses and prolonged periods of work against minimum stresses. The technique is much the same as that previously described, with the exception that two sets of lifts with the 10 RM are incorporated into the training schedule. Thus 10 lifts with 10RM Training period with minimum exercise weight, with half-time rest pause. 10 lifts with 10 RM
It is important to note that although the patient may not be able to perform the full number of repetitions during the second set of lifts with the 10 RM he must be prepared to attempt as many lifts as possible. Unless this is done maximum hypertrophy will not result. Expert supervision and care are most important in this type of training. An enthusiastic patient may attempt too much and bring about muscular strain or joint effusion. •
sing the IORM of aD
iii arying out too many di8 EXERCISE TECHNIQUE All movements must be performed in a smooth controlled manner so that the muscles work concentrically, statically and then excentrically. Thus, in strengthening the quadriceps femoris muscle from a sitting position ~ a fixation bench, the patient extends the knee to its full extent, 'holds' it in this
muscles will becoInI:::
impossible to make method of determi
RESISTED EXERCISES
...... are organized ~ 1IIIdue fatigue. A diIicuIt to achieve. .-niciPate fully in abriously depend IIIauId not only be QIIIl cbeck on the laa.eseach day. All .... automatic. "'mldI of their own , ,_ _um or pulley
31
position for a moment, and then allows it to return to the starting position. After a momentary pause the movement is repeated. (See Figs. 19 and 24, pp. 23 and 28.) In exercising the muscles of the limbs it is usual to limit resistance to the affected limb only. When the limbs are equal in strength, however, the sound limb may be exercised against resistance also. In practice this is seldom necessary, because the sound limb will be exercised adequately when other aspects of the patient's rehabilitation programme are carried out--during sessions devoted to specific and general exercises and in recreational activities.
ASSESSING MUSCLE STRENGTII
ibed, with the lllllillPDrlIted into the
lot be able to perform hwiththe 10RMhe ; Unless this is done 1m. and care are most ian may attempt too
L
Idmanner so that the
amically. Thus, in lining position on a 11m,
In redeveloping weak muscles it is important to test periodically the 10 repetition maximum weight of the corresponding sound muscle group, so that the relative weakness of the affected muscle group may be ascertained, and a standard set for the patient to aim at. The result is expressed as a fraction: Left/Right = 9kg/4kg, in the case of a weak right quadriceps femoris muscle. In dealing with the trunk muscles, where this type of comparison is not possible, a known standard is determined by testing out a number of normal subjects. The 10 RM weight of the affected and corresponding sound muscle groups should be recorded twice weekly and plotted as a graph. These tests not only form a reliable guide to progress but are extremely instructive. In addition, the incontrovertible evidence that muscles are becoming stronger is a great encouragement to both patient and therapist, especially in cases where progress is slow. Each time the tests are made the same weight apparatus or weight-and pulley circuit should be used. This is particularly important when using pulley circuits, because the frictional resistance offered by individual pulley sheaves varies considerably. The same precautions apply when weights and weight-and-pulley circuits are used for exercise purposes.
MAKING A TEST In assessing the 10 RM of a muscle group it is important for the patient to avoid trying out too many different poundages before arriving at the correct one. The muscles will become so fatigued by this preliminary work that it will be almost impossible to make an accurate test. A useful method of determining the weight is for the therapist to select a weight which he considers to be a reasonable resistance for the purposes of the test, and then ask the patient to make a small movement against its resistance. In this way the patient can try the effect of the weight on his
32
muscles without using them sufficiently to produce fatigue. If he finds the weight is too much, or too little (bearing in mind a series of ten repetitions), the poundage is adjusted accordingly and the test repeated. When the patient thinks that the correct weight has been found, he tries the ten full movements against it. If the patient and the therapist are satisfied after this that the weight is the right one, no further tests are made. If they are not satisfied with the result, the muscles are allowed to rest until they are ready for exercise again and a further test is made. For assessment purposes a test with a One Repetition Maximum (the greatest weight which can be lifted once only by the muscle group) is sometimes used when muscle development has reached a satisfactory level and there is no danger of irritating a traumatized joint.
.~
RESIS'
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Myometer Recently a hand-held myometer (Fig. 25), which monitors muscle strength, has been developed for clinical use. * Basically, the instrument is a device to measure the peak force applied by the examiner in resisting, and overcoming, the maximum contraction of a muscle group. The force is expressed in kilograms and the instrument has a recording range of 0·1-30,0 kg, which may be seen on the digital readout display.
The myometer head, which Cl .-r:asuring element of a standard PI -=amrmg consists of the de8CC1i the wiper of a conductive II 100000000 operations. To some degree the range of usc ~ of the examiner in resisriD needs to assume an extremely: when testing large mu illllllliriceps femoris. Methods of measuring muscle I :..ometer and strain gauge, were evaluation of voluntary-m1l '~ometer was also the subjcc
Myometer simple myometer designed spell femoris muscle during the ' by Mr J. V. Gough, ~IHospitaL
The myometer has the advanIlIl a rigid frame which is positiOIE F-wable applicator, which makes, to the measuring deviCe. 1 a pressure gauge. Compressi operates the gauge.
Reset Button
- f - - -"'-
TIle resistance training methods I ... those originally formulated by _ pan of a pioneer scheme of ma UK (Nicoll, 1941, 1943). Later, other methods of resista ~iques used by bodybuilder. lime to time. Three main system ..-e in use today: DeLorme ane Osford technique (1951); and M
Myometer Head with Spreader Applicator Fig. 25. A hand-held myometer for monitoring muscle strength.
* Penny and Giles Transducers Ltd., Christchurch, Dorset.
The heavy resistance systems a although they may be used equa
RESISTED EXERCISES . . . . . .1:..
If he finds the
Maximum (the . . muscle group) is a satisfactory level
muscle strength, ...ranent is a device to
",_Unlt
~ Applicator
~ strength.
33
The myometer head, which carries a spreader applicator, utilizes the measuring element of a standard Penny and Giles transducer. The method of m~asUring consists of the deflection of a diaphragm in air; the deflection moves the wiper of a conductive plastic potentiometer with a life expectancy of 100000000 operations. To some degree the range of usefulness of the instrument is limited by the strength of the examiner in resisting the contractions ofthe patient's muscles. He needs to assume an extremely stable position when using the myometer, especially when testing large muscle groups such as the hamstrings and quadriceps femoris . Methods of measuring muscle strength and fatigue, including the use of myometer and strain gauge, were described by Edwards and Hyde (1977). The evaluation of voluntary-muscle function by means of a hand-held dynamometer was also the subject of a paper by Edwards and McDonnell (1974).
Fixed Myometer A simple myometer designed specifically to test the strength of the quadri ceps femoris muscle during the final degrees of knee extension has been designed by Mr J. V. Gough, Director of Rehabilitation, Pinderfields General Hospital. The myometer has the advantage of being firmly stabilized during testing by a rigid frame which is positioned over the patient's lower leg. A padded movable applicator, which makes contact with the upper third of the tibia, is linked to the measuring deviee. This consists of a simple, oil-filled bellows and a pressure gauge. Compression of the bellows during extension of the knee operates the gauge.
OTHER METHODS OF RESISTANCE TRAINING The resistance training methods described in the previous section are based on those originally formulated by Nicoll and Colson over the period 1940-43 as part of a pioneer scheme of medical rehabilitation for injured miners in the UK (Nicoll, 1941, 1943). Later, other methods of resistance training (based on the heavy resistance techniques used by bodybuilders and weight-lifters) were developed from time to time. Three main systems, known by the names of their originators, are in use today: DeLorme and Watkins technique (1951); Zinovieff or Oxford technique (1951); and McQueen technique (1954).
Heavy Resistance Systems The heavy resistance systems are mainly intended for use with weights, although they may be used equally well with weight-and-pulley circuits.
34
RESI
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Common to the three techniques is the 10 Repetition Maximum (10 RM), the maximum weight which can be lifted by the weak muscle group for ten repetitions only. For example, in assessing the 10 RM of a weak quadriceps femoris muscle, the patient assumes a sound starting position on a fixation bench, with a weight boot strapped to his foot, and observes the following schedule. Starting with the weight of the boot and its loading bar, and increasing by small amounts (e.g. 0,5-2,5 kg), he lifts each weight ten times at a normal controlled rate. The weight which requires the maximum muscular effort to perform the ten repetition series of lifts is taken as the 10 RM.
of the number of indi (all with different weigl syKem irritating. The CODSt
IORM resistance is maimaI Thus
ass of lifts. DeLorme and Watkins'Fractional' Technique The 10 RM resistance is increased gradually over 3 sets of repetitions. Thus
4~~1; 'Iii
1st sec 1 2nd sec 3td sec.
4th sec I
1st set: 10 lifts with half 10 RM 2nd set: 10 lifts with three-quarters 10 RM 3rd set: 10 lifts with 10 RM
Thirty lifts are carried out daily, four times a week. Each week the 10RM is progressed.
COMMENT
The system has the advantage of being extremely straightforward and simple to follow. Considerable care is needed in assessing the initial 10 RM or the patient may be disheartened by finding it almost impossible to achieve the final full set of lifts.
ZinoviefJ (Oxford) Technique The 10 RM resistance is decreased gradually over ten sets of repetitions. Thus 1st set: 10 lifts with lORM 2nd set: 10 lifts with 10RM subtracting 0'5kg 3rd set: 10 lifts with 10 RM subtracting 1 kg 4th set: 10 lifts with 10 RM subtracting I· 5 kg 5th set: 10 lifts with 10RM subtracting 2kg 6th set: 10 Jifts with 10 RM subtracting 2'5 kg 7th set: 10 lifts with 10 RM subtracting 3 kg 8th set: 10 lifts with 10RM subtracting 3'5kg 9th set: 10 lifts with 10 RM subtracting 4 kg 10th set: 10 lifts with 10RM subtracting 4·5 kg
A hundred lifts are carried out daily, five times weekly. At each exercise session an attempt is made to progress the 10 RM,
,,- •• u:dmiques I .....,.. In geueral. tbc .....lCDJ'ft'!l'Yafter iDju pIIascs considen linin mel joint II
RESISTED EXERCISES
""'Maimum (lORM),
iIIIl* DBISde group for
ten ~ of. weak. quadriceps ~ position on a fixation ,.. • .ebes the following , - ' - loading bar, and ca:It ..agbt ten times at _lDDimum muscular IIIiD:D .. the 10 RM.
35
COMMENT
Because of the number of individual sets of repetitions which must be followed (all with different weights) many patients and their therapists find the system irritating. The constant changing of weights is also extremely time-consuming.
McQueen Technique The 10 RM resistance is maintained, without addition or subtraction, over four sets of lifts. Thus 1st set: 10 lifts with 10 RM 2nd set: 10 lifts with 10 RM 3rd set: 10 lifts with 10 RM 4th set: 10 lifts with 10 RM
3 leIS of repetitions.
Forty lifts are carried out three times a week. Progression is achieved by attempting to increase the 10 RM every one to two weeks. Ea:h week the 10 RM
COMMENT
The system is straightforward but the overall work load is heavy; the patient needs considerable determination to follow it satisfactorily. As with the DeLorme and Watkins technique care is needed in assessing the initial 10 RM, or overloading of the muscles may result and the patient will experience difficulty in completing the final set of lifts .
......,. .bIe to achieve the
-...H.o-s. 1-5.
3. H.
1r4.
ilrHq ,~.
At each exercise
Other Heavy Resistance Systems A number of other heavy resistance systems have been developed by therapists and physical educationists with specialized experience of weight training. In these systems the RM varies between 1 and 10, with a 6 or 8 RM being common. The number of repetitions and sets of lifts varies also, e.g. 6, 8 or 10. For maximum muscle development six repetitions, in six sets of lifts, is advocated (total of 36 lifts). Many experts in the field of weight training consider that the widely accepted figure of 10 lifts per set could well be replaced by a lower number, and suggest 6 as a useful compromise. They emphasize that the patient's concentration and maximum effort wanes over long lifting sessions .
Limitation of Heavy Resistance Systems Heavy resistance techniques need to be used with considerable care in exercise therapy. In general, they are more applicable to the intermediate and late phases of recovery after injury and disease than to any other stage. Ifused in the earlier phases considerable modification is frequently necessary to avoid muscle strain and joint reaction.
lU!
36
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
3. RESISTANCE BY SPRINGS Springs, rubber elastic strands and various compressible materials, such as Dunlopillo and Sorbo rubber, all possess the property of elasticity and are used to provide different forms of therapeutic resistance.
Long Spiral Springs Long spiral (or long tension) springs, being readily extensible, offer re sistance to the working muscle group as they are stretched, and assistance to the return movement as they recoil. Alternatively, the recoil movement may be controlled by excentric action of the working muscles (Fig. 26).
In general, standard spiral S(l are available in four main weig and 40 lb (1S·1 kg). The weight n:s1stance or poundage offered . ape inside the spring becomes and checks overstretching and When a specific weight of S(l 1he weight required) can be 1 Kquired resistance (Fig. 274: arranged in parallel are equal!
'I~
\ a
Fig. 26. Method of arranging a cord and spring unit to provide resistance for the extensor muscles of the hip in lying. The angle of pull is critical. So also is the weight resistance of the spring used; it must be capable of supporting the lower limb in addition to providing resistance for the hip extensors.
Resistance given by these springs can be extremely useful, but it has two disadvantages. It is not physiologically sound: resistance from springs is always weakest at the beginning of the movement, when the muscles are extended, and strongest at the end of the movement when the muscles are shortened; and it cannot be accurately assessed. The weight resistance of a tension spring depends on the type of material and thickness of wire from which it is constructed and the average diameter of the coils.
Conversely, arranging tw( (Fig. 27b), can be used to provided the springs are eXD its full limit. In practice, the: of linkage can be cumlJen(]
Arranging Spring Resis
In arranging spring resista 1. A stable and cornforUI the resisted movements to 2. The spring must be (J some exercises it must also part (see Fig. 26).
RESISTED EXERCISES
r
It a.b:rials, such as elasticity and are
~
~::Dsible,
offer re .... aod assistance to ~ movement may
37
In general, standard spiral springs are still (1982) graded in pounds. They are available in four main weights: 10 lb (4'5 kg), 20lb (9 kg), 30lb (13'6 kg) and 40 lb (18'1 kg). The weight marked on each spring represents the weight re~tance or poundage offered when it is stretched to its full length. A safety tape inside the spring becomes taut when the predetermined point is reached and checks overstretching and damage to the coils. When a specific weight of spring is not available two springs (each of half the weight required) can be used in parallel combination to provide the required resistance (Fig. 27a). For example, two 30lb (13'6 kg) springs arranged in parallel are equal to a 60lb (27'2 kg) spring.
~(Fig. 26). i
RSisunce for the .... So also is the paning the lower
I.
lid, but it has two ~ from springs is
me muscles are • me muscles are
l
~ type of material aage diameter of
a
b
Fig. 27. Springs arranged in parallel and springs linked in series.
Conversely, arranging two springs of equal 'weight' end-to-end, or in series (Fig. 27b), can be used to produce a spring of half the weight resistance, provided the springs are extended through the range required to extend one to its full limit. In practice, the double length of spring produced by this method of linkage can be cumbersome.
Arranging Spring Resistance
In arranging spring resistance a number of points must be observed:
1. A stable and comfortable starting position must be used which enables the resisted movements to be isolated correctly. 2. The spring must be of the correct weight resistance for the muscles; in some exercises it must also be capable of supporting the weight of the moving part (see Fig. 26).
38
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
3. The positioning of the spring in relation to the moving part requires considerable care. The arrangement used must not only ensure that the spring is slightly stretched at the start of the movement, but offers effective resistance throughout the required range of movement. 4. The connecting links that attach the spring to the fixed point and the moving part must be sufficiently strong to withstand considerable stresses. For many movements, particularly those of a wide range nature, it is necessary to increase the distance between the fixed point and the spring; the link then consists of a suspension cord with a single runner for adjustment purposes. The link between the spring and the moving part consists of a spring loaded hook with swivel and some form of sling; the self-locking 3-ring sling shown in Fig. 26 is widely used. (See also Fig. 16, p. 19.) For some arm movements a handle attached to the spring is used in place of a sling. Other Types of Springs ~al
Short Tension Springs Short tension springs of a high resistance level offer minimum extensibility, and are not used in resistance training. They are sometimes employed in suspension therapy to provide buoyancy when a heavy part ofthe body, such as the pelvis or trunk, has to be supported in sling suspension for a fairly long period of time. The springs are then arranged to form a link between the overhead support and the suspension cords. Small Compressible Springs These springs form the resistance element in the familiar hand grip unit which is used to improve the coarse gripping action of the hand. Another similar device for improving grip consists of a Z-shaped spring made from flat steel. Elastic Strands and Sorbo Rubber Rubber elastic strands of various widths are sometimes u;ed in place of long spiral springs; they are especially useful for providing light resistance. Rubber elastic has the disadvantage of not being particularly durable. Sorbo rubber, being both compressible and extensible, is extremely useful in providing light resistance for improving the gripping action of the hand. Rubber balls and sponges of different shapes and sizes provide useful variations.
Progression of Spring Resistance With spring resistance an accurate and precise progression in strength is not
possible. A very approximab l1li: "weight' of the spring « (+5tg) spring by a 20lb (91 . . . .ed in parallel.
JIaalding putty, day, PIaSI ~ both resistance for 1 for the joints. This type of resistance is I more realistic functional ~p, e.g. stool searinl and woodwork (J ~t, such as planes • work. .Rrmedial games which e Competitive blow K of a syringe to blow oti ~ly useful and popuI the 'players' can b are described and iI 3rd ed.
degree of resistance of!
moved and the rate ( ically necessitates the di increase in resistance. an associated iD ~ce associat$d with in the direction 0
!a
i.mieved by the patient usi the limb through tb holding a paddle or ..wement. This not only il .. the surface area of the ;
RESISTED EXERCISES
Ie IIIIO'ring pan requires " euIy ensure that the .... but offers effective
*III
IIIL
tied point and the mnsiderable stresses. jIIr: mage nature, it is the spring; the ~......::c for adjustment
,....ad
amsists of a
~
spring
'-locking 3-ring sling
.. 19.} For some
ia)llllce ofa sling.
arn~
I
lIlioimum extensibility, om.etimes employed in nan of the body, such pension for a fairly long IrDl a link between the
iani1iar hand grip unit I of the hand. Another iped spring made from
:s uied in place of long iding light resistance. Iicularly durable. b1e, is extremely useful jug action of the hand. I sizes provide useful
Ilion in strengrh is not
39
possible. A very approximate degree of progression is achieved by increasing the 'weight' of the spring or springs employed, e.g. by replacing a 10lb (4·5 kg) spring by a 20lb (9 kg) spring, or increasing the number of springs arranged in parallel.
4. RESISTANCE BY MALLEABLE MATERIALS Moulding putty, clay, Plasticine or wet sand into various simple shapes provides both resistance for the hand muscles and some degree of mobilizing activity for the joints. This type of resistance is limited and often employed as an introductory to the more realistic functional activities provided by an occupational therapy workshop, e.g. stool seating, which provides both narrow and wide grips, printing and woodwork (padded handles being used for some of the equipment, such as planes and sanding blocks), model making and wrought iron work. Remedial games which encourage grip complement these workshop ac tivities. Competitive blow football (necessitating the squeezing of the rubber bulb of a syringe to blowout air to propel a ping-pong ball along a table) is extremely useful and popular. So also is bar football: the handles used to activate the 'players' can be adapted to offer various types of grip. These games are described and illustrated in Wynn Parry's Rehabilitation oj the Hand, 3rd ed.
5. RESISTANCE BY WATER The degree of resistance offered by water depends on the surface area of the part moved and the rate of movement. Increasing the surface area auto matically necessitates the displacement of a larger volume of water and leads to an increase in resistance. Similarly, an increase in the speed of movement produces an associated increase of resistance. This is largely due to the turbulence associat~d with a-more rapid movement, positive pressure being created in the direction of the movement and a negative, or drag force, behind it. In pool therapy, when the body is floating horizontally in the water with buoyancy providing support, it is comparatively easy to enlarge the surface area of a limb by the use of a small float, such as a swim ring or cork or polystyrene block. When. the arm is exercised a simple progression can be achieved by the patient using the flat of his hand (rather than the edge) as he moves the limb through the water. A more advanced progression consists of his holding a paddle or bat, or similar flat object, in the hand during movement. This not only increases the lengrh of the lever but adds effectively to the surface area of the arm.
40
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
When movements are made in a downward direction from a floating horizontal position the upthrust of buoyancy provides resistance. 'The maximum upthrust is experienced when the limb is at right angles to the buoyant force. The effect is reduced the nearer the moving part gets to the vertical. If the range of movement goes beyond 90°, buoyancy will no longer be providing resistance and the movement beyond the vertical becomes buoyancy assisted. Flexion of the hip is an example (Fig. 28a). The starting position is prone lying at the edge of a stretcher or over the exercise bars so that the hip is free. The patient brings the leg downwards and forwards into flexion. Only the first part of the movement (outer-to-middle range for the hip flexors) is resisted by buoyancy. The rest of the movement (middle-to inner range) is assisted. 'Similarly, when doing knee extension, the full effect of the resistance will be felt when the lower leg is horizontal, at right angles to the buoyant force (inner range for the quadriceps) (Fig. 28b). 'The muscle work can be increased in the usual ways, by increasing speed, duration, length of lever and resistance. Extra resistance can be provided by 1GI
a
.mg floats which the patieII *-:r the shape and density a aacises can be devised in t *rapist may well be woIkil It should be noted that dm ~cy minimizes or cane:
lill::sistance by the therapist is or where suitable n: ~lled pressure should b whenever possible, the -.rement. This is especiaD] .Pm; the body weight and advantage. Manual resistance of tim -.ed accurately. It is also amount of resistance D ..,...nred for heavy occupatM In self-resistance the patia example, in high sit:tiDI can be resisted by the r~ movements of the . i..ated successfully by the Self-resistance is obviou t-.:ogth is not possible an
b ~
~~~~~~
Fig. 28. a, Upthrust of buoyancy used as a resistance for the hip flexors from a prone lying position at the edge of a stretcher or over the exercise bars. Only the first part of the movement (outer to middle range for hip flexors) is resisted by buoyancy. The rest of the movement is assisted. b, Buoyancy used as resistance for the knee extensors: same starting position as described in Fig. 28a. The full effect of the resistance is felt when the lower leg is horizontal, at right angles to the buoyant force (inner range for quadriceps). (Illustrations reproduced from 'Basic hydrotherapy', Physiotherapy (1981),67,258-262, by kind permission of the author and the Editor of the JournaL)
P. and Kepson G. (19E
due types of apparatus fix ally. PhysiotJrerapy 66, 82~ Dd.onne T. L. (1945) RestOG BtaeJoint Surg. Z7, 646-66'
Dd.onne T. L. and Watkins A
Arch. Phys. Med. Z9, 263-Z: Dd.onne T. L. and Watkins J ~ Medirol Applicatio1l. Nc DidtF. W. (1968) A review of 4,35-41.
RESISTED EXERCISES
from a floating taistance. 'The right angles to the ~ part gets to the /ImCY will no longer e ~ becomes . 2&). The starting die exercise bars so laud forwards into IiiddIe range for the IaDent (rniddle-to 1m 5
r. resistance will it. buoyant force !J increasing speed,
em be provided by
lap flexors from a :De bars. Only the .-s) is resisted by - t as resistance Fir. 2&. The full • right angles to n:produced from iad permission of
41
using floats which the patient has to push down into the water. These floats alterthe shape and density of the moving part. Very powerful strengthening exercises can be devised in this way, but instability is the problem, and the /therapist may well be working as hard as the patient, to hold him down.'* It should be noted that during upward return movements to the horizontal buoyancy minimizes or cancels out much of the resistance .
6. MANUAL RESISTANCE Resistance by the therapist is useful in cases where the muscles are extremely weak or where suitable resistance apparatus is not available. Smooth controlled pressure should be applied by the hand throughout the movement and, whenever possible, the therapist's stance should be in the line of the movement. This is especially important when moderate or strong resistance is given; the body weight and the thrusting action of the legs can then be used to advantage. Manual resistance of this type has the disadvantage that it cannot be assessed accurately. It is also not possible for the therapist to give or maintain the amount of resistance necessary to strengthen muscles to the degree required for heavy occupations. In self-resistance the patient resists his own movements with a sound limb. For example, in high sitting, with the ankles crossed, the extensors of one knee can be resisted by the weight and pressure of the other leg. Similarly, various movements of the wrist, elbow and shoulder of one limb can be resisted successfully by the hand of the opposite limb. Self-resistance is obviously extremely limited. Accurate assessment of strength is not possible and only a relatively few muscle groups can be treated.
REFERENCES Butler P. and Kepson G. (1980) Quadriceps strengthening: a comparative study of three types of apparatus for strengthening the quadriceps femoris muscle ,dynami cally, Physiotherapy 66, 82-85. DeLorme T. L (1945) Restoration of muscle power by heavy resistance exercises. J. Bone Joint Surg. 27, 646--667. DeLorme T, L and Watkins A. L. (1945) Technics of progressive resistance exercises. Arch. Phys. Med. 29, 263-273. DeLorme T. L and Watkins A. L (1951) Progressive Resistance Exercises: Technique and Medical Application. New York, Appleton-Century-Crofts. Dick F. W. (1968) A review of recent studies pertaining to strength. Br.J, Sports Med. 4,35--41.
* This
description and the accompanying illustrations are taken from 'Basic hydro therapy' (Physiotherapy, Sept., 1981) by Anne Golland, MCSP.
42
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Edwards R. H. T. and Hyde S. (1977) Method of measuring muscle strength and fatigue. Physiotherapy, 63, 51-55. Edwards R. H. T. and McDonnell M. (1974) Handheld dynamometer for evaluating voluntary muscle function. Lancet 2, 757. Nicoll E. A. (1941) Rehabilitation of the injured. Br. Med. J. 1,501-506. Nicoll E. A. (1943) Principles of exercise therapy. Br. Med. J. 1,747-750. McQueen I. (1954) Recent advances in the technique of progressive resistance exercises. Br. Med. J. 2, 1193--1198. Websters B. M. (1982) Factors influencing strength testing and exercise prescription. Physiotherapy 68, 42--44. Williams P. L. and Warwick R. (1980) Gray's Anatomy, 36th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone. Wynn Parry C. B. (1973) Rehabilitation of the Hand, 3rd ed. London, Butterworths. Zinovieff A. (1951) Heavy resistance exercises: the Oxford technique. Br. J. Phys. Med. Ind. Hyg. 14, 129.
1111 '~
2
section describes a nUll the early stages of mol positioning and movioa designed to COl and directions. For and from standing
ring muscle strength and
2
iIIImOmeter for evaluating ,. I. 501-506. 1'. 1.141-150. ~ progressive resistance ad exercise prescription.
,. 36th ed. Edinburgh,
Loodon, Butterworths. a:dmique. Br. ]. Phys.
/
FUNCTIONAL MOVEMENTS This section describes a number of basic functional movements which are used in the early stages of mobilization and re-education. They are concerned with positioning and moving in bed and on the floor. They also include manreuvres designed to enable patients to move safely through various positions and directions. For example, from lying to sitting, from sitting to standing, and from standing to floor level.
43
5. Movements on the bed or floor
MOVING ON THE BED FROM SUPINE LYING Moving Towards the Head of the Bed
I...... i
I
I
The mana:uvre is usually carried out from crook lying. The patient raises the pelvis off the supporting surface to the low Bridge position by extension of the hips and spine combined with down-pressure from the arms and shoulder girdle. The body is then moved horizontally towards the head of the bed by a strong thrusting movement from the soles of the feet. This action is often associated with extension of the neck. In clinical practice, when it is not possible to use both legs, the mana:uvre is modified by changing the starting position. The patient flexes the hip and knee of the sound leg until the knee is bent to about 90 with the sole of the foot resting flat on the bed; at the same time he flexes the elbows to a right angle (Fig. 29a). He then raises the pelvis off the supporting surface to the low Bridge position by a strong movement of extension of the flexed hip and spine combined with down-pressure from the arms and shoulder girdle (Fig. 29b). Strong pressure on the sole of the foot of the bent leg then helps to propel the body horizontally towards the bed head, as previously described . 0
.......J /'....
L
nu
...
nm~n b
a Fig. 29.
Moving Down the Bed
I, ..... J I
The patient assumes the crook lying position with the elbows flexed to about 90 c (Fig. 30a). As a preliminary movement he arches the spine strongly with the pelvis remaining on the bed. He then presses down firmly with elbows and head and raises the pelvis slightly clear of the supporting surface (Fig. 30b). He eases the pelvis downwards towards the heels in a relatively small range movement. The active muscles are then relaxed smoothly and the pelvis lowered on to the bed. This sequence of movements is repeated.
45
46
~ ......................~ ...
IIIInds facing downwards. This a 5Drting position (Fig. 3Ia).
a
The pelvis is then raised clear .. the hips and thoracolumbar ' position (Fig. 3Ib).
......
b Fig.30.
In practice, if it is not possible for the patient to flex both legs in the starting position, the manreuvre can be carried out successfully using one leg only.
Moving Across the Bed
111~ "111
MOVEMENl
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
I+-I
The patient takes up the crook lying position with the anns slightly away from the sides and the palms of the hands resting on the bed. He raises the pelvis off the supporting surface (low Bridge position: Fig. 30b) and eases it sideways in the required direction. He then lowers the pelvis on to the bed, allows the legs to straighten out, and adjusts the alignment of the upper trunk and head. It is possible to carry out this manreuvre with one leg in a crook position. When moving to the side of the straight leg it is advisable to place this limb into an abducted position, so as to avoid adduction stresses at the hip during the sideways movement. This is particularly important in the postoperative care of a total hip replacement.
Rolling on to the Left Side
IL~ I
The patient flexes the hip and knee of the right leg until the knee is bent to about 90°, with the sole of the foot resting flat on the bed; the left leg is straight and the left hand grasps the side of the bed with the arm slightly abducted. A simultaneous movement of strong head turning to the left, right arm stretching across the chest-with a finn thrust from the right foot-helps to rotate the whole of the trunk and pelvis to the left. In this position the flexed right leg lies over the straight left leg. To stabilize the body the left leg is then flexed to the same degree as the right. The patient is then in a modified crook side lying position. In this posture considerable pressure is exerted on the left shoulder, and some patients, particularly the elderly, may experience considerable discom fort. To avoid this the right hand can be used to press down on the bed and help to manreuvre the arm and shoulder into a comfortable position.
Assuming Bridge Position
~
The patient flexes the knees to 90 0 with the soles of the feet resting on the bed; the legs are slightly astride with the inner borders of the feet about a foot breadth apart. The anns are slightly away from the sides with the palms ofthe
.....
~. a
The position is widely used J lIal-pan and attention to press1l widely used as a preliminary JIl1:Viously described. In certain clinical conditions 11K: crook position the bridgil crooked. The starting position i daring movement manual supp llattocks. Another method ofP
To roll to the left from supim die left; he then brings the k ..u:es contact with the outer si 1D 90° with the ~1&ow extendec swung vigorously across the ' lDIDed strongly to the left ant At the end of this manreuvr die left thigh and the right 2 pient then arches the spine ~ ..,sition. If the patient finds it difficul _ indicated here, a series of s em be made with the arm IDOvement which carries the Another method of rolling die left head post of the be< IDOvements with a strong pU: In the initial stages of ro 1herapist stands at the side 0 N.B. It is important to no patient must be positioned s
MOVEMENTS ON THE BED OR FLOOR
~---II::K both legs in the IIfulIy using one leg
47
hands facing downwards. This arrangement oflegs and arms ensures a stable starting position (Fig. 31a). The pelvis is then raised clear of the supporting surface by strong extension of the hips and thoracolumbar spine with associated knee extension: Bridge position (Fig. 31b).
.....~ ................. ~ .... a b Fig. 31.
slightly away =bed. He raises the ir·3(6) and eases it dYis on to the bed, tof'the upper trunk IDDS
ill a crook position. e to place this Jimb !II at the hip a.~ring • the postoperative
the knee is bent to bed; the left leg is :h the arm slightly IIg to the left, right II! right foot-helps
lIight left leg. To Icgree as the right.
Do
left shoulder, and lliderable discom III on the bed and Ie position.
rating on the bed; feet about a foot :h the palms of the
The position is widely used for various nursing procedures, e.g. giving of bed-pan and attention to pressure areas. In a modified form (low Bridge) it is widely used as a preliminary to a number of functional movements, as previously described. In certain clinical conditions when it is not possible to utilize both legs in the crook position the bridging manreuvre can be achieved with one leg crooked. The starting position is then somewhat unstable. To count~ract this during movement manual support can be provided under the lumbar spine or buttocks. Another method of providing stability is to support the straight leg with a firm pillow .
Rolling froIn Supine to Prone Lying
ffS]
To roll to the left from supine lying the patient crosses the right ankle over the left; he then brings the left arm close to the left side so that the palm makes contact with the outer side of the thigh. The right shoulder is abducted to 90" with the elbow extended and the palm facing upward. The arm is then swung vigorously across the chest to the left. Simultaneously, the head is turned strongly to the left and the trunk follows the movement. At the end of this manreuvre the patient lies prone with the left arm under the left thigh and the right arm, with elbow flexed, under the chest. The patient then arches the spine slightly and brings the arms into a comfortable position. If the patient finds it difficult to achieve prone lying in one main movement, as indicated here, a series of small range rocking movements towards the left can be made with the arm and trunk. They culminate in one definite movement which carries the patient over into prone lying. Another method of rolling over to the left consists of the patient grasping the left head post of the bed with the right hand, and assisting the trunk movements with a strong pulling action. In the initial stages of rolling, manual assistance is often helpful. The therapist stands at the side of the bed to which the movement is made. N.B. It is important to note that at the start of the rolling procedure the patient must be positioned so that when he assumes the prone position his
48
MOVEMEN'l
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
body is fully supported by the bed and there is no likelihood of his falling over the edge.
X.B. Seat lifting is widely use lime in wheelchairs and an The lifting is done iI to accomplish the moveDJI
MANffiUVRES ON THE FLOOR OR BED Seat Lifting (to relieve the buttocks of body pressure)
~
The patient assumes the long sitting position with the trunk inclined slightly backwards and the palms of the hands resting on the supporting surface with the fingers pointing outwards. He then lowers the trunk backwards a few degrees and raises the seat clear of the floor or bed by strong extension of the hips, the hands and heels carrying the total body weight (Fig. 32). The seat is then returned to its original position by a reversal of the previous movements.
_~_L""
••••••
a
~._
... _.
IliraYeUing': a simple methl
,,,,.,.uung' Forwards ...... -+ patient assumes a modif'icl _-breadth apart, the trunk iII flat on the supporting S1l He then lifts the seat ck:: ~eously carrying it fora knees (Fig. 34b). He then I "position the seat is situated well flexed, and the trunk i
b
1l1li
Fig. 32.
"I
Seat lifting can also be carried out from the standard long sitting position with the trunk vertical and the arms by the sides. In this case it is easier if the hands are clenched and the weight is taken chiefly on the proximal phalanges. When seat lifting is carried out on a bed or soft mat (where the supporting surface will yield to hand pressure) it is advisable to use a pair of hand grips mounted on rectangular wooden bases (Fig. 33).
~
--~
..... -.-.--
a
To progress along the floor distance. He then moVe3 the original starting posit of movements is repeaD
"TN!lJelling' Backwards .:!=...: is achieved in much til !-we:ment starts by the patic rliKkward direction. He thera -.,yes it back towards the at! 1Ial. Finally, the feet are m -nng position is assumed.
"Travelling' Sideways \. .]
Fig. 33. Seat lifting is facilitated by the use of a pair of platform mounted hand
grips.
The patient assumes a modi! die trunk inclined backwards die hands rest on the suppoI1 To move, for example, to t
49
MOVEMENTS ON THE BED OR FLOOR
DOd of his falling over
N.B. Seat lifting is widely used by patients who have to spend long periods of time in wheelchairs and armchairs to relieve the buttocks of constant pressure. The lifting is done intermittently, the hands grasping the chair arms to accomplish the movement.
.-n:>.i
'Travelling': a simple method of moving the body over a support ing surface
I1IDk inclined slightly ppotting surface with . . backwards a few IftlDg extension of the ~(FW. 32). The seat is pn:v:ious movements.
~.- .....
llong sitting position cae it is easier if the ~proximal phalanges. ~ the supporting r a pair of hand grips I
Ifixm mounted hand
-+ -+
The patient assumes a modified crook sitting position with the feet about a foot-breadth apart, the trunk inclined backwards and the palms of the hands resting flat on the supporting surface with the fingers pointing outwards (Fig. 34a). He then lifts the seat clear of the bed or floor by extending the hips, simultaneously carrying it forwards towards the heels by flexion of the hips and knees (Fig. 34b). He then lowers the seat to the supporting surface. (In this position the seat is situated some distance in front of the hands, the knees are well flexed, and the trunk is inclined further back.) (Fig. 34c.)
..~... _.. _ . h1____ . _.lvL.. a
c
b
Fig. 34.
To progress along the floor or bed the patient places each foot forwards a short distance. He then moves the trunk and arms in the same direction, so that the original starting position is assumed. To cover a wider distance the series of movements is repeated.
'Travelling' Sideways
1. . . 1
The patient assumes a modified long sitting position with the feet together, the trunk inclined backwards with the arms away from the sides; the palms of the hands rest on the supporting surface with the fingers pointing outwards. To move, for example, to the left, the patient leans back slightly and raises
50
MOV!
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
the seat clear of the floor or bed, so that the body weight rests entirely on the heels and hands. Simultaneously, he moves the pelvis over to the left. He then lowers the seat to the supporting surface, and moves first the hands with the trunk, and then each foot separately, to the left. To cover a wider distance this series of movements is repeated. N.B. To avoid pressure on the heels 'travelling' sideways can be carried out from a modified crook sitting position. See 'Travelling' forwards.
MOVEMENTS AT FLOOR LEVEL Moving from Sitting on Floor to Sitting on Low Stool
~
1111
-.~~
.......
~
...
~
..
a b c Fig. 35.
He then parts the legs slightly and flexes the hips and knees as far as possible with the soles of the feet resting on the flo~r, each leg being moved in tum. Then, with a strong movement of extension of the arms, reinforced by extension of knees and hips, he lifts the body upwards and backwards so as to bring the buttocks on to the front edge of the stool (low grasp inclined long sitting position) (Fig. 35c). From this position he flexes each knee in tum to about 90°, inclines the trunk slightly forwards, and eases the seat back on the stool to a better sitting position (by extension of knees and downward pressure through the straight arms). The hands, in tum, are then moved backwards to a more comfortable position on the stool.
Assuming Standing from Prone Kneeling with Use of Chair
~
From prone kneeling (p. 268) with a chair positioned so that the front edge of the seat is close to the head (Fig. 36a), the patient first places the palm of each hand on the chair seat. He extends the elbows fully so that the trunk is raised backwards to an oblique position. He then moves one leg forward so that the hip and knee are well flexed and the sole of the foot rests on the floor (Fig. 36b).
(Fig. 36c).
.bj:::L..
a
The patient assumes a long sitting position (p. 267) with the spine in contact with the front edge of a stool, 20-25 cm high, positioned behind him. He moves the arms backwards and places the palms of the hands on either side of the stool top, close to the front edge, so that the elbows are well flexed and the shoulder joints fully extended. Fig. 35a-b.
«
The body is then raised legs and arms, the toes oft to the movement. In the p over the chair seat, with d leg fully extended. The rei
The rear leg is now am The trunk is then raised t1
MOVEMENTS IN PR()
Although many individual mobility, find prone lyiIq length of time, it is undoub a stable starting position, fj trauma. Similarly, it allow. with the lower legs maina reducing oedema. In addition, prone lyi movemen~s to be carried assuming.:prone kneeling. 1 forwards in a series of 'WI
Arching Arching movements of til forearm support position ( downward at shoulder Ie degree of elbow extension the movements (Fig. 37a) A wider range of spinl achieved by placing the mid-chest level. The eU)01 (Fig. 37b).
.---~--------
Itt rests entirely on the
ftr to
the left. He then irst the hands with the ~
51
MOVEMENTS ON THE BED OR FLOOR
is repeated.
IIlIJS can be carried out ~
The body is then raised upwards by a strong thrusting movement of both legs and arms, the toes of the rear foot being dorsiflexed to give added thrust to the movement. In the position reached in this way the arms are vertically over the chair seat, with the trunk more or less horizontal, and the forward leg fully extended. The rear leg, slightly flexed at the knee, rests on the toes (Fig. 36c).
forwards.
rStoolJ.
c
Fig. 36.
.. the spine in contact ...m behind him. He IIIIads on either side of ~ well flexed and the
The rear leg is now carried forwards and placed alongside the other one. The trunk is then raised to the vertical.
MOVEMENTS IN PRONE LYING ON BED OR MAT
I lI1ld knees as far as dJ. leg being moved in Ie arms, reinforced by ad backwards so as to .. grasp inclined long s each knee in turn to IS the seat back on the IDees and downward wrn. are then moved L
JseofCbair
6
a
J.
ullat the front edge of !laces the palm of each hat the trunk is raised Ie leg forward so that bot rests on the floor
.=
Although many individuals, particularly the elderly and those with limited mobility, find prone lying an uncomfortable position to maintain for any length of time, it is undoubtedly extremely useful in clinical practice. It forms a stable starting position, for example, for encouraging knee flexion following trauma. Similarly, it allows ankle and foot movements to be performed freely with the lower legs maintained in the verticaL This is particularly useful in reducing oedema. In addition, prone lying not only allows a range of spinal arching movements to be carried out, but forms a natural introductory step to assuming prone kneeling. From prone lying the body can also be manreuvred forwards in a series of 'wriggling' movements. Arching Arching movements of the spine can be facilitated by placing the arms in forearm support position (arms to sides, elbows fully flexed and palms facing downward at shoulder level). The movements are associated with a small degree of elbow extension, the forearms and palms providing a firm base for the movements (Fig. 37a). A wider range of spinal arching, combined with hip extension, can be achieved by placing the palms of the hands by the sides of the trunk at mid-chest level. The elbows are then extended fully during the trunk arching (Fig. 376).
.-.-~ a
.. - .. -.- ...
~ 6
Fig. 37.
-.---.- ....
~.c
..
52
MOV1!Ml
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
The palms may also be moved forwards until they are in line with the head. Full elbow extension is then associated only with spinal extension (Fig. 37c). Arching is useful in the treatment of postural kyphosis and round shoulders. It is also valuable in the early mobilization of young adults who have spent considerable periods of time in bed following various onhopll!dic procedures, e.g. fractured shaft of femur treated conservatively with Thomas's splint and traction.
.. ,.
)iI~
#i~ ~
.
C
•
f.I
Assuming Prone Kneeling With the arms in forearm support position (see Arching) the trunk is moved backwards mainly by strong pressure from the arms (full elbow extension with shoulder flexion) combined with flexion of the hips and knees. To bring the arms into the vertical position the hands are 'walked' backwards to the required degree (Fig. 38a-c).
-~_. a
____ LL. ___ .~ __
b Fig. 38.
c
Leopard Crawl ('Creeping') This is a somewhat complex and strenuous method of propelling the body in a forward direction along the bed or mat, using a contralateral pattern of movement. It is carried out from a modified forearm support position with the upper arms venical and the forearms resting on the supporting surface; the hands may be clenched, which is preferable, or the palms may face downward. The movement starts by the right arm being moved forwards a short distance while the head and trunk are turned to the left. At the same time the left knee is drawn up through 90°, with the inner aspect making contact with the supporting surface. The body is then propelled forwards by a strong levering movement of the right arm (which acts as a prop for the trunk) combined with a thrusting movement from the flexed left leg. To continue the forward progression the same pattern of movement is repeated with the other arm and leg. This method of progression in prone lying is often beyond the physical capabilities of many elderly and disabled individuals. A similar but less strenuous method of progession consists of a 'wriggling' type of manreuvre.
'Wriggling' This consists of propelling the body in a forward direction along the bed or mat. The patient moves in a wriggling motion with the arms in forearm
support position (see ArchiD plantar surfaces of the toe populsive action is acbie'¥' pressure from the toes), folIO!
MOVEMENTS ON THE BED OR FLOOR De
with the head.
l!IISion (Fig. 37,).
IOSis and round oung adults who nous orthopredic servatively with
c trunk is moved dhow extension Iknees. To bring .awards to the
~.-
:mng the body in lateral pattern of on: position with pporting surface; palms may face
fOrwards a short he same time the : making contact If forwards by a rap for the trunk) leg. To continue q>eated with the
IJIld the physical similar but less pc of manreuvre.
along the bed or in forearm
IIlDS
53
support position (see Arching) and the ankles fully dorsiflexed, so that the plantar surfaces of the toes rest on the supporting surface. The main propulsive action is achieved by alternate hip updrawing (with strong pressure from the toes), followed by alternate elevation of the shoulder girdle.
MOVING FROIil
6. Moving from sitting and standing
MOVING FROM SITTING TO FLOOR LEVEL
•
1
.-t
The patient sits on a low stool, 20-25 cm high, with the legs stretched out in front of him and with the heels resting on the floor; the hands grasp the sides of the stool (low grasp inclined long sitting) (Fig. 39a). Taking the weight on his hands he eases the pelvis slightly forwards and lowers it on to the floor with the trunk held erect (Fig. 39b). During this mana:uvre the knees and hips are well flexed, and the main muscle work is confined to the extensors of the elbows .
_L___~ a
b
_ __
Fig. 39
From the position shown in Fig. 39b the legs are then straightened out and the palms of the hands placed on the floor (long sitting). N.B. The use of a stool or chair higher than that recommended prohibits the use of this mana:uvre because of the demands made on the working muscles and the stresses imposed on the shoulder joints and shoulder girdle.
MOVING FROM STANDING TO FLOOR LEVEL
.-t
Hands Supported on Chair Seat The patient faces the front of a chair seat with his feet about a foot-length away from the front edge. He places the palms of the hands flat on the seat so that the trunk assumes a horizontal position. He then carries one leg backwards and places the foot on the floor with the ankle dorsiflexed (Fig.40a).
The body is lowered downwards until the patient is in a modified half kneeling position (Fig. 40b). The forward leg is then carried back until it lies alongside the other; this brings the patient into the kneeling position with the palms of the hands resting on the chair seat (Fig. 40c). 54
From this position the patient I right knee. The body is m lland to assume a right side sinD RSting on the chair seat. This bII me left lower leg.
1D the
c-fl_= ___/\_D._--. . b
a
From side sitting a variety of (I 8ting, crook sitting, crook side N.B. The back of a chair can a .........;na (see belO'W). It is less sul the patient to keep 11
Grasping Chair Bad patient grasps the back of I body positioned as shown in me weight of the rear leg [1
_ di _ _ _ _ a
J b
Taking most of the body weigi modified half-kneeling positill !llllckwards until he is in the mo back. The pelvis is then • heels (Fig. 41c). The right hand is taken oft' 1 to the right knee. The bo to assume a right-side sin the chair back to provid die floor by the side of the I From side sitting many other
MOVING FROM SITTING AND STANDING
g and
55
From this position the patient places the right hand on the floor, just lateral the right knee. The body is then lowered sideways in the direction of the iand to assume a right side sitting position (p. 267), with the left hand still RSting on the chair seat. This hand is then placed on the floor by the side of die left lower leg. II)
_ AB _____ ~_ _ _1H
ELJ..
a
lie legs stretched out in Ie bands grasp the sides I. Taking the weight on IIWeI'S it on to the floor lIO:UVre the knees and Bed to the extensors of
c
b
Fig. 40.
From side sitting a variety of other positions may be readily assumed: long sitting, crook sitting, crook side-lying, prone kneeling and prone lying. N.B. The back of a chair can also be used to give support during the body lowering (see below). It is less stable than the chair seat but has the advantage of allowing the patient to keep the spine erect during the initial stages of the movement.
Hands Grasping Chair Back The patient grasps the back of a chair (which must have a stable base) with the body positioned as shown in Fig. 41a. The arms are shoulder-width apart and the weight of the rear leg rests on the toes. I. straightened
out and
1&>.
commended prohibits III8de on the working I and shoulder girdle.
_ _cd____ dSL-----rU_
a
b
c
Fig. 41.
II
about a foot-length
baods flat on the seat
fIe then carries one Ihe ankle dorsiflexed
is in a modified half Iricd back until it lies ling position with the
Taking most of the body weight on the hands the patient lowers the body to a modified half-kneeling position (Fig. 41b). He then moves the forward leg backwards until he is in the kneeling position with the hands still holding the chair back. The pelvis is then lowered backwards until the buttocks rest on the heels (Fig. 41c). The right hand is taken off the chair back and placed on the floor, just lateral to the right knee. The body is lowered sideways in the direction of the hand to assume a right-side sitting position (p. 267), with the left hand still holding the chair back to provide a steadying effect. This hand is then placed on the floor by the side of the left lower leg. From side sitting many other positions may be assumed, as outlined in the previous section.
56
MOVING FROM SITTING TO STANDING ~ Sitting in Chair with Arms From the sitting position the patient places the hands well forward on the chair arms and draws the heels slightly back to bring them underneath the front edge ofthe chair. The hands then grip the chair arms and the trunk is inclined slightly forwards (Fig. 42a). The elbows are now extended and at the same time extension of the hips and knees takes place, the inclined position of the trunk being maintained. During this movement the hands take the weight of the trunk (Fig. 42b).
.\ 'fli
MOVINGFR
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
~-----~-b
a
Fig. 42.
Use of Chair The rising movements can be bead of the bed, as shown in E presses down strongly on the : am nearest to him with the 01
N.B. With the patient SlaD n:quires the minimum of effor1 so that he comes to stand witb (During this re-positioning be other.) The patient can n01ll assist in the lowering process.
When the body weight is fully over the feet (by continuous extension of hips and knees) the hands are removed from the chair and the arms are allowed to hang loosely at the sides. The patient is then in standing. N.B. For the elderly and the disabled chairs with arms are essential. They can then help themselves to stand by using their hands and arms, as previously described. The base of the chair should be as wide and stable as possible to prevent tipping when the patient endeavours to stand.
*
Sitting in Chair without Arms Moving from sitting to standing is achieved in much the same manner as previously described, but the patient starts by having the palms of the hands resting over the lower thighs. In rising he exerts downward pressure on the thighs. For the elderly and the disabled getting up from a chair without arms can be a somewhat precarious manreuvre. Much depends on the physical ability of the individual concerned.
The patient stands on the fl(XJ llmister rail; the toes are close To ascend the stairs the sou 1Idl forwards on the first trc .,vement weight is taken on provides additional support.) ixwards, the weight being tali; Ibe hand on the banister conti The sound limb is then strai position. At the same time tb mee) and the foot placed on tb The same stair-climbing tc
Sitting over Side of Bed To achieve standing from this position the height ofthe bed must allow the patient to sit comfortably with the thighs fully supported, the feet resting flat on the floor, and the knees flexed to a right angle. The actual rising technique is the same as described in the previous section (Sitting in Chair with Arms), but the patient's hands either rest on the mattress or are placed over the lower third of the thighs. Handgrips mounted on rectangular-shaped boards (see Fig. 33, p. 48) may be used to prevent the hands sinking into the mattress as downward pressure is exerted.
~
I
• Preparatory Method. The siD IISed when the weakness of one leg ammal manner. The same basic I ~ full weight-bearing on the WC! ill stair work are outside the scop
MOVING FROM SITTING AND STANDING
lid! forward on the IIan underneath the lIDS and the trunk is rcdalded and at the ~iDdined position of .ads take the weight
57
Use of Chair The rising movements can be aided by positioning a chair with arms at the head of the bed, as shown in Fig. 43. In getting up from the bed the patient presses down strongly on the mattress with one hand, and grasps the chair arm nearest to him with the other, so as to gain additional support.
Fig. 43.
tinuous extension of .. and the arms are l in standing. I are essential. They IIIDds and arms, as I wide and stable as I to stand.
N.B. With the patient standing with one hand holding the chair arm it requires the minimum of effort to manreuvre the feet and body through 90°, so that he comes to stand with his back towards the front edge of the chair. (During this re-positioning he has to transfer his grasp on one chair arm to the other.) The patient can now assume a sitting position, using both hands to assist in the lowering process.
NEGOTIATING STAIR8-PREPARATORY METHOD* Ascending Stairs
i
~ bed must allow the I, the feet resting flat
The patient stands on the floor facing the stairs with one hand holding the banister rail; the toes are close to the riser of the first step. To ascend the stairs the sound leg is raised and the sole of the foot placed well forwards on the first tread by flexion of hip and knee. (During this movement weight is taken on the affected leg, and the hand on the banister provides additional support.) (Fig. 44a.) The body is then inclined slightly forwards, the weight being taken principally by the flexed sound limb, while the hand on the banister continues to provide support. The sound limb is then straightened fully and the trunk raised to the erect position. At the same time the weak leg is lifted (flexed slightly at hip and knee) and the foot placed on the first tread alongside the other foot (Fig. 44b). The same stair-climbing technique is used to negotiate the rest of the stairs.
the previous section either rest on the Handgrips mounted ~used to prevent the is exerted.
* Preparatory Method. The simple method of negotiating stairs described here is used when the weakness of one leg prevents the patient moving up and down stairs in a normal manner. The same basic pattern is followed when sticks or crutches are used and full weight-bearing on the weak leg is not allowed. The methods of using these aids in stair work are outside the scope of this section and have not been described.
!be same manner as ~ palms ofthe hands .-d pressure on the
Dr without arms can l
I
the physical ability
58
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
-~---a
b
Fig. 44.
Ideally, to achieve maximum support-although this is often not a practicable proposition-the banister should be on the side of the affected leg.
Descending Stairs
.-t
The patient stands at the head of the stairs with the toes close to the edge; he holds the banister rail with one hand. To descend the stairs the weight of the body is taken on the sound leg, and the weak leg is carried forwards so that the back of the heel is close to the top of the first riser. The hand on the banister provides support during this movement (Fig. 45).
Fig. 45.
The body is then lowered downwards, by controlled flexion of the hip and knee of the sound leg, and the foot of the weak leg is placed on the first stair tread. The weak leg is now straight and fully extended at the knee. (During this stage it is advisable for the patient to incline the body backwards a few degrees to counteract any tendency to tip forwards.) . Full body weight is then transferred to the weak leg, with the hand on the banister offering support, and the trunk is held erect. Next, the flexed sound leg is carried forwards, extended, and the foot placed alongside the other foot on the stair tread. The same leg-placing technique is used to negotiate the rest of the stairs.
PROGRESSIV
IntroductiOl
The free exercises listed here 81 and mobility, as described in ( ... all parts of the body. In arranging the neck and tr1 las to be covered, each section I into Static or Isometric ExercU with a brief analysis of the IDII Grading. All the exercises Ii &Tly, Intermediate and Adv(l1I icasible, into two or more graI Numbers prefixing the eXI ftrious grades. Where more d pade, the number is folloM Intermediate Exercises for Sp
PART 3
often not a : affected leg.
I
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISES
the edge; he
IUlld leg, and )Se to the top \ during this
rthe hip and the first stair nee. (During a few degrees
Introduction The free exercises listed here are arranged progressively in terms of strength and mobility, as described in Chapter 2 (pp. 7-12), and include movements for all parts of the body. In arranging the neck and trunk exercises, where a wide range of exercises has to be covered, each section devoted to a particular muscle group is divided into Static or Isometric Exercises and Dynamic or Isotonic Exercises, together with a brief analysis of the main type of movement. Grading. All the exercises listed are grouped under three main headings: Early, Intermediate and Advanced. In turn, each group is divided, whenever feasible, into two or more grades. Numbers prefixing the exercises indicate progression throughout the various grades. Where more than one exercise of the same type is listed in a grade, the number is followed by a, b or c to indicate this. See p. 82, Intermediate Exercises for Spinal Extensors.
hand on the
md
the
foot
of the stairs.
59
7. Head and neck exercises
Head and neck exercises provide work for the muscles which activate the atlanto-occipital joints and the joints of the cervical spine. The exercises given here have been classified in relation to the individual muscle groups.
Starting Positions Many types of starting positions are used for head and neck exercises, but those most useful for remedial work are sitting, low grasp sitting (Fig. 46) and reach grasp sitting (Fig. 47). Crook sitting and cross sitting (Figs. 48 and 49) are often used in the treatment ofsmall children. The low grasp and reach grasp sitting positions are valuable when head side bending and head turning exercises are performed, because the shoulders are fixed.
Fig. 46.
Fig. 48.
Fig. 47.
Fig. 49.
In this chapter the sitting position has been used when describing exercises which may be performed from it or any of its suitable modifications.
FLEXORS OF HEAD AND NECK Types of Dynamic Exercises
Head on Trunk Three main groups of exercises are classified here. 1. Flexion of the head and neck from lying and crook lying.
Example: Yard (palms on floor) lying; Head bending forwards (Fig. 50).
2. Part-range (from and to midline) extension and flexion of the head and neck from sitting. 61
62
B
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Example: Sitting; Head bending backwards. 3. Full-range flexion and extension. of the head and neck from the high lying position with the head unsupported. Example: High lying (plinth: head unsupported); Head bending forwards and backwards, and return to starting position (Fig. 51).
~~·"~l ,," \,.....
~
'\... ,...I
Fig. 50.
at
,
,\(if:ryO··
J
Fig. 51.
Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1 1. Sitting; Head bending backwards.
GRADE
2 1. ~o progression. 2. Yard (palms on floor) lying; Head bending forwards. (See Fig. 50.)
~ening Exerc:isl ilr-mtary: No.1, p. 62;
of Dynamic ED:
GRADE
Intermediate 1 1. No progression. 2. High lying (plinth: head unsupported); Head bending forwards and backwards, and return to starting position. (See Fig: 51.)
from sitting or exta F.x.am.ple: (i) Sitting; B (ii) Forehead I 6. Full-range flexion I
GRADE
EXTENSORS OF HEAD AND NECK
Types of Static Exercises
1. Attempted Movement Attempted movement of the head and neck from lying and crook lying without movement of the joints.
Example: Lying; Head pressing backwards.
2. Fixation of Head and Neck Stabilization of the head and neck in the Body raising type of exercise from a suitable lying position. Example: Stride lying (head supported by partner); 'Log raising' by partner (Fig. 52).
Example: Prone knee~ to starling pt.J
~ Fig. 53.
2. Trunk on Head This group includes d exercises; they are perf( lying, and stride crook ~ Examples: (i) Lying; j (ii) Arm C1'e Wrestle!
63
HEAD AND NECK EXERCISES
... oedt from the high .-i~~fonwardsand
I(FW·51).
b Fig. 52.
'Y.51.
Strengthening Exercises
Elementary: No. I, p. 62; Advanced: No.2, above.
Types of Dynamic Exercises
wards. (See Fig. 50.)
I bending forwards and ... 51.)
l
lying and crook lying
I type of exercise from a t "LDg
raisi~
by partner
1. Head on Trunk Two main groups of exercises are classified here: a. Part-range (from and to midline) flexion and extension of the head and neck from sitting or extension of the head and neck from prone lying. Example: (i) Sitting; Head bending fonwards. (ii) Forehead rest prone lying; Head bending backwards. b. Full-range flexion and extension of the head and neck from prone kneeling. Example: Prone kneeling; Head bending fonwards and backwards, and return to starting position (Fig. 53) .
Fig. 53.
Fig. 54.
Fig. 55.
2. Trunk on Head This group includes the Chest ralsmg and Wrestler's Bridge types of exercises; they are performed from such starting positions as lying, crook lying, and stride crook lying. Examples: (i) Lying; Chest raising (Fig. 54). (ii) Arm cross stride crook lying (head on mat); press up to high Wrestler's Bridge (Fig. 55).
64
2 1. Prone kneeling; Head rhythmical pressing to a gi'V la. Prone kneeling; Hea( 2. Prone kneeling; Head 3. Forehead rest prone I
GRADE
Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE
m
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
1
1. Sitting; Head bending forwards.
2 1. Prone kneeling; Head bending forwards and backwards, and return to starting position. (See Fig. 53, p. 63.) 2. Forehead rest prone lying; Head bending backwards. 3. Lying; Chest raising. (See Fig. 54, p. 63.) GRADE
Types of Dynamic Exer
Intermediate
1
1 and 2. No progressions.
3. Crook lying; Chest raising.
GRADE
2
1 and 2. No progressions.
3. Neck rest crook lying; Chest raising.
GRADE
tllM
t
Advanced GRADE
1
1 and 2. No progressions.
3. Arm cross stride crook lying (head on mat); press up to high Wrestler's Bridge. (See Fig. 55, p. 63.)
2
1 and 2. No progressions.
3. Arm cross stride lying (head on mat); press up to low Wrestler's Bridge (Fig. 56).
Three main groups of exel I. Full-range flexion 3114 lying. Example: Crook side-Ij return to starll 2. Part-range (from and the: head and neck from si Example: Sitting; Head chest, foll~ position. 3. Straightening of the I occipital joints, followed Il occipital joints (Chin inill usually taken from sitting
GRADE
:;:;?';:.-3--·~"-·
...... -S iI""~
~
•• '
"
Fig. 56.
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary
1 L Sitting; Head dropping forwards and stretching upwards. 2. Sitting; Head nodding forwards (1-2), followed by stretching upwards
GRADE
(3-4).
Strengthening Exercls Elementary
1 1. Crook side-lying; H starting position.
GRADE
2 1. No progression. 2. Sitting; Head bend chest, and Head stretchl 3. Sitting; Head bene: chest, followed by Head 4. Sitting; Chin indn position.
GRADE
HEAD AND NECK EXERCISES
65
2 1. Prone kneeling; Head bending forwards, and bending backwards with rhythmical pressing to a given count, followed by return to starting position. 1a. Prone kneeling; Head bending forwards and backwards continuously. 2. Prone kneeling; Head dropping forwards and bending backwards. 3. Forehead rest prone lying; Head bending backwards with rhythmical pressing to a given count.
GRADE
awards, and return to
IJr.Irds.
FLEXORS AND EXTENSORS OF HEAD AND NECK Types of DynaDlic Exercises
Head on Trunk
IS
up to high Wrestler's
D
low Wrestler's Bridge
gupwards. I by stretching upwards
Three main groups of exercises are classified here. 1. Full-range flexion and extension of the head and neck from crook side lying. Example: Crook side-lying; Head bending forwards and backwards, and return to starting position. 2. Part-range (from and to midline) or full-range flexion and extension of the head and neck from sitting. Example: Sitting; Head bending forwards to press the chin gently against the chest, followed by Head bending backwards, and return to starting position. 3. Straightening of the cervical concavity with slight flexion of the atlanto occipital joints, followed by flexion of the neck with extension of the atlanto occipital joints (Chin indrawing and poking forwards). The movements are usually taken from sitting.
Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1 1. Crook side-lying; Head bending forwards and backwards, and return to starting position.
GRADE
2 1. No progression. 2. Sitting; Head bending forwards to press the chin gently against the chest, and Head stretching upwards. 3. Sitting; Head bending forwards to press the chin gently against the chest, followed by Head bending backwards, and return to starting position. 4. Sitting; Chin indrawing and poking forwards, and return to starting position. GRADE
66
HI
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Mobilizing Exercises
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1 1. Crook side-lying; Head bending forwards and backwards continuously.
GRADE
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Crook lying; Head be 2 1. Sitting; Head bendinl 2. Sitting; Head bendin count.
GRADE
2 1. No progression.
GRADE
LATERAL FLEXORS OF HEAD AND NECK Types of Dynamic Exercises Head on Trunk Lateral flexion of the head and neck from lying, crook side-lying and sitting. Examples: (i) Crook lying; Head bending sideways. (ii) Crook side-lying (head resting on pillow); Head bending sideways (Fig. 57). (iii) Sitting; Head bending from side to side.
ROTATORS OF HEAl Types of Dynamic Ese!
Head on Trunk Rotation of the head and I Examples: (i) Crook lyil. (ii) Sitting; Jj
III.
f
Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE 1 1. Crook lying; Head bending sideways.
~~
,,~~ Fig. 57.
Strengthening Exerclsl
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Crook lying; Head 11 1a. Sitting; Head turni:
((.-
~~
.j,1.' '
Fig. 58.
2 1. Sitting; Head bending sideways.
Mobilizing Exercises
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Crook lying; Head t 1a. Sitting; Head tumi
GRADE
2 1a. Sitting; Head turD
GRADE
Intermediate 1 1. Crook side-lying (head resting on pillow); Head bending sideways. (See Fig. 57.)
GRADE
2 1. Crook side-lying (head touching supporting surface); Head bending sideways (Fig. 58).
GRADE
CIRCUMDUCTORS. Types of Dynamic Elll
Head on Trunk Circumduction of the h(
HEAD AND NECK EXERCISES
67
Mobilizing Exercises
Ckwards continuously.
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Crook lying; Head bending from side to side. GRADE
2
1. Sitting; Head bending from side to side.
2. Sitting; Head bending sideways with rhythmical pressing to a given count.
side-lying and sitting. ....,); Head bending
r- 58.
ROTATORS OF HEAD AND NECK Types of Dynamic Exercises Head on Trunk Rotation of the head and neck from lying, crook lying, and sitting. Examples: (i) Crook tying; Head turning. (ii) Sitting; Head turning from side to side.
Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE
1
1. Crook lying; Head turning.
1a. Sitting; Head turning.
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary GRADE
1
1. Crook lying; Head turning from side to side.
1a. Sitting; Head turning from side to side.
GRADE
2
1a. Sitting; Head turning with rhythmical pressing to a given count.
ending sideways. (See
rface); Head bending
CIRCUMDUCTORS OF HEAD AND NECK Types of Dynamic Exercises Head on Trunk Circumduction of the head and neck from sitting and prone kneeling.
68
PROGRESSIvE EXERCISE THERAPY
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary GRADE 1 1. Sitting; Head rolling.
8. TrunJ
2
L Prone kneeling; Head rolling.
GRADE
Trunk exercises provid thoracolumbar spine ar muscles of the hips, eel"! The exercises given b muscle groups of the th
FLEXORS OF THE Types of Static
,
t
men:
1. Abdominal Retractimt Retraction of the abdon lying, prone lying, sinill Example: Crook lying,
2. Leg or Legs on T~ In this group of exercisl given range of moveme the pelvis from being til the moving leg or legs. ~ the resting leg act static Four main types of eJ starting positions as lyiJ a. Flexion of the hip Example: Lying,- singl b. Flexion of one or b Example: Lying,- singl c, Flexion of one hip Example: Lying,' sing.
* In the average subject final degrees of movement Flexion of the hip should t of the abdominal muscles
8. Trunk exercises
Trunk exercises provide work for the spinal muscles which act on the thoracolumbar spine and pelvis; many of the exercises also activate the muscles of the hips, cervical spine and atlanto-occipital joints. The exercises given here have been classified in relation to the individual muscle groups of the thoracolumbar spine.
FLEXORS OF THE SPINE Types of Static Exercises 1. Abdominal Retraction Retraction of the abdominal muscles from such starting positions as crook lying, prone lying, sitting and standing. Example: Crook lying; Abdominal contractions. 2. Leg or Legs on Trunk In this group of exercises the hips are flexed in turn, or together, through a given range of movement. The abdominal muscles act statically to prevent the pelvis from being tilted forwards by the contraction of the hip flexors of the moving leg or legs. When the legs are moved in turn the hip extensors of the resting leg act statically with the abdomin~l muscles to fix the pelvis. Four main types of exercises are classified here. They are taken from such starting positions as lying, standing and hanging. a. Flexion of the hip and knee of one leg almost to the full extent. *
Example: Lying; single high Knee raising (Fig. 59).
b. Flexion of one or both hips up to 90° with flexion of the knee or knees. Example: Lying; single Knee raising. c. Flexion of one hip through 45°, with the knee extended.
Example: Lying; single Leg raising through 45°.
* In the average subject flexion of one hip (with the knee well flexed) through the final degrees of movement is associated with small range backward tilting of the pelvis. Flexion of the hip should therefore not be taken to its full extent if a pure static action of the abdominal muscles is required. 69
70
,
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
d. Flexion of the hips to 45° with the knees extended.
Example: Stretch grasp back towards standing (wall bars); Leg raising to 45°.
~~(t)
I
3. Trunk (Spine Straight) on Legs a. Trunk lowering backwards and raising from fixed inclined long sitting with the spine held straight. The hips are alternately extended and flexed through a range of 35-65°. Example: Wing fixed inclined long sitting (wall bar stool); Trunk lowering backwards through 450 (Fig. 60).
/ .0-' -"
\'
I
/,
'
,.m__ j
/ Fig. 59.
t
1
.
Fig. 60.
During the raising and lowering movements the abdominal muscles act statically to maintain the straight position of the spine. b. Trunk raising and lowering from fixed lying or fixed crook lying with the spine held straight. The hIps are alternately flexed and extended through a range of about 90°. Example: Wing fixed crook lying; Trunk raising (Fig. 61). During the raising and lowering movements the abdominal muscles act statically to maintain the straight position of the trunk.
4. Head on Trunk Head bending forwards from lying and crook lying. The abdominal muscles act statically to fix the origin of the scalene muscles and the sternomastoid muscles. Example: Crook lying; Head bending forwards. Head bending forwards is often combined with hip flexion movements to increase the static action of the abdominal muscles. Example: Lying; Head bending forwards with single high Knee raising.
.,
,
--- ___
/t\
:: ... \:::----
~ll:::::--"""
. ~
~~ ~
oJ.
Fig. 61.
Strengthening Exercises
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Crook lying; Abdominal 2. Lying; single Knee raiD 3. Lying; single high Knee 4. Lying; single Leg raisin; 5. Lying; single high Kno slow lowering. 6. Crook lying; Head bene! 7. Lying; Head bending f( 8. Low grasp fixed incline« bar stool); Trunk lowering b
2 1. Prone lying; AbdoJDina 2. Lying; Knee raising (F 3. Lying; cycling. 4. Lying; alternate Leg I'll 4a. Lying; single Leg rais 5 and 6. No progressions. 7. Yard (palms on floor) raising through 45° . 8. Wing fixed inclined 1011 lowering backwards througJ 9. Inclined prone falling
GRADE
Intermediate GRADE
5. Arm Bending from Prone Falling Position and its Modifications During the exercise the abdominal muscles act statically to prevent gravity from tilting the pelvis forwards and exaggerating the lumbar concavity. Example: Inclined prone falling (hands on beam); Arm bending (Fig. 62).
1. 2. 3. 4.
1
No progression. Stretch grasp back to' No progression. Lying; Leg raising tb
71
TRUNK EXERCISES
I:Id...
lin); Leg raising to 45°.
I I
4
II iodined long sitting r cstalded and flexed
Fig. 61.
Fig. 62.
rtIJo/); Trunk lowering
Strengthening Exercises
1Iiir·60· lJdominal muscles act dcrook lying with the
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Crook lying; Abdominal contractions. 2. Lying; single Knee raising. 3. Lying; single high Knee raising. (See Fig. 59, p. 70.) 4. Lying; single Leg raising to 45°. 5. Lying; single high Knee raising, Leg stretching forwards to 45°, and slow lowering. 6. Crook lying; Head bending forwards. 7. Lying; Head bending forwards with single high Knee raising. 8. Low grasp fixed inclined long sitting (hands grasping front edge of wall bar stool); Trunk lowering backwards through 35°.
II extended through a
2 1. Prone lying; Abdominal contractions . 2. Lying; Knee raising (Fig. 63). 3. Lying; cycling. 4. Lying; alternate Leg raising through 45 c •
4a. Lying; single Leg raising to 45°, followed by Leg raising to 15°.
5 and 6. No progressions.
7. Yard (palms on floor) lying; Head bending forwards with single Leg raising through 45°. 8. Wing fixed inclined long sitting (wall bar stool or balance bench); Trunk lowering backwards through 35°. 9. Inclined prone falling (hands on beam); Arm bending (Fig. 62). GRADE
. 61).
Idominal muscles act
-= abdominal muscles
lid the sternomastoid
bon movements to
lijrlt Knee raising.
wli/ications
If to prevent gravity
DDba.r concavity. bending (Fig. 62).
I
Intermediate 1 1. No progression. 2. Stretch grasp back towards standing (wall bars); Knee raising. 3. No progression. 4. Lying; Leg raising through 45°.
GRADE
72
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
4a-7. No progressions. S. Wing or fist bend fixed inclined long sitting (wall bar stool); Trunk lowering backwards through 45°. (See Fig. 60, p. 70.) 9. Inclined prone falling (hands on beam); Arm bending. (See Fig. 62, p. 71.)
2 1-7. No progressions. S. Wing or neck rest fixed inclined long sitting (wall bar stool); Trunk lowering backwards through 45-65° (Fig. 64). Sa. Wing fixed lying; Trunk raising. (See Fig. 61, p. 71.) 9. Prone falling; Arm bending (Fig. 65).
Types of Dynamic: 1. Spine on Pelvis Flexion of the spine 1 Example: Lying; U1
GRADE
-....- ..~ ",,'
~
,.~
~""'" \
2. Pelvis and Lumbar Pelvis tilting backw extensors. Example: Crook lYJ
.....(,.'.' ..... \,
F
....... '---->
3. Legs on Pelvis: Pel Fig. 63.
I
"
Fig. 64.
Advanced GRADE 1 1-7. No progressions. S. Stretch fixed inclined long sitting (wall bar stool); Trunk lowering backwards through 45-65°. 8a. Neck rest fixed lying; Trunk raising. 9. Horizontal prone falling; Arm bending (Fig. 66).
-> Fig. 65.
Fig. 66.
2 1-7. No progressions. 8. Stretch fixed crook sitting; Trunk lowering backwards to the floor. 8a. Stretch fixed lying; Trunk raising. 9. No progression.
Full flexion of the b extended, combined' Examples; (i) LyiJ (ii) LyiJ the
-
Iiiiil!!
F ig.
A modification oft The extensors of m main emphasis of tb Examp\e: Stretch straight
4. Spine on Pelvis: Flexion of the spi.Jl support. Example: Wing j
GRADE
5. Combined Move Flexion of the spi: moved either toge1
73
TRUNK EXERCISES
Types of Dynamic Exercises bar stool); Trunk I. (See Fig. 62, p.
bar stool); Trunk
.)
1. Spine on Pelvis
Flexion of the spine without movements of the pelvis or legs. Example: Lying; upper Trunk bending forwards (Fig. 67).
2. Pelvis and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk and Legs Pelvis tilting backwards, the abdominal muscles acting with the hip extensors . Example: Crook lying; Pelvis tilting backwards (Fig. 68).
Fig. 67.
Fig. 68.
3. Legs on Pelvis: Pelvis and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk Full flexion of the hips and knees, or flexion of the hips with the knees extended, combined with flexion of the thoracolumbar spine. Examples: (i) Lying; high Knee raising (Fig. 69). (ii) Lying; high Leg raising to touch the floor behind the head with the toes (Fig. 70). Trunk lowering
s to the floor.
Fig. 69.
Fig. 70.
A modification of this type of exercise consists of circling on rings or ropes. The extensors of the thoracolumbar spine work to a small extent, but the main emphasis of the exercise is on the abdominal and heaving muscles. Example: Stretch grasp standing (rings); circling and return circling with straight legs (Fig. 71).
4. Spine on Pelvis: Pelvis on Legs Flexion of the spine and hips, the legs being fixed by apparatus or living support. Example: Wing fixed crook lying; Trunk bending forwards (Fig. 72).
5. Combined Movements of Trunk and Leg or Legs Flexion of the spine combined with knee-raising movements; the legs are moved either together or one at a time.
74
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
;b
c
b
2b. Reach grasp sitting (1 2c. Reach grasp standing 3. Lying; high Knee raisi
Intermediate GRADE
1
1. Fixed crook lying; Tr
a
d
Fig. 71.
Examples: (i) Lying; high Knee raising, followed by over-pressure with [he hands, and upper Trunk bending forwards (Fig. 73). (ii) Lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with single high Knee raising.
Ii
a
~.
~
~
Fig. 73.
'" b
Fig. 72.
Strengthening Exercises
arms. 2-2c. No progressions. 3. Lying; high Knee raisi: upper Trunk bending forw. GRADE
2
1. Wing fixed crook lyiDj 2-2c. No progressions. 3. Lying (wall bars beb touch a low bar with the te 4. Heave grasp walk fon with bent knees, touching circling movement." (See J
Advanced GRADE
I
1. Neck rest fixed crooll 2-2c. No progressions. 3. Lying; high Leg raisi: (See Fig. 70, p. 73.) 4. Heave grasp walk for with straight legs, touchill circling movement." (See 5. Stretch grasp back tJ
Elementary I 1. Lying; upper Trunk bending forwards. (See Fig. 67, p. 73.)
GRADE
2. Crook lying; Pelvis tilting backwards. (See Fig. 68, p. 73.) 2a. Crook side-lying (under hand grasping front edge of mattress, other hand pressing down on mattress in front of chest); Pelvis tilting backwards. GRADE
2
1. Lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with single high Knee raising.
2. Prone kneeling; Pelvis tilting backwards.
2a. Reach grasp kneel sitting (wall bars); Pelvis tilting backwards.
GRADE
2
1-2c. No progressions. 3. Reach (or stretch) ly head with the toes. (See J 4. Stretch grasp standi! legs. (See Fig. 71, p. 74.) 5. Hanging (wall bars)
* The extensor muscles of emphasis of the exercise is ~
TRUNK EXERCISES
75
2b. Reach grasp sitting (wall bars); Pelvis tilting backwards.
2c. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); Pelvis tilting backwards.
3. Lying; high Knee raising. (See Fig. 69, p. 73.)
Intermediate 1 1. Fixed crook lying; Trunk bending forwards with assistance from the arms. 2-2c. No progressions. 3. Lying; high Knee raising, foHowed by overpressure with the hands, and upper Trunk bending forwards. (See Fig. 73, p. 74.) GRADE
d , tn:H!T-pressure with the
",.tIS (Fig. 73). f ath single high Knee
2 1. Wing fixed crook lying; Trunk bending forwards. (See Fig. 72, p. 74.) 2-2c. No progressions. 3. Lying (wall bars behind head); high Knee raising and stretching to touch a low bar with the toes. 4. Heave grasp walk forwards standing (rings); circling and return circling with bent knees, touching the floor with the feet at the end of the forward circling movement.* (See Fig. 71, p. 74.) GRADE
Advanced GRADE
Fig. 73.
2 1-2c. No progressions. 3. Reach (or stretch) lying; high Leg raising to touch the floor behind the head with the toes. (See Fig. 3b, p. 9.) 4. Stretch grasp standing (rings); circling and return circling with straight legs. (See Fig. 71, p. 74.) 5. Hanging (wall bars); high Knee raising. GRADE
_67, p. 73.) liB, p. 73.) :Ige of mattress, other !vis tilting backwards.
:Ie high Knee
1
1. Neck rest fixed crook lying; Trunk bending forwards.
2-2c. No progressions.
3. Lying; high Leg raising to touch the floor behind the head with the toes. (See Fig. 70, p. 73.) 4. Heave grasp walk forwards standing (rings); circling and return circling with straight legs, touching the floor with the feet at the end of the forward circling movement.* (See Fig. 71, p. 74.) 5. Stretch grasp back towards standing (wall bars); high Knee raising.
raising.
iag backwards..
* The extensor muscles of the thoracolumbar spine act to a small extent, but the main emphasis of the exercise is on the abdominal muscles and the depressors of the arms.
76
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
3 1-2c. No progressions. 3. Yard (palms on floor) lying; high Leg raising to touch the floor behind the head with the toes. 4. Inward grasp hanging (rings); circling and return circling with straight legs.* 5. Hanging (wall bars); high Leg raising. GRADE
This type of movement Example: Wing fixed hil: high); positUm "'-'-.
--. "~j., ....,r
r/
I.
,i' EXTENSORS OF THE SPINE
Types of Static Exercises 1. Leg on Trunk Raising each leg backwards, in turn, from prone lying, so that the hip joint is extended about 15°. The extensors of the thoracolumbar spine and the hip flexors of the stationary leg act statically to )revent the pelvis from being tilted backwards by the contraction of the hip extensors of the moving leg. Example: Forehead rest prone lying; single slight Leg raising backwards. When hip extension is taken beyond 15° the pelvis tilts forwards, because of the tension exerted on the ilio-femoral ligament. The extensors of the thoracolumbar spine then act dynamically.
I
~
2. Trunk (Spine Straight) on Legs Trunk lowering and raising from such starting positions as sitting, stride standing, and fixed high thigh support across prone lying. The trunk is kept straight while the hips are alternately flexed and extended. The extensors of the thoracolumbar spine act statically throughout the lowering and raising movements to prevent gravity from flexing the spine. The range of the hip movements varies in the different starting positions, as outlined below. a. Sitting and stride sitting. The forward lowering movement is limited by the apposition of the soft structures of the thighs and abdomen. Example: Wing stride sitting; Trunk lowering forwards (Fig. 74). b. Standing and stride standing. The forward lowering movement is taken as far as the length of the hamstring muscles allows. Example: Wing stride standing; Trunk lowering forwards. c. Fixed high thigh support across prone lying. The position is usually taken over two balance benches, one being placed on top of the other. Trunk lowering forwards is limited by the contact of the head with the floor. Example: Wing fixed high thigh support across prone lying (balance benches, 2 high); Trunk lowering forwards (Fig. 75).
* The extensor muscles of the thoracolumbar spine act to a small extent, but the main emphasis of the exercise is on the abdominal muscles and the depressors of the arms.
Fig. 74.
3. Arm Bending from FaJ During the exercise the I to maintain a straight p flexing it. Example: Over grasp J (Fig. 76).
4. Fallout Forward Exr, The exercises are perfon of the thoracolumbar spo a straight position of til perfect control the extell Example: Wing standi forwards (Fi
,~
L __ .
I
I
.l --FiI,
77
TRUNK EXERCISES
:JUCb the floor behind
This type of movement is usually introduced by a 'holding' exercise. Example: Wing fixed high thigh support across prone lying (balance benches, 2 high); position holding.
circling with straight
....,,.. ,',
.'
, \ ..
:;.-_-_....,.;....;:!10.4.
#,... ... _-, I
r---_/ 10 that
the hip joint is ... spine and the hip he pelvis from being IS of the moving leg. raising backwards. lis forwards, because ('he extensors of the
as sitting, stride The trunk is kept led. The extensors of lowering and raising DDS
lag.
Dt
starting positions,
:wement is limited by
abdomen.
S (Fig. 74).
IIJ movement is taken
Fig. 74.
:
L Fig. 75.
3. Arm Bending from Fall Hanging Position or its Modifications During the exercise the extensors of the thoracolumbar spine act statically to maintain a straight position of the trunk and to prevent gravity from flexing it. Example: Over grasp fall hanging (beam at shoulder height); Arm bending (Fig. 76).
4. Fallout Forward Ex('-cises The exercises are performed with or without arm movements. The extensors of the thoracolumbar spine act statically to counteract gravity and to maintain a straight position of the spine. Unless the exercises are performed with perfect control the extensors will be used dynamically. Example: Wing standing; fallout forwards, left Foot forwards, right Foot forwards (Fig. 77).
m.
e position is usually »ofthe other. Trunk with the floor. .. (balance benches, 2
.n extent, but the main
ilepressors of the arms.
Fig. 76.
Fig. 77.
78
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Strengthening Exercises
Elementary 1 Forehead rest prone lying; single slight Leg raising backwards. Wing stride sitting; Trunk lowering forwards. (See Fig. 74, p. 77.) Over grasp fall hanging (beam at shoulder height); Arm bending. (See 76.)
GRADE
1. 2. 3. Fig.
2 1. No progression. 2. Wing stride standing; Trunk lowering forwards. 3. Over grasp fall hanging (beam below shoulder height); Arm bending.
GRADE
Intermediate I 1. No progression. 2. Fist bend stride standing; Trunk lowering forwards. 2a. Wing fixed high thigh support across prone lying (balance benches, 2 high); position holding. 3. Over grasp fall hanging (beam below shoulder height); Arm bending with single Leg raising. 4. Wing standing; fallout forwards, left Foot forwards, right Foot forwards. (See Fig. 77.) GRADE
GRADE
Advanced 1 1. No progression. 2. Stretch stride standin 2a. Neck rest fixed bij benches, 2 high); Trunk Ie 3. Over grasp horizontal Arm bending with single I 4. Fist bend standing; j forwards, with Arm stretcl
GRADE
2
1. No progression. 2. Neck rest stride standing; Trunk lowering forwards. 2a. Wing fixed high thigh support across prone lying (balance benches, 2 high); Trunk lowering forwards. (See Fig. 75, p. 77.) 3. Over grasp horizontal fall hanging (beam and living support); Arm bending (Fig. 78). 4. Across bend standing; fallout forwards, left Foot forwards, right Foot forwards, with Arm flinging.
2 1-4. No progressions.
GRADE
Types of Dynamic ExeI
1. Pelvis and Lumbar Spa. Pelvis tilting forwards, the the flexors of the hips. Example: Crook lying; J
2. Leg on Pelvis: Pelvis IIJ Raising in turn each leg 1 grasp standing. The ilio-fc extension after about 15' forwards as far as possibJ. the flexors of the hip of d Example: Forehead rest
3. Trunk (Spine Arched) , This group includes Ches are taken from lying and spine act with the flexors
_
(z/
~ ................
Fig. 79.
Fig. 78.
Examples: (i) Lying; I (ii) High re. bar fror.
79
TRUNK EXERCISES
Advanced 1 1. No progression. 2. Stretch stride standing; Trunk lowering forwards. 2a. Neck rest fixed high thigh support across prone lying (balance benches, 2 high); Trunk lowering forwards. (See Fig. 75, p. 77.) 3. Over grasp horizontal fall hanging (beam and balance benches, 2 high); Arm bending with single Leg raising. 4. Fist bend standing; fallout forwards, left Foot forwards, right Foot forwards, with Arm stretching forwards. GRADE
iog backwards. $« Fig. 74, p. 77.) II); Arm bending. (See
ICight); Arm bending.
2 1-4. No progressions.
GRADE
Types of Dynamic Exercises
F III (balance benches, 2
1. Pelvis and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk and Legs Pelvis tilting forwards, the extensors of the thoracolumbar spine acting with the flexors of the hips. Example: Crook lying; Pelvis tilting forwards (Fig. 79).
height); Arm bending
Is. right Foot forwards.
mIs. III (balance benches, 2 living support); Arm ~
forwards, right Foot
2. Leg on Pelvis: Pelvis and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk Raising in tum each leg backwards beyond 15° from prone lying or reach grasp standing. The iIio-femoralligament of the moving hip joint checks hip extension after about 15°; to extend the leg further the pelvis is tilted forwards as far as possible by the extensors of the thoracolumbar spine and the flexors of the hip of the stationary leg. Example: Forehead rest prone lying; single Leg raising backwards. 3. Trunk (Spine Arched) on Legs This group includes Chest raising and preparatory Spanning exercises which are taken from lying and crook lying. The extensors of the thoracolumbar spine act with the flexors of the hips.
Fig. 79.
Fig. 80.
Examples: (i) Lying; Chest raising (Fig. 80). (ii) High reach grasp lying (wall bars: hands grasping 5th or 6th bar from floor); spanning (Fig. 81).
80
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
In these exercises crook lying is used as a progression on lying; it places the hip flexors in a shortened position, and so reduces their ability to raise the pelvis and lumbar spine from the floor.
Fig. 81.
6. Combined Movements (! In these exercises the exte extensor~ of the hips, Tb a. Spanning exercises I Examples: (i) Angle 1u. (ii) Arm ero WrestJe. b. Extension of the tho extension of the lower lin: Examples: (i) Prone ~ outward (ii) Neck re raising j
;.
Fig. 82.
: -... . -.=
4. Spine on Pelvis: Pelvis on Legs
In this group of exercises the extensors of the thoracolumbar spine are used with the extensors of the hips. There are three main types of exercises: a. Extension of the spine and hips from lax stoop stride sitting or standing, or any other suitable starting position, to bring the trunk to the erect position. Example: Lax stoop back lean stride standing (heels 30-40 cm in front of wall or upright); Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' (Fig. 82). b. As the previous type of exercise, but the trunk is uncurled to the stoop position. Example: Fist bend lax stoop kneel siuing; Trunk stretching forwards to stoop position with Arm stretching sideways (Fig. 83). c. Extension of the thoracolumbar spine and hips from prone lying with the legs fixed. Example: Neck rest fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards (Fig. 84).
I', .... ., .,.' ... , . . "
, I
I
e;I
~l
-",'
.....
\:.0- Fig. 83.
f~-~,
" '........4....,-:::::
: :0('.,••: -. .A(
.:~
__ •
"'
'''''' Fig. 84
5. Spine on Pelvis Extension of the thoracolumbar spine from prone lying. The extensors of the thoracolumbar spine are used dynamically; the extensors of the hips act statically to fix the pelvis. Example: Prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards (Fig. 85).
". t
Fig.
..-~ Fig.
Strengthening Exerci
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Lying; Chest raisa 2. Crook lying; Pelvil 2a. Crook side-lying hand pressing down on 3. Forehead rest p1'Ol 4. Lax stoop stride si contact with wall or up assistance from arms. 5. Lax stoop kneel stretching forwards to ~
2 1. Crook lying; Che!
GRADE
2. Reach grasp kneel
r
81
TRUNK EXERCISES
DO on lying; it places the !heir ability to raise the
6. Combined Movements of Legs or Leg on Pelvis with Extension of Spine In these exercises the extensors of the thoracolumbar spine are used with the extensors of the hips. There are two main groups of exercises: a. Spanning exercises and similar movements. Examples: (i) Angle hanging (wall bars); spanning (Fig. 86). (li) Arm cross stride crook lying (head on mat); press up to high Wrestler's Bridge. (See Fig. 55, p. 63.) b. Extension of the thoracolumbar spine from prone lying combined with extension of the lower limbs; the limbs are moved either in tum or together. Examples: (i) Prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards and single Leg raising backwards (Fig. 87). (ii) Neck rest prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Leg raising backwards.
Fig. 82.
.
.
;'f ~'-". " ' .. A~ ___ .... __ o
. ,~
'If'
:oIumbar spine are used ~ types of exercises: bide sitting or standing, 10k [0 the erect position. JO-.4Ocm in front of wall , wrtebra' (Fig. 82). :is uncurled to the stoop
YU:lri.ng forwards to stoop ir- 83)_ , from prone lying with •
backwards (Fig. 84).
. . The extensors of the IeIlSOrs ,?f the hips act
ir Arm turning outwards
•
-.:-----" .. ,
Fig. 85.
Fig. 87
Fig. 86.
Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE 1 1. Lying; Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79.) 2. Crook lying; Pelvis tilting forwards. (See Fig. 79, p. 79.) 2a. Crook side-lying (under hand grasping front edge of mattress, other hand pressing down on mattress in front of chest); Pelvis tilting forwards. 3. Forehead rest prone lying; single Leg raising backwards. 4. Lax stoop stride sitting (hands on thighs, and lower part of sacrum in contact with wall or upright); Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' with assistance from arms. 5. Lax stoop kneel sitting (palms on floor with elbows bent); Trunk stretching forwards to stoop position with Elbow stretching. 2 1. Crook lying; Chest raising. 2. Reach grasp kneel sitting (wall bars); Pelvis tilting forwards.
GRADE
82
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
2a. Reach grasp sitting (wall bars); Pelvis tilting forwards. 2b. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); Pelvis tilting forwards. 3. Fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards (Fig. 88).
~=-&?~ Fig. 88.
3a. Prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards. (See Fig. 85, p. 81.) 4. Lax stoop back lean stride standing (heels 30--40 cm in front of wall or upright); Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra'. (See Fig. 82, p. 80.) 4a. Lax stoop kneel sitting (hands clasped behind back); Trunk stretching with unclasping of hands and Arm turning outwards. 5. As above, but Trunk is stretched forwards to stoop position. 6. Crook lying; Pelvis raising. (See Fig. 150, p. 116.) Intermediate GRADE 1 1. Neck rest crook lying; Chest raising. la. High reach grasp lying (wall bars: hands grasping 5th or 6th bar from floor); spanning. (See Fig. 81, p. 80.) 2. No progression. 3. Neck rest fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards. (See Fig. 84, p.80.) 3a. Neck rest prone lying; Trunk bending backwards. 3b. Prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards and single Leg raising backwards. (See Fig. 87, p. 81.) 4. As Exercise 4 above, but arms in neck rest. 4a. Neck rest lax stoop kneel sitting; Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra'. 5. Fist bend lax stoop kneel sitting; Trunk stretching forwards to stoop position with Arm stretching sideways. (See Fig. 83, p. 80.) 6. No progression. GRADE
2
1. No progression. la. High reach grasp crook lying (wall bars: hands grasping 5th or 6th bar from floor); spanning. (See Fig. 4a, p. 9.) lb. Stretch grasp back support kneel sitting (wall bars); spanning (Fig.
89).
2. No progression. 3. Head rest fixed prone I 3a. Prone lying; Trunk II and Leg raising backwards. ~ I
~qJ
I
~~,
{.
~
.!
;
,,,4 ,
:
...
Fig. 89.
3b. Stride prone lying; 'I turning outwards, Knee ben the heels together (Fig. 90). 3c. Prone kneeling; single Leg stretching and raising b
--rl. a
4. No progression. 4a. Fist bend lax stoop ] stretching to arch position (
~ a
5. Lax stoop stride standi Trunk stretching forwards 6. No progression.
83
TRUNK EXERCISES
rwards. fOrwards. I with Arm turning
2. No progression. 3. Head rest fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards. 3a. Prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards and Leg raising backwards. ~
~llJ:/:~' I.
..
.~O_~\ ~
f.,!
.: : :
[JJl
turning outwards.
::m in front of wall or r Fig. 82, p. 80.) ck); Trunk stretching ~
position.
)
I
I.
.:~~"'-'
Fig. 90.
Fig. 89.
3b. Stride prone lying; Trunk bending backwards combined with Arm turning outwards, Knee bending and Leg raising backwards, so as to bring the heels together (Fig. 90). 3c. Prone kneeling; single Arm raising forwards-upwards with opposite Leg stretching and raising backwards (Fig. 91) .
..... II 5th or 6th bar from
lwar"ds. (See Fig. 84,
a
b Fig. 91.
Is.
[Ill
turning outwards
4. No progression. 4a. Fist bend lax stoop leg backward stretch half kneel sitting; Trunk stretching to arch position (Fig. 92).
:rching 'vertebra by • forwards to stoop .80.)
a
b Fig. 92.
liSping 5th or 6th bar IUS); spanning (Fig.
5. Lax stoop stride standing (hands clasped behind neck, elbows forwards); Trunk stretching forwards with Elbow parting to neck rest position. 6. No progression.
84
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Advanced GRADE
1
1. No progression.
1a. Angle hanging (waH bars); spanning. (See Fig. 86, p. 81.)
Ib-2. No progressions.
3. Stretch fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards.
3a. Neck rest prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Leg raising
backwards. 3b-4. No progressions. 4a. As Exercise 4a Intermediate, Grade 2, but arms in neck rest position. (See Fig. 92.) 5. Lax stoop stride standing; Trunk stretching forwards with Arm stretch ing forwards-upwards to stretch position. 6. Arm cross stride crook lying (head on mat); press up to high Wrestler's Bridge. (See Fig. 55, p. 63.) 7. Drag grasp lax stoop walk forwards standing (wall bars); assuming reverse hanging position (Fig. 93). 2 1. No progression.
lao Stretch grasp back support long sitting (wall bars); spanning (Fig. 94).
1b-2. No progressions.
GRADE
---..
-----
~,
~-.-.-
.
~
•-
-
~
6. Arm cross stride lyina (See Fig. 56, p. 64.) 6a. Stride crook lying (p press up to the Crab (Fig. 7. No progression.
'j; /' I'
,'''f1f'
,'- .. - . .., ,
.r---.:
/
I
I
L. Fig. 95.
FLEXORS AND EX1'E
Types of Static Exen::ia Trunk (Spine Straight) 011 Combined movements ofll 76) are taken from fixed D The spinal flexors and extc the hips are alternately ex The backward lowering the forward lowering moVl muscles. During trunk 1011 used statically; the spinal forwards and raised. Example: Wing fixed ill backwards tht to starting pm
-
~ ~
~
a
/.
c
I,
I: :"" .... (.
b Fig. 93.
Fig. 94.
3. Neck rest lax stoop fixed high thigh suppon across prone lying (balance benches, 2 high); Trunk stretching to arch position (Fig. 95). 3a. Stretch prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Leg raising backwards. 3b-4. No progressions. 4a. As Exercise 4a, Intermediate, Grade 2, but arms in stretch position. (See Fig. 92.) 5. No progression.
Strengthening Exercll Trunk lowering forwan backwards exercises whi (pp. 71-72). See exampt.
85
TRUNK EXERCISES
86, p. 81.)
6. Arm cross stride lying (head on mat); press up to low Wrestler's Bridge. (See Fig. 56, p. 64.) 6a. Stride crook lying (palins on floor behind shoulders, elbows forwards); press up to the Crab (Fig. 96). 7. No progression.
rards.
IU'ds with Leg raising
9
,~.
f-'
J'
'fO
I' II
5 in
neck rest position. , ,
uds with Arm stretch-
.r--.':
,... .
'.)
'
-.~
I
I
L
B\.} Fig. 95.
I
Fig. 96.
up to high Wrestler's
FLEXORS AND EXTENSORS OF THE SPINE (wall bars); assuming
:os); spanning (Fig. 94).
Types of Static Exercises Trunk (Spine Straight) on Legs Combined movements of trunk lowering backwards and forwards (pp. 70 and 76) are taken from fixed inclined long sitting with the knees slightly flexed. The spinal flexors and extensors act statically to keep the spine straight, while the hips are alternately extended and flexed. The backward lowering movements are taken through a range of 35-65°; the forward lowering movements are limited by the tension of the hamstring muscles. During trunk lowering backwards and raising, the spinal flexors are used statically; the spinal extensors act statically as the trunk is lowered forwards and raised. Example: Wing fixed inclined long sitting (wall bar stool); Trunk lowering backwards through 65°, raising and lowering forwards, and return to starting position (Fig. 97).
Fig. 94.
s prone lying (balance
";g. 95).
Us with Leg raising
as in stretch position.
Fig. 97.
Strengthening Exercises Trunk lowering forwards movements are added to the trunk lowering backwards exercises which are performed from fixed inclined long sitting (pp. 71-72). See example above.
86
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
~ C
Types of Dynamic Exercises 1. Pelvis and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk and Legs Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards from such starting positions as crook lying, prone kneeling and reach grasp sitting. The extensors and flexors of the thoracolumbar spine act with the hip flexors and extensors. Example: Crook lying; Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards. (See Figs. 79 and 68, pp. 79 and 73.)
2. Combined Movements of Trunk and Leg or Legs a. Simultaneous movement of trunk and each leg in turn. The spine is flexed and extended in prone kneeling, the movements being accompanied by flexion and extension of each leg. Example: Prone kneeling; single high Knee raising with Head bending forwards, followed by Leg stretching and raising backwards with Head bending backwards, and return to starting position (Fig. 98).
···· fl "
......... ". /"",
. ".....
.......
....
,
' ........ -~ ,..j;' L
a
iv. Circling exercises at t Example: Under grasp waIJ forwards-upwat (Fig. 102) .
~
b
a
Fig. 98.
b. Simultaneous movement of trunk and both legs. This group of exercises includes: i. Flexion and extension of the spine, hips, and knees in side-lying. Example: Side-lying; Trunk bending forwards with high Knee raising, followed by Trunk stretching backwards with Leg stretching and carrying backwards (Fig. 99). ii. Jumping the feet rhythmically backwards and forwards between crouch sitting and prone falling (Fig. 100).
~
1?
b
a
~~ c
Fig. 100.
Fig. 99.
Nest Hang exercises in rings.
Example: Hanging from hands and feet (rings),' Nest Hang (Fig. 101).
lll.
b a
3. Spine on Pelvis: Pelvis Two main groups of exm a. Flexion and extensio rhythmical pressing or exercises are often consi thoracolumbar spine and starting positions for the fixed towards standing at Examples: (i) Stride l
rhyth"a
Trunkl (ii) Fist be.
stretchi presses.
87
TRUNK EXERCISES
ws Irting positions as crook b::nsors and flexors of the ttensors. 6tu:kwards. (See Figs. 79
The spine is flexed being accompanied by
a
1IlTIt.
i.Irc
with Head bending r raising backwards with 'lining position (Fig. 98).
c
b
d
Fig. 101.
iv. Circling exercises at the beam. Example: Under grasp walk forwards standing (beam at head height); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with straight legs (Fig. 102).
This group of exercises
b
c
d e
in side-lYIng. ,;u, high Knee raising, fI1ilh Leg stretching and tIeeS
nvards between crouch
Fig. 100.
r Hang (Fig. lOJ).
a Fig. 102.
3. Spine on Pelvis: Pelvis on Legs Two main groups of exercises are classified here: a. Flexion and extension exercises of the spine and hips which incorporate rhythmical pressing or over-stressing movements in full flexion. The exercises are often considered to be of use in increasing flexion of the thoracolumbar spine and in 'stretching' the hamstring muscles. The usual starting positions for the movements are stride standing, long sitting, and fixed towards standing at the wall bars. (See Fig. 104, p. 88.) Examples: (i) Stride standing; Trunk bending forwards-downwards with rhythmical pressing to beat the floor (1-3), followed by slow Trunk stretching upwards (4-6) (Fig. 103). (ii) Fist bend long sitting; Trunk bending forwards with Arm stretching forwards to reach the toes, or beyond them, with 3 presses.
88
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
(iii) Fixed toward standing (wall bars); Trunk bending forwards to grasp the ankle of the raised leg-aver-stressing of Trunk bending-and slow stretching upwards (Fig. 104). All the rhythmical pressing and over-stressing trunk flexion exercises have been deliberately omitted from the list of mobility exercises in this section, because they are considered by orthopaedic surgeons to be wholly pernicious. The exercises seldom do any good, and they are calculated to do the utmost harm to the spine, even when the hamstrings do not seriously limit hip flexion. A large number of people have congenital shortening of the hamstrings, and under no circumstances can these muscles be stretched. The force of attempting to stretch the muscles by spinal flexion exercises will be expended either upon the intervertebral discs, or upon the epiphyseal plates of the vertebral bodies. In the adolescent, damage to the epiphysial plates will be radiographically observed as osteochondritis, and the defective growth of the epiphysial plates may cause wedging of the vertebral bodies and permanent damage. In adults the force exerted on the fronts of the lower lumbar discs may be sufficient to rupture the annulus fibrosus of one of the discs and produce a frank prolapse of the nucleus pulposus. b. Wide range strengthening exercises for the flexors and extensors of the spine and hips, which are taken from fixed inclined long sitting (see Fig. 105). The trunk is flexed to the lax stoop position, fully extended, and then returned to the erect position. Example: Wing fixed inclined long silting (balance bench); Trunk bending forwards to lax stoop position, followed by Trunk stretching upwards, lowering, and bending backwards to touch the floor with the head, and return to starting position (Fig. 105).
2 1. Prone kneeling; si followed by Leg strel backwards, and return GRADE
Intermediate GRADE
2 1. No progression. 2. Under grasp waI forwards-upwards and I p.87.) 3. Low grasp fixed i forwards to lax stoop lowering and bending t to starting position. (~ position.)
GRADE
Advanced GRADE
\ \
#
\\ I ....~
:!... )
\~ '..,;:
t \
'.i,"
..\..........
~
.~~.;'~
-')\1'.
'- ..
t \1+ J
Fig. 103.
Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1
No exercises.
GRADE
-"'=...
;,:"."; " . " "
..
:\1-·····-." \'. ,;., ' \
~
,", ;1 !:
Fig. 104.
.
-~~
;
Fig. 105.
1
1. No progression. 2. Under grasp waD forwards-upwards and, p.87, which shows the
1
1. No progression. 2. Stretch under gr. downwards-forwards 'U easier starting position 3. Wing fixed incli forwards to lax stoop lowering and bending 1 to starting position. (oS
2 1. No progression. 2. Under grasp I downwards-forwards ~ easier starting positiOll 3. As Exercise 3, G
GRADE
* For introductory em
TRUNK EXERCISES
Tnmk bending forwards .quer-stressing of Trunk Is (Fig. 104). k flexion exercises have IeI'Cises in this section, D be wholly pernicious. ed to do the utmost harm limit hip flexion. ring of the hamstrings, Itt'etched. The force of :rcises will be expended piphyseal plates of the piphysial plates will be defective growth of the l bodies and permanent the lower lumbar discs Jf one of the discs and
n and extensors of the qsitting (see Fig. lOS).
Jded, and then returned
bench); Trunk bending rl by Trunk stretching !s to touch the floor with Fig. lOS).
89
2 1. Prone kneeling; single high Knee raising with Head bending forwards, followed by Leg stretching and raising backwards with Head bending backwards, and return to starting position. (See Fig. 98, p. 86.) GRADE
Intermediate GRADE 1 1. No progression. 2. Under grasp walk forwards standing (beam at head height); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with bent knees. *' (See Fig. 102, p.87, which shows the exercise performed with straight knees.) GRADE
2
1. No progression.
2. Under grasp walk-forwards standing (beam at head height); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with straight legs. (See Fig. 102, p.87.) 3. Low grasp fixed inclined long sitting (balance bench); Trunk bending forwards to lax stoop position, followed by Trunk stretching upwards, lowering and bending backwards to touch the floor with the head, and return to starting position. (See Fig. lOS, p. 88, which shows a different starting position.)
Advanced 1 1. No progression.
GRADE
2. Stretch under grasp standing (beam); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with straight legs. (See Fig. 102, p. 87, which shows an easier starting position.) 3. Wing fixed inclined long sitting (balance bench); Trunk bending forwards to lax stoop position, followed by Trunk stretching upwards, lowering and bending backwards to touch the floor with the head, and return to starting position. (See Fig. lOS, p. 88.) Fig. 105.
2 1. No progression. 2. Under grasp hanging (beam); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with straight legs. (See Fig. 102, p. 87, which shows an easier starting position.) 3. As Exercise 3, Grade 1, but with arms in neck rest position. GRADE
* For introductory circling exercises at
the beam, see Technical Points, p. 91.
90
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Mobilizing Exercises
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Crook lying; Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards. (See Figs. 79 and 68, pp. 79 and 73.) lao Crook side lying (under hand grasping front edge of mattress, other hand pressing down on mattress in front of chest); Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards. 2. Side lying; Trunk bending forwards with high Knee raising, followed by Trunk bending backwards with Leg stretching and carrying backwards. (See Fig. 99, p. 86.) 2a. As the previous exercise, but during each trunk arching movement only one leg is carried back to the full extent.
2-2a. No progressiOi 3. Hanging from haD p.87.) 4. Crouch sitting; all jumping the Feet rhyth p.86.)
2 1-2a. No progressiOi 3. Hanging from haD backwards (Fig. 108).
GRADE
l
2 1. Prone kneeling; Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards with Head bending backwards and forwards (Fig. 106).
GRADE
~~~ a
b
c
a
Advanced GRADE 1 1-2a. No progressio 3. Hanging from 1:Jal
Fig. 106.
la. Reach grasp kneel sitting (wall bars); Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards. 1 b. Reach grasp sitting (wall bars); Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards. Ie. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards. 2-2a. No progressions.
~~
,
a
Intermediate 1 1. Wide lax stretch (palms downwards) lax stoop kneel sitting; Pluto sniffing (Fig. 107).
b
GRADE
~ a
~~ ~
b
Fig. 107.
c
TECHNICAL
pom
Introductory Exerci
1. Beam arranged at 1 The subject takes up a so that the chest is pre practises throwing dl attempts to straightel position on the other
91
TRUNK EXERCISES
is. (See Figs. 79 and 68,
dge of mattress, other ris tilting forwards and
2-2a. No progressions. 3. Hanging from hands and feet (rings or ropes); Nest H~ng. (See Fig. 101, p.87.) 4. Crouch sitting; alternating between prone falling and crouch sitting by jumping the Feet rhythmically backwards and forwards (1-6). (See Fig. 100, p.86.) 2 1-2a. No progressions. 3. Hanging from hands and feet (rings); Nest Hang with single Leg raising backwards (Fig. 108).
GRADE
Knee raising, followed d carrying backwards.
uk arching movement
:.c:kwards with Head a
c
b Fig. 108.
Advanced GRADE
1
1-2a. No progressions. 3. Hanging from hands and feet (rings); half Nest Hang (Fig. 109).
c
tilting forwards and
wards and backwards. biting forwards and
a
b
d
c
e
Fig. 109.
) kneel sitting; Pluto
c
TECHNICAL POINTS Introductory Exercises to Circling on the Beam 1. Beam arranged at Hip Level The subject takes up an under grasp full squat position, with knees forward, so that the chest is pressed against the beam and the feet are under it. He then practises throwing the legs up to the beam with bent knees. Later, he attempts to straighten the knees and pull over the beam to the standing position on the other side.
92
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
2. Beam a little under Hip Height The subject stands close to the beam, and grasps it with the fingers behind and the thumbs in front, so that the hands touch the thighs. He then leans over the beam as far as possible, simultaneously bringing the chin on to the chest and looking at the knees; he then bends the knees and brings the heels up to the seat, which allows the weight of the upper part of the body to carry the legs over the beam. The body should be kept in this curled-up position until the feet touch the floor.
lower side act staticall: sagging. Example: Side fall".
<-
-':"'::", ... "
\,. ...,
#
,,#
#/\~'
"
"
I
#
3. Using Two Beams: Lower Beam placed at Chest Level, and Upper Beam about 60 cm above ~'t The subject takes up the under grasp walk forwards standing position at the lower beam. He throws the legs up and gets the heels behind the upper beam; he then presses with the heels and bends the arms and circles up on the lower beam to the balance hanging position (Fig. 243, p. 271), In circling forwards downwards he bends the hip and knee joints as much as possible,
·1
Use of S~pporters Until the subject has acquired a good circling technique two supporters should stand on either side of him to give him confidence. Support is most often required when the subject changes his grasp before extending the body, and the assistants' hands should be placed under the shoulders and legs. It is also a wise precaution to put an agility mattress or mat under the beam in case the subject should accidentally lose his grasp.
-( ' - ''':'..:-1111____l o L
'''"
Fig. 110.
3. Fallout Outward EJ
The exercises are pert flexors of the thoracoh spine straight and to p leg. Unless the exeras. will be used dynamia Example: Wing Stall
Strengthening ExCi Elememary
1 1. Side toward stan
GRADE
LATERAL FLEXORS OF THE SPINE Types of Static Exercises 1. Trunk (Spine Straight) on Leg Trunk lowering and raising sideways from standing or thigh support side towards standing by abducting and adducting the hip joint of one leg, the other leg being raised and lowered sideways with the trunk. Throughout the exercise the lateral flexors of the spine on the upper side act statically to keep the spine straight and to prevent gravity from side flexing it. Example: Side toward standing (wall bar stool),' Trunk lowering sideways to place the hand on the stool with single Leg raising sideways (Fig. 110).
the hand on the stool 2, Inclined side 6 sideways.
2 1. Half stretch sid
GRADE
sideways to place the 2. Side falling; sin;
Intermediate GRADE
2. Lateral Movemems of the Arm and/or Leg from Side Falling Position or its Modifications During the exercises the lateral flexors of the thoracolumbar spine on the
1
1. Wing thigh su sideways with single 2. Half fist bend s stretching sidewaYS-I
93
TRUNK EXERCISES
ith the fingers behind thighs. He then leans ~ the chin on to the s and brings the heels rt of the body to carry lis curled-up position
lower side act statically to keep the trunk straight and to prevent it from sagging. Example: Side falling; single Leg raising sideways (Fig. III).
rei, and Upper Beam mding position at the :bind the upper beam; :in:les up on the lower . In circling forwards as possible.
lique two supporters
:ace. Support is most e extending the body, oulders and legs. It is IIlder the beam in case
Fig. 110.
Fig. Ill.
Fig. 112.
3. Fallout Outward Exercises The exercises are performed with or without arm movements. The lateral flexors of the thoracolumbar spine of the upper side act statically to keep the spine straight and to prevent it from bending towards the side of the forward leg. Unless the exercises are performed with perfect control the lateral flexors will be used dynamically. Example: Wing standing; fallout outwards, left and right (Fig. 112). Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1 1. Side toward standing (wall bar stool); Trunk lowering sideways to place
GRADE
the hand on the stool with single Leg raising sideways. (See Fig. llO.) 2. Inclined side falling (hand on wall bar stool); single Leg raising sideways .
.. thigh support side joint of one leg, the 1IIlk. Throughout the : act statically to keep jog it. ~ lowering sideways to Leg raising sideways
GRADE
2
1. Half stretch side toward standing (wall bar stool); Trunk lowering
sideways to place the free hand on the stool with single Leg raising sideways. 2. Side faIling; single Leg raising sideways (Fig. 111).
Intermediate 1 1. Wing thigh support side toward standing (beam); Trunk lowering
GRADE
Falling Position or
lumbar spine on the
sideways with single Leg raising sideways (Fig. 113). 2. Half fist bend side falling; single Leg raising sideways with single Arm stretching sideways-upwards.
94
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
3. Wing standing; fallout outwards, left and right. (See Fig. 112, p. 93.) 4. Stretch grasp high toward toe standing (wall bars); assuming Star position (Fig. 114). 4 ..- - ....
" \
,\·l)·~~ "'
'-¥
Types of Dynamic EI 1. Spine on Pelvis Lateral flexion of the sJl such as ride sitting, stricl Fixation of Pelvis, p. 9fi Examples: (i) Stride
(ii) Riden
jromJ
I
iI r-.
.
i a
,
/ t
. .____
~-~~
b Fig. 113.
\
•
I
(iii) Half ~
Trunk presm.
....
\
....~: ~: Fig. 114.
2 1. Half stretch half wing thigh support side towards standing (beam); Trunk lowering sideways with single Leg raising sideways. 2. Horizontal side falling; single Leg raising sideways (Fig. 115). GRADE
Fig. !16. .,.~
~ ,.
~
.!,
Fig. 115.
3. Fist bend standing; fallout outwards, left and right, with Arm stretching upwards. 4. No progression.
2. Spine on Pelvis: Pelt. Lateral flexion of the 1 pelvic tilting to occur, lying. The lateral flez abductors and adductOl Examples: (i) Stnd (ii) StritJ (iii) Fixe; bendl
Advanced GRADE
1
1. Stretch side toward standing (wall bars); Trunk lowering sideways to grasp the bars with single Leg raising sideways. 2. Half fist bend horizontal side falling; single Leg raising sideways with single Arm stretching sideways-upwards. 3-4. No progressions. 2 No progressions.
GRADE
3. Legs on Pelvis: Pew Leg raising sideways c group of exercises incll lateral flexors of the t adductors. Examples: (i) HaFQ (ii) ()'I)eT swiFQ
py TRUNK EXERCISES
n. (See Fig. 112, p. 93.) 1111 bars); assuming Star
,,----
..
\,
\~'--I~------1
. I
..
I r-. - __ I
,. ,./'
\.
"-.- ..
~
95
Types of Dynamic Exercises 1. Spine on Pelvis Lateral flexion of the spine from a starting position which fixes the pelvis, such as ride sitting, stride sitting, and foot support side toward standing (see Fixation of Pelvis, p. 99). Examples: (i) Stride sitting; Trunk bending sideways. (ii) Ridesitting (chair: thighs gripping chair back),- Trunk bending from side to side (Fig. 116). (iii) Half neck rest foot support side toward standing (wall bars); Trunk bending sideways towards the bars with rhythmical pressing to 3 counts (Fig. 117).
:
" -~:
Fig. 114.
~ds standing (beam); ieways. layS (Fig. 115).
Fig. 116.
In, with Arm stretching
t
Fig. 117.
Fig. 118.
2. Spine on Pelvis: Pelvis on Legs Lateral flexion of the trunk from a starting position which allows lateral pelvic tilting to occur, such as stride standing, stride lying, and fixed side lying. The lateral flexors of the thoracolumbar spine act with the hip abductors and adductors. Examples: (i) Stride standing; Trunk bending from side to side. (ii) Stride lying; Trunk bending sideways. (iii) Fixed side-lying (one leg slightly in front of other); Trunk bending sideways (Fig. 118).
lowering sideways to
: raising sideways with
3. Legs on Pelvis: Pelvis and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk Leg raising sideways or leg swinging from side to side from hanging; this group of exercises includes leg lowering sideways from reverse hanging. The lateral flexors of the thoracolumbar spine act with the hip abductors and adductors. Examples: (i) Hanging (wall bars); Leg raising sideways (Fig. 119). (ii) Over grasp hanging (beam); Arm walking sideways with Leg swinging from side to side (Fig. 120).
96
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
4. Pelvis and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk Hip updrawing from such starting positions as heave grasp lying and reach grasp standing. The pelvis is tilted sideways by the combined action of the lateral flexors of the thoracolumbar spine ofthe side of the raised hip, and the hip abductors of the opposite side. Example: Reach grasp standing (wall bars); Hip updrawing (Fig. 121). This group of exercises includes lateral pelvic tilting from side to side; the usual starting positions for these movements are reach grasp kneel sitting and reach grasp standing. Example: Reach grasp kneel sitting (wall bars); Pelvis tilting from side to side.
~ Fig. 120.
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Stride lying; Tl1l 2. Heave grasp lym, Hip updrawing. (Su.l 3. Stride sitting; TI
2 1. Lying; Trunk be side. 1a. Lying; Trunk b 2. Reach grasp Stall 3. Neck rest stride 4. Neck rest stride
GRADE
.-.---
~;:::>.
Fig. 119.
.<:~:.\l ~
Strengthening Eser
,,
~w:~l Fig. 121.
Fig. 122.
5. Simultaneous Movement of Trunk and One Leg Lateral flexion of the spine combined with either Hip updrawing or single Leg carrying sideways of the side to which the trunk is moved. The movements are performed in lying. Examples: (i) Lying; Trunk bending sideways with Hip updrawing of the same side. (ii) Lying; Trunk bending sideways with single Leg carrying to the same side.
Intermediate
1 1 and 1a. No prog! 2. Reach grasp W. updrawing, and lowe! 3. Stretch ride sitti sideways. 4. Stretch stride 51
GRADE
2 1-4. No progressi( 5. Side falling (one supporting surface, n (See Fig. 122, p. 96.)
GRADE
Advanced
1 1-5. No progressil 6. Fixed side-lyin sideways. (See Fig. J 7. Reverse hangiD
GRADE
6. Pelvis Lowering and Raising from Side Falling Position Pelvis lowering and raising from side falling by combined movements of lateral flexion of the thoracolumbar spine and hip abduction and adduction. The lateral flexors of the thoracolumbar spine on the underneath side of the trunk act with the hip abductors of the underneath leg and the hip adductors of the uppermost leg. Example: Side falling (one leg slightly in front of other); Pelvis lowering to touch supporting surface, raising as high as possible, and return to starting position (Fig. 122).
." Leg lowering side1i1 leg raising sideways fu one for the average P hanging is often used .
TRUNK EXERCISES
97
Strengthening Exercises grasp lying and reach IJI11bined action of the me raised hip, and the
rflfDing (Fig. 121). :from side to side; the Jr.lSp kneel sitting and
Elementary GRADE
1. 2. Hip 3.
1
Stride lying; Trunk bending sideways. Heave grasp lying (mattress) or lying (hands grasping sides of mattress); updrawing. (See Fig. 121.) Stride sitting; Trunk bending sideways.
2 1. Lying; Trunk bending sideways with single Leg carrying to the same side. la. Lying; Trunk bending sideways with Hip updrawing of the same side. 2. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); Hip updrawing. (See Fig. 121.) 3. Neck rest stride sitting; Trunk bending sideways. 4. Neck rest stride standing; Trunk bending sideways. GRADE
filting from side to side.
Intermediate I I and la. No progressions. 2. Reach grasp high half standing (wall bars and stool); Hip sinking, updrawing, and lowering to starting position. 3. Stretch ride sitting (chair: thighs gripping chair back); Trunk bending sideways. 4. Stretch stride standing; Trunk bending sideways.
GRADE
Fig. 122.
rNirawing or single Leg l The movements are flip updrawing of the
rtle Leg carrying to the
rm
bined movements of mon and adduction. lldemeath side of the ad the hip adductors
r); Pelvis lowering to
JOSSible, and return to
2. 1-4. No progressions. 5. Side falling (one leg slightly in front of other); Pelvis lowering to touch supponing surface, raising as high as possible, and return to staning position. (See Fig. 122, p. 96.)
GRADE
Advanced GRADE 1 1-5. No progressions. 6. Fixed side-lying (one leg slightly in front of other); Trunk bending sideways. (See Fig. 118, p. 95.) 7. Reverse hanging (wall bars); Leg lowering sideways (Fig. 123, p. 99.)*
* Leg lowering sideways from reverse hanging is easier for the working muscles than leg raising sideways from hanging. The reverse hanging position, however, is a difficult one for the average patient to maintain; for this reason leg raising sideways from hanging is often used before the other exercise.
98
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
2
1-5. No progressions.
6. Half neck rest fixed side lying (one leg slightly in front of other); Trunk bending sideways. 7. Hanging (wall bars); Leg raising sideways. (See Fig. 119, p. 96.)* GRADE
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary GRADE 1 1. Stride lying; Trunk bending from side to side. 2 1. Stride standing; Trunk bending from side to side. 2. Ride sitting (chair: thighs gripping chair back); Trunk bending from side to side, (See Fig. 116, p. 95.) 3. Reach grasp kneel sitting (wall bars); Pelvis tilting from side to side. GRADE
5. Wing fixed side u towards the bars with ' from the bars to 3 slow, position.) 6. No progression. 7. Over grasp hangim from side to side. (See,
Advanced GRADE 1 1. Lax stretch stride la-4. No progressiOl 5. As Exercise 5, Inll 6. No progression. :!:--..
:- Intermediate 1 1. Neck rest stride standing; Trunk bending from side to side. la. Stride standing; Trunk bending from side to side with rhythmical pressing to 3 counts in position. 2. Neck rest ride sitting (chair: thighs gripping chair back); Trunk bending from side to side. 2a. Ride sitting (chair: thighs gripping chair back); Trunk bending from side to side with rhythmical pressing to 3 counts in position. 3. No progression. 4. Stride standing; Trunk bending sideways with single Arm (of opposite side) swinging forwards-downwards-sideways-upwards, the Trunk being bent to the side during the sideways-upwards swing of the arm. 5. Half neck rest foot support side toward standing (wall bars); Trunk bending sideways towards the bars with rhythmical pressing to a given count. (See Fig. 117, p. 95.) 6. Half neck rest leg sideways stretch half kneeling; Trunk bending sideways with rhythmical pressing to a given count (Fig. 124). GRADE
'~I'
1
2 1. Head rest stride standing; Trunk bending from side to side. la-4. No progressions.
=t=I7f'
~.
=0=== Fig. 123.
Fixation of Pelvis d The pelvis is securely 1. Ride sitting on a I chair back, or the legs 126.) 2. High ride sitting, The pelvis is also fu the hips fully abduCtl toward standing, and II. Fig. 124.) The pelvis
GRADE
* Leg lowering sideways from reverse hanging is easier for the working muscles than leg raising sideways from hanging. The reverse hanging position, however, is a difficult one for the average patient to maintain; for this reason leg raising sideways from hanging is often used before the other exercise.
ROTATORS OF 1: Types of Dynamic: 1. Spine on Pelvis
Rotation of the spine ride sitting and proIl1
99
TRUNK EXERCISES
t front
of other); Trunk
'Fig. 119, p. 96.)*
:Ie.
i Trunk bending from
Dg
5. Wing fixed side toward standing (wall bars); Trunk bending sideways towards the bars with rhythmical pressing to 3 counts, and bending away from the bars to 3 slow counts. (See Fig. 125, which shows arms in neck rest position.) 6. No progression. 7. Over grasp hanging (beam); Arm walking sideways with Leg swinging from side to side. (See Fig. 120, p. 96.)
Advanced GRADE 1 1. Lax stretch stride standing; Trunk bending from side to side.
la-4. No progressions.
5. As Exercise 5, Intermediate, Grade 2, but arms in neck rest (Fig. 125). 6. No progression.
from side to side.
side to side. side with rhythmical : chair back); Trunk
i Trunk
Fig. 123.
Fig. 124.
Fig. 125.
bending from
osition.
ogle Arm (of opposite ds, the Trunk being tfthe arm. Ig (wall bars); Trunk ssing to a given count.
ling; Trunk bending 1'ig. 124).
Fixation of Pelvis during Lateral Flexion of Spine The pelvis is securely fixed in the following positions: 1. Ride sitting on a chair, or a balance bench, with the thighs gripping the chair back, or the legs gripping the bench sides. (See Fig. 116, p. 95 and Fig. 126.) 2. High ride sitting, with the legs gripping the high plinth. The pelvis is also firmly fixed in positions where one leg is supported, with the hips fully abducted; such positions include foot support (or fixed) side toward standing, and leg sideways stretch half kneeling. (See Fig. 117, p. 95 and Fig. 124.) The pelvis is less securely fixed in stride sitting.
!ide to side.
lie working muscles than
Ill, however,
is a difficult I nising sideways from
ROTATORS OF THE SPINE Types of Dynamic Exercises 1. Spine on Pelvis Rotation of the spine from a starting position which fixes the pelvis, such as ride sitting and prone kneeling (see Fixation of Pelvis, p. 103).
100
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Examples: (i) Wing ride sitting (balance bench: legs gripping bench sides); Trunk turning (Fig. 126). (ii) Prone kneeling; Trunk turning with single Arm swinging sideways and rhythmical pressing to 3 counts (Fig. 127).
~ Jt~
a
Fig. 126.
2. Wing stride-sitt.iol 3. Stride-standing; '1 4. Reach grasp close 2 1 and 2. No progresl 3. Stride lying; Trw (Fig. 129).
GRADE
b
Fig. 127.
2. Legs, Pelvis, and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk Rotation of the trunk by moving the pelvis and legs together, the upper trunk being the fixed point. Example: Yard (palms on floor) crook lying; Knee swinging from side to side (Fig. 128).
4. Heave grasp lyiDj 4a. Crook lying; Pel 5. Prone kneeling; I (See Fig. 127, p. 100, exercise.)
Intermediate
1 1-4a. No progressi 5. Turn prone kne turning with single A.! the movement perfor
GRADE
a
b Fig. 128.
1ti .~
3. Spine on Pelvis: Pelvis on Legs GRADE 2 Rotation ofthe trunk from a starting position which allows hip rotation, such 1-5. No progressi4 as stride standing, standing, and stride lying. 6. Yard (palms 0 Example: Stride standing; Trunk turning from side to side with Arm swing lowering sideways (I ing loosely at the sides. 4. Pelvis and Lumbar Spine on Upper Trunk and Legs Pelvic rotation from a starting position which allows hip rotation and fixes the upper trunk and legs. Example: Reach grasp close standing (wall bars); Pelvis turning.
~~-
j~~ a
Pi
Strengthening Exercises
Elementary GRADE
1
1. Wing ride sitting (balance bench: thighs gripping bench sides); Trunk
turning (Fig. 126).
Advanced
1 1-5. No progre
GRADE
101
TRUNK EXERCISES
i
gripping bench sides);
single Arm swinging .anmts (Fig. 127).
I
2. Wing stride-sitting; Trunk turning. 3. Stride-standing; Trunk turning. 4. Reach grasp close standing (wall bars); Pelvis turning. GRADE
2
1 and 2. No progressions. 3. Stride lying; Trunk turning with single Arm carrying across the chest (Fig. 129).
b Fig. 129
Mer, the upper trunk StDinging from side to
4. Heave grasp lying (wall bars); Pelvis turning.
4a. Crook lying; Pelvis raising, turning, and lowering.
5. Prone kneeling; slow Trunk turning with single Arm raising sideways. (See Fig. 127, p. 100, which shows the movement performed as a mobility exercise.) Intermediate 1 1-4a. No progressions. 5. Turn prone kneeling (one arm bent loosely across chest); slow Trunk turning with single Arm raising sideways. (See Fig. 127, p. 100, which shows the movement performed as a mobility exercise.)
GRADE
I'WS
hip rotation, such
side with Arm swing-
rotation and fixes the
is turning.
GRADE
2
1-5. No progressions. 6. Yard (palms on floor) half crook half vertical leg lift lying; Leg lowering sideways (Fig. 130).
~ b
a
Fig. 130.
bench sides); Trunk
Advanced GRADE 1 1-5. No progressions.
Fig. 131.
102
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
6. Yard (palms on floor) vertical leg lift lying; slow Leg swinging from side to side (Fig. 131).
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1 1. Arm cross ride sitting (chair: thighs gripping chair back); Trunk
2 1-5. No progressiOil 6. Over grasp fixed! Trunk turning with siJ 134, which shows a JDI
GRADE
GRADE
Advanced
turning from side to side. 2. Stride standing; Trunk turning from side to side with Arm swinging loosely at the sides.
GRADE
1
1-3. No progressiOil 4. Lax reach stoop a alternate Arm swinginj
2 1. Across bend ride sitting (chair: thighs gripping chair back); Trunk turning from side to side with alternate Arm flinging. 2. Half lumbar rest stride standing; single Arm swinging forwards, and sideways with Trunk turning. 3. Yard (palms on floor) crook lying; Knee swinging from side to side. (See Fig. 128, p. 100.) 4. Prone kneeling; Trunk turning with single Arm swinging sideways. (See Fig. 127, p.l00, which shows a rhythmical pressing exercise.) GRADE
~
Fig. 13
Intermediate 1 1. Arm cross ride slttmg (chair: thighs gripping chair back); Trunk turning from side to side with rhythmical pressing to 3 counts in position.
GRADE
2. Stride standing; Trunk turning from side to side with Arm swinging loosely at the sides and rhythmical pressing to 3 counts in position. 3. No progression. 4. Turn prone kneeling (one arm bent loosely across chest); Trunk turning with single Arm swinging sideways and rhythmical pressing to 3 counts (Fig. 132).
Asf
b
a
Fig. 132.
5. Reach half kneeling; Trunk turning with single Arm swinging sideways and rhythmical pressing to a given count.
5. No progression. 6. Over grasp hom such a height that bar: Trunk turning with s 2
No progressions.
GRADE
Fixation of Pelvis
t
The pelvis is secure.: 1. Ride sitting on a chair back, or the legs and 100.) 2. High ride sitti~ The pelvis is also' sitting and kneel sittm these positions diftk crook sitting provide
103
TRUNK EXERCISES IV
Leg swinging from
: chair back); Trunk
2 1-5. No progressions. 6. Over grasp fixed stride fall hanging (beam: feet fixed by living support); Trunk turning with single Arm swinging sideways to touch floor. (See Fig. 134, which shows a more advanced exercise.)
GRADE
Advanced GRADE
e with Arm swinging
1
1-3. No progressions. 4. Lax reach stoop stride standing; Trunk turning from side to side with alternate Arm swinging sideways and across the chest (Fig. 133).
, chair back); Trunk inging forwards, and ElK from side to side.
I swinging sideways. og exercise.) Fig. 133.
Fig. 134.
chair back); Trunk J counts in position. ~ with Arm swinging " in position.
5. No progression. 6. Over grasp horizontal fall hanging (beam and living support: beam at such a height that hand cannot touch floor if grasp of one hand is released); Trunk turning with single Arm swinging sideways (Fig. 134).
best); Trunk turning sing to 3 counts (Fig.
GRADE
n swinging sideways
2
No progressions.
Fixation of Pelvis during Spinal Rotation
The pelvis is securely fixed in the following positions:
1. Ride siuing on a chair, or a balance bench, with the thighs gripping the chair back, or the legs gripping the bench sides. (See Figs. 116 and 126, pp. 95 and 100.) 2. High ride siuing, with the legs gripping the high plinth. The pelvis is also well fixed in prone kneeling (see Fig. 127, p. 100). Cross sitting and kneel sitting give good fixation of the pelvis, but adults usually find these positions difficult to maintain. Siuing, stride siuing, long siELing and crook sitting provide some fixation of the pelvis.
104
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
COMBINED EXERCISES FOR THE ROTATORS, FLEXORS, AND EXTENSORS Types of Dynamic Exercises
Only the main types of combined exercises have been classified here. All the
exercises are based on the following sequence of movement-Spine on Pelvis:
Pelvis on Legs.
1. Working Flexors and Rotators of Spine with Hip Rotators Flexion and rotation of the trunk, without flexion of the hips, from lying and stride lying. Example: Stride lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with turning and single Arm carrying across the chest (Fig. 135).
:. _,.tc - -
~
.. ..,
v '-< r-.-.. . '1
,
lJ i1;~~:::6?:~\
~]
~
I!J
Fig. 137.
Strengthening Exerclsel Elementary GRADE
2. Working Flexors and Rotators of Spine and Hips
Flexion and rotation of the spine and hips from fixed lying and fixed crook lying. Example: Neck rest fixed crook lying; Trunk bending forwards with turning (Fig. 136).
~ Fig. 135.
(~ ~f~~~~ ([ ~~.
1
1. Stride lying; Trunk t Arm carrying across the ell
2 1. Stride lying; upper "I Arm carrying across the ell
GRADE
V-i~
Fig. 136.
3. Working Extensors and Rotators of Spine with Hip Extensors Extension and rotation of the spine, with extension of the hips, from a lax stoop position which prevents pelvic rotation. (See Fixation of Pelvis, p. 103.) Example: Fist bend lax stoop kneel sitting; Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' with turning (Fig. 137).
4. Working Extensors and Rotators of Spine and Hips Extension and rotation of the spine and hips from such positions as fixed prone lying and lax stoop stride standing. Examples: (i) Neck rest fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with turning (Fig. 138). (ii) Lax stoop back lean stride standing (heels 30-40cm infront of upright); Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' in different planes (Fig. 139).
Intermediate 1 L No progression.
GRADE
2. Fixed lying; Trunk 1 from arms. GRADE
2
L No progression.
2. Fixed slight crook l] single Arm carrying acrosl
Advanced GRADE 1 1. No progression. 2. Wing fixed crook lyiI1 136, p. 104.)
2 1. No progression. 2. Neck rest fixed crook 136, p. 104.)
GRADE
'Y
105
TRUNK EXERCISES
mRS, FLEXORS,
M
D classified here. All the C'lD.ellt-Spine on Pelvis:
l'Dtators !be hips, from lying and
Fig. 137.
Fig. 138.
Fig. 139.
Is with turning and single
Strengthening Exercises (Flexors and Rotators)
d lying and fixed crook I' forwards with turning
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Stride lying; Trunk turning with Head bending forwards and single Arm carrying across the chest. 2 1. Stride lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with turning and single Arm carrying across the chest. (See Fig. 135, p. 104.)
GRADE
'-;~
~::.:::::.. "
~
I
\
.
•
. ".
W·136.
Extensors
£Jf the hips, from a lax arion of Pelvis, p. lO3.) stretching 'vertebra by
uch positions as fixed
mding backwards with
els 30-40cm injront oj , vertebra' in different
Intermediate 1 1. No progression. 2. Fixed lying; Trunk bending forwards with turning, with assistance from arms. GRADE
2 1. No progression.
GRADE
2. Fixed slight crook lying; Trunk bending forwards with turning and single Arm carrying across the chest. Advanced GRADE 1 1. No progression. 2. Wing fixed crook lying; Trunk bending forwards with turning. (See Fig. 136, p. lO4.) 2 1. No progression.
GRADE
2. Neck rest fixed crook lying; Trunk bending forwards with turning. (Fig. 136, p. lO4.)
106
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Strengthening Exercises (Extensors and Rotators) Elementary GRADE
1
3. Head rest fixed pm (See Fig. 138, p. 105.) 4. As Exercise 4, Adv.
1. Fist bend lax stoop kneel slttmg; Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' with turning. (See Fig. 137, p. 105.) GRADE
CIRCUMDUCTORS
2
1. As Exercise 1 above, but arms in neck rest. 2. Lax stoop back lean stride standing (heels 30-40 cm in front of upright); Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' in different planes (See Fig. 139, p. lOS.)
Intermediate 1 1. Across bend lax stoop kneel sitting; Trunk stretching 'vertebra by
GRADE
vertebra' with turning and single Arm stretching and raising midway upwards. 2. As Exercise 2, Elementary, Grade 2, but arms in neck rest. GRADE
1
Types of Dynamic Elr.l
The exercises are based , Pelvis: Pelvis on Legs.
1. Working CircumductDI Circumduction of the sp from such starting positi Example: Wing ride siJ rolling (Fig.
2. Working CircumauctIJ
2
1 and 2. No progressions.
3. Fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with turning.
Circumduction of the : standing and lax fall hal
Advanced 1
1 and 2. No progressions.
3. Wing fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with turning.
GRADE
~!
GRADE
2
1 and 2. No progressions. 3. Neck rest fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with turning. (See Fig. 138, p. 105.) 4. Wing lax stoop fixed high thigh support across prone lying (balance benches, 2 high); Trunk stretching with turning to arch tum position (Fig. 140).
/~>!
L-··.J·
L :g:
.J~
Fig. 140.
3
1 and 2. No progressions.
GRADE
Fig. 141.
Examples: (i) Wing (ii) Lax J
Mobilizing Exercise Elementary
1 1. Wing ride sittina! rolling (Fig. 141). 2. Wing stride stan.
GRADE
107
TRUNK EXERCISES
lators)
3. Head rest fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with turning. (See Fig. 138, p. 105.) 4. As Exercise 4, Advanced, Grade 2, but arms in neck rest position.
It stretching 'vertebra by
CIRCUMDUCTORS OF THE SPINE -40cm in front of upright); rent planes (See Fig. 139,
k stretching 'vertebra by iog and raising midway
Types of Dynamic Exercises The exercises are based on the following sequence of movement-Spine on Pelvis: Pelvis on Legs.
1. Working Circumductors of Spine with Hip Flexors and Extensors Circumduction of the spine combined with flexion and extension of the hips from such starting positions as ride sitting and high ride sitting. Example: Wing ride sitting (balance bench: legs gripping bench sides); Trunk rolling (Fig. 141) .
.. in neck rest.
Is with turning.
2. Working Circumductors of Spine with Hip Muscles Circumduction of the spine combined with hip movements from stride standing and lax fall hanging (rings).
,
.~-.~-",
,
M....
/'
,/~,.# f
#"
-- ~ ... "
;i"~ ....
\::';'"
;wards with turning.
"'-'
: backwards with turning.
prone lying (balance I) arch turn position (Fig.
Fig. 141.
Fig. 142.
toSS
Examples: (i) Wing stride standing; Trunk rolling. (ii) Lax fall hanging (rings); rolling (Fig. 142).
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary GRADE
I
1. Wing ride sitting (balance bench: legs gripping bench sides); Trunk rolling (Fig. 141). 2. Wing stride standing; Trunk rolling.
108
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
2 1. Neck rest ride sitting (balance bench: legs gripping bench sides); Trunk
GRADE
9. Breal
rolling. 2. Neck rest stride standing; Trunk rolling.
Intermediate GRADE
1
No progressions. 2 1 and 2. No progressions. 3. Lax fall hanging (rings); rolling. (See Fig. 142, p. 107.)
GRADE
Strengthening Exercises
See Trunk rolling exercises in previous section. The movements are per
formed more slowly than when used as mobility exercises.
Breathing exercises rna unilateral exercises whi exercises combined wit breathing. Bilateral localized e:JI breathing, and General exercises are crook hi respiratory movemenb by the use of a webbiJI Examples: (i) Crook CosUIJ
~
Fig. 143. La
(ii) Cr/)j breIJ
dun
(iii) Crt)
endl prel
Bilateral breathin thorax when the rail
py
ping bench sides); Trunk
• p. 107.)
lie movements are per rcises.
9. Breathing exercises
Breathing exercises may be divided into three main groups: (1) Bilateral or unilateral exercises which are localized to the respiratory muscles; (2) Arm exercises combined with breathing; and (3) Trunk exercises combined with breathing. Bilateral localized exercises consist of Apical, Costal, and Diaphragmatic breathing, and General deep breathing. The best starting positions for these exercises are crook half-lying, crook lying and half-lying (p. 269). The respiratory movements are localized by the therapist's or patient's hands or by the use of a webbing strap or belt. Examples: (i) Crook half-lying (hands on sides of lower ribs); lower lateral Costal breathing with light pressure from hands (Fig. 143).
Fig. 143. Lower lateral Costal breathing from crook half-lying.
(ii) Crook half-lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphragmatic breathing, with emphasis on contraction of abdominal wall during expiration (Fig. 144). (iii) Crook half-lying (webbing strap round lower chest, with free ends held by hands); lower lateral Costal breathing with light pressure from strap (Fig. 145). Bilateral breathing exercises are used: (a) to increase the mobility of the thorax when the range of expiration or inspiration is reduced; (b) to ventilate
109
110
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
~ .-~
!1'\"
.11:""
PI
function. For example breathing the ribs are til the serratus anterior III dragging action of the I increase the range of iI
BILATERAL LOCi!
Exercises to
Fig. 145. Using a strap to localize lower lateral Costal breathing.
the lungs and prevent stagnation of mucous secretions; and (c) to teach correct breathing habits. Unilateral localized exercises are used in the treatment of certain chest conditions. For example, Crook half-lying (hand on side of left lower chest); left lower lateral Costal breathing with hand pressure (Fig. 146), may be used in the treatment of empyema. 2. Arm exercises with breathing, e.g. Stride sitting; Arm raising sideways upwards with breathing. 3. Trunk exercises with breathing, e.g. Stride sitting; Trunk bending sideways with breathing. Physiotherapists tend to concentrate on the first group of exercises, because in the remainder the associated arm and trunk movements neutralize the action of the respiratory muscles; hence there is no net gain in respiratory
InCreBIi
In these exercises eIDIl must be as easy and sl 1. Crook half-lying with emphasis on coni 144, p. 110.) 2. Crook half-lying breathing with pressu p. 109.) 3. Crook half-lying breathing with pressu 4. Crook half-tying clavicles); Apical breli In Exercises 1-3 a 1'.1 (See Fig. 145, p. llO. 5. Slight stoop sin resting on a table iI pressure by therapisl may use a strap to 10 6. Crook half-Iyinj
BREATHING EXERCISES
111
Fig. 146. Unilateral Costal breathing.
function, For example, in the exercise Arm raising sideways-upwards with breathing the ribs are fixed by the intercostal muscles, to stabilize the origin of the serratus anterior muscle; the fixation of the ribs neutralizes the upward dragging action of the pectoral muscles on the thorax, which would otherwise increase the range of inspiratory chest movement.
BILATERAL LOCALIZED BREATHING EXERCISES Exercises to Increase the Expiratory Range
ostaI breathing,
ions; and (c) to teach
IDlent of certain chest rof left lower chest); left 16), may be used in the
Arm raising sidewaysTrunk bending sideways [ group of exercises, movements neutralize net gain in respiratory
In these exercises emphasis is laid on prolonged, full expiration. Inspiration must be as easy and shallow as possible, 1. Crook half-lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphragmatic breathing with emphasis on contraction of abdominal waH during expiration. (See Fig. 144, p, 110,) 2. Crook half-lying (hands on sides of lower chest); lower lateral Costal breathing with pressure by hands on ribs during expiration, (See Fig. 143, p, 109.) 3. Crook half-lying (hands on sides of upper chest); upper lateral Costal breathing with pressure by hands on ribs during expiration, 4, Crook half-lying (forearms crossed and fingers resting on chest below clavicles); Apical breathing with pressure by fingers during expiration, In Exercises 1-3 a webbing strap may be used to localize the chest movements, (See Fig. 145, p, 110,) 5, Slight stoop sitting (patient's forehead and arms supported on pillows resting on a table in front of his stool); posterior Basal breathing with pressure by therapist's hands during expiration, Alternatively, the patient may use a strap to localize the rib movements, 6, Crook half-lying; general deep breathing with emphasis on expiration,
112
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
7. Stride sitting; Trunk dropping loosely forwards-downwards to lax stoop position, with expiration, and Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' with shallow inspiration. 8. Stride sitting; Trunk turning with Arm swinging loosely at the sides: expiration during the backward turning movements, and shallow inspiration during the forward turning movements.
Exercises to Increase the Inspiratory Range
In these exercises emphasis is laid on deep inspiration, followed by 'normal'
expiration.
1. Crook half-lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphragmatic breathing with emphasis on the relaxation of the abdominal wall during inspiration. (See Fig. 144, p. 110.) 2. Crook half-lying (hands on sides of lower chest); lower lateral Costal breathing with light pressure from hands. (See Fig. 143, p. 109.) 3. Crook half-lying (hands on sides of upper chest); upper lateral Costal breathing with light pressure from hands. 4. Crook half-lying (forearms crossed and fingers resting on chest below clavicles); Apical breathing with light pressure from fingers. In Exercises 1-3 a webbing strap may be used to localize the chest movements and to give light resistance. (See Fig. 145, p. 110.) 5. Crook half-lying; general deep breathing. 6. Skipping and rhythmical hopping exercises, running and swimming, to make the patient breathe deeply.
I
full-width Velcro fasteni it provides the chest wal Supporting the sides 4 has the effect of enhaD diaphragm and thoracic: expended in a lateral dO
TECHNICAL POINT Practical Techniques EXERCISES TO VENTILATE THE LUNGS AND PREVENT STAGNATION OF MUCOUS SECRETIONS
The bilateral localized breathing exercises given in the previous lists are used,
a full respiratory excursion being encouraged. Unilateral localized exercises
are also used.
Postural drainage and some form of percussion, especially shakings and coarse vibrations, are frequently employed in association with the breathing exercises. The patient is also trained to cough effectively in order to assist the expectoration of the loosened secretions. The coughing action is greatly improved if the therapist or the patient supports the sides of the lower chest firmly with the hands. Alternatively, support can be given by the use of a broad webbing strap, which is positioned as shown in Fig. 145, p. 110. The patient tightens the ends of the strap held in his hands to produce the necessary tension. A Hawksley Cough-Lok (Fig. 147) is sometimes used in place of a webbing strap; it has the advantage of being about 10 em wide and of being fitted with
When the breathing eXeJ hands to localize the m understands the breathil (about 1·5 m long and ' 143-146, pp. 109 and 11 the strap when the exet'1 When the therapist is supervising his breathiJ enables him both to fet difficulty. The patient'5 particularly during expi hygiene, but reduces the infected secretions.
Starting Positions
Ideally, localized breath
BREATHING EXERCISES
113
Is-downwards to lax 'vertebra by vertebra'
J loosely at the sides: Hi shallow inspiration
,.~,: .. ..';
'.,,"<:~
.
....
followed by 'normal' ~gmatic
o during
breathing inspiration.
; lower lateral Costal
:3, p. 109.)
Fig. 147. A Hawksley Cough-Lok.
; upper lateral Costal ~g
on chest below
ngers. re the chest movements
full-width Velcro fastenings. When adjusted in position round the lower ribs it provides the chest wall with an extremely firm and stable support. Supporting the sides of the lower thorax in this manner during coughing has the effect of enhancing the upward pressure of the abdomen on the diaphragm and thoracic contents by preventing some of the pressure being expended in a lateral direction.
:og and swimming, to
o PREVENT
ll"eVious lists are used, raJ localized exercises
[JCcia1ly shakings and :Ill with the breathing , in order to assist the
:rapist or the patient bands. Alternatively, p, which is positioned :ods of the strap held
in place of a webbing d of being fitted with
TECHNICAL POINTS Practical Techniques When the breathing exercises are first taught the therapist generally uses his hands to localize the movements for the patient. Later, when the patient understands the breathing techniques, he uses his hands or a webbing strap (about 1·5 m long and 7 em wide) to localize the chest movements (Figs. 143-146, pp. 109 and 111). Light resistance may be given with the hands or the strap when the exercises are used to increase the range of inspiration. When the therapist is localizing breathing movements for the patient, or supervising his breathing techniques, he should adopt a position which enables him both to feel and observe the respiratory movements without difficulty. The patient's head should be turned away from the therapist, particularly during expiration. This is not only in the interests of normal hygiene, but reduces the possibility of the therapist coming into contact with infected secretions. Starting Positions Ideally, localized breathing exercises are carried out from a starting position
114
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
which gives the body maximum support, relaxes the abdominal muscles, and does not require any unnecessary muscle work, e.g. crook half-lying (Fig. 143, p. 109), crook lying (Fig. 148) and half-lying. The head is generally supported by a pillow; in the crook and crook half-lying positions pillow support for the thighs is also very helpful in ensuring relaxation.
10. Pe]
Exercises to strengtbel (1) Minor degrees of
Stress incontinence CIl by laxity ofthe mud may be produced by i Pelvic floor exercise Fig. 148. Crook lying as a starting position for localized breathing; the thigh and head pillows ensure relaxation.
Other starting positions are used to achieve specific purposes. For example, a modified half-lying position (with the patient lying on one side) is useful in localizing movement to the ribs of the 'free' side. A modified stoop sitting position is also used for posterior basal breathing (p. 111).
Physical Education From the standpoint of physical education sitting and standing may be used as starting positions for localized breathing exercises in addition to the positions previously described.
Breathing Exercises in Physical Education Correct breathing habits are of considerable importance to the normal individual. For example, correct diaphragmatic breathing helps to prevent the development of lax abdominal muscles, and so indirectly assists in the maintenance of good posture. In the older age groups full diaphragmatic excursion is essential in order to ventilate the base of each lung adequately. Full ventilation prevents the accumulation of stagnant mucous secretions in the base of the lung, which are prone to become infected. Infected secretions may contribute to the formation of such conditions as bronchiectasis and lung abscess.
TYPES OF PELVI( The muscles of the pc 1. By contracting t maximus. This produ sphincters of tbe blad The hip adductor'S together from such S1:II muscles are also exen: Examples: (i) CrooJ (ii) Crool Pelvi 2. By activating 'til pelvic floor whereby abdominal wall in 01 abdominal pressure'. i The abdominal wa gluteus maximus and crook lying and 'crool Examples: (i) Croo, ing '/) expir, (ii) Croo, ing r.r. contT
*Yates-Bell J. G. aru (Congress number: Sep
Iiominal muscles, and rook half-lying (Fig. be head is generally ring positions pillow relaxation.
10. Pelvic floor exercises
Exercises to strengthen the pelvic floor muscles are used in the treatment of (1) Minor degrees of prolaps; of the vaginal wall after childbirth, and (2) Stress incontinence caused by injury to the bladder sphincters, or, in women, by laxity of the muscles of the pelvic floor. Injury to the bladder sphincters may be produced by instrumentation or by prostatic resection. Pelvic floor exercises are also used in ante- and post-natal training.
ilhing: the thigh and
TYPES OF PELVIC FLOOR EXERCISES
lIpOses. For example, one side) is useful in lDdified stoop sitting 11).
landing may be used in addition to the
I
IDee to the normal ing helps to prevent Iirectly assists in the I fun diaphragmatic IICh lung adequately. DUCOUS secretions in LInfected secretions lDCbiectasis and lung
The muscles of the pelvic floor are exercised indirectly in three ways. 1. By contracting the hip adductors and the lower fibres of the gluteus maximus. This produces an associated contraction of the levator ani and the sphincters of the bladder.* The hip adductors and extensors are exercised as separate groups or together from such starting positions as crook lying, lying, and standing. The muscles are also exercised in association with the sphincter ani. Examples: (i) Crook lying (soft pillow between knees); Knee closing. (ii) Crook lying (soft pillow between knees); Knee closing with Pelvis raising and contraction of Sphincter ani. 2. By activating 'the postural reflex between the abdominal wall and the pelvic floor whereby the pelvic floor contracts at the same time as the abdominal wall in order to withstand the strain of the increased intra abdominal pressure'. * The abdominal wall is exercised either alone or in association with the gluteus maximus and external sphincter ani from such starting positions as crook lying and crook side lying. Examples: (i) Crook lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphragmatic breath ing with strong contraction of the Abdominal wall during expiration. (See Figs. 144 and 148, pp. 110 and 114.) (ii) Crook lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphragmatic breath ing with strong contraction of the Abdominal wall, plus Anal contraction, during expiration. *Yates-Bell J. G. and Cooksey F. S. (1937) (Congress number: Sept.), pp. 28, 31, and 32.
115
J.
Chart. Soc. Massage Med. Gymn.
116
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
(iii) Crook lying; Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards, with emphasis on the backward tilting movement. (See Fig. 149, which shows a different starting position.) 3. By contracting the external sphincter ani. It is possible that a con traction of this muscle is associated with a contraction of the pelvic floor muscles. The external sphincter ani may be exercised independently or in asso ciation with the gluteal, abdominal, and hip adductor muscles. Specific exercises for the sphincter are performed from such starting positions as lying, crook lying, and standing. Example: Crook lying; Anal contractions (attempting to draw anus up into pelvis).
~~_. a
_b
Fig. 149.
r~-
~r----
;e
Fig. ISO.
Pelvic floor Exercises Elementary 1 1. Crook lying; Anal contractions (attempting to draw anus up into pelvis). 1a. As above, but with legs crossed. Fig. 149 shows the starting position. 2. Lying; Leg turning outwards with Anal contractions. 3. Crook lying (soft pillow between knees); Knee closing. 4. Crook lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphragmatic breathing with strong contraction of the abdominal wall during expiration. (See Figs. 144 and 148, pp. 110 and 114.) 5. Crook lying; Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards, with emphasis on the backward tilting movement. (See Fig. 149, which shows a different starting position.) Sa. As Exercise 5, but taken from crook side lying.
5b. As Exercise 5, but taken from lying, with legs crossed (Fig. 149).
GRADE
2 1 and 2. No progressions. 3. Crook lying (soft pillow between knees); Knee closing with Pelvis raising and Anal contractions (Fig. 150). 3a. Slight leg lift lying (legs crossed: heels supported on stool); Pelvis raising with Hip adduction. 3b. Inclined long sitting (ankles crossed); pressing Knees together with Gluteal and Anal contractions.
GRADE
4. Crook lying (baJ strong contraction 01 expiration. 5-5b. No progress
Intermediate GRADE 1 1-3a. No progressi 3b. Standing (legl contraction. 4-5b. No progresSi 6. Walking while II 7. Standing; practi 8. Standing; practi Gluteal and Anal COIl
PELVIC FLOOR EXERCISES
and backwards, with (See Fig. 149, tion.)
I possible that a con
DO of the pelvic floor
rlDJUmt.
pendently or in asso :tor muscles. Specific I starting positions as
r to draw anus up into
----, A.!-.,.- ~i
----,.
Fig. 150.
.. anus up into pelvis).
I the starting position.
tions.
losing.
pnaric breathing with
irarion. (See Figs. 144
rds, with emphasis on
ich shows a different
crossed (Fig. 149).
e closing with Pelvis n:ed on stool); Pelvis
Knees together with
117
4. Crook lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphragmatic breathing with strong contraction of the abdominal wall, plus Anal contraction, during expiration. S-Sb. No progressions.
Intermediate I 1-3a. No progressions. 3b. Standing (legs crossed); Heel raising with Gluteal and Anal contraction. 4-Sb. No progressions. 6. Walking while maintaining contraction of Gluteus maximus. 7. Standing; practising combined sustained Gluteal and Anal contraction. 8. Standing; practising coughing while maintaining combined sustained Gluteal and Anal contraction. GRADE
11. Shoulder girdle exercises
RETRACTORS Strengthening
1. Sitting; Shoulder 2. Lying; Shoulder 1
PROTRACTORS AI Strengthening These exercises provide work for the muscles which activate the sternoclavi cular and acromioclavicular joints without causing movements of the shoulder joint. Examples of some dynamic exercises are given here.
1. Sitting; Shoulder: 2. Crook lying; exen
Mobilizing Sitting; Shoulder r01lD
ELEVATORS Strengthening Sitting; Shoulder raising.
ELEVATORS, PRa Mobilizing
Mobilizing 1. Sitting; continuous Shoulder raising and lowering. 2. Sitting; alternate Shoulder shrugging.
DEPRESSORS Strengthening 1. Sitting; Shoulder depression. 2. Lying; Shoulder depression.
ELEVATORS AND DEPRESSORS Strengthening 1. Lying; Shoulder raising and depression, and return to starting position. 2. Sitting; Shoulder raising, lowering, depression, and return to starting position.
PROTRACTORS Strengthening 1. Sitting; Shoulder rounding 2. Lying; Shoulder rounding. l1S
1. Sitting; Shoulder 2. As above, but wi1
SHOULDER GIRDLE EXERCISES
·
exerCIses
activate the sternocIavi IOvements of the shoulder :II here.
I
:.ring.
:rum to starting position. II, and return to starting
119
RETRACTORS Strengthening L Sitting; Shoulder bracing. 2. Lying; Shoulder bracing.
PROTRACTORS AND RETRACTORS Strengthening 1. Sitting; Shoulder rounding and bracing, and return to starting position. 2. Crook lying; exercise as above. .r;
Mobilizing Sitting; Shoulder rounding and bracing.
ELEVATORS, PROTRACTORS AND RETRACTORS Mobilizing L Sitting; Shoulder girdle rolling with emphasis on retraction. 2. As above, but with emphasis on protraction.
SHOll
12. Combined shoulder joint and shoulder girdle exercises
2. Bend sitting (stil forwards-upwards. * 3. Grasp walk-foIWlll bending, stretching fOI1 4. Reach grasp stOOl Arm raising forwards-u
Advanced In the majority of the exercises given here the shoulder- girdle moves with the shoulder joint; in certain of the exercises, however, shoulder girdle move ment is negligible, e.g. in rotation of the shoulder joint from the neutral position.
1. SHOULDER FLEXORS AND FORWARD ELEVATORS OF ARM Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE 1 1. Bend lying; single or double Elbow raising forwards. 2 1. Bend sitting; single or double Elbow raising forwards or forwards upwards. 2. Bend sitting; single or double Arm stretching forwards-upwards.
GRADE
3 1. Sitting; single or double Arm raising forwards or forwards-upwards. 2. No progression.
GRADE
Intermediate
1
1. No progression. 2. First bend walk-fCl forwards-upwards. 3--4. No progressiODll 5. Grasp walk-foIWlll forwards-upwards, and forearm to 3 counts. 5a. As above, but bot 6. Grasp walk-foIWlll forwards-upwards, and forearm to 3 counts. 6a. As above, but bot
2 1-4. No progressiODll 5-6a. Grasp walk-fa forwards-upwards, and forearms to 2 counts, ani: 2 counts. (See Fig. 151.: GRADE
Mobilizing Exercises
1 No progressions.
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Bend crook lying; ;
GRADE
GRADE
GRADE
2
1. Grasp walk-forwards standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm
raising forwards or forwards-upwards. *
* Stick Exercises: The types of sticks used for these exercises are broomsticks and ash sticks. In general, broomsticks are more suitable for remedial work than ash sticks, because they are lighter. 120
GRADE
2
1. Bend sitting; alten
* See footnote, p. l20.
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
fer .lses joint and
121
2. Bend sitting (stick crosswise in front of chest); Arm stretching forwards-upwards. * 3. Grasp walk-forwards standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm bending, stretching forwards-upwards, and lowering to starting position.* 4. Reach grasp stoop stride standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm raising forwards-upwards. *
Advanced
:del" girdle moves with the :1'", shoulder girdle move er joint from the neutral
I ELEVATORS
ixwards.
III forwards or forwards-
B forwards-upwards.
ds or forwards-upwards.
1 1. No progression. 2. First bend walk-forwards standing; single Arm punching forwards or forwards-upwards. 3-4. No progressions. 5. Grasp walk-forwards standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging forwards-upwards, and club circling backwards or forwards behind the forearm to 3 counts. Sa. As above, but both arms are moved together (Fig. 151). 6. Grasp walk-forwards standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging forwards-upwards, and club circling backwards or forwards in front of the forearm to 3 counts. 6a. As above, but both arms are moved together. GRADE
2 1-4. No progressions. 5-6a. Grasp walk-forwards standing (Indian clubs); Arm swinging forwards-upwards, and club circling (a) backwards or forwards behind the forearms to 2 counts, and (b) backwards or forwards in front of the forearms to 2 counts. (See Fig. 151.) GRADE
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary GRADE 1 1. Bend crook lying; alternate Elbow raising forwards.
ise in front of body); Arm n:ises are broomsticks and ash :medial work than ash sticks,
2 1. Bend sitting; alternate Elbow raising forwards.
GRADE
... See footnote, p. 120.
122
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
SHO
3 1. Crook lying; alternate Arm raising forwards. 2. Toward standing (wall); single (affected) Arm 'crawling up the wall' (Fig. IS2).
GRADE
.. i'd
:','~.~:"
,,
...p, ...,'
I
1 1. Bend sitting; sin.!
GRADE
2 1. Sitting; single or
:J
GRADE
: .'
:;,;::;-",:'£ I
Elementary
~",
'): i #0, '<' I....
,::.~.
Strengthening Exel'
.....
i
Intermediate
1 1. Prone lying; sing
'.. . ... ........ _....,
GRADE
2. Reach stoop stricl
2 1. No progression. 2. Reach grasp stoo raising backwards (F~
GRADE
Fig. 151.
Fig. 152.
Fig. 153.
Fig. 154.
Intermediate GRADE
1
1. Crook lying; alternate Arm swinging forwards. 2. No progression. 3. Walk-forwards standing; alternate Arm swinging forwards-upwards. 4. Walk-forwards standing; Arm swinging forwards-upwards, with in creasing range to reach stretch position on the 4th count. S. Walk-forwards standing; Arm swinging forwards and forwards upwards. 2
1-2. No progressions.
3. Walk-forwards standing; alternate Arm swinging forwards-upwards with rhythmical pressing to 3 counts. 4. Grasp walk-forwards standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm swinging forwards-upwards with or without rhythmical pressing. * S. Grasp walk-forwards standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm swinging forwards and forwards-upwards.* GRADE
',1 ~
3. SHOULDER FI..I ARM WORKING W
Many of the movemen the starting positions exercises of the should examples are given bel 1. Walk-forwards 51 and downwards-bam 2. Half crook side downwards-backward!! 3. Reach stoop strid and raising backwards
4. SHOULDER AD) OF ARM
Strengthening Exerl
Elementary
2. SHOULDER EXTENSORS
GRADE
In these exercises movement of the shoulder girdle occurs after the shoulder joint has been extended fully. See also Exercises for the Depressors of the Arm, p. 127.
about 90°, and elbow l
* See
footnote, p. 120.
1 1. Sitting (affected \
* See
footnote, p. 120.
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
123
Strengthening Exercises
Iwling up the wall'
Elementary 1 1. Bend sitting; single or double Elbow raising backwards.
GRADE
2 1. Sitting; single or double Arm raising backwards.
GRADE
Intermediate GRADE
1
1. Prone lying; single or double Arm raising backwards.
2. Reach stoop stride standing; Arm raising backwards (Fig. 153). 2 1. No progression. 2. Reach grasp stoop stride standing (stick crosswise behind legs); Arm raising backwards (Fig. 154).*
GRADE
:r;r. 154.
3. SHOULDER FLEXORS AND FORWARD ELEVATORS OF ARM WORKING WITH SHOULDER EXTENSORS
[)[Wards-upwards. -upwards, with in
[.
:ds and forwards
forwards-upwards
ront of body); Arm pressing.* ront of body); Arm
Many of the movements given in the previous sections may be combined (or the starting positions modified) to give wide range flexion and extension exercises of the shoulder joint, with movement of the shoulder girdle. Some examples are given below. 1. Walk-forwards standing; alternate Arm swinging forwards-upwards and downwards-backwards. 2. Half crook side-lying; single Arm swinging forwards-upwards and downwards-backwards. 3. Reach stoop stride-standing; Arm raising forwards-upwards, lowering, and raising backwards as far as possible, and return to starting position.
4. SHOULDER ABDUCTORS AND SIDEWAYS ELEVATORS OF ARM Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1 1. Sitting (affected upper limb resting on table, with shoulder abducted to about 90°, and elbow flexed); single Deltoid contractions. GRADE
s after the shoulder : Depressors of the
* See footnote, p.
120.
124
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
2 1. No progression. 2. Bend half-lying; single or double Elbow raising sideways. 3. Half crook side-lying; single Elbow raising sideways.
GRADE
GRADE
3
1. No progression. 2. Bend sitting; single or double Elbow raising sideways. 3. Half crook side-lying; single Arm raising sideways (Fig. 155).
SHOULDER
5. Grasp stride standing (l upwards, and club circling I 3 counts. Sa. As No.5, but both am 6. Grasp stride standing (1 upwards, and club circling ba 3 counts. 6a. As No.6, but both arDI
2 1-4. No progressions. 5-6a. Grasp stride standil upwards, and club circling (a) (b) backwards in front of the J GRADE
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary Fig. 155.
4 No progression. Half-lying or sitting; single or double Arm raising sideways-upwards. No progression. Bend sitting; single or double Arm stretching sideways-upwards.
GRADE
1. 2. 3. 4.
1 1. Bend half-lying; altematJ
GRADE
2 1. Bend sitting; alternate EI 2. Side toward standing (1
GRADE
wall'. (See Fig. 152, p. 122.11 GRADE
GRADE
3
1. Sitting; alternate Arm ra 2. No progression.
Intermediate 1
No progressions.
Intermediate l1 !~
2 1-3. No progressions. 4. Bend grasp stride standing (stick crosswise in front of chest); Arm stretching sideways-upwards. * GRADE
Advanced
1
1-3. No progressions.
4. Fist bend stride standing; single Arm punching sideways or sideways upwards.
GRADE
* See foomote, p.
120.
1 1. Stride standing; Arm sw 2. No progression. 3. Stride standing; AJ;m sw. the same time and direction. ( 4. Low arm cross stride sta 5. Stride standing; Arm s range to reach stretch positic:m GRADE
2 1. Stride standing; Arm
GRADE
S'll
* This exercise provides some 11
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
: sideways. :ways.
ieways. (Fig. 155).
125
5. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging sideways upwards, and club circling backwards or forwards behind the forearm to 3 counts. Sa. As No.5, but both arms are moved together. 6. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging sideways upwards, and club circling backwards or forwards in front of the forearm to 3 counts. 6a. As No.6, but both arms are moved together.
'Ilys
2 1-4. No progressions. 5-00. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); Arm swinging sideways upwards, and club circling (a) backwards behind the forearms to 2 counts, and (b) backwards in front of the forearms to 2 counts.
GRADE
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1 1. Bend half-lying; alternate Elbow raising sideways.
GRADE
GRADE
ing sideways-upwards.
ideways-upwards.
2
1. Bend sitting; alternate Elbow raising sideways.
2. Side toward standing (wall); single (affected) Arm 'crawling up the wall'. (See Fig. 152, p. 122, which shows the toward standing position.) 3 1. Sitting; alternate Arm raising sideways-upwards. 2. No progression.
GRADE
Intermediate 1 1. Stride standing; Arm swinging sideways-upwards. 2. No progression. 3. Stride standing; Arm swinging to right and left, both arms moving in the same time and direction. (See Fig. 156, p. 126.)* 4. Low arm cross stride standing; Arm swinging sideways-upwards. * 5. Stride standing; Arm swinging sideways-upwards with increasing range to reach stretch position on the 4th count.
GRADE
1
front of chest); Arm
: sideways or sideways-
2 1. Stride standing; Arm swinging sideways-upwards to beat the fists
GRADE
* This exercise provides some work for
the shoulder adductors.
126
SHot
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
together (1-2), and swinging downwards-sideways to beat the sides of the thighs (3-4).* 2. No progression. 3. Wide grasp stride standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm swinging to right and left (Fig. 156).t
GRADE
·• I I
~, 1
: ·
"'ti\ '1\'
R
,
'\
r---!
:
3 1 and la. No progre 2. Sitting (elbows fI Shoulder adduction, to
GRADE
4
1 and la. No progre 2. Stride standing; si across the chest.
.~ .
R
6. SHOULDER ADD OF ARM WORKING
See Exercises marked wi movements given in Se abduction and adductiCl shoulder girdle.
Fig. 156.
S. SHOULDER ADDUCTORS In these exercises movement of the shoulder girdle accompanies movement of the shoulder joint. (See also Exercises for the Depressors of the Arm, p. 129.)
7. DEPRESSORS OJ Strengthening Exerc
Elementary See Introductory Exer1 rings or ropes, and Rot
Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE 1 1. Sitting (hands clasped in front of body with elbows flexed to about 90°); pressing palms together strongly to produce static contractions of pectoralis major. la. Sitting (hands and forearms resting on thighs); single or double Arm pressing inwards against the trunk to produce static contractions of pectoralis major. 2 1 and la. No progressions. 2. Bend sitting; single Shoulder adduction, to move Elbow across the chest. GRADE
* This exercise provides some work for the shoulder adductors. t See footnote, p. 120.
Intermediate
1 1. Under grasp stan with take-off from floo
GRADE
2 1. Under grasp ~ 2. Inward grasp haD 3. Heave grasp staru bent knees, touching d movement. (See Fig. I( exercise with straight I 4. Under grasp waf forwards-upwards and p. 87, which shows the GRADE
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
, beat the sides of the
front of body); Arm
127
3 I and lao No progressions. 2. Sitting (elbows flexed to 90° and forearms in front of chest); single Shoulder adduction, to move Arm across the chest.
GRADE
4 I and 1a. No progressions. 2. Stride standing; single or double Shoulder adduction, to move Arm(s) across the chest. GRADE
6. SHOULDER ABDUCTORS AND SIDEWAYS ELEVATORS OF ARM WORKING WITH SHOULDER ADDUCTORS See Exercises marked with an asterisk in Section 4, pp. 123-126. Certain ofthe movements given in Sections 4 and 5 may be combined to give wide-range abduction and adduction exercises ofthe shoulder joint, with movement ofthe shoulder girdle.
7. DEPRESSORS OF ARM AND SHOULDER EXTENSORS
:companies movement ~i'essors of the Arm,
Strengthening Exercises
Elementary See Introductory Exercises to Arm bending from hanging, circling on the rings or ropes, and Rope climbing, pp. 129-130'. Intermediate
flexed to about 90°); lttactions of pectoralis
IrS
single or double Arm IltIactions of pectoralis
[We Elbow across the
aors.
1 1. Under grasp standing (beam slightly above head level); Arm bending with take-off from floor.
GRADB
2 1. Under grasp hanging (beam); Arm bending (Fig. 157). 2. Inward grasp hanging (beam); Arm bending (Fig. 158). 3. Heave grasp standing (rings or ropes); circling and return circling with bent knees, touching the floor with the feet at the end of the forward circling movement. (See Fig. lOla, p. 87, for starting position, and Fig. 71, p. 74, for exercise with straight legs.) 4. Under grasp walk-forwards standing (beam at head height); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with bent knees. (See Fig. 102, p. 87, which shows the exercise performed with straight legs.) GRADE
128
sa
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
8. DEPRESSORS
Strengthening ED
Elementary See below IntroductOl 1. Stretch grasp hi
Fig. 158. Fig. 157.
Advanced 1 1-2. No progressions. 3. Heave grasp standing (rings or ropes); circling and return circling with straight legs, touching the floor with the feet at the end ofthe forward circling movement. (See Fig. lOla, p. 87, for starting position, and Fig. 71, p. 74, for movement.) 4. Under grasp walk-forwards standing (beam at head height); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with straight legs. (See Fig. 102, p.87.) 5. Rope climbing: left or right Hand leading with Leg grasp. GRADE
2 1-2. No progressions. 3. Stretch grasp standing (rings or ropes); circling and return circling with straight legs. (See Fig. 71, p. 74.) 4. Stretch under grasp standing (beam); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with straight legs. (See Fig. 102, p. 87, which shows an easier starting position.) 5. Rope climbing: Hand over Hand with Leg grasp. GRADE
F. Intermediate 1 1. Angle hanging
GRADE
2. Over grasp SbI with take-()ff from tl
2 1. No progressiOi 2. Over grasp ba:I 3. Over grasp ba:I
GRADE
from side to side.
(~
Introductory Exel 3 1-2. No progressions. 3. Inward grasp hanging (rings); circling and return circling with straight legs. (See Fig. 71, p. 74, for movement.) 4. Under grasp hanging (beam); circling forwards-upwards and downwards-forwards with straight legs. (See Fig. 102, p. 87, for movement.) 5. Rope climbing: Hand over Hand without Leg grasp. GRADE
Arm Bending from J Subject Working fl1it weight during the aJ waist. Exercise Performed standing, with the b rest his arms after I
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
129
8. DEPRESSORS OF ARM AND SHOULDER ADDUCTORS
Strengthening Exercises
Elementary See below Introductory Exercises to Arm bending from hanging. 1. Stretch grasp high stoop standing (wall bars); Arm bending (Fig. 159).
FW·158.
-. -. -.
::::::::::: .
--:--: Fig. 159.
\
ling and return circling with
Fig. 160.
Ie end
of the forward circling Iition, and Fig. 71, p. 74, for
Intermediate m at head height); circling luttaight legs. (See Fig. 102,
with Leg grasp.
1 1. Angle hanging (wall bars and living support); Arm bending (Fig. 160). 2. Over grasp standing (beam slightly above head level); Arm bending with take-off from floor.
GRADE
2 1. No progression. 2. Over grasp hanging (beam); Arm bending. 3. Over grasp hanging (beam); Arm walking sideways with Leg swinging from side to side. (See Fig. 120, p. 96.)
GRADE
ling and return circling with
ling forwards-upwards and _102, p. 87, which shows an
: grasp.
Introductory Exercises
return circling with straight
I forwards-upwards and .102, p. 87, for movement.) L.cg grasp.
Arm Bending from Hanging Subject Working with Partner. The partner takes some ofthe subject's body weight during the arm bending. He stands behind him, and grasps him at the waist. Exercise Performed from Standing. The arm bending is performed from standing, with the beam arranged at stretch height. This allows the subject to rest his arms after each arm-bending movement.
130
SHl
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Circling on Rings or Ropes The subject attempts the circling in stages, first trying out a quarter turn, then a half circle, and finally a full circle. He need not attempt the return circle at first, but may let go of the rings or ropes and stand up when his feet touch the floor at the end of the forward circling. Until the subject has acquired a good circling technique two supporters should stand on either side of him to give him confidence and, if necessary, to support him. It is also a wise precaution to put a mattress under the rings or ropes in case the subject accidentally loses his grasp.
Strengthening Exc! Elementary 1 1. Neck rest lying;
GRADE
2 1. No progression.
GRADE
3 1. Yard (palms fOl 161).
GRADE
Circling on the Beam See p. 91.
Rope Climbing Leg Grip. The subject practises taking and maintaining the leg grip, first with one foot behind the rope and then with the other. In the initial stages he sits on a stool which has been placed close to the rope. He grasps the rope as high as he can with both hands, and tries the leg grip without throwing any weight on to the arms. He must be taught to carry the feet well forward when he has gripped the rope, to prevent it from being held between the thighs instead of the knees; this would result in a weak grip. The subject tests the grip by lifting his buttocks from the stool and swinging on the rope, or using his legs as in climbing. Thus he bends the arms and stretches the legs without losing his grip with the knees and feet, and then sits down on the stool again by allowing the arms to straighten out and the knees to bend. Ascending and Descending the Rope. When the leg grip has been mastered the subject practises ascending and descending the rope from standing, without raising the hands much higher than stretch height. He then progresses to the full climb.
,, " ,,
'" .........
11/
1
Intermediate
1 1. No progression 2. Inclined prone height); Arm benditJ
GRADE
GRADE
2
1. No progressior
2. Inclined prone bending. (See Fig. 6 Advanced
9. SHOULDER PROTRACTORS GRADE
Protraction of the shoulder joint 'is a movement in which the fully abducted arm is brought towards the fully flexed position'.* The movement is associated with protraction of the shoulder girdle.
2. Prone falling;. GRADE
.. ApPLETON A. B. (1946) Surface and Radiological Anatomy, 2nd ed., p. 46. Cambridge: Helfer.
1
1. No progressiOl
2
1. No progressia
2. Horizontal pn
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
131
Strengthening Exercises
lout a quarter turn, II attempt the return rand up when his feet
aique two supporters e and, if necessary, to :lIS under the rings or
Elementary GRADE
1
1. Neck rest lying; single or dOUble Arm protraction. 2 1. No progression.
GRADE
3 1. Yard (palms forwards) lying; single or double Arm protraction (Fig. 161).
GRADE
,_-0, / t :;~"''' ',
.
be leg grip, first with ~ initial stages he sits asps the rope as high throwing any weight rorward when he has the thighs instead of
from the stool and , Thus he bends the I the knees and feet, ms to straighten out p has been mastered
'"
"
i
I
"I
\
II/~~
Fig. 161.
Fig. 162.
Intermediate 1 1. No progression. 2. Inclined prone falling (wall bars: hands between shoulder and hip height); Arm bending (Fig. 162).
GRADE
:ope from standing,
h height. He then
2 1. No progression. 2. Inclined prone falling (beam below hip height: hands supported); Arm bending. (See Fig. 62, p. 71.) GRADE
Advanced b the fully abducted The movement is
~,
1 1. No progression. 2. Prone falling; Arm bending. (See Fig. 65, p. 72.)
GRADE
2 1. No progression. 2. Horizontal prone falling; Arm bending. (See Fig. 66, p. 72.)
GRADE
2nd ed., p. 46.
132
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Strengthening :I
10. SHOULDER RETRACTORS
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Neck rest (e1
Retraction of the shoulder joint is a movement in which the fully flexed arm is moved backwards through the horizontal plane to the fully abducted position. The movement is associated with retraction of the shoulder girdle.
2 1. Reach si~
GRADE
Strengthening Exercises
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Neck rest (elbows forward) stoop stride standing; single or double Elbow parting. GRADE
3 1. Yard (palms together strongly. return to starting
GRADE
2
1. No progression.
Intermediate
3 1. Reach stoop stride standing; single or double Arm parting.
GRADE
1 1. Reach gras)l stick carrying ba repetition of mml 2. Reach gra5II Arm bending in :
GRADE
Intermediate 1 1. No progression. 2. Reach grasp stoop stride standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm bending to bring stick to chest (Fig. 163).* 3. Over grasp fall hanging (beam at shoulder height); Arm bending. (See Fig. 76, p. 77.)
GRADE
2
No progressions.
GRADE
Advanced
1 1-2. No prog1 3. Fist bend the chest (Fig. 1
2 1-2. No progressions. 3. Over grasp fall hanging (beam below shoulder height); Arm bending.
GRADE
GRADE
3 1-2. No progressions. 3. Over grasp horizontal fall hanging (beam and living support); Arm bending. (See Fig. 78, p. 78.)
GRADE
11. SHOULDER PROTRACTORS AND RETRACTORS For definition of protraction and retraction of the shoulder joint see previous sections.
* See footnote,
* See footnote. p. 120.
1
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
133
Strengthening Exercises h the fully flexed arm is II) the fully abducted of the shoulder girdle.
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Neck rest (elbows forwards) sitting; single or double Elbow parting. 2 1. Reach sitting; single or double Arm parting.
GRADE
GRADE
iIing; 'single or double
3
1. Yard (palms forwards) sitting; Arm carrying forwards to press the palms together strongly, followed by Arm carrying backwards to the full extent, and return to starting position.
Intermediate 1 1. Reach grasp walk-forwards standing (stick crosswise in front of chest); stick carrying backwards to the right, and return to starting position, and repetition of movement to the left. * 2. Reach grasp walk-forwards standing (stick crosswise in front of chest); Arm bending in horizontal plane to bring stick to chest. *
GRADE 1m
parting.
rise in front of body);
2
No progressions.
GRADE
Il); Arm bending. (See
Advanced 1 1-2. No progressions. 3. Fist bend stride standing; single Arm punching horizontally across the chest (Fig. 164).
GRADE
!eight); Arm bending.
living support); Arm
"'CTORS
Ilder joint see previous Fig. 163.
* See footnote,
p. 120.
Fig. 164.
134
SHot
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Mobilizing Exercises Intermediate
.---~,
1 1. Reach grasp walk forwards standing (stick crosswise in front of chest); stick swinging backwards and forwards in the horizontal plane.* 2. Across bend walk forwards standing; Elbow pressing backwards with Arm flinging on the 3rd count. 3. Standing (arms crossed firmly over chest); Cabman's warm-up swing. GRADE
~'
..:;::::
Fig. 165.
12. LATERAL ROTATORS OF SHOULDER JOINT Strengthening Exercises See Exercises in which the arms are raised sideways-upwards, p. 123. In these exercises the lateral rotators of the shoulder joint act with the shoulder abductors and the elevators of the arm.
13. MEDIAL ROTA Strengthening Exer
Elementary
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Forearm reach si 2. Sitting; Arm nm
1 1. Forearm reach sitting; single or double Arm turning outwards (Fig. 165). 2. Sitting; single or double Arm turning outwards.
GRADE
2 1. Heave lying; sin: (Fig. 168). 2. No progression.
GRADE
2 1. Forward heave lying; single or double Arm turning inwards through 90°
GRADE
(Fig. 166).
2. No progression. 3 1. Half crook side-lying (elbow of uppermost arm flexed to 90°, and forearm in contact with chest); single Arm turning outwards. 2. Sitting; single or double Hand placing on back of neck or slight distance behind neck. GRADE
1
3 1. No progression 2. Sitting; single distance behind it.
GRADE
Intermediate 1 1. No progression. 2. As Exercise 2, in previous grade, but performed in prone lying. 3. Heave grasp sitting (stick crosswise); Arm turning inwards to bring stick against chest. Fig. 167 shows the exercise taken from walk-forwards standing.* GRADE
Intermediate
1 1. Heave grasp ly 2. As Exercise 2,
GRADE
* See footnote, p. 120. I
135
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
rise in front of chest);
Ial pIane.*
ISing backwards with
ill'S
warm-up swing.
!NT '8l'ds, p. 123. In these the shoulder
:t with
Fig. 165.
Fig. 166.
Fig. 167.
13. MEDIAL ROTATORS OF SHOULDER JOINT Strengthening Exercises Elememary 1 1. Forearm reach sitting; single or double Arm turning inwards. 2. Sitting; Arm turning inwards.
GRADE
ning outwards
2 1. Heave lying; single or double Arm turning inwards through 90° (Fig. 168). 2. No progression.
GRADE
inwards through 90°
. flexed to 90°, and
IraI'ds.
edt or slight distance
prone lying.
inwards to bring
!'rom walk-forwards
Fig. 168.
3 1. No progression. 2. Sitting; single or double Hand placing on lumbar spine or slight distance behind it. GRADE
I
Ig
Imermediate I l. Heave grasp lying (stick crosswise); Arm turning inwards through 90°.
GRADE
2. As Exercise 2, in previous grade, but performed in prone lying.
136
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
s
14. LATERAL AND MEDIAL ROTATORS OF SHOULDER JOINT Many of the movements given in the two previous sections may be combined to give wide-range rotation exercises of the shoulder joint. Two examples of mobilizing exercises are given here. 1.. Forearm reach sitting; Arm turning outwards and inwards continuously to a given count. 2. Sitting; alternate Hand placing behind the neck and the lumbar spine.
/
..............
I
t \
15. SHOULDER CIRCUMDUCTORS AND ELEVATORS OF ARM
Mobllizing Exercises
Fig. Ifill
Elementary 1 1. Bend sitting; single or double Elbow circling forwards or backwards. 2. Bend sitting; alternate Elbow circling forwards or backwards.
GRADE
2a. As Exercise : direction.
2 1. Wide grasp WI Arm circling fol"Wlll stretching forwards forwards to startin8 la-2. No progres 2a. Wide grasp s swinging in a circle, left.* GRADE
2
No progressions.
GRADE
3 1. Sitting or walk-forwards standing; single or double Arm circling forwards or backwards. la. Sitting or walk-forwards standing; alternate Arm circling forwards or backwards. 2. Stride standing; single Arm circling in the frontal plane, the circling starting in an outwards or inwards direction. 2a. As Exercise 2, but both arms are moved together and in the same direction. GRADE
1
I
Intermediate GRADE
1
1. Walk-forwards standing; single or double Arm swinging in a circle: forwards or backwards. la. Walk-forwards standing; alternate Arm swinging in a circle: forwards or backwards. lb. Fallout forwards standing (hand on thigh); single Arm swinging in a circle: forwards or backwards (Fig. 169). 2. Stride standing; single Arm swinging in a circle in the frontal plane, the circling starting in an outwards or inwards direction.
Advanced
1 1. Grasp walk-f(l swinging in a foIWII la, b. No progm 2. Grasp stride 5 the frontal pillne, d 2a. As Exercise direction (Fig. 170)
GRADE
2 1. Grasp walk-fo forwards circle, pill backwards behind tl
GRADE
* See foomote, p.
I
137
SHOULDER JOINT AND GIRDLE EXERCISES
-
OF
..)....
/
sections may be combined da joint. Two examples of
"
I
\
/'~'-........
sand inwards continuously
I
xdt and the lumbar spine.
\
\
'\
..I
\
R,' " I J
}
\
/
--
ELEVATORS
Fig. 169.
g forwards or backwards. rds or backwards.
......
./ Fig. 170.
2a. As Exercise 2, but the arms are moved together and in the same direction.
\
2 1. Wide grasp walk-forwards standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm circling forwards-upwards (Arm bending to bring stick close to chest, stretching forwards-upwards to stretch position, and lowering downwards forwards to starting position)." 1a-2. No progressions. 2a. Wide grasp stride standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm swinging in a circle in the frontal plane, the circling starting to the right or left .., GRADE
or double Arm circling ~
Arm circling forwards or
frontal plane, the circling
together and in the same
Advanced GRADE
1
1. Grasp walk-forwards standing (Indian clubs); single or double Arm
bIn swinging in a circle:
tIging in a circle: forwards
single Arm swinging in a
:k in the frontal plane, the on.
swinging in a forwards or backwards circle. la, b. No progressions. 2. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging in a circle in the frontal plane, the circling starting in an outwards or inwards direction. 2a. As Exercise 2, but the arms are moved together and in the same direction (Fig. 170). 2 1. Grasp walk-forwards standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging in a forwards circle, pausing in the half high reach position to swing the club backwards behind the forearm to I count.
GRADE
" See footnote, p. 120.
138
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
13. Elb«
la, b. No progressions.
Ie. As Exercise 1, but the arms are moved together.
2. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging in a circle in the frontal plane, pausing in the half high yard position to circle the club backwards behind the forearm to 1 count. 2a. As Exercise 2, but the arms are moved together.
Strengthening Exercises See Exercises in previous section. The movements are performed more slowly than when used as mobility exercises.
FLEXORS
Strengthening Exerc:l
Elementary GRADE 1 1. Sitting (forearms i forearms supinated); siI
2 1. No progression. 2. Lying; single or d
GRADE
3 1. No progression. 2. Sitting; single or .
GRADE
Intermediate
1 1. No progression. 2. Grasp standing (l 3. Reach grasp stOC Arm bending to bring
GRADE
•
GRADE
2
1-3. No progressiOl 4. Grasp stride sou chest, bending (allowi circling backwards I downwards. 4a. As previous exc 5. Stretch grasp hi 159, p. 129.)
* Srick Exercises: sticks. Because they are
13. Elbow exerCIses
r. I swinging in a circle in lion to circle the club
f.
are performed more
FLEXORS Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE
1
1. Sitting (forearms and hands resting on table, with elbows flexed and forearms supinated); single Biceps contractions.
2 1. No progression. 2. Lying; single or double Elbow bending through 90°.
GRADE
3 1. No progression. 2. Sitting; single or double Elbow bending.
GRADE
Intermediate GRADE
1. 2. 3. Arm
1
No progression. Grasp standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm bending.* Reach grasp stoop stride standing (stick crosswise in front of body); bending to bring stick to chest. (See Fig. 163, p. 133.)*
2 1-3. No progressions. 4. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging across the chest, bending (allowing the upper arm to return to side of trunk), and club circling backwards behind the forearm to 3 counts, and stretching downwards. 4a. As previous exercise, but both arms are moved together. 5. Stretch grasp high stoop standing (wall bars); Arm bending. (See Fig. 159, p. 129.) GRADE
" Stick Exercises: The types of sticks used for these exercises are broomsticks and ash sticks. Because they are lighter, broomsticks are more useful for early remedial work.
139
140
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
6. Over grasp fall hanging (beam at shoulder height); Arm bending. (See Fig. 76, p. 77.)
2. Bend sittil:
Intermediate Advanced GRADE
I l-la. No prCl 2. Bend gra upwards.*
GRADE
1
1-4a. No progressions. 5. Angle hanging (wall bars and living support); Arm bending. (See Fig. 160, p. 129.) 6. Over grasp fall hanging (beam below shoulder height); Arm bending. 7. Under grasp or over grasp hanging (beam slightly above head height); Arm bending with take-off from floor. (See Fig. 157, p. 128, and Fig. 171, of Arm bending without take-off.) 2 1-5. No progressions. 6. Over grasp horizontal fall hanging (beam and living support); Arm bending. (See Fig. 78, p. 78.) 7. Under grasp or over grasp hanging (beam); Arm bending. Fig. 171 shows Arm bending from over grasp hanging. (See also Fig. 157, p. 128.)
GRADE
2 1-2. No PfOi 3. Graspsm the frontal plan pa using in the I brought behind to 3 counts. 4. Inclined I height); Arm b
GRADE
Advanced GRADE
1
1-3. No prCl
4. Inclined I bending. (See
2 1-3. No p~ 4. Horizon.
GRADE
"
Fig. 171.
EXTENSORS
Strengthening Exercises
Ii
Elementary 1 1. Sitting; single Triceps contractions.
GRADE
1a. Lying; single Arm pressing downwards. 2
l-1a. No progressions.
2. Bend lying; single or double Arm stretching forwards.
GRADE
GRADE
3
l-la. No progressions.
FLEXORSJ
Strengtheni
Elementa,ry GRADE 1 1. Lying;! GRADE
2
1. Bend si
la. Bend
1
* See foom!
141
ELBOW EXERCISES
eight); Arm bending. (See
2. Bend sitting; single or double Arm stretching sideways-upwards.
Intermediate I I-Ia. No progressions. 2. Bend grasp sitting (stick crosswise); Arm stretching sideways upwards.*
GRADE
); Arm bending. (See Fig. ~ height); Arm bending. lr;InIy above head height); 7, p. 128, and Fzg. 171, of
ad living support); Arm ~ 'e
Arm bending. Fig. 171 also Fig. 157, p. 128.)
o.:wards.
2 I-2. No progressions. 3. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging in a circle in the frontal plane (the circling starting in an outwards or inwards direction), pausing in the half stretch position to (a) bend the arm, so that the hand is brought behind the head, and (b) circle the club backwards behind the forearm to 3 counts. 4. Inclined prone faIling (wall bars: hands between shoulder and hip height); Arm bending. (See Fig. 162, p. 131.) GRADE
Advanced 1 1-3. No progressions. 4. Inclined prone falling (beam below hip height: hands supported); Arm bending. (See Fig. 62, p. 71.)
GRADE
2 1-3. No progressions. 4. Horizontal prone falling; Arm bending. (See Fig. 66, p. 72.)
GRADE
FLEXORS AND EXTENSORS Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE I I. Lying; single or double Elbow bending. 2 I. Bend sitting; single or double Arm stretching forwards.
la. Bend sitting; Arm stretching forwards and sideways.
GRADE
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - _ _-_ _ - ..
* See footnote, p. 139.
..
I'
142
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Intermediate No progressions.
14. Fore= . exercises
Advanced I 1. Fist bend walk-forwards standing; single Arm punching forwards, and
GRADE
strong return movement. la. Fist bend stride standing; single Arm punching sideways, and strong return movement.
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 2 1. Sitting or walk-forwards standing; alternate Elbow bending and stretch ing, the extremes of both movements being emphasized. 2. As above, but elbow flexion is combined with supination of forearm, and elbow extension is combined with pronation of forearm.
The weight of the moving impracticable to give lisn Specimen exercises for tb
GRADE
1. FOREARM EXERG
PRONATORS
Strengthening Exercis
Elementary 1. Sitting (elbows fleD forwards-downwards); siJ
Intermediate I 1. Walk-forwards standing; single Elbow bending and stretching, with
GRADE
gentle rhythmical pressing to 3 counts on reaching the extremes of movement. 2. No progression. 3. Wide grasp stride standing (stick crosswise in front of body); Arm circling forwards-upwards (Arm bending to bring stick to chest, stretching forwards-upwards to stretch position, and lowering downwards-forwards to starting position). *
* See footnote, p.
Intermediate 2. Half forearm read pointing downwards: hal single Forearm turning ill end pointing outwards. Jl standing.*
139.
~
:, ----_ _- ..
* Stick Exercises: The typ
sticks. Because they are ligl
14. Forearm, wrist and hand exerCIses
D
punching forwards, and
bing sideways, and strong
The weight of the moving part in these exercises is relatively small; hence it is impracticable to give lists of progressive exercises as in previous chapters. Specimen exercises for the individual muscle groups are listed.
!bow bending and stretch 1Sized.
Ih supination of forearm,
iforearm. \
1. FOREARM EXERCISES
PRONATORS Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1. Sitting (elbows flexed to 90°, with palms together and fingers pointing forwards-downwards); single or double Forearm pronation.
ing and stretching, with IChing the extremes of
in front of body); Arm stick to chest, stretching
Intermediate 2. Half forearm reach grasp standing (stick vertical with distal end pointing downwards: hand grasps shaft some distance from proximal end); single Forearm turning inwards until stick is in horizontal position with distal end pointing outwards. Fig. 172 shows the exercise taken from walk forwards standing. *
downwards-forwards to
Fig. 172. " Stick Exercises: The types of sticks used for these exercises are broomsticks and ash sticks. Because they are lighter, broomsticks are more useful for early remedial work.
143
144
FORI
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
3. Starting position as above, but distal end of stick points upwards; single Forearm turning outwards until stick is in horizontal position with distal end pointing outwards."
Advanced 3. Stick exercises as proximal end."
Advanced 4. Stick exercises as above, but hand grasps the stick close to the proximal end."
PRONATORS AND Strengthening Exerc:
SUPINATORS Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitting (palms downwards, lax wrists and fingers); single or double Forearm supination, so that the fingers point upwards. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position.
Intermediate 2. Half forearm reach grasp standing (stick vertical with distal end pointing downwards: hand grasps shaft some distance from proximal end); single Forearm turning outwards until stick is in horizontal position with distal end pointing inwards. Fig. 173 shows the exercise taken from walk forwards standing."
Elementary 1. Forearm reach sill Fig. 165, p. 135, shoWl!
Intermediate 2. 'Screwing' inward resistance (Fig. 174).* 3. Half forearm reac zontal, with distal end from proximal end); l horizontal position will
~ r· ~ Fig. 174.
.
3a. Starting positio turning inwards ,until inwards.*
11'
~ ~
Fig. 173
1
2a. Starting position as above, but distal end of stick points upwards; single Forearm turning inwards until stick is in horizontal position with distal end pointing inwards."
* See foomote, p.
143.
Advanced 4. Stick exercises resistance is increased the stick close to the I
* See footnote,
p. 143
145
FOREARM, WRIST AND HAND EXERCISES
toints upwards; single JSition with distal end
close to the proximal
Advanced 3. Stick exercises as above, but the hand grasps the stick close to the proximal end.*
PRONATORS AND SUPINATORS Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); single or double Forearm turning. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position.
as and fingers); single n upwards. Fig. 165,
Intermediate 2. 'Screwing' inwards and outwards movements with a stick against self resistance (Fig. 174).* 3. Half forearm reach grasp standing (palm downwards, and stick hori zontal, with distal end pointing outwards: hand grasps shaft some distance from proximal end); single Forearm turning outwards until stick is in horizontal position with distal end pointing inwards (Fig. 175).*
ica1 with distal end
from proximal end); izontal position with ise taken from walk
ick points upwards; 11 position with distal
,,r'.\
.,
!
- - - --=--1'if---_
Fig. 175.
Fig. 174.
. \
'\
I
I
.
Fig. 176.
3a. Starting position as above, but palm faces upwards; single Forearm turning inwards until stick is in horizontal position with distal end pointing inwards.*
Advanced 4. Stick exercises as above. In the 'screwing' movements the self resistance is increased, and in the Forearm turning exercises the hand grasps the stick close to the proximal end.
* See footnote,
p. 143.
146
FORE
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
5. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); single Elbow bending to 90", and club swinging in a circle in an outwards or inwards direction. Fig. 176 shows a swinging which starts in an outwards direction. 5a. As Exercise 5, but both arms are used at the same time. 6. Grasp walk-forwards standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging forwards-upwards, and club circling (a) backwards behind the forearm to 2 counts, and (b) backwards in front of the forearm to 2 counts. 6a. As Exercise 6, but both arms are moved at the same time.
Mobilizing Exercises
WRIST FLEXORS Strengthening Exerci Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitt Wrist flexion (Fig. 177). 2. As above, but with
Intermediate 3. Half grasp standinl with distal end resting proximal end); single W
Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); single, double, or alternate Forearm turning inwards and outwards.
Intermediate 2. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); single or double Forearm turning inwards and outwards with rhythmical pressing to a given count. 3. Forearm reach sitting (lax wrists and fingers); alternate Forearm turning inwards and outwards with a shaking motion. 4. Sitting or walk-forwards standing; alternate Elbow bending (with Forearm supination) and stretching (with Forearm pronation). 5. Half Forearm reach grasp standing (stick in vertical position, and grasped at centre of shaft); single Forearm turning inwards and outwards with a swinging motion. 6. 'Screwing' inwards and outwards movements with a stick. (See Fig. 174, p. 145.)
J
tff
Fig. 1
4. Forearm reach gra flexion. Fig. 165, p. 13~
Advanced 5. As Exercise 3, but Advanced
See Club Exercises in previous section.
WRIST EXTENSOR Strengthening Exere :1 ;t
2. WRIST EXERCISES The muscles of the wrist are exercised synergically when the fingers are used, e.g. in gripping, the wrist extensors act synergically. Exercises and simple occupations for the fingers should always be used in association with specific wrist exercises.
Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitl or double Wrist extern 2. As Exercise 1, bu
* See footnote,
p. 143.
I'
FOREARM, WRIST AND HAND EXERCISES
lx>w bending to 90 and rection. Fig. 176 shows a 0
,
same time. single Arm swinging behind the forearm to 2 2 counts. Ie same time.
I;
147
WRIST FLEXORS Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitting (palms upwards, lax fingers); single or double Wrist flexion (Fig. 177). 2. As above, but with Finger flexion.
Intermediate 3. Half grasp standing (palm forwards, and stick held obliquely forwards with distal end resting on floor: hand grasps shaft some distance from proximal end); single Wrist bending (Fig. 178).* Ie, or alternate Forearm
iJuble Forearm turning given count. ~); alternate Forearm
...,
L
Elbow bending (with ronation). vertical position, and inwards and outwards :hastick.(SeeFig.174,
Fig. 177.
Fig. 178.
4. Forearm reach grasp standing (palms upwards: stick crosswise); Wrist flexion. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position.*
Advanced 5. As Exercise 3, but the hand grasps the stick close to the proximal end.*
WRIST EXTENSORS Strengthening Exercises
en the fingers are used, Exercises and simple ISOciation with specific
Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitting (palms downwards, lax fingers and wrists); single or double Wrist extension. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position. 2. As Exercise 1, but with Finger extension.
* See footnote, p.
143.
148
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Intermediate 3. Half grasp standing (palm backwards, and stick held obliquely forward with distal end resting on floor: hand grasps shaft some distance from proximal end); single Wrist extension (Fig. 179).*
FO
Intermediate 2. Forearm reach si with gentle rhythmica movement. 3. Forearm reach s wrists); alternate Wl (Fig. 180).
Fig. 179.
4. Forearm reach grasp standing (palms downwards: stick crosswise); Wrist extension. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position.*
4. Standing or sitri sides); alternate Wrisl
Advanced 5. As Exercise 3, but the hand grasps the stick dose to the proximal end. *
WRIST ABDUcn Strengthening EUl WRIST FLEXORS AND EXTENSORS
Strengthening Exercises
Elementary 1. Sitting (forearms and hands supported on table, palms facing inwards and fingers lax); single or double Wrist flexion and extension, and return to starting position. 2. As above, but perfotmed from Forearm reach sitting.
IlII
11 ,1:
Mobilizing Exercises
~I
Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); alternate Wrist flexion and extension. (See Fig. 180, which shows a modified position of forearms. '" See footnote, p. 143.
Elementary 1. Sitting (hands a and fingers lax); sing: 2. As above, but'll
Intermediate 3. Half gras" stan with distal end rest proximal end); singh:
Advanced 4. As Exercise 3, t
" See footnote, p. 14:
FOREARM, WRIST AND HAND EXERCISES
149
Intermediate
tk held obliquely forward batt some distance from
2. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); single Wrist flexion and extension, with gentle rhythmical pressing to a given count on reaching the extremes of movement. 3. Forearm reach sitting or standing (palms downwards, lax fingers and wrists); alternate Wrist flexion and extension with a shaking motion (Fig. 180).
Fig. 180. ~ds:
stick crosswise); reach position. *
JSe to
the proximal end. *
WRIST ABDUCTORS Strengthening Exercises Elementary
k, palms facing inwards extension, and return to
I
4. Standing or sitting (fingers interlocked, with elbows flexed and arms to sides); alternate Wrist flexion and extension.
sitting.
istflexion and extension. Orearms.
1. Sitting (hands and forearms supported on table, palms facing inwards and fingers lax); single or double Wrist abduction. 2. As above, but with fingers straight.
Intermediate
3. Half grasp standing (palm inwards, and stick held obliquely forward with distal end resting on floor: hand grasps shaft some distance from proximal end); single Wrist abduction. (See Fig. 179, p. 148.)*
Advanced
4. As Exercise 3, but the hand grasps the stick close to the proximal end.*
"See footnote, p. 143.
150
WRIST ADDUCTORS Strengthening Exercises Elementary 1. Sitting (forearms and hands resting on table, palms facing inwards, fingers lax); single or double Wrist adduction. 2. As above, but the fingers are kept straight.
WRIST ABDUCTORS AND ADDUCTORS Mobilizing Exercises Elementary I. Sitting (forearms and hands resting on table, palms downwards and fingers lax); alternate Wrist abduction and adduction. 2. As Exercise 1, but the fingers are kept straight. Intermediate 3. As previous exercises, but with gentle rhythmical pressing to a given count on reaching the extremes of movement.
WRIST CIRCUMDUCTORS Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); single or double Wrist circling. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position.
".
F(
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Advanced 2. Grasp stride standing (Indian clubs); single Elbow bending to 90°, and club swinging in a circle in an outwards or inwards direction. (See Fig. 176, p. 145.) Za. As above, but both arms are used together. 3. Grasp walk-forwards standing (Indian clubs); single Arm swinging forwards, and club circling (a) backwards behind the forearm to Z counts, and (b) backwards in front of the forearm to 2 counts. 3a. As above, but both arms are moved together.
Strengthening Exercises Advanced See Club Exercises, above.
3. HAND EXERCI. Simple occupations a used in association wi
EXERCISES TO !
Elementary 1. Forearm reach S1 and slow recoil: each shows Forearm reach 2. Sitting; squeeziI 3. Sitting (comer c into a tight ball in the 4. Sitting (end OfUl into a ball in the pabI
Intermediate 5. Standing; stick 1 places alternately (F, 6. As Exercise 5. loosened and tighteD 7. Standing; stick '
1~,
r
Fig.
is!.
8. Reach grasp Sll the arms to catch it ; 9. Bend grasp sa catching.* 10. Reach standiJ: Arm lowering and 51
* See footnote, p. 14:
151
FOREARM, WRIST AND HAND EXERCISES
APY
3. HAND EXERCISES Simple occupations and everyday activities for the hand should always be used in association with specific exercises for the fingers and thumb.
lie, palms facing inwards,
EXERCISES TO STRENGTHEN THE GRIP Elementary
Ie, palms downwards and :ion.
:ht.
lIJlieal pressing to a given
Dr
1. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); strong Finger and Thumb bending, and slow recoil: each hand in turn or both hands together. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position. 2. Sitting; squeezing a sorbo-rubber balL 3. Sitting (corner of sheet of newspaper held in hand); rolling up paper into a tight ball in the palm of the hand without assistance from the free hand. 4. Sitting (end of unrolled crepe bandage held in hand); rolling up bandage into a ball in the palm of the hand without assistance from the free hand.
Intermediate 5. Standing; stick travelling upwards and downwards, the hands changing places alternately (Fig. 181).* 6. As Exercise 5, but the stick is held in one hand, and the grasp is loosened and tightened alternately during the 'travelling'. * 7. Standing; stick throwing from hand to hand (Fig. 182).*
??bt
double Wrist circling.
I
i
~i
Dbow bending to 90° , and s direction. (See Fig. 176,
lIS); single Arm swinging e forearm to 2 counts, and
r.
Fig. 181.
Fig. 182.
Fig. 183.
8. Reach grasp standing (stick crosswise); releasing stick and 'dropping' the arms to catch it in the hands again. * 9. Bend grasp standing (stick crosswise); stick throwing upwards and catching. * lO. Reach standing (palms downwards: stick rests crosswise on arms); Arm lowering and stick catching (Fig. 183).*
* See footnote,
p. 143.
152
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
11. Inward grasp fall hanging (2 ropes); Arm bending. (See Fig. 76, p. 77, where a beam is shown in place of ropes.) 12. Stretch grasp standing (lor 2 ropes); Arm bending with Ankle stretching to take weight off feet.
Advanced 13. Inward grasp horizontal fall hanging (2 ropes and living support); Arm bending. (See Fig. 78, p. 78, where a beam is shown in place of ropes.) 14. Over or under grasp hanging (beam); Arm bending. (See Figs. 157 and 171, pp. 128 and 140.) 15. Heave grasp walk-forwards standing (rings or ropes); circling and return circling with bent knees, touching the floor with the feet at the end of the forwards circling movement. (See Fig. 71, p. 74, which shows a progression on the exercise.) 16. Rope climbing with Leg grasp.
EXERCISES TO STRENGTHEN THE FINGER AND THUMB EXTENSORS Elementary 1. Sitting (forearms and hands resting on table, palms downwards); Finger and Thumb extension: each hand in turn, or both hands together. 2. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); exercise as above.
FOI
2. Starting positiOil relaxation: each hand I 3. Sitting (palms of upwards and thumbs together with flexion 0 joints being kept extel
EXERCISES TO S HYPOTHENAR J\II See Exercises to Stn: localized exercises of I 1. Forearm reach Ii each finger in tum wi hands together. Fig. 1, 2. Forearm reach s (opposition of Thumt together. 3. Forearm reach si 4. Forearm reach: abduction and adducti
EXERCISES TO INCREASE THE RANGE OF FINGER FLEXION OR EXTENSION See Exercises given in two previous groups. Other exercises consist of: (a) Finger flexion or extension with rhythmical pressing to a given count, and (b) Wide range flexion and extension of the fingers and thumb.
Examples: (i) Half forearm reach (lax fingers)j Finger flexion with rhyth mical pressing to 3 counts. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position. Oi) Forearm reach sittingj Finger and Thumb bending and stretching: each hand in turn, or both hands together.
EXERCISES TO STRENGTHEN THE INTRINSIC MUSCLES Elementary 1. Sitting (forearms and hands resting on table, palms downwards); single or double Hand shonening (flexion of the metacarpophalangeal joints with the interphalangeal joints kept extended).
I
FOREARM, WRIST AND HAND EXERCISES
og. (See Fig. 76, p. 77,
bending with Ankle
153
2. Starting position as above; Finger or Thumb parting, closing and relaxation: each hand in turn, or both hands together. 3. Sitting (palms of hands together in front of chest, with fingers pointing upwards and thumbs extended); Hand shortening (pressing finger tips together with flexion of the metacarpophalangeal joints-the interphalangeal joints being kept extended-and opposition of carpo-metacarpal joints).
d living support); Arm
in place of ropes.) jog. ~See Figs. 157 and
£ ropes); circling and h the feet at the end of . 74, which shows a
RAND
lIS downwards); Finger
Dds together.
rove.
F FINGER
~ exercises consist of: g to a given count, and Id thumb. fler flexion with rhyth •. 135, shows Forearm
, Thumb bending and hands together.
!liSIC MUSCLES os downwards); single phalangeal joints with
EXERCISES TO STRENGTHEN TIlE TIlENAR AND HYPOTIlENARMUSCLES See Exercises to Strengthen the Grip, pp. 151-152. Examples of some localized exercises of an elementary grade are given below. 1. Forearm reach sitting (lax fingers); 'making O's' (touching the tip of each finger in turn with the tip of the thumb): each hand in turn, or both hands together. Fig. 165, p. 135, shows Forearm reach position. 2. Forearm reach sitting (palms upwards, lax fingers); Palm hollowing (opposition of Thumb and 5th Finger): each hand in turn, or both hands together. 3. Forearm reach sitting; single or double Thumb circling slowly. 4. Forearm reach sitting (palms upwards); single or double Thumb abduction and adduction.
15. Hip exercises
Certain hip exercises in which the lower limbs are moved on the trunk are associated with movements of the pelvis and lumbar spine. These associated hip and trunk movements are described in the chapter on trunk exercises (pp. 69-108). When leg exercises are used to activate the hip muscles the lower limbs ought not to be moved together as, for example, in Leg raising from lying. 'Double leg' exercises have a greater specific effect on the spinal muscles.
HIP FLEXORS Strengthening Exercises (See also Exercises for the Flexors of the Spine, pp. 69-76.) Elementary
2. Low grasp back 2a. As above, but l
Mobilizing Exerds
Elementary 1. Lying; alternate 2. Lying; alternate
Intermediate 1. No progression. 2. Lying; cycling.
1 1. Lying; single Knee raising. (See p. 69.)
GRADE
2 1. Lying; single high Knee raising. (See Fig. 59, p. 70.)
GRADE
Skipping ExerciseS
Intermediate GRADE
HIP EXTENSORS Strengthening Ese (See also Exercises f(
1
1. Low grasp back towards standing (wall bars); single high Knee raising (Fig. 184). 2. Lying; single Leg raising to 45°.
2a. Lying; single Leg raising.
3. Lying; single high Knee raising, Leg stretching forwards to 45°, and lowering. 2 1. No progression.
GRADE
154
0
Elementary 1 1. Lying or prone 2. Lying; single L
GRADE
2 1-2. No progressi 3. Reach grasp 51 backwards.
GRADE
HIP EXERCISES
lOVed on the trunk are pine. These associated tel' on trunk exercises
uscles the lower limbs Leg raising from lying. 11 the spinal muscles.
155
Fig. 184.
2. Low grasp back towards standing (wall bars); single Leg raising to 45°. 2a. As above, but single Leg raising.
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1. Lying; alternate Knee raising. 2. Lying; alternate high Knee raising.
1)9-76.)
Intermediate 1. No progression. 2. Lying; cycling.
HIP EXTENSORS
.70.)
Strengthening Exercises (See also Exercises for the Extensors of the Spine, pp. 76-85. Hopping and Skipping Exercises may also be included.)
lIgle high Knee raising
Elementary GRADE
1
1. Lying or prone lying; single or double Gluteal contractions.
2. Lying; single Leg down pressing. ~
forwards to 45°, and 2 1-2. No progressions. 3. Reach grasp standing (wall bars or chair back); single Leg raising backwards.
GRADE
156
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Intermediate 1 1-2. No progressions. 3. Forehead rest prone lying; single Leg raising backwards. 4. Low reach grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising and Knee bending. (See Fig. 194, p. 165.) 5. Low reach grasp high standing (wall bars and balance bench); stepping down backwards, sound Leg leading (1-2), and stepping up forwards, sound Leg leading (3-4). (See Fig. 195, p. 165.) 6. Climbing the wall bars, 1-2 bars at a step. GRADE
2 1-2. No progressions. 3. Prone kneeling; single Leg stretching and raising backwards. (See leg movement of Fig. 98b, p. 86.) 4. Half wing half low yard grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising and Knee bending (Fig. 185).
GRADE
5. Toward standing (b affected Leg leading (1-2 leading (3-4). 6. No progression. 7. Half wing half low y: stool); single Heel raising arms, and Fig. 188 for mo 8. Half wing half low J Knee full bending. 9. Low reach grasp higt full bending (Fig. 186). GRADE
(3-4) (Fig. 187).
rr
·It
~
Fig. 185.
5. Reach grasp standing (wall bars and balance bench); stepping up forwards, affected Leg leading (1-2), and stepping down backwards, affected Leg leading (3-4). 6. Climbing the wall bars, 2-3 bars at a step. 7. Low reach grasp instep support standing (wall bars and stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending. (See Fig. 188, p. 157), which shows a progression on the exercise.) 8. Low reach grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising and Knee full bending.
Fig. 186.
6. No progression. 7. Wing instep suppor1 bending (Fig. 188). 8. Wing standing; Heel 9. Half low yard grasp Knee full bending. 3 1-3. No progressions. 4. Stretch standing; He 5-6. No progressions. 7. Stretch instep suppcl
GRADE
Advanced GRADE
1
1-3. No progressions. 4. Wing standing; Heel raising and Knee bending.
2
1-3. No progressions. 4. Neck rest standing; I 5. Back toward standina! affected Leg leading (1-2),
: backwards.
Using and Knee bending.
. balance bench); stepping
pping up forwards, sound
157
HIP EXERCISES
~y
5. Toward standing (balance bench or stool); stepping up forwards, affected Leg leading (1-2), and stepping down backwards, affected Leg leading (3-4). 6. ~o progression. 7. Half wing half low yard grasp instep support standing (wall bars and stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending. (See Fig. 185 for position of arms, and Fig. 188 for movement.) 8. Half wing half low yard grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising and Knee full bending. 9. Low reach grasp high half standing (wall bars and plinth); single Knee full bending (Fig. 186). 2 1-3. ~o progressions. 4. ~eck rest standing; Heel raising and Knee bending. 5. Back toward standing (balance bench or stool); stepping up backwards, affected Leg leading (1-2), and stepping down forwards, affected Leg leading
GRADE
ising backwards. (See leg
I bars); Heel raising and
(3-4) (Fig. 187).
,,,,' Ii II
ICe bench); stepping up Iown backwards, affected
III bars and stool); single p. 157), which shows a
I raising and Knee full
Fig. 186.
Fig. 188.
6. ~o progression. 7. Wing instep support standing (stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending (Fig. 188). 8. Wing standing; Heel raising and Knee full bending. 9. Half low yard grasp high half standing (wall bars and plinth); single Knee full bending. 3 1-3. ~o progressions. 4. Stretch standing; Heel raising and Knee bending
5-6. ~o progressions.
7. Stretch instep support (stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending.
GRADE
18·
Fig. 187.
158
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
8. Neck rest standing; Heel raising and Knee full bending. 9. Lax reach high half standing (plinth or high bench); single Knee full bending. (See Fig. 200, p. 167.)
Mobilizing Exerd Elementary 1. Half crook side forwards and backwl 2. As above, but t
Mobilizing Exercises Intermediate GRADE
1
1. Forehead rest prone lying; single Leg raising backwards with rhyth mical pressing to 3 counts. 2. Bend grasp high standing (wall bars); Knee full bending and stretching with Hand travelling down and up the bars. (See Fig. 206, p. 169.)
2 1. Prone kneeling; single Leg stretching and ralsmg backwards, with rhythmical pressing to 3 counts. (See leg movement of Fig. 9gb, p. 86.) 2. No progression.
GRADE
IDP FLEXORS AND EXTENSORS Strengthening Exercises (See also Exercises for the Flexors and Extensors of the Spine, pp. 85-91.)
Intermediate 1. No progression 2. Reach grasp hq forwards and backwl
HIP ABDUCTOR:
Strengthening ED (See also Exercises fi Elementary
Elementary 1
GRADE
1
1. Half crook side-lying; single slight Leg raising sideways, and carrying forwards and backwards, and return to starting position.
1. Reach grasp sn 2. Reach grasp stl hip abductors of staJ 3. Hanging (wall .
2 1. Lying; single high Knee raising, and return to starting position, followed by Leg downpressing.
GRADE
GRADE
GRADE
2 1. Standing;' sing) 2. Standing; sing) 3. Half crook side
Intermediate 1 1. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); single high Knee ralsmg, Leg stretching and raising backwards, and return to starting position. 2. Prone kneeling; single high Knee raising, Leg stretching and I"dising backwards, and return to starting position. GRADE
IDPADDUCTOR Strengthening & (See also Exercises f
HIP EXERCISES
bending.
~ch); single Knee full
159
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1. Half crook side-lying; single slight Leg raising sideways, and carrying forwards and backwards to a given count (Fig. 189). 2. As above, but the Leg is swung forwards and backwards.
JlllCkwards with rhyth
,
tJending and stretching '. 206, p. 169.)
ising backwards, with Jf Fig. 98b, p. 86.)
1
Fig. 189.
Intermediate 1. No progression. 2. Reach grasp high half standing (beam and block); single Leg swinging forwards and backwards.
HIP ABDUCTORS
the Spine, pp. 85-91.)
Strengthening Exercises (See also Exercises for the Lateral Flexors of the Spine, pp. 92-99.) Elementary GRADE 1
lideways, and carrying ion.
to starting position,
1. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); single Leg raising sideways. 2. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); single slight Knee raising (activates hip abductors of standing leg). 3. Hanging (wall bars or beam); Leg parting. GRADE
2
1. Standing; single Leg raising sideways.
2. Standing; single Knee raising. 3. Half crook side-lying; single Leg raising sideways.
b Knee raising, Leg ng position.
5lretching and raising
HIP ADDUCTORS Strengthening Exercises (See also Exercises for the Lateral Flexors of the Spine, pp. 92-99.)
160
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Mobilizing Exen:
Elementary 1 1. Close lying; pressing Knees together. 2. Crook lying; Knee parting and closing to press the knees together.
GRADE
2 1. No progression. 2. Yard (palms on floor) vertical leg lift lying; Leg parting (Fig. 190).
Elementary 1 1. Lying; single other leg to a giVal GRADE
GRADE
2 1. As above, but
GRADE
Intermediate GRADE
\
1
1. Reach grasp b from side to side.
\
\
Fig. 190.
2a. Reverse hanging (wall bars); Leg parting. Fig. 123, p. 99, shows the reverse hanging position. 3. Hanging (wall bars or beam); Leg crossing. 4. Reach grasp high half standing (wall bars and block); single Leg crossing.
LATERAL ROTi Strengthening til Elementary GRADE
1
1. Half crook sM 2. Crook side-ly
2 1-2. Nop~ 3. High sitting crosses other leg. 3a. As above, b 4. Prone lying ( that feet are parte 5. Reach grasp l in starting positiol
GRADE
HIP ABDUCTORS AND ADDUCTORS Strengthening Exercises (See also Exercises for the Lateral Flexors of the Spine, pp. 92-99.)
Elementary GRADE
1
1. Lying; single slight Leg raising, and carrying sideways and across the other leg, and return to starting position. 2. Lying; Leg parting and crossing, and return to starting position. 2 1. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); single Leg raising sideways, lowering and crossing the standing leg, and return to starting position. parting and crossing, and return to 2. Hanging (wall bars or beam); starting position. GRADE
E
161
HIP EXERCISES
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1 1. Lying; single slight Leg raising, and carrying sideways and across the other leg to a given count. GRADE
the knees together.
2 1. As above, but the Leg is swung from side to side.
GRADE
: paning (Fig. 190).
Intermediate 1 1. Reach grasp high half standing (beam and block); single Leg swinging from side to side. GRADE
II,
LATERAL ROTATORS OF HIP Strengthening Exercises
\
123, p. 99, shows the
1 1. Half crook side-lying; single Leg turning outwards. 2. Crook side-lying; single Knee raising sideways, with feet kept together.
GRADE
Id block); single Leg
Ie,
Elementary
2 1-2. No progressions. 3. High sitting (plinth); single Thigh turning outwards, so that foot crosses other leg. 3a. As above, but both Thighs are turned outwards (Fig. 191). 4. Prone lying (knees flexed to 90°); allowing Thighs to turn inwards, so that feet are parted (Fig. 192). S. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); Hip turning outwards, feet remaining in starting position. GRADE
pp. 92-99.)
ileways and across the
ICIrting position.
og sideways, lowering MJSition. rossing, and return to
, Fig. 191.
Fig. 192.
162
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
MEDIAL ROTATORS OF HIP Strengthening Exercises Elementary GRADE
1
Mobilizing Exerciset As strengthening exm continuous manner, e.1l continuously to a given c pp. 99-103.)
1. Lying (lax legs); Leg turning inwards. 2. Crook lying; Knee parting. GRADE
2
1-2. No progressions. 3. High sitting (plinth); single Thigh turning inwards, so that lower leg moves outwards. 3a. As above, but both Thighs are turned inwards. 4. Stride prone lying (knees flexed to 90°); allowing Thighs to turn outwards, so that ankles cross each other (Fig. 193).
CIRCUMDUCTom Mobilizing Exercise
Elementary 1. Reach grasp high swinging in a circle. 2. Lying; single Lq 3. Half crook side-~
StrengtheningEx~
See Exercises in prell slowly than when WM Circumductors of the Fig. 193.
LATERAL AND MEDIAL ROTATORS OF HIP Strengthening Exercises (See also Exercises for the Rotators of the Spine, pp. 99-103.) Elementary GRADE
1
1. Reach grasp half standing (wall bars); single Leg turning inwards and outwards, and return to starting position. 2. Stride lying; single or double Leg turning inwards and outwards, and return to starting position. 2 1-2. No progressions. 3. High sitting (plinth); single or double Thigh turning inwards and outwards to the full extent, and return to starting position. 4. Prone lying; exercise as above. 5. Half crook lying; single Knee lowering sideways, raising to cross other leg, and return to starting position. GRADE
HIP EXERCISES
163
Mobilizing Exercises As strengthening exercises, above, but the movements are performed in a continuous manner, e.g. Stride lying; single Leg turning inwards and outwards continuously to a given count. (See also Exercises for the Rotators of the Spine, pp. 99-103.)
CIRCUMDUCTORS OF HIP ards, so that lower leg
IWing Thighs to turn
99-103.)
: turning inwards and
lis and outwards, and
turning inwards and lion.
raising to cross other
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1. Reach grasp high half standing (beam and block); single Leg circling or swinging in a circle. 2. Lying; single Leg circling. 3. Half crook side-lying; single Leg circling.
Strengthening Exercises See Exercises in previous section. The movements are performed more slowly than when used as mobility exercises. See also Exercises for the Circumductors of the Spine, pp. 107-108.)
2. Lying; single LA 2a. As above, but' 3. High sitting (pli 3a. As above, but ,
16. Knee exercises
Intermediate
1 1. Lying; single hi slow lowering. la-2a. No progres 3. Low reach grasJ
GRADE
KNEE FLEXORS Strengthening Exercises (See also single Leg raising backwards exercises, pp. 155-156.)
(Fig. 194).
~f t"~
Elementary 1 1. Crook lying or sitting; single or double Hamstring contractions.
GRADE
2 1. No progression. 2. Forehead rest prone lying; single or double Knee bending to 90°.
GRADE
Fig. 194.
3 1. No progression. 2. High sitting (table or bench); single or double Knee bending. 3. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); single Knee bending backwards.
GRADE
4. Low reach gra down backwards, s(] Leg leading (3--4) (j 5. Climbing the'
KNEE EXTENSORS GRADE
Strengthening Exercises (Hopping and Skipping Exercises may also be included.) Elementary 1 1. Long sitting (trunk inclined backwards with hand support) or half lying; single or double Quadriceps contractions. 2. As Exercise 1, with Ankle or Foot movements, e.g. single Quadriceps contractions with Ankle bending. GRADE
2 1. Lying; single Leg raising to 45° with Knee firmly braced. 1a. As above, but with Ankle bending.
GRADE
164
t,
2
1-2a. No progm 3. Half wing hal Knee bending. 4. Reach grasp forwards, affected] Leg leading (3--4). 5. Climbing the 6. Low reach II bending. 7. Low reach g Knee bending (F~ 8. Low reach g Heel raising and I
165
KNEE EXERCISES
2. Lying; single Leg raising with Knee firmly braced.
2a. As above, but with Ankle bending.
3. High sitting (plinth); single or double Knee stretching.
3a. As above, but with Ankle bending.
Intermediate I 1. Lying; single high Knee raising, Leg stretching forwards to 45°, and slow lowering. la-2a. No progressions. 3. Low reach grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising and Knee bending
GRADE
'. 155-156.)
(Fig. 194).
, ...
•
-
ring contractions.
I
~
:' I
,_
I
..
.,I
I
, 1
(.
~s , lIee
".
bending to 90°. Fig. 194.
Knee bending. bending backwards.
led.)
land support) or half
I:..g. single Quadriceps
y braced.
Fig. 195.
Fig. 196.
4. Low reach grasp high standing (wall bars and balance bench); stepping down backwards, sound Leg leading (1-2), and stepping up forwards, sound Leg leading (3-4) (Fig. 195). 5. Climbing the wall bars, 1-2 bars at a step.
2 1-2a. No progressions. 3. Half wing half low yard grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising and Knee bending. 4. Reach grasp standing (wall bars and balance bench); stepping up forwards, affected Leg leading (1-2), and stepping down backwards, affected Leg leading (3-4). 5. Climbing the wall bars, 2-3 bars at a time. 6. Low reach grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising and Knee full bending. 7. Low reach grasp stride standing (wall bars); Heel raising and single Knee bending (Fig. 196). 8. Low reach grasp instep support standing (wall bars and stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending.
GRADE
166
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
8. Wing instep sup] bending. (See Fig. 188 8a. Half low yard g1 Knee full bending. 9. No progression.
9. Short fallout forwards standing; vigorous thrusting backwards (Fig. 197).
Advanced 1 1-2a. No progressions. 3. Wing standing; Heel raising and Knee bending. 4. Towards standing (balance bench or stool); stepping up forwards, affected Leg leading (1-2), and stepping down backwards, affected Leg leading (3-4). 5. No progression.
GRADE
3 1-2a. No progressiCl 3. Stretch standing; 4-5. No progressiO[
GRADE
6. Neck rest standi 7. Neck rest stride 8. Neck rest instep bending. See Fig. 1st: 8a. Lax reach higb 200). 9. No progression.
J.J Fig. 197.
Fig. 198.
Fig. 199.
6. Half wing half low yard grasp-standing (wall bars); Heel raising and Knee full bending. (Fig. 198) 7. Half wing half low yard grasp stride-standing (wall bars); Heel raising and single Knee bending. 8. Half wing half low yard grasp instep support standing (wall bars and stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending. 8a. Low reach grasp high half standing (wall bars and plinth); single Knee full bending. (See Fig. 186, p. 157.) 9. Fallout forwards standing; vigorous thrusting backwards (Fig. 199). 2 1-2a. No progressions. 3. Neck rest standing; Heel raising and Knee bending. 4. Back towards standing (balance bench or stool); stepping up backwards, affected Leg leading (1-2), and stepping down forwards, affected Leg leading (3-4). (See Fig. 187, p. 157.) 5. No progression. 6. Wing standing; Heel raising and Knee full bending. 7. Wing stride-standing; Heel raising and single Knee bending.
KNEE ROTATOR.:
Specific exercises for the knee is associat~ for the Knee Flex( pp. 164-167.
GRADE
t
KNEE FLEXORS
Strengthening Exl Knee flexion and ex lying and high sittiJ: bending, stretching, (
py
KNEE EXERCISES
rusting backwards (Fig.
167
8. Wing instep support standing (stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending. (See Fig. 188, p. 157.) 8a. Half low yard grasp high half standing (wall bars and plinth); single Knee full bending. 9. No progression. 3 1-2a. No progressions. 3. Stretch standing; Heel raising and Knee bending.
4-5. No progressions .
GRADE
IJ.
stepping up forwards, ackwards, affected Leg
.
Fig. 200.
6. Neck rest standing; Heel raising and Knee full bending. 7. Neck rest stride standing; Heel raising and single Knee bending. 8. Neck rest instep support standing (stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending. See Fig. 188, p. 157, which shows the arms in wing position. 8a. Lax reach high half standing (plinth); single Knee full bending (Fig.
Fig. 199.
200). bars); Heel raising and
9. No progression.
wall bars); Heel raising
IlaDding (wall bars and
KNEE ROTATORS
ad plinth); single Knee
Specific exercises for the knee rotators are not given here, because rotation of the knee is associated with flexion and extension movements. See Exercises for the Knee Flexors, p. 164, and Exercises for the Knee Extensors, pp. 164-167.
llaCkwards (Fig. 199).
ting.
Ilepping up backwards,
Is,. affected Leg leading
ling.
bending.
Dee
i KNEE FLEXORS AND EXTENSORS Strengthening Exercises
Knee flexion and extension movements may be combined in half crook side
lying and high sitting, e.g. High sitting (table or bench); single or double Knee
bending, stretching, and return to starting position. (Fig. 201.)
168
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Fig. 201.
Fig. 202.
10. l,.-ow grasp inc raising, attempting II 11. Bend grasp higI Hand travelling dow: two bars only.
EXERCISES TO RESTORE THE RANGE OF KNEE FLEXION a. For use when the range of Knee flexion is less than 45° 1. Lying; affected Knee raising with heel in contact with supporting surface. 2. Half crook side-lying; affected Knee bending and stretching con tinuously to a given count. 3. Prone lying; alternate Knee bending. 4. Prone lying; affected Knee bending with rhythmical pressing to a given count. 5. High sitting (plinth: heels resting on stool, with knees flexed); alternate Knee stretching.
c. For use when d 1-2. Omitted.
3. Prone lying; all 4. Prone lying; aft count. 5. Omitted. 6. High sitting (I: and backwards with 7. High sitting (Il and slow recoil.
b. For use when the range of Knee flexion is between 45° and 90° 1. Lying; affected Knee raising with heel in contact with supporting surface. 2. Half crook side-lying; affected Knee bending and stretching con tinuously to a given count. 3. Prone lying; alternate Knee bending. 4. Prone lying; affected Knee bending with rhythmical pressing to a given count. 5. High sitting (table or bench); alternate Knee stretching. 6. As above; alternate lower Leg swinging with Ankle bending and stretching (Fig. 202). 7. High sitting (table or bench); affected Knee attempted bending beyond stiff zone, and slow recoil. 8. Prone kneeling (knee position modified if necessary); Trunk moving backwards and forwards. (See Fig. 205, p. 169.) 8a. As Exercise 8, but with rhythmical pressing to a given count at end of backwards movement. 9. Short walk-forwards standing (hands on forward knee); small range bending and stretching of forward knee (Fig. 203).
' · In
t.;-"'- -. , _... t
..
•
/
Fig. 205.
8. Prone kneelinl 8a. As above, bu backwards movemc
-1
ll'Y
169
KNEE EXERCISES
Fig. 202.
iF KNEE FLEXION
las than 45° contact with supponing
Fig. 203.
Fig. 204.
10. Low grasp inclined long sitting (balance bench); single high Knee raising, attempting to touch front edge of bench with heel (Fig. 204). 11. Bend grasp high standing (wall bars); Knee bending and stretching with Hand travelling down and up the bars. Fig. 206, shows Hand travelling over two bars only.
iog and stretching con
~ pressing to a given h knees flexed); alternate
liletween 45° and 90° :ontact with supporting
c. For use when the range of Knee flexion is over 90° 1-2. Omitted. 3. Prone lying; alternate Knee bending. 4. Prone lying; affected Knee bending with rhythmical pressing to a given count. 5. Omitted. 6. High sitting (table or bench); alternate lower Leg swinging forwards and backwards with Ankle bending and stretching (Fig. 202). 7. High sitting (table or bench); affected Knee bending as far as possible, and slow recoil.
og and stretching con 16·L-_...., .
mical pressing to a given
Ittetching. iIh Ankle bending and
empted bending beyond
zssary); Trunk moving
, a given count at end of
rani knee); small range
Fig. 205.
b
a Fig. 206.
S. Prone kneeling; Trunk moving backwards and forwards (Fig. 205). Sa. As above, but with rhythmical pressing to a given count at end of the backwards movement.
170
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
17. An:
9. Fallout forwards standing (hands on forward knee); small range bend ing and stretching of forward knee. (See Fig. 203, p. 169.) 10. As Exercise 10, previous section. 11. Bend grasp high standing (wall bars); Knee bending and stretching with Hand travelling down and up the bars. Fig. 206 shows Hand travelling over two bars only. 12. Lax stoop half kneeling (hands on floor); small range bending and stretching of forward knee (Fig. 207).
1. ANKLE EXERCj
DORSIFLEXORS Strengthening Exa (Balance Exercises IDlI Elementary Fig. 207.
b
a Fig. 208
13. Forearm reach grasp kneeling (wall bars); attempting to assume kneel sitting (Fig. 208).
1 1. Half lying or k support (heels free); si 2. As above, but w
GRADE
2 1. High sitting (pli 2. No progression. 3. Sitting; single 0
GRADE
Intermediate
1 1. No progression. 2. Reach grasp stl! 3. No progression.
GRADE
.
PLANTAR-FLEX(
Strengthening Ext (See also Exercises fo and Balance Exercise Elementary
1 1. Long sitting (1 lying; single or dout
GRADE
I knee); small range bend • p. 169.)
17. Ankle and foot exercises
mding and stretching with lows Hand travelling over IIDllll range bending and
1. ANKLE EXERCISES
DORSIFLEXORS Strengthening Exercises (Balance Exercises may also be included.)
Elementary
b Fig. 208
I:IDpting to assume kneel
1 1. Half lying or long sitting with trunk inclined backwards and hand support (heels free); single or double Ankle bending with slight Knee raising. 2. As above, but without Knee raising.
GRADE
2 1. High sitting (plinth); single or double Ankle bending. 2. No progression. 3. Sitting; single or double Forefoot raising.
GRADE
Intermediate 1 1. No progression. 2. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); Forefoot raising. 3. No progression.
GRADE
PLANTAR-FLEXORS
Strengthening Exercises
(See also Exercises for the Knee Extensors, pp. 164-167. Hopping, Skipping,
and Balance Exercises may also be induded.)
Elementary GRADE
1
1. Long sitting (trunk inclined backwards with hand suppon) or half lying; single or double Ankle stretehing.
171
172
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
2 1. Prone lying (plinth: feet free); as previous exercise.
GRADE
3 1. Sitting; single or double Heel raising.
GRADE
DORSIFLEXORS A Strengthening men (Balance Exercises ~ Many of the move combined, e.g. High si starting position.
Intermediate I 1. Reach grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising.
GRADE
2 1. Half yard grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising. 2. Reach grl'Sp instep support standing (wall bars and stool); single Heel raising. (See Fig. 209, which shows a progression on this exercise.)
GRADE
Mobilizing Exercise
Elementary 1. Half lying or 101 support (heels free); aI 2. High sitting (p1.iJ: 3. Sitting (one ankI and stretching conlin.: 4. Sitting; alternate
Advanced GRADE
1
1. Wing standing; Heel raising.
lao Standing; Heel raising with Arm swinging forwards and forwards upwards. 2. Half yard grasp instep support standing (wall bars and stool); single Heel raising. 3. Walking on the toes with 'springing' steps. 2 1. Neck rest standing; Heel raising.
GRADE
la. No progression.
2. Wing instep support standing (stool); single Heel raising (Fig. 209).
2. FOOT EXERCI INVERTORS Strengthening Em (Balance exercises II Elementary
1 1. Half lying or support (heels free) la. As Exercise)
GRADE
Fig. 209.
2 1. High sitting (] lao As Exercise·
GRADE
Za. Lax yard half standing; single Heel raising. 3. Running on the toes.
ANKLE AND FOOT EXERCISES
173
DORSIFLEXORS AND PLANTAR-FLEXORS n::ise.
Strengthening Exercises (Balance Exercises may also be included.) Many of the movements given in the two previous sections may be combined, e.g. High sitting (plinth); Ankle bending, stretching, and return to starting position. Mobilizing Exercises
iDg. I l
and stool); single Heel this exercise.)
Elementary 1. Half lying or long sitting with trunk inclined backwards and hand suppon (heels free); alternate Ankle bending and stretching. 2. High sitting (plinth); as above. 3. Sitting (one ankle crossed over opposite knee); single Ankle bending and stretching continuously to a given count. 4. Sitting; alternate Forefoot and Heel raising (Fig. 210).
Orwards and forwards-
bars and stool); single
:d raising (Fig. 209).
1 Fig. 210.
2. FOOT EXERCISES INVERTORS
Strengthening Exercises (Balance exercises may also be included.) Elementary GRADE 1
1. Half lying or long sitting with trunk inclined backwards and hand support (heels free); single or double Foot turning inwards. lao As Exercise 1, with Toe flexion.
2 1. High sitting (plinth); single or double Foot turning inwards.
lao As Exercise 1, with Toe flexion.
GRADE
174
ANI
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
2. Sitting (one ankle crossed over opposite knee); single Foot turning inwards. 3. Sitting; single or double inner Border raising. 4. Sitting; attempting to accentuate medial longitudinal arches.
Intermediate 1 1-2. No progressions. 3. Reach grasp standing (wall bars) or standing; inner Border ralsmg. 4. Starting position as Exercise 3; attempting to accentuate mediallongi tudinal arches.
GRADE
Mobilizing Exercises Elementary 1. Half lying or long Iii support (heels free); alten tinuously to a given count. 2. High sitting (plinth); 3. Sitting (one ankle c:I' inwards and outwards conI 4. Short stride sitting; il given count.
CIRCUMDUCTORS
EVERTORS
Mobilizing Exercises
Strengthening Exercises (Balance exercises may also be included.)
Elementary 1. Half lying or long s support (heels free); single 2. High sitting (plinth); 3. Sitting (one ankle en: N.B. Emphasis may be Circling with emphasis on
Elementary 1 1. Half lying or long sitting with trunk inclined backwards and hand support (heels free); single or double Foot turning outwards.
GRADE
2 1. High sitting (plinth); single or double Foot turning outwards. 2. Sitting (one ankle crossed over opposite knee); single Foot turning outwards. 3. Short stride sitting; single or double outer Border raising. GRADE
Strengthening ExerciM The movements given in tl ing exercises; they are the
INTRINSIC MUSCLE.l Intermediate
Strengthening Exerdsl
I 1-2. No progressions. 3. Reach grasp short stride standing (walls bars) or standing; outer Border raising.
Elementary 1. Sitting; single or
GRADE
INVERTORS AND EVERTORS Strengthening Exercises (Balance Exercises may also be included.) Certain of the movements given in the two previous sections may be combined, e.g. High sitting (plinth); Foot turning inwards and outwards, and return to starting position.
~ I
"
"J/
.... ~,-~
Fig. 211. Foot sI:
ANKLE AND FOOT EXERCISES
ore); single Foot turning I
prudinal arches.
rig; in,ner Border raIsmg. •accentuate mediallongi
175
Mobilizing Exercises
Elementary 1. Half lying or long SIttIng with trunk inclined backwards and hand support (heels free); alternate Foot turning inwards and outwards con tinuously to a given count. 2. High sitting (plinth); as above. 3. Sitting (one ankle crossed over opposite knee); single Foot turning inwards and outwards continuously to a given count. 4. Short stride sitting; inner and outer Border raising continuously to a given count.
CIRCUMDUCTORS Mobilizing Exercises
cd backwards and hand
Elementary 1. Half lying or long SittIng with trunk inclined backwards and hand support (heels free); single or double Foot circling. 2. High sitting (plinth); as above. 3. Sitting (one ankle crossed over opposite knee); single Foot circling. N.B. Emphasis may be placed on a particular part of the circling, e.g. Circling with emphasis on inversion.
outwards.
IIDing outwards.
I:IC); single Foot turning
Strengthening Exercises
The movements given in the previous section may also be used as strengthen
ing exercises; they are then performed more slowly.
rder raising. INTRINSIC MUSCLES Strengthening Exercises
II:' standing;
outer Border
::Yious sections may be Dtlrds and outwards, and
Elementary I. Sitting; single or double Foot shortening (flexion of the metatarso phalangeal joints, with extension of the interphalangeal joints) (Fig. 211). la. Half lying (feet supported by footboard, with ankles dorsiflexed); single or double Foot shortening. See above. (Fig. 212.)
176
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
2. Halflying or long sitting (trunk inclined backwards with hand support); Toe parting and closing. la. Sitting (feet resting on floor or in tray of sand); Toe parting and closing.
~~
. 'to.
~
~~-
-
--~ ---~.....;,...~
~-~~C
j
Fig. 212. Foot shortening adapted for bed use: the feet are supported by a
footboard.
~~l"'l ~-
.;~-,
::--:;:~~~
J!
Fig. 213. Another exercise for the intrinsic muscles.
3. Sitting (toes resting on book); Toe flexion at the metatarsophalangeal joints, with extension of the interphalangeal joints: each foot in turn, or both together (Fig. 213). 4. Sitting (feet resting on book, with all the toes free); Toe flexion at the metatarsophalangeal joints, with extension of the interphalangeal joints: each foot in turn, or both together.
Intermediate 1. Standing; single or double Foot shortening. (See Exercise 1, Elemen tary grade). 2. No progression. 3. Standing; practising correct 'push off' movement from toes in walking (interphalangeal joints of toes must be kept extended).
TOE FLEXORS A The strengthening ell strong flexion and e:I starting position. Example: Half lyi support), both tog. The mobilizing e which are performecl Example: Long sit bendiJrg together.
ANKLE AND FOOT EXERCISES
swards with hand support);
of sand); Toe parting and
be feet are supported by a
_muscles.
at the metatarsophalangeal I: each foot in turn, or both
IICS free); Toe flexion at the interphalangeal joints: each
• (See Exercise 1, Elemen
:meat from toes in walking 1Ided).
177
TOE FLEXORS AND EXTENSORS The strengthening exercises for the flexors and extensors of the toes consist of strong flexion and extension movements, followed by a slow return to the starting position. Example: Half lying or long sitting (trunk inclined backwards with hand support); strong Toe bending, and slow recoil.' each foot in turn, or both together. The mobilizing exercises consist of flexion and extension movements which are performed in a continuous manner. Example: Long sitting (trunk inclined backwards with hand support); Toe
bending and stretching continuously to a given count.' both feet
together.
il:
PART 4
APPLIED EXERCISE THERAPY
179
18. Construction and use of tables of specific exercises
The tables consist of lists of movements which provide exercise for a particular part of the body; they are used in the treatment of localized lesions, such as fractures, chest diseases and postoperative abdominal conditions. A series of graded tables is required to provide smooth, progressive exercise from the early to the late phase of recovery. If a patient's condition remains stationary for a considerable time the exercises are changed or modified to maintain interest. The patients are treated individually or by group or class methods. In many hospitals and rehabilitation centres men and women are exercised together in the same groups or classes. Group and Class Work The difference between group and class methods of instruction is not always understood. In group work a small number of patients (6 at the most), with the same or similar types of disability, are treated together. The therapist indicates the exercise to be performed and the patients practise it individu ally. The therapist goes from patient to patient and gives individual coaching as required. In class work a number of patients (10-12 at the most), with the same or similar types of disability, exercise in unison under the guidance of the therapist. General Exercises In rehabilitation centres general exercises and games are used in addition to specific exercises. In hospital rehabilitation departments the limited amount of time available for treatment makes it difficult to organize full-scale general exercise classes. The difficulty can be overcome to some extent by arranging short sessions of general 'warming-up' exercises to music before the specific exercise periods (p. 256).
THE EXERCISE TABLE The exercises are selected with regard to the aims of treatment and the phase 181
"II'
182
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
of recovery reached by the patient. In general, the same type of exercises are used for both men and women. Some of the more strenuous exercises, however, are not suitable for women. One method of compiling and using a table of specific exercises is given here.
is confined to bed...-a bance of the bedclodJ straight Leg raising ill patient resting in bed : ~.
I Compiling the Exercise Table The aims of treatment are divided into two groups: those of primary importance and those of secondary importance. The exercises which are chosen to achieve the aims are also divided into two groups: Primary and Secondary Exercises. This method has been followed in compiling the lists of progressive exercises for the clinical conditions included in the following chapters.
Using the Exercise Tables Primary and secondary exercises are used at each exercise period. The secondary exercises are spaced between the primary exercises, e.g. two or three primary exercises are followed by one or two secondary exercises. In this way there is no danger of the affected part being subjected to too concentrated a period of activity. When the table consists of one group of exercises only this suggestion cannot be followed.
Avoiding Fatigue Exercises which activate the same muscle groups should not be given consecutively, because this may produce fatigue. Exercises which use the same muscles in association with other muscles, to produce different movements, may follow each other with little danger of over-fatigue. For example, in strengthening the trunk muscles two exercises which use the abdominal muscles as flexors of the spine should not be given consecutively, but a series of exercises in which the abdominal muscles are used as flexors, rotators and lateral flexors of the spine is permissible. Short rest periods are given whenever they are thought to be necessary.
t
I Ii
i, I
I ~
•
'LITTLE-AND-OFTEN' SELF-PRACTICE
I
To obtain the maximum benefit from specific exercise therapy the patient should practise two or three of the more important exercises from the exercise table on a 'little-and-often' basis during the day. Unfortunately, this aspect of physical treatment is often overlooked. The exercises selected for self-practice must be simple, and-if the patient
I
-----
~
£ I
LISTS OF SPECIF:
To aid the therapist in some lists of progres Introductory notes in exercises are suitable I
TABLES OF SPECIFIC EXERCISES
:APY
183
is confined to bed--capable of being performed with the minimum distur bance of the bedclothes. For example, Quadriceps contractions and single straight Leg raising in small range are the 'key' exercises prescribed for a patient resting in bed after meniscectomy.
same type of exercises are nore strenuous exercises, specific exercises is given
LISTS OF SPECIFIC EXERCISES To aid the therapist in planning exercise tables for certain clinical conditions some lists of progressive exercises are given in the following chapters. Introductory notes in each chapter describe the conditions for which the exercises are suitable and give details of the SUrgical procedures used.
p:oups: those of primary The' exercises which are two groups: Primary and m in compiling the lists of included in the following
ICb exercise period. The lIlY exercises, e.g. two or 1'0 secondary exercises. In 1: being subjected to too ~ consists of one group of
should not be given Exercises which use the es, to produce different oger of over-fatigue. For I exercises which use the at be given consecutively, uscles are used as flexors, )1e. Short rest periods are
IpS
,
,t I
1
:rcise therapy the patient sereises from the exercise Ifortunately, this aspect of imple, and-if the patient
EXERCISE
19. Exercise therapy after abdominal surgery
respiratory passages of !II postoperative analgesic c as twenty-four hours; in of the associated pain iD
Interaction of these Facn Both the decreased res secretions lead to pulmol bronchus, or to multiJ bronchioles. The lattel bronchial pneumonia, if ever, may arise indepell inhaled from the mouth
This chapter describes the various forms of exercise therapy which may be used in the postoperative treatment of gastrectomy, cholecystectomy, appendicectomy and inguinal, femoral and umbilical herniae. For con venience of description the exercise procedures which are used to prevent postoperative respiratory and circulatory complications have been grouped together as an introductory section. Preoperative training of the patient in the exercises and techniques to be used is essential. It is also most important that the therapist explains very simply the reasons for the exercises, without in any way alarming the patient or increasing his apprehension of surgery.
Alteration of Posture After major operations, ! is often encouraged to iii 214) during the 1st and: for about 1-2 hours at a This routine alterati~ of great importance in t atelectasis. It also helps I in the various positiOOl breathing exercises at fr Ballinger and DrapIQ therapy after surgery. <) physiotherapy before an or pneumonia from 42 I
RESPIRATORY COMPLICATIONS The main causes of postoperative respiratory complications, such as bron chitis, bronchopneumonia and atelectasis, are: (1) Decreased respiratory movement, particularly limitation of diaphragmatic excursion, and (2) Increased amount of mucous secretions in the respiratory passages as a result of some anaesthetic agent irritation, and inhibition (for a variable period) of the normal ciliary action.
Decreased Respiratory Movement This means that parts of the lungs are out of action and not expanding fully, especially at the bases. The principal factors that produce this state are pain and associated reflex spasm of the diaphragm. The respiratory excursion of the diaphragm is especially limited after operations on the upper abdomen, and this is most evident on the 1st postoperative day. The fall of vital capacity may be as low as 20-25 per cent of normal on the 1st postoperative day. It improves gradually over the next six to ten days.
Increased Amount of Mucous Secretions Normally the cough reflex ensures that the patient successfully empties his
•
184
, #
~
Postural Drainage Should a collapse of a precautions, the patien drainage ofthe affected . lobe is affected the patiel 214), and the foot of the as previously described, time in the specific drai Postural drainage of tl coarse vibrations, enCOll in lying and crook sid patient's hands or a Q Crook side-lying (therap
T
after
I
J
!
.t
and techniques to be therapist explains very way alarming the patient
IICS
~
md not expanding fully, oduce this state are pain
especially limited after lOSt evident on the 1st I low as 20-25 per cent of lIduaIly over the next six
successfully empties his
185
respiratory passages of secretions. After general anaesthesia, with or without postoperative analgesic drugs, the reflex is very often diminished for as long as twenty-four hours; in addition, the patient is disinclined to cough because of the associated pain in his wound.
Interaction oj these Factors Both the decreased respiratory movement and the increased amount of secretions lead to pulmonary congestion and the danger of blockage of a main bronchus, or to multiple patchy collapse by blockage of many small bronchioles. The latter complication is specially likely to proceed to bronchial pneumonia, if inadequately dealt with. Bronchopneumonia, how ever, may arise independently of collapse, due to infected material (often inhaled from the mouth) gaining a foothold on predisposed ground.
~erCJse therapy which ctmny, cholecystectomy, ilical herniae. For con Jicb are used to prevent ions have been grouped
;tIications, such as bron } Decreased respiratory die excursion, and (2) .ory passages as a result (for a variable period) of
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
f
Alteration of Posture After major operations, such as gastrectomy and cholecystectomy, the patient is often encouraged to lie flat on his back, and on the left and right side (Fig. 214) during the 1st and 2nd postoperative days. He remains in each position for about 1-2 hours at a time. This routine alteration of posture assists in the drainage of the lungs and is of great importance in the prevention of pulmonary complications, such as atelectasis. It also helps to 'break' any flatulence which may be present. While in the various positions the patient is encouraged to carry out localized breathing exercises at frequent intervals. Ballinger and Drapanas (1972) emphasize the value of skilled physio therapy after surgery. 'In the experience of Bendixen and colleagues, chest physiotherapy before and after operation reduces the incidence of atelectasis or pneumonia from 42 to 12 per cent.'
Postural Drainage Should a collapse of a particular area of the lung develop in spite of all precautions, the patient's posture must be modified to secure adequate drainage of the affected part. For example, if the lateral area of the left lower lobe is affected the patient is placed in the right crook side-lying position (Fig. 214), and the foot of the bed is raised 30-60 cm. Routine alteration of posture, as previously described, must still be continued, but the patient spends more time in the specific drainage position. Postural drainage of this type will be reinforced by the use of shakings and coarse vibrations, encouragement of coughing and expectoration of secretions in lying and crook side-lying (the wound area being supported by the patient's hands or a Cough-Lok), and unilateral breathing exercises, e.g. Crook side-lying (therapist's hand on side oj lower chest); lower lateral Costal
186
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
EXERCISE THERAPY
3. Crook lying (hands on sid! breathing. 4. Crook lying (forearms eros clavicles); Apical breathing. 5. Crook lying; general deep hi
CIRCULATORY COMPLICA
Fig. 214. Alteration of posture after major abdominal surgery. The patient is encouraged to lie on his back, and on the left and right side, for about 1-2 hours at a time during the first and second postoperative days. This routine alteration of posture is of great importance in the prevention of pulmonary complications, such as atelectasis.
breathing, and Crook side-lying (therapist's hand on posterior aspect of lower chest); posterior Basal breathing.
Postoperative Breathing Exercises Bilateral breathing exercises are used in the early postoperative days follow ing all forms of abdominal surgery. They are particularly important in the period before the patient is allowed out of bed for the major part of the day. In addition to being part of regular treatment sessions supervised by the therapist, some of the more important exercises should be carried out by the patient throughout the day on 'little and often' lines. The starting positions used for the exercises will obviously depend on the patient's condition and the individual preference of the therapist. To avoid repetition crook lying and crook side-lying are used for the exercises given here. 1. Crook lying and crook side-lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphrag matic breathing.* (See Fig. 144, p. 110.) 2. Crook lying (hands on sides of lower chest); lower lateral Costal breathing. (See Fig. 143, p. 109.)
* After gastrectomy and cholecystectomy, where the incisions used involve the upper abdomen (pp. 188-201), diaphragmatic breathing is generally extremely shallow on the 1st postoperative day and may be almost impossible to obtain.
'Various factors have been record! ofthrombosis and embolism. ThR the possible causes: (a) Increased 1 the intima of the vein at operation, The last is probably the most imp! postoperative day and is present t 'Several competent authorities which occurs in the veins of the 1m interference with the action of the , fulfilling a respiratory function, movement of the blood through t action of the diaphragm [by prom. the chest]. As the movements of abdominal surgery, the pumping ~ slowing of the venous circulation 1
Postoperative Leg Exercises Simple foot, ankle and leg exerc:iSl days to accelerate the venous circu They are especially important in til In addition to forming part of II therapist, some of the more impoI1 patient throughout the day on <J important in the period before rq Useful exercises, taken in'lyi7l1f 1. Lying; alternate Ankle bend 2. Lying; alternate Foor tu1'1liII 3. Lying; single Foot circling. 4. Lying; Toe bending and st1' 5. Lying; single slight Knee ra down pressing. 6. Lying; single and double QJ 7. Lying; combined Quadricep
! THERAPY
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
187
3. Crook lying (hands on sides of upper chest); upper lateral Costal breathing. 4. Crook lying (forearms crossed and fingers resting on chest below clavicles); Apical breathing. S. Crook lying; general deep breathing.
CJRCULATORY COMPUCATIONS
Ibdominal surgery. The patient is .wright side, for about 1-2 hours rative days. This routine alteration Iu::ioo of pulmonary complications,
Iumd on posterior aspect of lower
early postoperative days follow are particularly important in the bed for the major part of the day. lbIlent sessions supervised by the :ercises should be carried out by lid often' lines. :ises will obviously depend on the li::rence of the therapist. To avoid are used for the exercises given I:
lid on upper abdomen); Diaphrag 10.) wee chest); lower lateral Costal
Ie the incisions
used involve the upper g is generally extremely shallow on the sible to obtain.
'Various factors have been recorded as being responsible for the production ofthrombosis and embolism. Three main factors are now recognized as being the possible causes: (a) Increased tendency for the blood to clot, (b) Injury to the intima of the vein at operation, and (c) Slowing ofthe venous circulation. The last is probably the most important ... The slowing starts in the second postoperative day and is present until the patient becomes ambulant . . . 'Several competent authorities think that the slowing of the circulation which occurs in the veins of the lower limbs after abdominal surgery is due to interference with the action of the diaphragm. The diaphragm, in addition to fulfilling a respiratory function, also accounts in large measure for the movement of the blood through the veins to the right heart-the pumping action of the diaphragm [by production of intermittent negative pressure in the chest]. As the movements of the diaphragm are much depressed after abdominal surgery, the pumping action is interfered with and consequently slowing of the venous circulation takes place' (Gunn Roberts, 1946).
Postoperative Leg Exercises Simple foot, ankle and leg exercises are used during the early postoperative days to accelerate the venous circulation through the lower limbs and pelvis. They are especially important in the period before regular walking is allowed. In addition to forming part of regular treatment sessions organized by the therapist, some of the more important exercises should be carried out by the patient throughout the day on 'little and often' lines. This is especially important in the period before regular walking is allowed. Useful exercises, taken in lying or half-lying, include: 1. Lying; alternate Ankle bending and stretching. 2. Lying; alternate Foot turning inwards and outwards. 3. Lying; single Foot circling. 4. Lying; Toe bending and stretching rhythmically: both feet. S. Lying; single slight Knee raising and lowering, followed by firm Leg downpressing. 6. Lying; single and double Quadriceps contractions. 7. Lying; combined Quadriceps and Gluteal contractions: alternate legs.
188
EXERCISE TID
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
General Progressions 8. Sitting over edge of bed; alternate Ankle bending and stretching. 9. Sitting over edge of bed; alternate lower Leg swinging with Ankle bending and stretching. 10. Sitting over edge of bed; single Knee stretching. II. S itting (chair); alternate Forefoot raising (1-4), followed by alternate
Heel raising (5-8).
12. Sitting (chair); single high Knee raising, lowering and downpressing of
Foot on to floor.
1. GASTRECTOMY* Partial gastrectomy may be performed in the treatment of peptic ulcer (gastric or duodenal ulcer), and carcinoma of the stomach. Total gastrectomy may be performed for: (1) Carcinoma of the stomach; (2) High gastric ulcer; and (3) Ulcer of the lower end of the oesophagus.
TYPES OF INCISION A right upper paramedian incision is commonly used (Fig. 215). Sometimes a left upper paramedian incision is used, e.g. in certain cases of gastric ulcer and in carcinoma when wide removal of the stomach is necessary. The incision is vertical in direction and is situated 1·2-2'5 cm from the midline; it extends approximately from the costal margin to a point one side of the umbilicus (Fig. 215).
Stages of Incision I. Incision of skin and subcutaneous tissues, down to the anterior sheath of the rectus muscle. 2. Incision of the anterior sheath of the rectus muscle in the line of the skin incision. 3. Retraction of the rectus muscle laterally, so that no large nerves or vessels are damaged.
* a. A gastro-enterostomy (to short-circuit the pyloric part of the stomach and duodenum) is performed by some surgeons for inoperable cases of carcinoma of the pylorus and for pyloric stenosis. A right upper paramedian incision is used. After treatment by exercise therapy is the same as described for gastrectomy. b. Vagotomy, together with gastro-enterostomy or pyloroplasty, is sometimes performed for cases of duodenal ulcer. A left upper paramedian incision is used; the exercise therapy is as described for gastrectomy. c. Highly selective vagotomy (also known as 'proximal gastric denervation') is now widely used in the treatment of duodenal ulceration.
, 1
I, • .
.
, .I .,• if
Kocherls
,
s~~~~i~~
J
II
+ __
Battle's pararectal _ _ incision
Gridiron (M~~~~i~r:~
, ....
i J !
t
f
•·• •
••
•"
t
,· ~
~
•• ~
"
t
~
,
Fi.! 4. Incision of the posten skin incision.
EXERCISE AND THE ~ The aponeurosis of the obi anterior and posterior shea! therefore tend to pun more trunk exercise. When tnm1 be of the slow controlled tl Although it is quite post simple abdominal exercises it has been found more co the 3rd day. Breathing ell essential during the first time for abdominal exercil
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
Kocher', .ubco'tal _ _-+~~!i-:;/ incision
Battle', pararectal incision
ed (Fig. 215). Sometimes a nain cases of gastric ulcer
ach is necessary. lilted 1·2-2·5 cm from the margin to a point one side
m to the anterior sheath of
189
Incision for inguinal
, j
• ,
~->!i~~- hernia
Fig. 215. Abdominal incisions.
4. Incision of the posterior rectus sheath and peritoneum in the line of the skin incision,
uscle in the line of the skin
EXERCISE AND THE SUTURE UNE
) that no large nerves or
The aponeurosis of the oblique and transverse abdominal muscles form the anterior and posterior sheaths of the rectus muscle, Active trunk rotation will therefore tend to pull more strongly on the suture line than any other form of trunk exercise. When trunk rotation movements are performed they should be of the slow controlled type, and quick jerky movements must be avoided, Although it is quite possible, and safe, for the average patient to perform simple abdominal exercises of all types on the 1st and 2nd postoperative days, it has been found more convenient in practice to leave these exercises until the 3rd day, Breathing exercises and movements for the lower limbs are essential during the first 2 postoperative days, and usually there is little time for abdominal exercises.
ric part of the stomach and tJIe cases of carcinoma of the dian incision is used. After Dc gastrectomy. pyloroplasty, is sometimes mtedian incision is used; the
I gastric denervation') is now
190
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
i
EXERCISE 1
EXERCISE THERAPY
Remedial Aims
The lists of progressive exercises given here are intended to be a guide to the after-treatment of partial and total gastrectomy.
PRIMARY
FIRST 2 POSTOPERATIVE DAYS
SECONDARY
Usually, intravenous therapy is used on the lst day, and one of the patient's arms or legs is immobilized for this purpose. A Ryle's tube may be in position for intermittent aspiration of the stomach remnant. To help prevent pulmonary complications the patient should spend a considerable amount of his time lying flat on his back and on the left and right sides; he stays in each position for about 1-2 hours at a time (p. 185). Should a collapse of a particular area of the lung develop in spite of all precautions, postural drainage will be instituted as outlined on p. 185.
Sitting out of Bed Provided that there are no respiratory complications, sitting out in a chair for about 10-20 minutes is generally allowed on the 1st postoperative day. Supervised walking round the bed is usually allowed on the 2nd day.
Remedial Aims To prevent postoperative respiratory and circulatory complications.
Exercise Period 15-20 minutes, two or three times daily. In addition to these treatment sessions the patient will practise some of the exercises on 'little and often' lines.
Primary Exercises
Breathing, Ankle/Foot and Leg Exercises (see previous section, pp. 186-188)
It should be noted that diaphragmatic breathing is extremely shallow on the
1st postoperative day and may be almost impossible to obtain (p. 184).
1. To prevent postopel 2. To maintain the al transverse groups.
1. To maintain the otb 2. To maintain the mu the feet.
Exercise Period 20 minutes, twice daily_ exercises on 'little and 01
i
Primary Exercises Breathing, Ankle/Foot an Trunk Exercises 1. Crook lying (hand ( 2. Stride lying; Trunk See Fig. 129, p. 10] 3. Lying; Head bendiJ: 50 and Fig. 59, p. C
It
t
t,
L
,t
•
Secondary Exercises '
Trunk Exercises 1. Lying; slight Chest raising.) 2. Crook lying; Pelvis
Leg Exercises 1. Half lying; single 2. Half lying; si~g]e
0 0
i
5th TO 10th POSTOf 3rd and 4th POSTOPERATIVE DAYS The patient rests in bed between intervals of sitting out in a chair; provided there are no respiratory complications he takes up an ordinary half-lying position. Short periods of walking in the ward are encouraged.
Usually the stitches are I the patient's condition sutures are sometimes us 8itting in a chair. The a
THERAPY
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
191
Remedial Aims
intended to be a guide to the ny.
Ire
PRIMARY
1. To prevent postoperative respiratory and circulatory complications. 2. To maintain the abdominal muscles, particularly the oblique and transverse groups. SECONDARY
1st day, and one of the patient's !\ Ryk's tube may be in position
mnant.
the patient should spend a lis back and on the left and right IOW'S at a time (p. 185). Should a dol> in spite of all precautions, II:d on p. 185.
1. To maintain the other trunk muscles. 2. To maintain the muscles that support the medial longitudinal arches of the feet.
tIS
Cations, sitting out in a chair for co. the 1st postoperative day. , allowed on the 2nd day.
Exercise Period 20 minutes, twice daily. In addition, the patient will practise some of the exercises on 'little and often' lines throughout the day.
Primary Exercises Breathing, Ankle/Foot and Leg Exercises (see previous section, pp. 186-188 Trunk Exercises 1. Crook lying (hand on abdomen); Abdominal contractions. 2. Stride lying; Trunk turning with single Arm carrying across the chest. See Fig. 129, p. 101. 3. Lying; Head bending forwards with single high Knee raising. See Fig. 50 and Fig. 59, p. 62 and 70.
DJlatory complications.
Secondary Exercises
in addition to these treatment r:: exercises on 'little and often'
previous section, pp. 186-188) iiog is extremely shallow on the ~ble to obtain (p. 184).
Trunk Exercises 1. Lying; slight Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79, which shows full Chest raising.) 2. Crook lying; Pelvis raising. (See Fig. 150, p. 116.)
Leg Exercises 1. Half lying; single or double Ankle bending. 2. Half lying; single or double Foot turning inwards.
5th TO 10th POSTOPERATIVE DAY sitting out in a chair; provided Ikes up an ordinary half-lying :d are encouraged.
Usually the stitches are removed on the 10th postoperative day, depending on the patient's condition and the surgeon's opinion. (Absorbable cutaneous sutures are sometimes used.) The patient spends an increasing amount of time sitting in a chair. The amount of walking is also increased.
192
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Remedial Aims As for the 3rd and 4th postoperative days. An additional (Primary) aim is to improve posture.
, IF
EXEIlC
i
Exercise Period 20-30 minutes, once or twice daily.
1. PATIENT LYING ON BED
assume a modified b without producing di: (Fig. 217).
Primary Exercises Breathing, Ankle/Fool and Leg Exercises See pp. 186-188. Because of the patient's increasing mobility the number of exercises used from this section can now be limited to, say, diaphragmatic and lower lateral costal breathing and a general leg movement.
3. PATIENT STAJ
Trunk Exercises 1. Stride lying; Trunk turning with Head bending forwards and single Arm carrying across the chest. (See Fig. 129, p. 101.) 2. Lying; single high Knee raising, Leg stretching forwards to 45° and slow lowering. 3. Lying (hands grasping edges of mattress); upper Trunk bending forwards with assistance from arms. 4. Heave grasp lying (head posts of bed); Hip updrawing. (See Fig. 121, p. 96, which shows exercise performed in standing.)
Primary Exercises
Posture and Walking 1. General correcti 2. Walking practio
10th TO 14th PO~
The patient is often d
Secondary Exercises Trunk Exercise
Lying; Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79.)
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
To redevelop the abel groups.
2. PATIENT SITTING IN CHAIR
Primary Exercises Trunk Exercises 1. Stride sitting; Trunk turning with Arm moving loosely sideways in the direction of the hands to grasp the chair back (Fig. 216). 2. Stride sitting; Trunk bending sideways. Secondary Exercises Trunk Exercise Stride sitting (hands on thighs); Trunk bending forwards-downwards to
SECONDARY
I1
I
..I.
1. To redevelop tIi 2. To redevelop tb the feet. 3. To re-educate Il
Exercise Period 30 minutes, once or
T. IRAPY
lditional (Primary) aim is to
I•
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
I•
193
j
i t
f
,• Fig. 216.
ling mobility the number of d to. say, diaphragmatic and
Fig. 217.
assume a modified lax stoop position (movement taken as far as possible without producing discomfort in wound area), followed by Trunk stretching. (Fig. 217).
lDOVement. 3. PATIENT STANDING
~ forwards and single ft, p. 101.) Idling forwards to 45° and
Primary Exercises
Posture and Walking I. General correction of posture in standing and walking. 2. Walking practice.
IS>; upper Trunk bending
, updrawing. (See Fig. 121, I113Dding.)
rring loosely sideways in ir back (Fig. 216).
og forwards-downwards to
10th TO 14th POSTOPERATIVE DAY
The patient is often discharged from the ward between the 10th and 14th day.
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
To redevelop the abdominal muscles, particularly the oblique and transverse groups. SECONDARY
1. To redevelop the other trunk muscles. 2. To redevelop the muscles that support the medial longitudinal arches of the feet. 3. To re-educate neuromuscular coordination.
Exercise Period 30 minutes, once or twice daily.
194
EXERClSI
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
&£rcise Period 30 minutes, once or tw
Primary Exercises Trunk Exercises 1. Fixed stride lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with turning and
single Arm carrying across the chest. (Fig. 218).
2. Crook lying; Pelvis raising and turning. 3. Half lumbar rest stride standing; single Arm swinging forwards, and
sideways with Trunk turning.
4. Low reach grasp standing (chair back); Hip updrawing. (See Fig. 121, p. 96.) which shows a different starting position.) 5. Stride standing; Trunk bending sideways. 6. Lying; high Knee raising, followed by over-pressure with the hands,
and upper Trunk bending forwards. (See Fig. 73, p. 74.)
7. Lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with single high Knee raising.
(See Figs. 59 and 67, pp. 70 and 73.)
Primary Exercises
Trunk Exercises 1. Fixed stride lyiDt single Arm carryi
Secondary Exercises Trunk Exercises 1. Lax stoop stride sitting; Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' in
different planes. (See Fig. 139, p. 105.)
2. Crook lying; Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79.) 3. Forehead rest prone lying (pillow under abdomen); single slight Leg
raising backwards.
4. Neck rest stride sitting; Trunk lowering forwards. Leg Exercises 5. Low reach grasp standing (chair back); inner Border raising. Balance Exercises 6. Back towards standing (wall bars or wall); single Knee raising. 7. Half yard finger support side toward standing (wall bars or wall);
balance walking forwards with Knee raising.
FROM 14th POSTOPERATIVE DAY The exercises suggested here are of a moderately strenuous type. They are used for one to two weeks if exercise therapy is prescribed for the patient after he is discharged from the ward.
Remedial Aims As for the 10th-14th postoperative day.
HI!
,
2. Prone kneeling;: (Fig. 219.) 3. Stride standing; 4. Fixed crook lyin; (See Fig. 72, p.' 5. Fist bend fixed backwards tllrml
~
• ,.
.
Secondary Exerclsl
Trunk Exercises 1. Lax stoop back ) front of wall baI different planes. 2. Neck rest crook 3. Forehead rest p may have to be II abdominal muse 4. Prone kneeling: bending backwa 5. Fist bend stride
Foot Exercise 6. Standing; inner
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
195
Bxercise Period 30 minutes, once or twice daily. :wards with turning and S).
Primary Exercises
IWinging forwards, and pdrawing. (See Fig. 121, 00.) •
••
Trunk Bxercises 1. Fixed stride lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with turning and single Arm carrying across the chest (Fig. 218).
•
ressure with the hands, 73, p. 74.) iDgIe high Knee raising.
Fig. 218.
Fig. 219.
Patebra by vertebra' in I.) 1IDeIl); single slight Leg
lids.
2. Prone kneeling; slow Trunk turning with single Arm raising sideways. (Fig. 219.) 3. Stride standing; Trunk bending sideways. 4. Fixed crook lying; Trunk bending forwards with assistance from arms. (See Fig. 72, p. 74, which shows a different starting position.) 5. Fist bend fixed inclined long sitting (wall bar stool); Trunk lowering backwards through 45°. (See Fig. 60, p. 70.)
lJorder raising.
~
Dg
Secondary Exercises Knee raising. (wall bars or wall);
renuous type. They are ibed for the patient after
Trunk Bxercises 1. Lax stoop back lean stride standing (heels about a footlength or more in front of wall bar upright); Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' in different planes. (See Fig. 139, p. 105.) 2. Neck rest crook lying; Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79.) 3. Forehead rest prone lying; single Leg raising backwards. The exercise may have to be modified, so that the spinal extension does not stretch the abdominal muscles unduly or cause pain. 4. Prone kneeling; Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards with Head bending backwards and forwards. (See Fig. 106, p. 90.) 5. Fist bend stride sitting; Trunk lowering forwards.
Foot Bxercise 6. Standing; inner Border raising.
196
EXERCISE .
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Balance Exercises 7. Balance walking forwards with opposite Knee and Arm raising. 8. Balance halfstanding (balance bench rib); balance walking fowards and backwards.
2. CHOLECYSTECTOMY The gallbladder is removed in cases of chronic cholecystitis, with or without the presence of gallstones. Disease of the gallbladder is more common in women than in men.
TYPES OF INCISION The most common incision used today is the right upper paramedian incision (Fig. 215, p. 189). In certain cases (obese subjects, for example, where good exposure is required), Kocher's subcostal incision is used (Fig. 215, p. 189). This incision was employed more often in the past, before the introduction of muscle relaxing drugs in anaesthesia.
EXERCISE THERAP
,
•i,.
•
•• t
f
i
t
t
t
I
J
It
Right Upper Paramedian Incision. (See p. 188.)
Kocher's Subcostal Incision (Fig. 215, p. 189) The incision begins just below the xiphoid process and extends downwards and outwards to the tip of the 9th costal cartilage, 2·5 cm below and parallel with the costal margin. All the abdominal muscles, including the lateral half of the rectus and its sheath, are divided in the same line. The 9th intercostal nerve is severed. Thus this incision produces a flaccid paralysis of certain of the fibres of the abdominal muscles, which predisposes to herniae.
As suggested for gastrCI be noted, as indicated he 1. Usually intravenow 2. 'Getting Up.' Aftel hours, sitting in a chair postoperative day. WaJkiI After cholecystectomy, .. drainage into bag), the 'I Ii ttle slower. 3. Discharge from ,. patient is usually allO'tl postoperative day. Wba generally discharged froll day.
---
--~-- ...
Appendicectomy is per. chronic inflammation of appendicitis the operati appendix occurs, or afta will complicate the origi is removed between attlll
I
I
TYPES OF INCISIO
The most common inm or muscle-splitting incil and the right lower pan
I
Drainage In a straightforward cholecystectomy some form of drainage is employed for 48-72 hours. Bile secretions are drained into a Redivac vacuum bottle or a Porto-vac suction unit. When the common bile-duct is incised and explored (for the presence of an obstructing stone), aT-tube is used to drain the common bile-duct. The tube drains into a bag attached to the patient's thigh and is usually retained for about 10 days.
Gridiron Incision (F~ The incision is an obliQ1 in the line of the fibres length, with its centre at drawn from the umbilic Stages of Incision
1. Incision of skin an muscle.
i
!
ERAPY
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
197
EXERCISE THERAPY Dee and Arm raising. ba1ance walking fowards and
.
MY
';
:holecystitis, with or without iJladder is more common in
It upper paramedian
,
•
As suggested for gastrectomy (pp. 190-196). Certain modifications must be noted, as indicated here: 1. Usually intravenous therapy is not given. 2. 'Getting Up.' After cholecystectomy, when a drain is used for 48-72 hours, sitting in a chair for 10-20 minutes is usually allowed on the 1st postoperative day. Walking is encouraged when the drainage is discontinued. After cholecystectomy, with exploration of the common bile-duct (T-tube drainage into bag), the 'getting up' regime is much the same but may be a little slower . 3. Discharge from ward. After straightforward cholecystectomy the patient is usually allowed to return home between the 7th and 10th postoperative day. When the common bile-duct is explored the patient is generally discharged from the ward between the 10th and 12th postoperative day.
incision
::ts, for example, where good
Icision is used (Fig. 215,
~ in the past, before the hcsia.
188.)
3. APPENDICECTOMY Appendicectomy is performed in the treatment of acute, subacute, and chronic inflammation of the vermiform appendix. During an acute attack of appendicitis the operation may be carried out before perforation of the appendix occurs, or after perforation has occurred (when a general peritonitis will complicate the original condition). In chronic appendicitis the appendix is removed between attacks-'interval appendicectomy'.
It) ~
and extends downwards 2·5 em below and parallel IS, induding the lateral half me line. The 9th intercostal t.ccid paralysis of certain of Iisposes to herniae.
TYPES OF INCISION
I!:;
of drainage is employed for lledivac vacuum bottle or a
Iored (for the presence of an lBIlDlon bile-duct. The tube and is usually retained for
The most common incision used in this country is the gridiron (McBurney) or muscle-splitting incision. Other incisions are Battle's pararectal incision and the right lower paramedian incision. (See p. 189.)
Gridiron Incision (Fig. 215, p. 189) The incision is an oblique one and runs in a downward and inward direction in the line of the fibres of the external oblique muscle. It is about 5 cm in length, with its centre at the junction of the middle and lateral thirds of a line drawn from the umbilicus to the right anterior superior iliac spine.
Stages of Incision 1. Incision of skin and subcutaneous tissues, down to the external oblique muscle.
t
198
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
I'
EXERCU
When the pararectal based on that suggeste should be more rapid.
2. Incision of the external oblique in the line of its fibres. Retraction of the external oblique to expose the internal oblique muscle. 3. Separation of the internal oblique and transversalis muscles in the line of their fibres. 4. Incision of the peritrneum.
The abdomen is closed in five stages.
1st POSTOPERAn
The patient is usua1ly , the morning or afterno in bed he is encouraged left and right sides. (FQ hour at a time. This alt and helps to 'break' at
Battle's Pararectal Incision (Fig. 215, p. 189)
This incision is considered to give better views, but is said to be somewhat
more liable to hernia. The incision is a vertical one, sub-umbilical in position
and about 5 em in length.
Right Lower Paramedian Incision (Fig. 215, p. 189)
The incision is used when the diagnosis is uncertain, or when exploration of
the lower abdomen (usually in the case of a female) is desired. See p. 188 for
details of right upper paramedian incision.
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
1. To prevent postCl 2. To prevent posUl 3. To maintain the transverse group!
EXERCISE AND lHE SUTURE LINE
Gridiron Incision
Because the muscles have been split in the direction of their fibres abdominal
exercises will not tend to separate the sutured muscle edges. Nevertheless,
reasonable care should be shown in the choice and performance of trunk
exercises throughout the postoperative phase of treatment.
Battle's Incision and Right Lower Paramedian Incision
Both types of incision entail cutting of the anterior and posterior sheaths of
the rectus muscle, which are formed by the aponeuroses of the oblique and
transverse abdominal muscles. Active trunk rotation movements will there
fore tend to pull more strongly on the suture line than any other form of trunk
exercise. The suggestions made on p. 189 regarding choice and performance
of trunk exercises in the after-treatment of gastrectomy should be followed.
EXERCISE lHERAPY The lists of progressive exercises given here are intended to be a guide to the after-treatment of (1) Interval Appendicectomy, and (2) Appendicectomy performed for acute appendicitis before perforation has occurred. It is assumed that a gridiron incision is used.
SECONDARY
To maintain the othel
Exercise Period 20 minutes. In additi some of the exercises
, t1 II
,
Primary Exercises
Breathing, Ankle! FOOl Trunk Exercises • 1. Stride lying; T chest (See Fig. I 2. Heave grasp lyiJ p. 96, which sh4
.. This aim is not so iJ involves the upper abdc the diaphragm is far les
'Y
5 fibres. Retraction of the : muscle. rsalis muscles in the line
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
199
When the pararectal or the paramedian incision is used exercise therapy is based on that suggested for gastrectomy (pp. 190-196). Progress, however, should be more rapid.
1st POSTOPERATIVE DAY is sa,id to be somewhat ;ub-umbilical in position
I
The patient is usually allowed to sit out in a chair for 30-45 minutes during the morning or afternoon and to walk in the ward for a short distance. While in bed he is encouraged to spend much of his time lying on his back and on the left and right sides. (Fig. 214, p. 186); he remains in each position for about an hour at a time. This alteration of posture assists in the ventilation of the lungs and helps to 'break' any flatulence which may be present.
. 189) \0 or when exploration of is desired. See p. 188 for
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
1. To prevent postoperative respiratory complications.* 2. To prevent postoperative circulatory complications. 3. To maintain the abdominal muscles, particularly the oblique and transverse groups. Dftbeir fibres abdominal de edges. Nevertheless, Ii performance of trunk
SECONDARY
To maintain the other trunk muscles.
IbD.eDt.
• Incision
md posterior sheaths of roses of the oblique and I movements will there Lany other form of trunk choice and performance my should be followed.
Ided to be a guide to the ad (2) Appendicectomy DI1 has occurred. It is
Exercise Period 20 minutes. In addition to this treatment session the patient will practise some of the exercises on 'little and often' lines during the day.
Primary Exercises Breathing, AnklejFoot and Leg Exercises (See previous section, pp. 186-188.) Trunk Exercises 1. Stride lying; Trunk turning with single Arm carrying across the chest (See Fig. 129, p. 101.) 2. Heave grasp lying (head posts of bed); Hip updrawing. (See Fig. 121, p. 96, which shows a different starting position.)
*This aim is not so important as in the treatment of conditions where the incision involves the upper abdomen (e.g. gastrectomy), because the respiratory excursion of the diaphragm is far less limited.
200
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
EXERCISI
Secondary Exercises Trunk Exercises 1. Lying: slight Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79, which shows full-range Chest raising.) 2. Crook lying; Pelvis raising. (See Fig. 150, p. 116.)
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
!
•
To redevelop the abdoll groups. SECONDARY
1. To redevelop the I 2. To re-educate nell
2nd-5th POSTOPERATIVE DAY
...
The patient spends an increasing amount of time sitting out in a chair and in walking in the ward.
•
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
1. To prevent postoperative respiratory and circulatory complications.* 2. To maintain the abdominal muscles, particularly the oblique and
transverse groups.
3. To maintain normal posture and reinstitute walking. SECONDARY
Exercise Period 30 minutes daily.
• t
•
Exercises
As after operations fOl'
FROM 7th POSTOP I
..
To maintain the other trunk muscles.
Exercise Period 20-30 minutes daily.
The exercises suggestcc: be used for 1-2 weeks it has been discharged m
Remedial Aims As previous section.• activity.
Exercises
As after operations for inguinal hernia. (See pp. 205-206.)
Exercise Period 30 minutes daily.
Exercises
As after operations fOl'
6th-7th POSTOPERATIVE DAY The stitches are removed on the 7th day. Provided that the patient's condition is satisfactory he is discharged home on the same day.
4. OPEl!
* These aims are achieved by the patient sitting out of bed and walking about in the ward. Breathing exercises and movements to accelerate the venous circulation through the lower limbs are therefore not necessary in the average case after the first postoperative day. In this connection it must be borne in mil.::l that the bulk of the appendicectomy cases fall into the younger age group, in which postoperative pulmonary and circulatory complications are less to be feared.
DEFENCE MECHA The inguinal canal COl temporary increase in i in coughing and defaet:
l
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
201
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
lich shows full-range
•
To redevelop the abdominal muscles, particularly the oblique and transverse groups. SECONDARY
1. To redevelop the other trunk muscles. 2. To re-educate neuromuscular coordination.
:out in a chair and in
KY complications. *
ty the oblique and lC·
)6.)
I that the patient's arne day.
Id walking about in the IJUS circulation through ~ case after the first .::1 that the bulk of the I which postoperative
Exercise Period 30 minutes daily.
•
Exercises
As after operations for inguinal hernia. (See pp. 206-207.)
FROM 7th POSTOPERATIVE DAY The exercises suggested here are of a moderately strenuous nature. They may be used for 1-2 weeks if exercise therapy is prescribed for the patient after he has been discharged from the ward.
Remedial Aims As previous section. In addition (Secondary): To promote generalized activity.
Exercise Period 30 minutes daily.
Exercises
As after operations for inguinal hernia. (See pp. 208-209.)
-
..- - --;:--=-=-==-~:-=-::-:-::--=:-:-::-::c:-::.--:~-:-::-:-:-:-==-:;::-::------
4. OPERATIONS FOR INGUINAL HE.:..:R.:..:N..:::.IA-=--_..._ _
DEFENCE MECHANISM OF INGUINAL CANAL The inguinal canal constitutes a weak area in the abdominal wall. During a temporary increase in intra-abdominal pressure, such as occurs, for example, in coughing and defaecation, there is a tendency for the abdominal viscera to
202
ED!
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
be forced into the canal. The canal possesses an efficient defence mechanism against this occurrence:
i
Shutter Action The muscles of the inguinal region 'react to strain in the following manner: (1) Contraction of the external oblique narrows the gap in the external ring. (2) Associated tightening of the rectus sheath and the underlying muscle forms a firm foundation for the remaining actions. (3) Straightening of the arched conjoint tendon diminishes the interval between it and the inguinal ligament, but a weakened triangular area persists with its base in the region of the emerging cord at the external ring, due to the tendinous segment of conjoint tendon. Recurrent herniae are common at this site and care should be taken at operation to repair this portion adequately. (4) Lateral and upward movement of the U-shaped internal ring tightens the fascia trans versalis. (5) Finally, there is blockage of the inguinal canal by the bulk of the cremaster muscle which is pulled upwards on contraction' (Macfarlane and Thomas, 1977).
contents to be ext opposite the subCll does not traverse til hernia" , (Beesly aJ Oblique inguinal appears first in infaJ in females' (Aird, I
OBLIQUE INGU
In general, two mai may be recognized This is the method the hernia is genen canal still revisable inguinal canal. Thi abdominal muscuJ: hernias.
Valvular Mechanism The obliquity of the canal (which to some extent constitutes a valvular mechanism) is an additional safeguard. Increased intra-abdominal pressure apposes firmly the posterior and anterior walls of the canal. Opposite the area of greatest weakness in the posterior wall (the deep inguinal ring) is placed the strongest part of the abdominal wall: the internal oblique fibres and the aponeurosis of the external oblique.
Simple Hernioto An incision is madt two-thirds of the i external oblique ml inguinal ring is de external oblique is' inguinal canal. n identified. The sac is closed in three 5
INGUINAL HERNIA An inguinal hernia results when the mechanism of the inguinal canal fails and the abdominal viscera escape through the deep inguinal ring, the inguinal canal, and the superficial inguinal ring, to reach sometimes the scrotum or labium majus. The escaped viscera are contained in a sac which is composed of peritoneum and extraperitoneal tissue. The hernial sac descends within the coverings of the spermatic cord in the male; its contents may include omentum, bowel, fluid, or loose bodies (from omentum). The most common contents are omentum and small intestine. Failure of the inguinal mechanism may be the result of irregularities in the development of the contents of the canal (congenital hernia). It may also be due to loss of the shutter action from the hypotonus of age or debility (acquired hernia). 'In the most frequent type, the hernia passes down the inguinal canal. For this reason it is referred to as "oblique inguinal hernia". Weakness of the abdominal musculature may, however, allow the abdominal
Excision of Sac , After excision of d the inguinal canal.
Bassini Procedure The operation ail: posterior wall of d and the conjoint te This method has b be used 'only if th and parallel, so tI brought together u
1
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
It defence
mechanism
be following manner: , in the external ring. Ie underlying muscle Straightening of the :0 it and the inguinal s base in the region of endinous segment of l site and care should rely. (4) Lateral and lenS the fascia trans nal by the bulk of the ion' (Macfarlane and
mstitutes a valvular Hlbdominal pressure 1I8l. Opposite the area ioal ring) is placed the mque fibres and the
203
contents to be extruded at the other weak area of the inguinal region opposite the subcutaneous (superficial) inguinal ring. This variety, which does not traverse the full length of the canal, is referred to as "direct inguinal hernia'" (Beesly and Johnson, 1939). Oblique inguinal hernia may develop at any age, but 'it most commonly appears first in infancy, youth or early adult life. It is commoner in males than in females' (Aird, 1957a).
OBLIQUE INGUINAL HERNIA: OPERATIVE PROCEDURES In general, two main types of operative treatment for oblique inguinal hernia may be recognized. (1) Simple herniotomy, or complete removal of the sac. This is the method of choice in infants, children and young fit adults, where the hernia is generally congenital and the secondary changes in the inguinal canal still revisable. (2) Excision of the hernial sac, followed by repair of the inguinal canal. This is usually indicated in the older age group (where the abdominal musculature is of poor quality) and in the case of recurrent hernias.
Simple Herniotomy An incision is made about a finger's breadth above and parallel to the medial two-thirds of the inguinal ligament, so as to expose the aponeurosis of the external oblique muscle. (See Fig. 215, p. 189.) The margin of the superficial inguinal ring is defined and the cord is isolated. The aponeurosis of the external oblique is divided from the subcutaneous ring along the line of the inguinal canal. The coverings of the cord are then divided and the sac identified. The sac is transfixed at its neck, ligated and removed. The wound is closed in three stages.
IgUinal canal fails and Ial ring, the inguinal times the scrotum or Ie which is composed
Excision of Sac with Repair of Canal After excision of the hernial sac a variety of methods may be used to repair the inguinal canal. The Bassini operation is summarized here.
spermatic cord in the tJI" loose bodies (from md small intestine. If irregularities in the :mia). It may also be IS of age or debility Dia passes down the rue inguinal hernia". ,allow the abdominal
Bassini Procedure The operation aims at strengthening the whole of the potentially weak posterior wall of the inguinal canal by suturing the internal oblique muscle and the conjoint tendon to the inguinal ligament, behind the spermatic cord. This method has been much criticized, and Aird (1957b) states that it should be used 'only if the conjoint tendon and inguinal ligament lie close together and parallel, so that they may be apposed without tension'. If they are brought together under tehsion, the conjoint tendon may tear, thus losing the
204
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
desired effect. A further criticism levelled at the Bassmi operation is that it is
said to interfere with the shutter mechanism of the canal.
EXERCI
•
FIRST 3 POSTOPI
It
•
ABDOMINAL EXERCISES FOLLOWING OPERATIONS FOR
INGUINAL HERNIA
The scope of abdominal exercises depends on the type of operative procedure
which has been performed.
,• \#I
l
On the 1st postoperat for about 30---45 mim sitting and walking is When resting in bet his back and on the let each position for aboll the ventilation of the : present.
1
, ~
After Silnple HerniotolnY
Abdominal exercises assist in the functional recovery of the inguinal mechan
ism (p. 202), and so help to prevent a recurrence of the hernia.
Exercise and the SUlure Line Because the aponeurosis of the external oblique muscle is divided in the line of its fibres, abdominal exercises will not tend to separate the sutured edges. Reasonable care should be taken, however, in the choice and per formance of trunk exercises throughout the postoperative phase of treatment.
After Excision of Hernial Sac, with Repair by Bassini Operation Abdominal exercises help to restore the strength of the abdominal muscles, and so assist in the recovery of the valvular aspect of the inguinal mechanism (p. 202). It is debatable if the exercises can assist in the functional recovery of the shutter mechanism of the canal; theoretically, this has been obliterated by the repair process. In practice, however, it may be doubted if such function has been completely replaced.
~
Remedial Aims
I
PRIMARY
l
1. To prevent post 2. To maintain til transverse groUJ; 3. To maintain the
,
•;•
I
II
SECONDARY
To maintain the othc:
Exercise Period 20-30 minutes daily. practise some of the'
Prilnary Exercise!
Breaching, Ankie/FOI Exercise and the Suture Line Much the same attitude towards trunk exercises may be taken as previously suggested. From experience it would appear that the repair procedures do not necessitate a more conservative approach to exercise therapy.
TRUNK EXERCISES
tI
1
EXERCISE THERAPY
I!
The lists of progressive exercises given here are intended to be a guide to the after treatment of (a) Simple herniotomy, and (b) Excision of hernial sac, with repair of inguinal canal by Bassini operation.
I
.l
1. Stride lying; Tl (See Fig. l29, I 2. Crook lying (hi 3. Lying; Head b 4. Lying (hands g p. 96, which sl: HIP EXERCISES
5. Lying; single ~ of movement. 6. Lying; single I
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
oi operation is that it is mal.
!RATIONS FOR of operative procedure
205
FIRST 3 POSTOPERATIVE DAYS On the 1st postoperative day the patient is generally allowed to sit in a chair for about 30-45 minutes and to walk a little in the ward. The amount of sitting and walking is gradually increased over the 3 days. When resting in bed the patient should spend some of his time lying flat on his back and on the left and right sides (Fig. 214, p. 186); he should remain in each position for about an hour at a time. This alteration of posture assists in the ventilation of the lungs and helps to 'break' any flatulence which may be present.
Remedial Aims If the inguinal mechan !be hernia.
PRIMARY
~e is divided in the o separate the sutured D the choice and per m phase of treatment.
SECONDARY
IIassini Operation be abdominal muscles, be inguinal mechanism ~ functional recovery of bas been obliterated by ubted if such function
be taken as previously pair procedures do not lherapy.
led to be a guide to the scision of hernial sac,
1. To prevent postoperative respiratory and circulatory complications. 2. To maintain the abdominal muscles, particularly the oblique and transverse groups. 3. To maintain the mobility of the hip joint of the affected side.
To maintain the other trunk muscles.
Exercise Period 20-30 minutes daily. In addition to this treatment session the patient will practise some of the exercises on 'little and often' lines throughout the day.
Primary Exercises
Breathing, Ankle/Foot and Leg Exercises (see previous section, pp. 186-188)
TRUNK EXERCISES
1. Stride lying; Trunk turning with single Arm carrying across the chest. (See Fig. 129, p. 101.) 2. Crook lying (hand on abdomen); Abdominal contractions. 3. Lying; Head bending forwards with single slight Knee raising. 4. Lying (hands grasping sides of mattress); Hip updrawing. (See Fig. 121, p. 96, which shows a different starting position.) HIP EXERCISES
5. Lying; single Knee raising (of affected side), gradually increasing range of movement. 6. Lying; single Leg carrying sideways.
206
E
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Secondary Exercises TRUNK EXERCISES
7. Lying; slight Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79, which shows full-range Chest raising.) 8. Crook lying; Pelvis raising. (See Fig. 150, p. 116.)
4th-7th POSTOPERATIVE DAY The patient spends an increasing amount of time sitting in a chair and walking about in the ward. The stitches are removed on the 7th postoperative day. (Absorbable cutaneous sutures are sometimes used.) The patient is warned not to attempt to lift any heavy object. Before being discharged home he should be given some elementary instruction in the correct techniques of lifting and carrying.
4. Lying; Heal 5. Lying (hant wards with. 6. Crook lying being restn
Secondary Exe Trunk Exercises 1. Crook lying range Chest
2. PATIENT S
Remedial Aims
Primary Exerc
PRIMARY
Trunk Exercises
1. To prevent postoperative respiratory and circulatory complications. '" 2. To maintain the abdominal muscles, particularly the oblique and transverse groups. 3. To maintain normal posture and reinstate good walking habits. SECONDARY
To maintain the other trunk muscles.
Exercise Period
30 minutes daily.
1. Stride sittiD direction of 2. Stride sittin
Secondary Exe 1. Stride sittin assume am without pri stretching •
1. PATIENT LYING ON BED
3. PATIENT
Primary Exercises
Primary Exel'l
Trunk Exercises 1. Stride lying; Trunk turning with Head bending forwards and single Arm carrying across the chest. (See Fig. 129, p. 101.) 1. Crook lying (hands grasping sides of mattress); slow Knee swinging from side to side. (See Fig. 128, p. 100.) 3. Lying (hands grasping sides of mattress); Hip updrawing. (See Fig. 121, p. 96, which shows the exercise in standing.)
Check on PostUT~ 1. General COl 2. Walkiitg pI
* These aims are achieved by the patient sitting out of bed and walking about in the ward. Breathing exercises and movements to accelerate the venous circulation through the lower limbs are therefore not necessary in the average case after the 3rd postoperative day.
The exercises Sl be used for 1-2 . has been discha
~
FROM 7th P(J
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
which shows full-range .16.)
207
4. Lying; Head bending forwards with single Knee raising. 5. Lying (hands grasping sides of mattress); upper Trunk bending for wards with assistance from arms. 6. Crook lying; Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards (range of forward tilt being restricted). (See Figs. 68 and 79, pp. 73 and 79.)
Secondary Exercises , Slthng in a chair and OIl tht 7th postoperative , used.) The patient is : being discharged home lie correct techniques of
Trunk Exercises 1. Crook lying; slight Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79, which shows full range Chest raising.)
2. PATIENT SITTING IN CHAIR
Primary Exercises atory complications. * IiJarly the oblique and
Trunk Exercises 1. Stride sitting; Trunk turning with Arm moving loosely sideways in the direction of the turning to grasp the chair back. (See Fig. 216, p. 193.) 2. Stride sitting; Trunk bending sideways.
I wallting habits.
Secondary Exercises 1. Stride sitting (hands on thighs); Trunk bending forwards-downwards to assume a modified lax stoop position (movement taken as far as possible without producing discomfort in wound area), followed by Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra'. (See Fig. 217, p. 193.)
3. PATIENT STANDING
Primary Exercises og forwards and single t. 101.)
:); slow Knee swinging
Check on Posture and Walking l. General correction of posture in standing and walking. 2. Walking practice.
Idrawing. (See Fig. 121,
FROM 7th POSTOPERATIVE DAY d and walking about in the ftDOUS circulation through aage case after the 3rd
The exercises suggested here are of a moderately strenuous type. They may be used for 1-2 weeks if exercise therapy is prescribed for the patient after he has been discharged from the ward.
208
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
1. To redevelop the abdominal muscles, particularly the oblique and transverse groups. 2. To educate the patient in the correct technique of lifting and carrying heavy objects.
,,
•
ED
SECONDARY
1. To redevelop the other trunk muscles. 2. To re-educate neuromuscular coordination.
Exercise Period 30 minutes daily.
Primary Exercises Trunk Exercises 1. Fixed stride lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with turning and single Arm carrying across the chest. (See Fig. 218, p. 195.) 2. Prone kneeling; slow Trunk turning with single Arm raising sideways. 3. Half lumbar rest stride standing; single Arm swinging forwards, and sideways with Trunk turning. 4. Low reach grasp standing (chair back); Hip updrawing. (See Fig. 121, p.96.) 5. Lying; Trunk bending sideways with single Leg carrying sideways to the same side. 6. Stride standing; Trunk bending sideways. 7. Lying; high Knee raising, followed by over-pressure with the hands, and upper Trunk bending forwards. (See Fig. 73, p. 74.) 8. Lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with single high Knee raising. (See Figs. 59 and 67, pp. 70 and 73.) Education in Lifting 9. Practice in correct technique of lifting and carrying heavy objects. (Fig. 220).
Secondary Exercises Trunk Exercises 1. Lax stoop back lean stride standing (heels about a foot-length in front of wall bar upright); Trunk stretching 'vertebra by vertebra' in different planes. (See Fig. 139, p. 105.) 2. Crook lying; Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79.)
Fig. 220. a, Inca straight back, posi object lifted. c, Co vision unobst:ruCU
Balance Exercises 3. Balance walkil 4. Balance walkil
FEMORAL HER A femoral hernia c the femoral canal" contains omentum. Femoral hernia i because the ingum female, and pregna Men who suffer j bakers, stokers and
Surgical Treatm An operation' is pc The sac is ligated a are employed, the
High Operation An incision is maw (p. 203), above and The external oblic
DAPY
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
209
x
lIIIrticu1arly the oblique and
IOique of lifting and carrying t
D.
c a b Fig. 220. a, Incorrect lifting technique. b, Correct lifting technique. Note straight back, position of legs and feet (giving stable base), and finn hold on object lifted. c, Correct carrying posture: object held securely and close to body, vision unobstructed.
~
forwards with turning and p.195.) single Ann raising sideways. !bID swinging forwards, and
Balance Exercises 3. Balance walking forwards and backwards with Knee raising. 4. Balance walking fowards with opposite Knee and Arm raising.
~Fig.218,
iip updrawing. (See Fig. 121, ~
Leg carrying sideways to
rer-pressure with the hands,
Fig. 73, p. 74.)
iIh single high Knee raising.
md carrying heavy objects.
Ibout a foot-length in front of :bra by vertebra' in different
!t. 79.)
5. FEMORAL AND UMBILICAL HERNIAE
FEMORAL HERNIA A femoral hernia consists of a downward extension of peritoneum through the femoral canal. Usually the hernia is not very large; as a rule the sac contains omentum. Femoral hernia is commoner in women than in men. This is said to be because the inguinal ligament makes a wider angle with the pubis in the female, and pregnancies increase intra-abdominal pressure. Men who suffer from this condition usually follow 'stooping' occupations: bakers, stokers and gardeners.
Surgical Treatment
An operation is performed unless there is some definite contra-indication.
The sac is ligated and the femoral canal closed. Two main types of procedure
are employed, the high operation and the low operation.
High Operation An incision is made, similar to that described for simple inguinal herniotomy (p. 203), above and parallel to the medial two-thirds of the inguinal ligament. The external oblique aponeurosis is divided and the posterior wall of the
210
EXERCISI
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
After Repair of a Large
inguinal canal exposed; the protuberance of peritoneum which forms the hernia can then be drawn out of the femoral canal from above.
Low Operation A vertical incision, 5-7·5 cm in length, is made over the hernial protuberance. The sac is exposed and dealt with from below. In both operations the hernial sac is cleared of its coverings, opened, explored, and the contents (if any) returned to the general peritoneal cavity. The pectineal fascia is sutured to the under-surface of the inguinal ligament. This closes the femoral canal.
• Postoperative Exercise Therapy As for operations for inguinal hernia (pp. 205-209). Exercises for the hip of the affected side are important during the first few postoperative days.
•
The patient remains in 1 sit in a chair on the lSi time of sitting out an( generally removed on d Great care must be tlII tissues are of poor qualit and cause reherniation. described for simple il suggested for starting tb addition, some of the 51 early stages of treatmeol An abdominal belt or 4 She must wear it when sI
•
, t
•
UMBILICAL HERNIA An umbilical hernia consists of a protrusion of the abdominal contents through the umbilicus. If the protrusion occurs close to the umbilicus the condition is known as a 'para-umbilical hernia'. Adult umbilical hernia occurs almost exclusively in obese women at the end of the child-bearing period. The hernia is probably the effect of increased intra-abdominal pressure (pregnancies, omental adiposity, bronchitis) on the umbilical cicatrix or the linea alba. The hernia sometimes reaches a huge size. It contains usually omentum and sometimes transverse colon and small intestine as well.
Surgical Treatment The hernia is treated by operation. Before operation an attempt is often made to reduce the patient's weight by dietetic means. A transverse elliptical incision is made which outlines the hernial protru sion; it is deepened through the fat until the stretched linea alba is exposed. The sac is defined and opened. Protruding bowel is returned to the general peritoneal cavity; omentum may be widely excised to reduce the volume of the abdominal contents; the sac is then ligated at the neck and excised. The stretched linea alba is sutured transversely with two rows of stitches, so that the flaps overlap; the subcutaneous tissues and the skin are then sutured.
i
t r
Exercise Therapy
After Repair of a Small Umbilical Hernia As after operations for inguinal hernia (pp. 205-209.)
1
REFERENCES
Aird 1. (1957a) A ComJHl1l p.527. Aird 1. (1957b) Ibid. p. 64! Ballinger W. F. and DrlI) pp.166-7. Beesly L. and Johnson T_ Oxford University Press Bendixen H. H. (1965) RIll Macfarlane D. A. and Tho Churchill Livingstone, I
EXERCISE THERAPY AFTER ABDOMINAL SURGERY
om which forms the above.
III
~alprotuberance.
coverings, opened, cral peritoneal cavity. the in.guinalligament.
IS
a:rcises for the hip of stoperative days.
211
After Repair of a Large Umbilical Hernia The patient remains in the ward for about 10 days. Usually she is allowed to sit in a chair on the 1st or 2nd postoperative day for 15-20 minutes. The time of sitting out and walking is gradually increased. The stitches are generally removed on the 10th day. Great care must be taken in exercising the abdominal muscles, because the tissues are of poor quality and any excessive strain may break down the repair and cause reherniation. The same types of abdominal exercises are used as described for simple inguinal herniotomy (pp. 205-209), but the time suggested for starting the exercises in sitting and standing must be delayed. In addition, some of the stronger abdominal exercises must be omitted in the early stages of treatment. An abdominal belt or corset is worn when the patient is allowed out of bed. She must wear it when she first sits out, as well as when standing and walking.
REFERENCES
: abdominal contents , to the umbilicus the
obese women at the the effect of increased ity) bronchitis) on the ICS reaches a huge size. erse colon and small
I
attempt is often made
the hernial protru linea alba is exposed. :wrned to the general :n:duce the volume of meek and excised. wo rows of stitches, so skin are then sutured.
ICS
Aird 1. (1957a) A Companion in Surgical Studies, 2nd ed. Edinburgh, Livingstone, p.527. Aird 1. (l957b) Ibid. p. 646. Ballinger W. F. and Drapanas T. (1972) Practice of Surgery. St Louis, Mosby, pp. 166-7. Beesly L. and Johnson T. B. (1939) Manual of Surgical Anatomy, 5th ed. London, Oxford University Press, p. 340. Bendixen H. H. (1965) Respiratory Care. St Louis, Mosby. Macfarlane D. A. and Thomas L. P. (1977) Textbook of Surgery> 4th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone, pp. 240-1.
Jl
20. Intervertebral disc lesions of the lumbar spine
When the annulus fibrosus of the intervertebral disc remains intact, but bulges posteriorly, the patient may complain of low back pain. When, however, the annulus ruptures and a prolapse of the nucleus pulposus occurs, the prolapse may impinge on a lumbar nerve root and cause sciatica. Conservative treatment will be sufficient for most disc lesions. Surgical treatment will be required for a small percentage of patients in whom the prolapse cannot be warded off the nerve root.
CONSERVATIVE TREATMENT Conservative treatment consists of: 1. Bed rest in the supine position on a rigid mattress for one to three weeks. Traction may be applied to the lower limbs (skin extension) or to the pelvis by means of a well-padded pelvic band. If traction is used the foot end of the bed is elevated. 2. Intermittent spinal traction. This is generally carried out in the physio therapy department. The method of application will depend on the patient's condition and the clinical judgement of the therapist. 3. Manipulation. On some occasions this will be carried out by the orthopaedic surgeon, with or without a general anaesthetic. On other occasions manipulation will be performed by a physiotherapist skilled in passive mobilization techniques. 4. Spinal support: plaster-of-Paris jacket, surgical brace or belt. All these supports are individually made and fitted. Exercise therapy is often used in association with these conservative measures. It should be noted that some surgeons do not allow trunk exercises when bed rest is prescribed (see Programme 1, p. 213).
SURGICAL TREATMENT Surgical treatment consists of the removal of the prolapsed portion of the intervertebral disc. Exercise therapy is used in the postoperative phase of recovery, as described on pp. 215-220. 212
EXERCISE THEF IS USED The exercise program when bed rest, with modified for use wheo support by plaster-o treatment is then on s extensors.
PROGRAMME 1: 1
TRACTION, IS US Remedial Aims PRIMARY
1. To maintain the the lower limbs 1 the method of D 2. To maintain til shoulder joints I 3. To prevent pos the period of inJ
Exercise Period Initially, 10-15 ~ placed as soon as poll
Examples of Pt'iJn
Leg Exercises 1. Lying; single; 2. Lying; single; 3. Lying; single; 4. Lying; (a) sin double Foot n 5. Lying; single] 6. Lying; single supporting su 'comfortable' I
Shoulder and Should; 7. Heave lying; iI
DISC LESIONS OF THE LUMBAR SPINE
:lise lesions of
213
EXERCISE THERAPY WHEN CONSERVATIVE TREATMENT IS USED
The exercise programmes outlined in this section have been arranged for use when bed rest, with or without traction, is used, Programme 2 may be modified for use when other conservative measures are employed, e.g. spinal support by plaster-of-Paris jacket or surgical brace. The emphasis of treatment is then on strengthening the muscles of the spine, particularly the extensors .
...;u disc remains
intact, but in of low back pain. When, lthe nucleus pulposus occurs, root and cause sciatica. .. most disc lesions. Surgical age of patients in whom the
.nress for one to three weeks. kin extension) or to the pelvis lion is used the foot end of the
Illy carried out in the physio
n will depend on the patient's aapist. will be carried out by the :neral anaesthetic. On other r a physiotherapist skilled in
1I'gica1 brace or belt. All these
Iioo with these conservative 15 do not allow trunk exercises ~ p. 213).
'the prolapsed portion of the in the postoperative phase of
PROGRAMME 1: WHEN BED REST, WITH OR WITHOUT TRACTION, IS USED Remedial Aims PRIMARY
1. To maintain the strength ofthe muscles and the mobility of the joints of the lower limbs within the limits imposed by the patient's condition and the method of immobilization used. 2. To maintain the strength of the muscles and the mobility of the shoulder joints and joints of the shoulder girdle. 3. To prevent possible respiratory and circulatory complications during the period of immobilization .
Exercise Period Initially, 10-15 minutes, twice daily. Supervised exercise periods are re placed as soon as possible by self-care practice on 'little and often' lines. Examples of Primary Exercises
Leg Exercises 1. Lying; single and double Quadriceps contractions. 2. Lying; single and double Gluteal contractions. 3. Lying; single and double Ankle bending. 4. Lying; (a) single and double Foot turning inwards, (b) single and double Foot turning outwards. 5. Lying; single Foot circling. 6. Lying; single small range Knee ralsmg with heel in contact with supporting surface (Le. flexion of each hip and knee through a 'comfortable' range, not exceeding 15° of hip flexion).
Shoulder and Shoulder girdle Exercises 7. Heave lying; inward and outward rotation of shoulder joints.
214
Dl
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
8. Lying; Shoulder rounding and bracing. 9. Lying; Shoulder shrugging.
Breathing Exercises 10. Lying (hands on sides of lower chest); lower lateral Costal breathing. 11. Lying (hand on upper abdomen); Diaphragmatic breathing.
I I ~
PROGRAMME 2: WHEN SYMPTOMS HAVE SUBSIDED AND TRACTION, IF USED, IS DISCONTINUED The patient rests in bed for a day or so and then progresses to short periods of sitting, standing and walking; it is important that a chair of suitable height and design is used. The emphasis of exercise treatment is on (a) strengthen ing the main trunk muscles, particularly the extensors; and (b) promoting the mobility of the thoracolumbar spine and knee joints. If spinal flexion is allowed by the surgeon it is best carried out in side-lying. Examples of Primary Exercises Back Exercises 1. Lying; Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79.) 2. Prone lying; Shoulder bracing. 3. Forearm support prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with assistance from arms. (See Fig. 37a, p. 51.) 4. Prone lying (arms behind back, fingers clasped); Trunk bending backwards with Arm raising backwards. 5. Lying; opposite Arm and Leg downpressing. Abdominal Exercise 6. Lying; Head bending forwards. Rotation Exercises 7. Stride lying; small range Trunk turning (i.e. raising one shoulder well off the bed). 8. Lying (hands grasping sides of bed); Pelvis turning from side to side. Lateral Flexion Exercise 9. Stride lying; Trunk bending sideways. Knee Exercise 10. Prone lying; alternate Knee bending.
Postural Training The patient must be D posture, especially wbc value in this respect. "I (and in some instanc emphasized.
Technique of Uftina I t is essential to give il with particular referelJj
EXERCISE THE IS USED
The patient is retume. Side-lying is maintain from right to left, and , positioned between the A well-padded adlH venous therapy is sou: Redivac wound drain i About the 2nd posIl back-lying position, pI1 From then on the pall side-lying. During this initial P' freely in bed and to ' respiratory and circula
Sitting out of Bed The patient is allowed periods between the ,2 chair of correct height
Spinal Flexion Opinion varies amoll, movements ofthe thor in side-lying about the sutures have been rem specific flexion moven
r
DISC LESIONS OF THE LUMBAR SPINE
IERAPY
I
l'Wer lateral Costal breathing. u:agmatic breathing.
f.t\VE SUBSIDED AND
ED
progresses to short periods of bat a chair of suitable height 'C3tIDent is on (a) strengthen ensors; and (b) promoting the :e joints. If spinal flexion is I side-lying.
k. bending backwards with
51.)
[5
clasped); Trunk bending
sing.
:i.e. raising one shoulder well
Iris turning from side to side.
215
Postural Training The patient must be made aware of the importance of maintaining a sound
posture, especially when standing and sitting. A full-length mirror is of great
value in this respect. The need to guard against flexion stresses of the spine
(and in some instances to prevent flexion taking place) must also be
emphasized.
Technique of Lifting and Back Care
It is essential to give instruction in correct lifting and carrying techniques,
with particular reference to the patient's occupation. (See Fig. 220, p. 209.)
EXERCISE THERAPY WHEN SURGICAL TREATMENT IS USED
The patient is returned from the operating theatre in a side-lying position. Side-lying is maintained for at least 24 hours, the position being changed from right to left, and vice versa, at regular 2-hour intervals. A firm pillow is positioned between the knees. A well-padded adhesive dressing is used over the incision area. Intra venous therapy is sometimes used for a day or so. In certain instances a Redivac wound drain is employed for up to 48 hours. About the 2nd postoperative day the patient is encouraged to take up a back-lying position, provided that it does not give rise to pain and discomfort. From then on the patient's resting posture varies between back-lying and side-lying. During this initial postoperative period the patient is encouraged to move freely in bed and to carry out simple exercises to prevent postoperative respiratory and circulatory complications.
Sitting out of Bed The patient is allowed to sit out in a suitable chair (at the bedside) for short periods between the 2nd and 5th postoperative day. It is important that a chair of correct height and design is used.
Spinal Flexion Opinion varies among orthopaedic surgeons as to when simple flexion movements of the thoracolumbar spine should be started. Some allow flexion in side-lying about the 6th postoperative day, while others delay this until the sutures have been removed (10th or 12th postoperative day). Others prohibit specific flexion movements.
216
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
After Sutures have been Removed The patient is discharged home when the sutures have been removed; he attends the hospital for exercise therapy for 4-6 weeks, depending on his occupation.
PROGRAMME 1: FIRST 2 POSTOPERATIVE DAYS Remedial Aims
4. Forearm sUJII with assistan 5. Prone lying; 6. Prone lying backwards w
Abdominal (Static) 7. Lying; Head
PRIMARY
1. To prevent postoperative respiratory complications. (See pp. 184-185.) 2. To accelerate the circulation through the veins of the lower limbs and pelvis. (See p. 187.)
Exercise Period 10 minutes, two or three times daily.
Primary Exercises Breathing exercises, particularly unilateral Apical and lower lateral Costal breathing; foot and ankle exercises, with emphasis on dorsiflexion move ments; and small range flexion and extension of hip and knee (in side-lying this is confined to the uppermost limb).
PROGRAMME 2: 3rd TO 10th OR 12th POSTOPERATIVE DAY WHEN SUTURES ARE REMOVED Remedial Aims
Breathing and Lee J 8. Breathing, fCl 9. Lying; single 10. Lying; single 11. Prone lying; N.B. (1) From encouraged to C3I'Il For example: (a) b stride standing, (b) position. In additio the quadriceps an extension movemea: (2) In the early 51 patient's height) c confidence.
PRIMARY
As in previous section. In addition: To strengthen the muscles of the thoracolumbar spine, particularly the extensors.
PROGRAMME] FORA PERIOD Remedial Aims
Exercise Period 15-20 minutes, twice daily.
PRIMARY
Primary Exercises
1. To strengthen extensors. 2. To increase d 3. To teach soUl
Back Exercises 1. Lying; slight Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79, which shows a full range movement.) 2. Lying; opposite Arm and Leg downpressing. 3. Prone lying; Shoulder bracing with Arm raising backwards.
Exercise Period 30 minutes, once used.
l
DISC LESIONS OF THE LUMBAR SPINE
:APY
es have been removed; he i weeks, depending on his
rIVE DAYS
ications. (See pp. 184-185.) :ins of the lower limbs and
II and lower lateral Costal ISis on dorsiflexion move llip and knee (in side-lying
II()STOPERATIVE
gthen the muscles of the
217
4. Forearm support prone lying; small range Trunk bending backwards with assistance from arms. (See Fig. 37a, p. 51.) 5. Prone lying; small range single Leg raising backwards. 6. Prone lying (arms behind back, fingers clasped); Trunk bending backwards with Arm raising backwards.
Abdominal (Static) Exercise 7. Lying; Head bending forwards.
Breathing and Leg Exercises 8. Breathing, foot, ankle, and static Quadriceps exercises. 9. Lying; single Hip and Knee flexion. 10. Lying; single and double Gluteal contractions. II. Prone lying; alternate Knee bending. N.B. (1) From about the 5th postoperative day the patient wi11 be encouraged to carry out some simple trunk movements in the erect position. For example: (a) lateral flexion movements of the thoracolumbar spine in stride standing, (b) gentle small range trunk rotation in the same starting position. In addition, in standing, the patient will be encouraged to exercise the quadriceps and gluteal muscle groups by small range flexion and extension movements of hips and knees. (2) In the early stages of standing and walking a Rollator (adjusted to the patient's height) can be used effectively to provide both stability and confidence.
PROGRAMME 3: FROM 10th OR 12th POSTOPERATIVE DAY FOR A PERIOD OF 2 WEEKS Remedial Aims PRIMARY
1. To strengthen the muscles of the thoracolumbar spine, particularly the extensors. 2. To increase the mobility of the joints of the thoracolumbar spine. 3. To teach sound postural habits and provide instruction in back care.
p. 79, which shows a full
11&. ming backwards.
Exercise Period 30 minutes, once daily_ Extra time should be allowed if pool therapy is used.
218
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Primary Exercises Back Exercises 1. Lying; Chest raising. (See Fig. 80, p. 79.) 2. Stride lying or lying; Pelvis raising (bridging). (See Fig. 31b, p. 47.) 3. Prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards. (See Fig. 85, p. 81.) 4. Prone lying; single Leg raising backwards. Abdominal Exercise *5. Lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with assistance from arms. Combined Flexion and Extension Exercises *6. Side lying; slow high Knee raising with or without Trunk bending forwards, followed by Trunk bending backwards with Leg stretching and carrying backwards. (See Fig. 99, p. 86.) *7. Prone kneeling; Pelvis tilting forwards and backwards with Head bending backwards and forwards. (See Fig. 106, p. 90.) Rotation Exercises 8. Stride lying; Trunk turning with single Arm carrying across the chest. (See Fig. 129, p. 101.) 9. Yard (palms on floor) crook lying; Knee lowering from side to side. (See Fig. 128, p. 100, which shows the movement performed as a swinging action.) Lateral Flexion Exercises 10. Stride lying; Trunk bending from side to side. 11. Lying (hands grasping sides of mat); Hip updrawing. (See Fig. 121, p. 96, which shows the exercise performed in standing.)
Postural Training The patient should be made aware of the importance of maintaining a sound posture at all times, particularly when at work. The need to guard against flexion stresses of the spine must be emphasized. Back Care It is important to give adequate instruction in correct lifting and carrying techniques, with particular reference to the patient'S occupation.
* Used
if spinal flexion is allowed.
I
PROGRAMME 4 RECOVERY Remedial Aims As in previous secti
Exercise Period 30 minutes, once d used. N.B. Progressive· suggested here. In a designed to simuJatl tional therapy, in tb used.
Primary Exercise
Back Exercises 1. High reach gJ floor); spanniJ 2. Prone lying; . and single Lc 3. Fist bend fixe 4. Fist bend fixe (See Fig. 138,
Abdominal Exercisel *5. Fixed crook ~ resting on mat. *6. Crook lying;
Combined Flexion al *7. Prone kneem followed by I backwards, 31
Rotation Exercises 8. Tum prone' single Arm 11 exercise peri
* Used if spinal fiell
'BERAPY
DISC LESIONS 0(1 THE LUMBAR SPINE
219
PROGRAMME 4: FROM 4th TO 6th WEEK OF RECOVERY
19.)
ridging). (See Fig. 31b, p. 47.)
is with Arm turning outwards.
•with assistance from arms.
ith or without Trunk bending tlackwards with L~g stretching p.86.) is and backwards with Head Fig. 106, p. 90.)
:Arm carrying across the chest.
r:e lowering from side to side. be movement performed as a
: to side.
flip updrawing. (See Fig. 121,
med in standing.)
onance of maintaining a sound
m.. The need to guard against
red.
in correct lifting and carrying
ment's occupation.
Remedial Aims As in previous section.
Exercise Period 30 minutes, once daily. Extra time should be allowed if pool therapy is used. N.B. Progressive circuit training forms a useful alternative to the exercises suggested here. In addition, in the later stages of recovery, a pre-work circuit designed to simulate normal working stresses (p. 251) can be used. Recrea tional therapy, in the form of modified volley ball and basket ball, can also be used.
Primary Exercises Back Exercises 1. High reach grasp lying (wall bars: hands grasping 5th or 6th bar from floor); spanning. (See Fig. 81, p. 80.) 2. Prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards and single Leg raising backwards. (See Fig. 5, p. 10.) 3. Fist bend fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards. 4. Fist bend fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with turning. (See Fig. 138, p. 105, which shows a stronger version of the exercise.)
Abdominal Exercises *5. Fixed crook lying; upper Trunk bending forwards with palms of hands resting on mat. *6. Crook lying; small range Knee raising.
Combined Flexion and Extension Exercise *7. Prone kneeling; single high Knee raising with Head bending forwards, followed by Leg stretching and raising backwards with Head bending backwards, and return to starting position. (See Fig. 98, p. 86.) Rotation Exercises 8. Turn prone kneeling (one arm bent across chest); Trunk turning with single Arm raising sideways. (See Fig. 132, p. 102, which shows the exercise performed as a mobility exercise.)
* Used if spinal flexion is allowed.
220
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
9. Yard (palms on floor) half crook half vertical leg lift lying; Leg lowering sideways. (See Fig. 130, p. 101.)
21. To
Lateral Flexion Exercise 10. Wing fixed side towards standing (wall bars); Trunk bending sideways towards the bars, and bending away from the bars. (See Fig. 125, p. 99, which shows an advanced mobilizing form of the exercise.)
REFERENCES Adams J. C. (1980) Standard Orthopaedic Operations, 2nd ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone, pp. 108-114. Edmonson A. S. and Crenshaw A. H. (ed.) (1980) Campbell's Operative Orthopaedics, Vol. 2, 6th ed. St Louis, Mosby, pp. 2107-2114.
Total hip replacemeDl conditions as osteo- 3J and discomfort but 11 function. The procedl associated with specif In recent years 80m successfully to restore in obliteration of the i acute suppurative art ment is often emploY' For example, after pi In general, total hi group. When used fOl to the hip or a cri! Longton (1982) state fails with stress and feasible, and hip PI'Ol! the elderly, frail, or c are used in young, hi
· vertical leg lift lying; Leg t.)
21. Total hip replacement
us); Trunk bending sideways rom the bars. (See Fig. 125, ring form of the exercise.)
IS,
2nd ed. Edinburgh, Churchill
..pbell's Operacive Orchopaedics,
Total hip replacement is widely used today in the surgical treatment of such conditions as osteo- and rheumatoid arthritis, associated not only with pain and discomfort but with severe restriction of joint movement and loss of function. The procedure is also used following severe trauma of the hip joint associated with specific damage to the acetabulum. In recent years some orthopaedic surgeons have used total hip replacement successfully to restore movement in old joint conditions which have resulted in obliteration of the joint surfaces, e.g. bony ankylosis of the joint following acute suppurative arthritis or tuberculosis in childhood. Total hip replace ment is often employed when previous hip surgery has proved unsuccessful. For example, after partial or hemi-arthroplasty. In general, total hip replacement is confined to patients in the older age group. When used for younger patients it is usually because of severe trauma to the hip or a crippling rheumatoid condition. Commenting on this, Longton (1982) states: 'The strength of a man-made prosthesis necessarily fails with stress and use. Prostheses of at least reasonable durability are feasible, and hip prostheses have given service for 20 years or so--usually in the elderly, frail, or crippled. The story may prove different if the appliances are used in young, heavy, active individuals.'
Fig. 221. Total replacement of the hip joint with a
low friction type of prosthesis: high density poly ethylene cup and stainless steel femoral component. Fixation is by methacrylate cement. (Illustration reproduced from Texcbook of Surgery, 4th ed., by kind permission of the editors, David A. Madarlane FRCS and Lewis P. Thomas FRCS, and the pub lishers, Churchill Livingstone.)
221
222
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
The low friction Charnley hip prosthesis (Fig. 221) is the most widely used of the many different types of prostheses designed for total hip replacement. It employs a femoral component of either stainless steel or cobalt-chrome alloy and a high-density polyethylene acetabulum. The femoral head is small, 22·25 mm in diameter. Both the femoral stem and acetabular component are cemented in position by a polymerizing plastic cement, such as methyl methacrylate. The artificial weight-bearing surfaces between metal and polyethylene provide low friction areas eapable of withstanding immense forces of many times the body-weight. A strain gauge inserted in a hip prosthesis has revealed that 'forces of at least four times the total body-weight may pass through such a joint in taking a single walking step' (Longton, 1973). For patients who are heavier than normal (over 80kg in weight) a heavy duty prosthesis, with a thicker stem, is employed.
PREOPERATIVE ASSESSMENT Normally the patient is admitted to hospital a few days before the operation is to be pe~formed. This ensures that there is adequate time for the various preoperative tests and procedures to be carried out, e.g. cross-matching of blood and X-ray examination. The period also gives the therapist an opportunity of making a careful assessment of the patient's function, establishing a good rapport, and gauging his future physical potential with regard to age and general condition. In this respect an understanding of the patient's past medical history is essential. In making an assessment the therapist will concentrate on: (a) range of movement of the joints ofthe lower limbs of both the affected and sound sides with particular reference to possible joint deformities and inequality between the lengths of the limbs; (b) effectiveness of the muscles controlling these joints; (c) range of movement of the lumbar spine; and (d) ability of the upper limbs to handle and control walking aids. The special problems of the elderly with regard to impairment of sight, hearing and general co-ordination must also be borne in mind.
PREOPERATIVE EXERCISE THERAPY Respiratory Function As most patients for hip arthroplasty are in the older age group, and the operation itself is a major and lengthy procedure, it is vital that every effort is made to improve respiratory function. Many patients are totally unaware of their poor respiratory levels, particularly those who have been habitual smokers. Correct breathing techniques are taught as soon as possible after the
patient is admitted to tl discharged home. Smol many patients resent th firmness by both nursil discouraged; often th.i3 expected; patients com function. • The breathing exercil with postoperative resJ] of hip mobility the baH Although the bilatera must also be taught uni important in the early patient's arms will be 1]
Rehearsing Positiqn of 1 It is necessary to expJ= which the patient will Salient points include: surgeons prefer bilaten ofthe affected hip. 'Big this connection.
Bridging A modified bridging m procedures) is taught' affected limb well supp a correctly adjusted 'JD( in stabilizing the body Bridging, as describe This will help to minD when a bed-pan is usee
PREOPERATIVE E
A simple programme admission. It aims at (l strength of the quadri venous circulation thn improving the mobiI1t should also include sui limbs and shoulder g:iJ:
nD!RAPy
Fig. 221) is the most widely used igoed for total hip replacement.
ltllinIess steel or cobalt-chrome
116m. The femoral head is small, and acetabular component are ilastic cement, such as methyl
II.
sween metal and polyethylene IDding immense forces of many IICrted in a hip prosthesis has he total body-weight may pass og step' (Longton, 1973). (over SOkg in weight) a heavy Ioyed.
few days before the operation is >adequate time for the various jed out, e.g. cross-matching of II also gives the therapist an :m: of the patient's function, I future physical potential with tapeCt an understanding of the ill concentrate on: (a) range of orb the affected and sound sides xmities and inequality between r the muscles controlling these line; and (d) ability of the upper : special problems of the elderly md general co-ordination must
ETIlERAPY I.the older age group, and the He, it is vital that every effort is patients are totally unaware of !lose who have been habitual
as soon as possible after the
TOTAL HlP REPLACEMENT
223
patient is admitted to the ward and continued on a regular basis until he is discharged home. Smoking is not allowed for 48 hours before the operation; many patients resent this bitterly, and have to be handled with considerable firmness by both nursing and therapy staff. After the operation smoking is discouraged; often this presents fewer difficulties than would have been expected; patients come to realize the value of their improved respiratory function. The breathing exercises used are those recommended in the section dealing with postoperative respiratory exercises, pp. 186-187. Because of the lack of hip mobility the half lying position is used in place of crook lying. Although the bilateral approach to costal breathing is employed the patient must also be taught unilateral breathing techniques. Unilateral exercises are important in the early postoperative phase of treatment when one of the patient's arms will be used for intravenous therapy.
Rehearsing Position of Immobilization It is necessary to explain and demonstrate the position of immobilization which the patient will be required to maintain immediately after surgery. Salient points include: (a) Abduction of the affected hip joint to 20° (some surgeons prefer bilateral hip abduction); and (b) Avoidance oflateral rotation ofthe affected hip. 'Big toe pointing towards the ceiling ... ' is a useful hint in this connection.
Bridging A modified bridging manreuvre (used for toilet purposes and other nursing procedures) is taught with the sound leg flexed at hip and knee and the affected limb well supported by the therapist or nurse (see p. 47). The use of a correctly adjusted 'monkey' chain or strap can be of considerable assistance in stabilizing the body during the bridging movement. Bridging, as described here, needs to be practised carefully by the patient. This wilJ help to minimize the risk of possible dislocation of the prosthesis when a bed-pan is used in the early phase of postoperative care.
PREOPERATlVE EXERCISE PROGRAMME A simple programme of exercises is started as soon as possible after admission. It aims at (a) improving respiratory function, (b) maintaining the strength of the quadriceps and gluteal muscle groups, (c) accelerating the venous circulation through the veins of the lower limbs and pelvis, and (d) improving the mobility of the joints of the lower limbs. The programme should also include suitable exercises to strengthen the muscles of the upper limbs and shoulder girdle in preparation for the use of walking aids.
224
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
When possible, it is advisable to measure the patient for the appropriate walking aid-generally elbow crutches, but sometimes a walking frame-and to give instruction in their correct use. The patient should then be en couraged to walk freely in the ward with the help of his specific aid.
Examples of Preoperative Exercises 1. Half lying; breathing exercises (both unilateral and bilateral). (See pp. 109-110.) 2. Half lying; single and double Quadriceps contractions. 3. Half lying; single and double Gluteal contractions. 4. Half lying; single and double Ankle bending. 5. Half lying; alternate Ankle bending and stretching. 6. Lying; single Knee raising with heel in contact with supporting surface, followed by Leg downpressing: sound limb only. 7. Lying; same exercise as above, but confined to affected limb. Therapist encourages the widest range of movement possible. In practical terms only a few degrees of true hip flexion may be possible. 8. Lying; single and double Hip abduction. At the affected hip movement may be limited to a few degrees. 9. Bend (fists on chest) stride lying; Elbow circling backwards. 10. Stride lying; single Arm raising forwards-upwards and rhythmical pressing in final position. 11. Standing; correction of faulty posture as far as possible. The use of a posture mirror is an advantage in giving this form of instruction. It increases the patient's awareness of his faulty stance.
POSTOPERATIVE TREATMENT When the patient is returned to the ward from the recovery room he is placed on the bed in a modified lying position (trunk raised slightly) with either the affected leg, or both legs, abducted to 20 c • The abducted position is used to ensure the stability of the prosthesis in the new acetabulum. A variety of methods of fixation and support is used to maintain the abducted position of the hips. For example: (a) Triangular foam wedge with wide base positioned between ankles; (b) Individual foam gutter trough or troughs; (c) Individual thigh slings attached to the sides of the bed; (d) Ankle 'gaiters' attached to a horizontal strut; (e) Pillow 'mound' positioned between the knees; and if) Hamilton-Russell traction arranged to provide positive abduction for the affected limb. Intravenous therapy will be used for a day or so: the dorsum of one of the hands is generally used for this purpose. A vacuum drain (Porto Vac or Redivac) is used for approximately 24 hours to drain the wound area. A bed cradle is in position to protect the affected limb from the weight of the bedclothes.
Individual surge habilitative treall is only necessary importance of usi From practiatl much to commel only based on tbi the low friction (
1. IMMEDIA"fl When the patien! him to carry out taught; he will all designed to accel Ward nursing! time to time they exercises in the ' nurse and themp
2. 1st AND 2nd The therapist ell correct position ( ensure that the I rotation. It shoul move his trunk i trunk position m
Exercises Quadriceps drill confined to the ! limb are started (generally after 2 in a fairly slow essential. With the surge and knee are als maximum supp< brief period oft; and knee should patient needs en
ERAPY
TOTAL HIP REPLACEMENT
225
r: patient for the appropriate
...... _ _ ~OSTOPERATIVE EXERCISE THERAPY _ _ _ __
etimes a walking frame-and patient should then be en of his specific aid.
Individual surgeons have established their own particular regimes of re habilitative treatment following total hip replacement. Some consider that it is only necessary to give practice in standing and walking; others stress the importance of using simple bed exercises as a preliminary to walking training. From practical experience the authors consider that the latter regime has much to commend it. The postoperative training plan outlined here is not only based on this premise, but has been arranged specifically for use when the low friction Charnley prosthesis is employed.
:IP
:bIateral and bilateral). (See contractions.
Inactions.
6ng.
IIlretching.
in contact with supporting
round limb only.
II to affected limb. Therapist
t possible. In practical terms
y be possible.
U the affected hip movement
I
\
circling backwards. lIs-upwards and rhythmical
far as possible. The use of a this form of instruction. It IIllty stance.
Ie recovery room he is placed ised slightly) with either the abducted position is used to acetabulum. .n: is used to maintain the rriangular foam wedge with idual foam gutter trough or Ie sides of the bed; (d) Ankle 'mound' positioned between rranged to provide positive
so: the dorsum of one of the ICUum drain (Porto Vac or !rain the wound area. A bed Ilb from the weight of the
1. IMMEDIATE POSTOPERATIVE CARE When the patient's level of awareness permits, the therapist will encourage him to carry out the simple breathing exercises which have been previously taught; he will also encourage him to practise the foot and ankle movements designed to accelerate the venous return through the lower limbs. Ward nursing staff have an important part to play in this form of care; from time to time they should remind the patient of the necessity of practising his exercises in the correct manner. This calls for close cooperation between nurse and therapist.
2. 1st AND 2nd POSTOPERATIVE DAYS The therapist checks the position of the affected limb to ensure that the correct position of hip abduction has been maintained. It is also important to ensure that the hip is in a neutral position and has not fallen into lateral rotation. It should be noted that there is a marked tendency for the patient to move his trunk in line with the abducted limb. If this occurs the patient's trunk position must be adjusted so that he lies centrally in bed. Exercises Quadriceps drill is started on the I st postoperative day; usually this is confined to the sound limb. Contractions of the quadriceps of the affected limb are started when the vacuum drain is removed from the wound area (generally after 24 hours). It is important that the contractions are performed in a fairly slow and positive manner. Adequate periods of relaxation are essential. With the surgeon's permission gentle flexion movements of the affected hip and knee are also started on the 1st postoperative day, the therapist giving maximum support. Assisted movement of this type should occupy only a brief period of time; in all, only about five careful flexion movements of hip and knee should be attempted. During this period of early hip movement the patient needs encouragement and reassurance.
226
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
In addition to this specific work, exercises to assist respiratory and circulatory function will be emphasized. (See Preoperative Exercise Pro gramme, p. 223.) Ideally, the therapist should arrange to visit the patient in the morning and afternoon for individual exercise sessions of about 10 minutes each.
3. FROM 2nd OR 3rd POSTOPERATIVE DAY UNTIL SUTURES ARE REMOVED BETWEEN 10th AND 14th DAY Standing, Walking and Sitting Individual surgeons differ considerably with regard to the exact time when the patient is first allowed out of bed for standing and walking. Some allow this on the 2nd or 3ed postoperative day, while others postpone standing and walking for several days: this gives time for the patient to increase his range of hip flexion. It should be noted that some surgeons prefer their patients to be able to sit comfortably in a chair of suitable height before they attempt to stand and walk. In the sitting position the patient must have his hips well abducted. Because of limited hip flexion many patients experience considerable dif ficulty in assuming a normal sitting position. To compensate for this the chair seat is 'angled' by the addition of two pillows, so that the patient assumes an inclined sitting position. A stable well-designed armchair with the following features is an essential piece of equipment for an orthopaedic ward specializing in reconstructive hip surgery: Adjustable legs, to ensure correct seat height; Firm, non-sagging seat with cloth (rather than vinyl) covering; High raked back, capable of easy adjustment; Firm elongated arm rests to assist the patient in rising and lowering movements. A Tubigrip bandage is often used on the affected leg to prevent oedema when the patient is ambulant or sitting in a chair. The bandage should extend from the webs of the toes to the tibial tubercle, and it is essential that the correct size of Tubigrip is used. It is also important that the support should be removed at night.
Exercise Programme Routine breathing, quadriceps, foot and ankle exercises are continued. Arm and shoulder girdle exercises are progressed in strength. Generally the patient is allowed to take a more normal half lying position. Assisted active flexion of the hip and knee of the affected limb is continued as before, but the therapist encourages the patient to take a more active part.
The return movement ot encourage assisted activt It is helpful if the parie position. This not only degree relieves the butU
'Getting Up': The IDiI For the majority of pari taking weight on the 'ne they will need a conside all is well. It is most imp« expected of them, and ~ discomfort. Initially, the therapi manreuvring the patient positioned at right angle it is essential for the de for the hips to be maine prevent undue hip fleD During the main pivo chain to relieve pressun: from the far side of the To bring the patient t the bed. When the bun the legs and at the same this way the patient is I hip flexion. Throughout this mOll by the use of the 'mom N.B. Both the thef3J patient immediately if b change of body positiOl
Using the Tilt Table The use of a tilt table (4 process of moving the }: is recommended. Fundamentally, the 1 a stable tubular-steel b can be moved from stabilized effectively iJ inclination can be me incorporated in the tal
HERAPY
to assist respiratory and Preoperative Exercise Pro
liltS Ie!
!lie patient in the morning and bout 10 minutes each.
TOTAL HIP REPLACEMENT
227
The return movement of active extension is also emphasized. Some surgeons encourage assisted active abduction of the affected hip. It is helpful if the patient spends short periods oftime resting in the supine position. This not only assists in promoting a better posture but to some degree relieves the buttocks of pressure.
'Getting Up': The Initial Approach
i DAY UNTIL SUTURES 14th DAY II.:g3rd to the exact time when ling and walking. Some allow others postpone standing and patient to increase his range of DDS prefer their patients to be ICight before they attempt to liNe his hips well abducted. experience considerable dif ,compensate for this the chair 10 that the patient assumes an
lowing features is an essential r:ializing in reconstructive hip
Ii
III
vinyl) covering;
;
ian in rising and lowering
li:cted leg to prevent oedema ~. The bandage should extend e, and it is essential that the nant that the support should
:xacises are continued. Arm in strength. Generally the ing position. be affected limb is continued nt to take a more active part.
For the majority of patients getting up for the first time after surgery and taking weight on the 'new' hip is something of a psychological ordeal, and they will need a considerable amount of reassurance from the therapist that all is well. It is most important that they should be given a clear idea of what is expected of them, and how they can be got on their feet safely without pain or discomfort. Initially, the therapist will need a competent assistant to help in manreuvring the patient from the normal lying position to one in which he is positioned at right angles to the long axis of the bed. During this manreuvre it is essential for the affected limb to be fully supported by the therapist, and for the hips to be maintained in an abducted position. It is also important to prevent undue hip flexion. During the main pivoting movement the patient will pull on the 'monkey' chain to relieve pressure on the buttocks; the assistant will support the trunk from the far side of the bed. To bring the patient to the standing position he is next eased to the edge of the bed. When the buttocks are resting on the bed edge the therapist lowers the legs and at the same time the assistant helps to raise the patient's trunk. In this way the patient is manreuvred into the standing position with minimal hip flexion. Throughout this movement the patient helps to minimize his body weight by the use of the 'monkey' chain. N.B. Both the therapist and his assistant must be prepared to assist the patient immediately if he shows signs of fainting or distress due to the sudden change of body position.
Using the Tilt Table The use of a tilt table (either manually or electrically operated) simplifies the process of moving the patient from the horizontal to the vertical position, and is recommended. Fundamentally, the tilt table consists of a padded platform which pivots on a stable tubular-steel base equipped with small braked wheels. The platform can be moved from the horizontal to the vertical position and can be stabilized effectively in any position between zero and 90°. The angle of inclination can be measured with the aid of the graduated angular scale incorporated in the table's design.
228
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
One end of the platform is equipped with a strong footrest; fold-away handles are provided on either side of the platform at about mid-position. Anchorage points are available for the use of restraining straps. Positioning the tilt table. The tilt table is used in conjuction with a variable height bed. The platform is set in a horizontal position alongside the bed (and securely braked) on the side of the patient's affected limb; the level of the platform and bed surface must be equal. The table is positioned as dose to the bed edge as possible. Before transferring the patient from the bed to the tilt table the platform surface should be covered with a sheet or cellular blanket. The covering not only adds to the patient's comfort but provides an easy means of adjusting his position when he is resting on the platform. Pillows are wedged longitudinally into the gap which exists between the edge of the platform and the bed. Trans/erring the patient. In transferring the patient from the bed to the tilt table the therapist needs the help of two assistants. The therapist and one assistant kneel on the platform, facing the bed; the second assistant stands at the far side of the bed. The patient (who lies in a supine position on the bed with his legs abducted) grasps the 'monkey' strap or chain, which is arranged on the overhead fixation point as near to the tilt table as possible so that its angle of indination assists in the transference process. The patient's legs are well supported by the therapist; his seat and trunk are supported by the assistant kneeling alongside the therapist. The patient is transferred by stages to the tilt table by the combined efforts of the kneeling supporters; their actions are reinforced by the patient using the 'monkey' strap or chain to take some of his body weight. The second assistant (who initially helped in the transference while standing by the bedside) now kneels on the bed to provide support and help in the final stage of the process. During this stage it is necessary for the kneeling supporters to move backwards into standing. Once securely positioned on the platform of the tilt table, with a pillow under his head, the patient is eased carefully down the platform until the soles of his feet make firm contact with the footrest; the hips remain in an abducted position with the toes pointing upwards. The hand grips are positioned so that when the patient grasps them his elbows will be slightly flexed. Tilting the patient. A very careful and gradual adjustment of the platform from the horizontal to the vertical position is then carried out. The actual time spent in reaching the vertical position can be extended, as thought necessary, by giving the patient short rest periods in various inclined positions. In this way the patient's circulatory system has time to adjust to the overall change of posture.
Training in Standing and Walking Initially the patient should stand with the help of a walking frame of a
suitable heigl with his feet! evenly on botl hip and knee t by hip exten carried out wi the patient's'l A brief pel preliminary n practised in I allows him to The patien affected leg, ; pattern with walking traini general condi The patien when walkinl Turning mO"ll using a series Walking WI with two stid of patients, Il been dischaQ home circum
4. WHEN S
AND PATI The prognu: covered in '\11 areas and sIt curbs will be In associa therapist she physical abi: provided in armchair of Before bei how to cope postures wb Adductio When restir pillow arraI settees, whi
'Y
tong footrest; fold-away at about mid-position. iWng straps. njuction with a variable III alongside the bed (and :d limb; the level of the positioned as close to the Il
tilt table the platform mutet. The covering not sy means of adjusting his re wedged longitudinally latform and the bed. l from the bed to the tilt . The therapist and one I:IOOIld assistant stands at Ie
the bed with his legs is arranged on the ISible so that its angle of : patient's legs are well pponed by the assistant
Iich
by the combined efforts zd by the patient using dy weight. The second while standing by the xl help in the final stage e kneeling supporters to
tih table, with a pillow ~ platform until the soles IS remain in an abducted grips are positioned so ~ slightly flexed. IIStment of the platform carried out. The actual ~ extended, as thought lis in various inclined bas time to adjust to the
a walking frame of a
TOTAL HlP REPLACEMENT
229
suitable height. He should be trained to stand in a good balanced position with his feet slightly apart. Once he has sufficient confidence to take weight evenly on both legs he is encouraged to carry out some simple exercises, e.g. hip and knee flexion of the affected leg through a comfortable range, followed by hip extension and abduction. Simple 'walking' movements are then carried out within the compass of the frame. This is very useful for boosting the patient's morale. A brief period of walking with the assistance of the frame is used as a preliminary to walking with elbow crutches. Walking with crutches is best practised in a relatively small area; this gives the patient confidence and allows him to concentrate on his gait. The patient should be tauglit to move both crutches forwards with the affected leg, and to take small even steps. Later on, a reciprocal walking pattern with the crutches is adopted. Care must be taken not to overdo walking training in the early stages, bearing in mind the patient's age and general condition. The patient must be warned against making sudden changes of direction when walking; this can produce rotation stresses at the 'new' hip joint. Turning movements are best carried out by either describing a wide arc or using a series of small hitching movements of the pelvis (lateral tilting). Walking with sticks. Some patients are able to progress rapidly to walking with two sticks, and are encouraged by their surgeons to do so. The majority of patients, however, use elbow crutches for a week or two after they have been discharged home. Much depends on the patient's general capability and home circumstances.
4. WHEN SUTURES HAVE BEEN REMOVED (10th-14th DAY) AND PATIENT REMAINS IN HOSPITAL FOR A DAY OR SO The programme of ambulation and exercise is progressed. The distance covered in walking will be gradually increased and should include uneven areas and sloping surfaces. The technique of negotiating steps, stairs and curbs will be practised. In association with the occupational therapist and the social worker the therapist should check on the patient's home circumstances in relation to his physical ability. It may be necessary for simple aids to daily living to be provided in the home, e.g. raised toilet seat, bath board, and suitable armchair of correct seat height. Before being discharged from the ward the patient must be given advice on how to cope safely at home, with special reference to the avoidance of certain postures which put stress on the 'new' hip. Adduction of the hips should be avoided, particularly in sitting and lying. When resting in bed on his sound side the patient should always have a firm pillow arranged longitudinally between the legs. Sitting on low chairs and settees, which emphasizes hip flexion, must also be avoided.
230
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
The patient should be instructed to keep his overall body weight within reasonable limite, so as to avoid overloading the prosthesis. He should also be advised to spend short periods of time (if feasible) in prone lying. Pool therapy. Provided the wound area is soundly healed, and the surgeon approves, pool therapy can be used with considerable advantage to improve the function of the lower limbs and body as a whole. It also provides a pleasant variation of the exercise programme. Patients for pool therapy need to be selected with considerable care. Outpatient treatment. It is helpful if the patient attends the hospital rehabilitation department two or three times a week for about 2-3 weeks after he has been discharged from the ward. This enables the therapist to check on his gait and general progress, and determine whether he needs one or two sticks in place of crutches. At this stage of recovery many patients do not require any form of walking aid.
Edmonson A. S. and VoL 2, 6th ed. St Longton E. B. (1973) 59, 116-119. Longton E. B. (1982
OTHER ASPECTS OF TOTAL HIP REPLACEMENT
REVISION ARTHROPLASTY In conditions where the original prosthesis has to be replaced due to mechanical failure or infection, the initial period of immobilization is extended considerably. It may consist of a 3-week period of complete bed rest. The treatment regime previously described (pp. 225-230) is then modified according to the surgeon's specific instructions.
ARTHROPLASTY FOLLOWING JOINT DISEASE IN CHILDHOOD When total hip replacement is used to restore movement in old joint conditions which have resulted in obliteration of the joint surfaces (bony ankylosis following acute suppurative arthritis or tuberculosis in childhood), both the initial period of immobilization and the treatment regime previously described are modified considerably, as indicated above. After restoration of joint movement one of the most difficult problems facing both surgeon and therapist is the weakness of the controlling hip muscles. The original joint disease may have severely damaged, or obliterated, some of the main muscle groups. Considerable instability of the joint may occur.
REFERENCES Adams J. C. (1980) Standard Orthopaedic Operations, 2nd ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone. Duthie R. B. and Ferguson A. B. (1973) Mercer's Orthopaedic Surgery, 7th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone.
• .t.
TOTAL HIP REPLACE,\1ENT
ill body weight within ais. He should also be prone lying. taled, and the surgeon advantage to improve lie. It also provides a for pool therapy need
231
Edmonson A, S, and Crenshaw A. H. (ed.) (1980) Campbell's Operative Orthopaedics, Vol. 2, 6th ed. St Louis, Mosby, pp. 2319-2324. Longton E, B. (1973) Orthopaedic surgery in arthritic lower-limb joints. Physiotherapy 59, 116-119. Longton E. B. (1982) Personal communication.
anends the hospital ·about 2-3 weeks after e therapist to check on · he needs one or two many patients do not
NT \ be replaced due to :milization is extended mplete bed rest, The 0) is then modified
SEIN 'Yement in old joint joint surfaces (bony rulosis in childhood), I:I1t regime previously e. 1St difficult problems r the controlling hip aaged, or obliterated, lity of the joint may
· Edinburgh, Churchill
FIIdic Surgery, 7th ed.
'(
~ 22. Meniscectomy
Meniscectomy is performed after an injury to a meniscus when the diagnosis of splitting and displacement is beyond doubt, e.g. when the meniscus has been displaced on more than one occasion.
TYPES OF INCISION Excision of Medial Meniscus Two main types of incision are used: the oblique incision and the transverse incision. The oblique incision, 3'8-5 cm in length, begins close to the inframedial aspect of the patella and extends downwards and slightly backwards to a point about 1·2 cm below the joint line. The structures involved include skin, subcutaneous tissues, capsule, and synovial membrane of the knee joint. The infrapatellar branch of the saphenous nerve may be divided. This causes temporary anaesthesia of the small zone of skin on the anterior aspect of the knee joint which is supplied by this nerve, and sometimes persistent tenderness of the scar. Smillie (1978a) states: 'The presence of the patellar plexus implies that sensory overlap is well developed in this region, and it is thus unusual for an area of diminished cutaneous sensation to remain permanently.' The traverse incision, about 3·8 cm in length, is made over the anteromedial aspect of the knee joint, parallel with the articular surface of the tibia, and about 1·2 cm above it. This incision does not damage the infrapatellar nerve and provides good exposure. If the incision is placed too low the scar may become adherent to the surface of the tibia.
management employee regimes that are widdJ therapy.
1. Non-weight-bearl • After the operation the wool compression baD rosis. The patient resa quadriceps control aD pillow is sometimes USI and does not extend to position of the joint. After about the 3rd 1 short periods of sittinl supported in a horizo gutter trough. Wa1kinl elbow crutches. Non-weight-beariIq 10th or 12th postopc discharged home or n After the stitches ha joint to control oedem makes a gradual progl
Exercise Therapy
Exercises to maintaiI started on the 1st po!! quadriceps statically, the reflex inhibition ( Transient pain loe; starting quadriceps i produced by the conI
AFTER REMOVAL OF SlJ
Excision of Lateral Meniscus The technique of approach is similar to that used for excision of the medial meniscus.
ESSENTIALS OF TREATMENT Orthopaedic surgeons differ with regard to the type of immobilization and 232
The main aims COM educating walking, = flexion. The reactiOi observed very carefu amount of activity a1l the effusion has sum The length of tinH depends to a consideJ
MENISCECTOMY
233
management employed in the postoperative phase of treatment. Three regimes that are widely used are outlined here with the appropriate exercise therapy.
1. Non-weight-bearing Regime
IiCUS when the diagnosis wben the meniscus has
ision and the transverse
lose to the inframedial dy backwards to a point involved include skin, lie of the knee joint. may be divided. This lon the anterior aspect d sometimes persistent m:sence of the patellar in this region, and it is s sensation to remain
c over the anteromedial IIl'face of the tibia, and the infrapatellar nerve I too low the scar may
After the operation the knee is immobilized by a firm flannel or domette-and wool compression bandage; this helps to prevent postoperative haemarth rosis. The patient rests in bed for about two to three days until he has good quadriceps control and can perform straight leg raising satisfactorily. A pillow is sometimes used to support the limb; it is placed under the lower leg and does not extend to the knee joint. Its purpose is to maintain the straight position of the joint. After about the 3rd postoperative day the patient is allowed out of bed for short periods of sitting and walking. When sitting the affected limb must be supported in a horizontal position by a stool and pillows or foam rubber gutter trough. Walking is restricted to a non-weight bearing technique with elbow crutches. Non-weight-bearing is continued until the stitches are removed on the 10th or 12th postoperative day. During this phase the patient may be discharged home or remain in the ward. After the stitches have been removed a crepe bandage is applied to the knee joint to control oedema and provide some degree of support. The patient then makes a gradual progression from partial to full weight-bearing.
Exercise Therapy Exercises to maintain the strength of the quadriceps femoris muscle are started on the 1st postoperative day. Generally the patient can contract the quadriceps statically, although in some cases it may be difficult to overcome the reflex inhibition of the muscle. Transient pain localized to the site of the operation is to be expected on starting quadriceps exercises. It results from the drag on the incision produced by the contracting muscle.
AFTER REMOVAL OF SUTURES
excision of the medial
If immobilization and
The main aims consist of redeveloping the quadriceps femoris muscle, re educating walking, and (if flexion exercises are allowed) restoring knee flexion. The reaction of the knee to weight-bearing and exercise must be observed very carefully; any marked increase of effusion indicates that the amount of activity allowed must be decreased and knee flexion omitted until the effusion has subsided. The length of time required to achieve full recovery after a meniscectomy depends to a considerable extent on the patient's occupation. 'Experience has
234
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
shown that whereas a clerk can return to his desk in the 4th week, a degree of physical fitness which will withstand the rigours of athletic activities is rarely possible in less than twelve weeks of organized rehabilitation. This applies in equal degree to those engaged in the manual occupations of heavy industry' (Smillie, 1978b).
ALLOWING KNEE FLEXION
Opinion varies among surgeons as to when knee flexion is to be allowed. Some consider that knee flexion exercises should not be used until the later phases of recovery, because in the earlier stages the movements may irritate the joint and produce an effusion. They stress that knee flexion usually returns by itself without any difficulty. Surgeons who hold this opinion will, in the absence of marked effusion, generally allow the patient to flex the knee within a pain-free range of movement once or twice daily about two weeks after the operation. Other surgeons allow gentle knee flexion exercises between the 10th and 14th postoperative days, provided they are kept within a painless range of movement and there is no significant joint effusion.
2. Early Weight-bearing Regime (after 5 days) Immediately after the operation the knee is immobilized in extension by a firm flannel or domette-and-wool compression bandage; this helps to prevent postoperative haemarthrosis. A gutter-type back splint is sometimes used in addition. The patient rests in bed for approximately 5 days with the affected limb elevated (foam rubber trough resting either on pillows or on an adjustable elevation frame). After five days the back splint is discarded and, provided that straight leg raising can be performed satisfactorily, the patient is allowed out of bed for short periods of walking practice (partial weight-bearing with elbow crutches). The stitches are removed between the 10th and 12th postoperative days, and the patient is discharged from the ward. A crepe bandage is applied to the knee joint to control oedema and provide some degree of support. Full weight bearing is allowed. Exercise Therapy As described previously (p. 233).
3. Early Weight-bearing Regime (with Plaster Cylinder)
After the operation a well-padded plaster cylinder is applied to the affected
limb; it extends from the upper third of the thigh to just above the malleoli. During the application of the cylinder the lower edge is well padded with
adhesive orthopaecl when the patient i: impinging on the surgeons prefer to lizer' .* The splint j the upper third of The patient reS thoroughly and fi raising-to be prac periods of standin! crutches) on the 3: When the patiell satisfactory he is a safely.) The plastc 10th and 12th pos patients' depart:m4
Acrepeban~
degree of support. continued for a rei The transitiOn fu must be gradual .. whether the joint
Exercise Therapy As described pw
MENISCECTO
Severe pain and : complications wi plications indud haemarthrosis. Of trauma at 4 operation is peru and capsule are membrane expo persistent synovi inadequate corol
* The 'knee iron metal struts, one e is constructed frO! allows a degree (J division of Charie
MENISCECTOMY
the 4th week, a degree of llh1etic activities is rarely »Iitation. This applies in mons of heavy industry'
235
adhesive orthopaedic foam. This helps to maintain the position of the cylinder when the patient is in the erect position and prevents the lower edge from impinging on the dorsum of the foot. (Instead of a plaster cylinder some surgeons prefer to use a Raymed wrap-around back splint or 'knee immobi lizer'. * The splint is applied over the compression bandage and extends from the upper third of the thigh to the ankle. The patient rests in bed for about 2 days to allow the plaster to dry thoroughly and for quadriceps exercises-and, if possible, straight leg raising-to be practised. In general, the patient is allowed out of bed for short periods of standing and walking practice (partial weight-bearing with elbow crutches) on the 3rd postoperative day. When the patient's walking and control of the affected limb are considered satisfactory he is allowed home. (It is important that he can negotiate stairs safely.) The plaster cylinder and stitches are usually removed between the 10th and 12th postoperative days, the patient returning to the hospital out patients' department for these procedures. A crepe bandage is applied to the knee to control oedema and provide some degree of support. In general, partial weight-bearing with elbow crutches is continued for a few days until the patient has regained full control of the knee. The transition from partial to full weight-bearing without elbow crutches must be gradual. Much will depend on the individual's reaction to pain and whether the joint is free of effusion.
/
llexion is to be allowed. be used until the later movements may irritate IBt knee flexion usually 10 hold this opinion will, Ie patient to flex the knee I: daily about two weeks It
:s between the 10th and thin a painless range of
t iIized in extension by a !lei this helps to prevent int is sometimes used in
Exercise Therapy As described previously (p. 233).
with the affected limb or on an adjustable liscarded and, provided Iy. the patient is allowed :iaI weight-bearing with 5
IIWS
MENISCECTOMY WITH COMPLICATIONS Severe pain and reactionary effusion of the knee are associated with certain complications which may arise during or after the operation. Such com plications include: (1) Trauma during the operation, and (2) Postoperative haemarthrosis. Of trauma at operation Smillie (I 978c) states: ' . . . Cases in which the operation is performed only with difficulty and in which the medial ligament and capsule are subjected to prolonged stretching . . . and the synovial membrane exposed to prolonged pressure . . . frequently suffer from persistent synovitis ... .' Postoperative haemarthrosis may occur as a result of inadequate compression of the knee by the bandage or padding of the plaster
2th postoperative days, I8J1dage is applied to the ofsupport. Full weight-
Cylinder)
applied to the affected just above the malleoli. Je is well padded with
t t
* The 'knee immobilizer' consists of a tapered back splint incorporating 4 removable metal struts, one each on the lateral and medial aspects and 2 on the posterior aspect. It is constructed from fabric-backed felt with a Velcro 'fold-back' closure system which allows a degree of adjustability. The 'immobilizer' is obtainable from Raymed (a division of Charles F. Thackray Ltd.), of Viaduct Road, Leeds, LS42BR.
236
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
cylinder. The condition gives rise to adhesions, residual synovial thickenings, and persistent effusion. Patients with a marked reaction of the knee will experience increased pain when they attempt to exercise the quadriceps femoris muscle. The authors are of the opinion that patients should not be bullied into exercising the muscle (as is often done), but allowed to rest the limb until the main reaction of the joint has subsided and a static contraction of the quadriceps can be obtained without difficulty. (This does not mean, however, that the patient is allowed to forget his role in attempting to activate the quadriceps muscle.) Straight leg raising will usually be possible about a day later.
Primary Exercil Quadriceps ExerciJ 1. Half lying; S1 2. Half lying (af 60"); 'holdini 3. As above; sm 4. Half crook s (affected) Kt carrying fon 5. Half crook 5 (affected) KI backwards. I
EXERCISE THERA:..:...P-"-V_ _ _ _ _ _ __ The lists of exercises given here are intended to be a guide to the postoperative treatment of meniscectomy when anyone of the three treat ment regimes described (pp. 233-235) are used.
PROGRAMME A: FOR USE WHEN KNEE IS IMMOBILIZED BY COMPRESSION BANDAGE, WITH OR WITIIOUT A BACK SPLINT (Regimes 1 and 2, pp. 233-234.) TABLE 1 From 1st postoperative day until straight leg raising can be performed without assistance: usually by 2nd or 3rd postoperative day.
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
To maintain the quadriceps femoris muscle.
SECONDARY
1. To maintain the mobility of the toes, ankle, midtarsal and subtalar joints. 2. To maintain the muscles of the lower leg and hip joint.
Exercise Period 10 minutes, twice daily. N.B. The patient must be instructed to contract the quadriceps femoris muscle correctly at least six times every half hour-'Give it six of the best ...'.
Secondary EXeI
Lower Leg Exera 1. Half lying; 1 2. Half lying; (c turning inWl! 3. Half lying; ( 4. Half lying; outwards.
Hip Exercises 5. Lying; sing! 6. Lying; sing 7. Lying; sing
TABLE 2 From 2nd or 3r removed). The patient p bearing reg'ime at
(non-weight-~
Patients on tb operation. Usua standing al)d Wi over the quadric
Remedial Aims As in previous:
'(
131 synovial thickenings, perience increased pain is muscle. The authors lied into exercising the , unti!-the main reaction , the quadriceps can be rever, that the patient is be quadriceps muscle.) :lay later.
be a guide to the one of the three treat-
D
IMMOBILIZED rIlIOUT
MENISCECTOMY
237
Primary Exercises Quadriceps Exercises 1. Half lying; single Quadriceps contractions. 2. Half lying (affected limb well supported by therapist: hip flexed to about 60"); 'holding' the position for a brief period. 3. As above; single Leg lowering with assistance. 4. Half crook side-lying (firm pillows supporting affected limb); single (affected) Knee bracing, followed by slight Leg raising sideways and carrying forwards. Initially, therapist provides support. 5. Half crook side-lying (firm pillows supporting affected limb); single (affected) Knee bracing, followed by slight Leg raising and carrying backwards. Initially, therapist provides support.
Secondary Exercises Lower Leg Exercises 1. Half lying; Toe bending and stretching: both feet. 2. Halflying; (a) alternate Ankle bending and stretching, (b) alternate Foot turning inwards and outwards. 3. Half lying; (a) single Ankle bending, (b) single Ankle stretching. 4. Half lying; (a) single Foot turning inwards, (b) single Foot turning outwards.
• iog can be performed
ve day.
:sal and subtalar joints.
p joint.
Ie quadriceps femoris e it six of the best. . .'.
Hip Exercises 5. Lying; single Gluteal contractions. 6. Lying; single and double Gluteal contractions. 7. Lying; single Leg downpressing.
TABLE 2 From 2nd or 3rd postoperative day until the 10th day (when stitches are removed). The patient performs the exercises on the bed. Patients on the non-weight bearing regime are allowed out of bed for short periods of sitting and walking (non-weight-bearing) from about the 3rd postoperative day. Patients on the weight-bearing regime remain in bed for about 5 days after operation. Usually they are allowed out of bed on the 5th day for sitting, standing and walking (partial weight-bearing), provided they have control over the quadriceps muscle and can perform straight leg raising satisfactorily.
Remedial Aims As in previous section.
238
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Exercise Period 15-20 minutes, twice daily. N.B. The patient must be instructed to contract the quadriceps femoris muscle correctly at least six times every half hour-' Give it six of the best .. .'.
N.B. Before the p inspect the state of intact; fine cracks c Remedial Aims
Primary Exercises Quadriceps Exercises 1. Half lying; single and double Quadriceps contractions. 2. Half lying; combined (single) Quadriceps and Gluteal contractions. 3. Lying; single Leg downpressing. 4. Lying; single Leg raising. When the patient can perform straight leg raising without any difficulty weight resistance is added, with the surgeon's permission. Usually a weight of 0.5 kg is used at first. It is progressed gradually. The exercise must not be allowed to cause pain or to overfatigue the quadriceps muscle. Throughout the leg lifting and lowering the knee must be kept firmly braced.
PRIMARY
To maintain the qu SECONDARY
1. To maintain t
joints. 2. To maintain d
Exercise Period 10 minutes, twice c:l N.B. The patien muscle correctly at ,
Secondary Exercises Lower Leg Exercises 1. Halflying; (a) alternate Ankle bending and stretching, (b) alternate Foot turning inwards and outwards. 2. Half lying; single or double Foot circling. 3. Half lying; (a) single and double Ankle bending, (b) single and double Ankle stretching, (c) single and double Foot turning inwards.
Hip Exercises 4. Half crook side-lying; single (affected) slight Leg raising sideways, and carrying forwards and backwards to 6 counts. (See Fig. 189, p. 159.) 5. Half crook side-lying; single (affected) Leg raising sideways. 6. Forehead rest prone lying; single Knee bracing, followed by slight Leg raising backwards.
PROGRAMME B: FOR USE WHEN KNEE IS IMMOBILIZED BY PLASTER CYLINDER OR RAYMED 'KNEE IMMOBILIZER' TABLE OF EXERCISES For first 2-3 postoperative days. The patient rests in bed for about 2 days to allow the plaster to dry out. A plastic sheet is usually in position under the affected limb to protect the bedclothes. A bed cradle allows air circulation and prevents bedclothes from coming into contact with the damp plaster cast.
Primary ExerciSl Quadriceps Exercis4
1. Half lying; su 2. Half lying; sU outwards. 3. Lying; single 4. Half lying; su and adductiOi
Secondary E:xe~
Lower Leg Exercis. 1. Half lying; T 2. Halflying; (a turning inwa 3. Half lying; (! 4. Half lying; ( outward),<
Hip Exercises 5. Lying; sing}. 6. Lying; singl~
EKAPY
ttact the quadriceps femoris '-'Give it six of the best .. :.
MENISCECTOMY
239
N.B. Before the patient starts his exercise programme the therapist should inspect the state of the entire plaster cylinder to ascertain if the plaster is intact; fine cracks can easily go undetected.
Remedial Aims /
PRIMARY
To maintain the quadriceps femoris muscle.
oontractions.
IOd Gluteal contractions.
SECONDARY
1. To maintain the mobility of the toes, ankle, midtarsal and subtalar
can perform straight leg
~ce is added, with the
, 0.5 kg is used at first. It is
It be allowed to cause pain or
mughout the leg lifting and
a:d.
:nl
lllretcbing, (b) alternate Foot
Idiug, (b) single and double turning inwards.
II
II:
Leg raising sideways, and
(See Fig. 189, p. 159.) raising sideways. :ing, followed by slight Leg
joints. 2. To maintain the muscles of the lower leg and hip joint.
Exercise Period 10 minutes, twice daily. N.B. The patient must be instructed to contract the quadriceps femoris muscle correctly at least six times every half hour-'Give it six of the best ... '.
Primary Exercises Quadriceps Exercises 1. Half lying; single Quadriceps contractions. 2. Half lying; single Knee bracing, followed by Hip turning inwards and outwards. 3. Lying; single Leg lifting (assistance from therapist) through 10-15 c • 4. Half lying; single Knee bracing, followed by small range Hip abduction and adduction.
lIS.
t IS IMMOBILIZED BY IE IMMOBll.IZER'
Secondary Exercises Lower Leg Exercises 1. Half lying; Toe bending and stretching; both feet. 2. Half lying; (a) alternate Ankle bending and stretching, (b) alternate Foot turning inwards and outwards. 3. Half lying; (a) single Ankle bending, (b) single Ankle stretching. 4. Half lying; (a) single Foot turning inwards, (b) single Foot turning outwards.
[low the plaster to dry out.
ft'ected limb to protect the I prevents bedclothes from
Hip Exercises 5. Lying; single Gluteal contractions. 6. Lying; single Leg downpressing.
240
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Progression of Exercise Programme On the 2nd or 3rd postoperative day the patient is allowed out of bed and is given instruction in standing and walking techniques. Elbow crutches are used for walking practice, and initially the patient is partial weight-bearing. As a preliminary to walking training the patient practises hip strengthening exercises in the standing position: he can stabilize himself by holding on to the back of a suitable chair. Later he can carry out the movements while stabilized by the crutches. Hip updrawing movements (with knee firmly braced) are of particular value. The patient is discharged home about the 4th postoperative day. It is most important that before he leaves the ward he has receIved adequate training in stair climbing with the help of crutches. N.B. The patient must be aware of the importance of practising his exercises at home in the correct manner.
PROGRAMME C: FOR USE AFTER 10th OR 12th POSTOPERATIVE DAY. THE EXERCISE TABLES HAVE BEEN ARRANGED TO SUIT THE REQUIREMENTS OF ANY OF THE THREE TREATMENT REGIMES DESCRIBED (pp. 233-235) TABLE 3 From 10th or 12th postoperative day, when stitches are removed, for about 2 weeks. Full weight-bearing is allowed. (If a non-weight-bearing regime has been followed previously, progression from partial to full weight-bearing must be gradual.) A crepe bandage is worn on the knee to control oedema and to provide some support.
Primary Exercises Quadriceps Exercises 1. Long sitting (rru double QuadriCCl 2. Halflying orlyin 3. Half lying or lyjI extension of kneI 4. High sitting (plil supported on sto
Knee Flexion Exercise 5. Lying; single K: surface." 6. Forehead rest pi
Walking 7. Re-education in N.B. When the WOJ exercises in the pool suggested.
TABLE 4 For use about a moo could be included as Remedial Aims
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
1. To redevelop the quadriceps femoris muscle. 2. To restore the mobility of the knee joint. 3. To re-educate walking. SECONDARY
I. To redevelop the muscles of the hip joint. 2. To re-educate neuromuscular co-ordination.
Exercise Period 30 minutes, once or twice daily. Additional time is required for the straight leg raising exercise against weight resistance.
PRIMARY
I. To redevelop t 2. To restore the SECONDARY
1. To redevelop t 2. To develop nel
Exercise Period.. 30 minutes, once d extension exercise a
* Not to be used in t not permit knee ftexk
IiRAPY
is allowed out of bed and is miques. Elbow crutches are :nt is partial weight-bearing. II: practises hip strengthening ize hiJnself by holding on to ':Y out the movements while lWements (with knee firmly t
postoperative day. It is most n:a:Jved adequate training in DpOnance of practising his
OR 12th I! TABLES HAVE BEEN e:NTS OF ANY OF THE tIDED (pp. 233-235)
IK:s are removed, for about 2 I-weight-bearing regime has niaI to full weight-bearing : knee to control oedema and
MENISCECTOMY
241
Primary Exercises Quadriceps Exercises 1. Long sitting (trunk inclined backwards with hand suppon); single and
double Quadriceps contractions.
2. Halflying or lying; single straight Leg raising against weight resistance. 3. Half lying or lying (wedge or pillow under affected knee); shon range
extension of knee, with or without weight resistance.*
4. High sitting (plinth: knees flexed comfortably to about 30°, with heels
supponed on stool); single Knee stretching.*
Knee Flexion Exercises 5. Lying; single Knee raising with heel kept in contact with supporting
surface.*
6. Forehead rest prone lying; alternate Knee bending and stretching.*
Walking 7. Re-education in walking. N.B. When the wound is fully healed and no effusion of the joint is present exercises in the pool may be used as an adjunct to the specific exercises suggested.
TABLE 4 For use about a month after the operation. Some of the exercises suggested could be included as part of a Specific Exercise Circuit (p. 249).
Remedial Aims PRIMARY
:Ie.
1. To redevelop the quadriceps femoris muscle. 2. To restore the mobility of the knee joint. SECONDARY
1. To redevelop the extensor muscles of the hip joint. 2. To develop neuromuscular co-ordination.
L
Exercise Period 30 minutes, once daily. Additional time is required for the resisted knee extension exercise and graduated pool therapy.
is required for the straight
* Not to be used in the presence of marked effusion of the knee, or if the surgeon does not permit knee flexion exercises (p. 234).
I:
242
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Primary Exercises Quadriceps Exercises 1 Half wing half low yard grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising and
Knee bending.
2. Low reach grasp stride standing (wall bars); Heel raising and single
Knee bending. (See Fig. 196, p. 165.)
3. Low reach grasp instep support standing (wall bars and stool); single
Heel raising and Knee bending.
4. Skipping: (a) Skip jumps with a rebound, (b) High skip jumps. 5. High sitting (bench); single (affected) Knee stretching against weight or
weight-and-pulley resistance.
Knee Flexion Exercises 6. Bend grasp high standing (wall bars); Knee bending and stretching with
Hand travelling down and up the bars. (See Fig. 206, p. 169.)
7. Lying; cycling.
Secondary Exercises Balance Exercises 1. Balance half standing (balance bench rib); balance walking fowards and
backwards.
2. Balance walking with Knee and Arm raising of the same side, and
opposite Arm raising backwards.
3. Toe balance walking along a straight line to 3 counts, followed by Knee
full bending and stretching with the knees forwards to 6 counts.
Hip Exercises 4. Primary Exercises 1-4.
TABLE 5*
A final exercise programme suitable for use when a high degree of physical
fitness is required.
Remedial Aims As in previous section.
* Progressive circuit training with weight resistance forms a very useful alternative to the exercise table. So also does a pre-work circuit designed to simulate normal working stresses (see p. 251).
•
Exercise Period As in previous section.
Primary Exercises
Quadriceps Exercises 1. Wing standing; f 2. Wing stride StalK 3. Wing instep SUp! bending. (See F;" 4. Skipping; Hoppa Fig. 8, p. 12.) 5. Bend standing; I opposite Arm sm (with opposite Al 6. Hopping with a ! 7. Wing standing; I sideways. 8. High sitting (ben weight-and-pulk
Knee Flexion Exercise 9. Forearm reach I sitting. (See Fig.
Secondary Exercls4
Balance Exercises 1. Balance half sa with Knee and j backwards. 2. Balance half sa wards to 3 coun knees forward tl
Hip Exercises 3. Primary Exercil /
REFERENCES Smillie I. S. (19788) Livingstone, p. lSI. Smillie I. S. (197Sb) Smillie L S. (197Sc) Il
n
! THERAPy
MENISCECTOMY
243
Exercise Period As in previous section. •
(wall bars); Heel raising and
II bars); Heel raising and single /
ling (wall bars and stool); single
1Ild, (b) High skip jumps. ~ stretching against weight or
:nee bending and stretching with · (See Fig. 206, p. 169.)
b); balance walking fowards and · raising of the same side, and Ie
to 3 counts, followed by Knee forwards to 6 counts.
leeS
Primary Exercises Quadriceps Exercises 1. Wing standing; Heel raising and Knee bending. 2. Wing stride standing; Heel raising and single Knee bending. 3. Wing instep support standing (stool); single Heel raising and Knee bending. (See Fig. 188, p. 157.) 4. Skipping: Hopping with a rebound and alternate Knee stretching. (See Fig. 8, p. 12.) 5. Bend standing; hopping with alternate Toe placing forwards (and opposite Arm stretching forwards), and alternate Toe placing sideways (with opposite Arm stretching sideways). (See Fig. 7, p. 12.) 6. Hopping with a rebound and opposite Knee and Arm raising. 7. Wing standing; hopping with a rebound and alternate Leg swinging sideways. 8. High sitting (bench); single (affected) Knee stretching against weight or weight-and-pulley resistance. Knee Flexion Exercise 9. Forearm reach grasp kneeling (wall bars); attempting to assume kneel sitting. (See Fig. 208, p. 170.)
Secondary Exercises Balance Exercises 1. Balance half standing (balance bench rib); balance walking forwards with Knee and Arm raising of the same side and opposite Arm raising backwards. 2. Balance half standing (balance bench rib); Toe balance walking for wards to 3 counts, followed by Knee full bending and stretching with knees forward to 6 counts.
when a high degree of physical
ICe forms a very useful alternative to csigned to simulate normal working
Hip Exercises 3. Primary Exercises 1-7; Secondary Exercise 2.
REFERENCES Smillie 1. S. (1978a) Injuries of the Knee Joint, 5th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone, p. 18l. Smillie 1. S. (l978b) Ibid. p. 173. Smillie L S. (l978c) Ibid. p. 179.
PART 5
/
GENERAL EXERCISE THERAPY In the broad sense general exercise therapy encompasses a wide spectrum of physical activity, ranging from informal movement and recreational pursuits to more organized and purposeful forms of exercise. This section of the book deals with two widely differing aspects of general exercise in use today: progressive circuit training (representing an intensive and highly organized form of movement) and exercises to music, which represent a more informal approach to general e.:'ercise.
245
23. Progressive circuit training
Circuit training was originally evolved by Morgan and Adamson in the early 19508, and was designed as a system of exercise training for maintaining and increasing physical fitness. It is capable of being adapted for all ability levels and aims at progressively developing endurance, strength, function and cardio-respiratory efficiency. Fundamentally, circuit training consists of a number of performers carrying out a series of pre-determined exercises, with or without apparatus, which are arranged in a definite sequence. The floor areas in which the activities are performed are known as 'exercise' or 'task stations'. The stations are visited in tum by the performers and the movements indicated for each individual are performed against a prescribed time allocation. Three circuit laps are completed with increasing rapidity, each successive lap taking less time than the previous one. During the final circuit lap the performers are working at maximum capacity. Several variations of this theme are possible (p. 254). It should be noted that a circuit may be the main core of a specific exercise session, or the culmination of a general fitness programme.
TYPES OF CIRCUIT There are four distinct types of circuit: (1) General Circuit (Fig. 222a), which aims at providing an overall fitness programme (p. 248); (2) Specific Circuit (Fig. 222b), which is used to exercise a particular body region with special reference to strengthening and mobilizing (p. 249); (3) Function Circuit (Fig. 222c), which utilizes the types of movement encountered in ordinary daily living as distinct from gymnastic exercises (p. 250); and (4) Pre-work Circuit (Fig. 222d), which provides a series of realistic work situations with emphasis on manual skills (p. 251).
PRACTICAL APPLICATION In a full circuit there are normally 7 or 8 exercise stations. The performer works at each exercise task for a set period of time, usually 1 minute. He 247
248
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
General Fitness Circuits for 7 Exercises These indicate how a theme may be modified to promote interest, and progress physical output.
CIRCUIT 1
CIRCUIT 2
CIRCUIT 3
NO APPARATUS WORKING IN PAIRS
EMPHASIS ON RESISTANCE
CONTINUOUS s~UTTLE RUNS
1
AIMS:To redE mobility of I
DESCRIPn
1rUDE SITTING (BAI.
BENCH: BUTTOCJ<:
RUN UP JDOWN INCLINED
~:~~I~~~"~
~ ---, "":t..::r 1 I ECK SUPPORT SPANNING
i
.
~----------------~---
."
/"
\
41
51
SQUAT STANDING
,~ ~'i".,.
j
~~'
PRONE LYING-ROCKING UP AND DOWN USING ARMS
"""""7 71
PRESS UPS
~
CLA'OPED
•
CHEST
~"
FIXE'D CROOK LYING SIT UPS WITH WEIGHT
LYING
31 STAt-':DiNG(HAND
GRASPING ONE 1 Ql= INCLINED pru BENCH)- SQUAT V'lITH FEET CU. ON FLOOR
~
SQUATTING(HEELS MISED ON BLOCK)-DUMB-BELLS IN EACH HAND
~t
PRONE LYING ( PARTNER FIXING SHOULDERS)
CLASPING PLINTH WITH TRUNK SUP>DRTED LEG LIFTING BACKWARDS
~--+------l~ ~~~~g ~ ~II~~
41
I
WITH PRRTNER A5SISTING
:
SUPP:;-10RTED PRESS uPS
t
FALLlNG~ 'WALl<
AND BACKWARD
5
FLOW
6, STEP UP3{ srcx
BAL.ANCE BEN....'1-l
WITH DJM~ flFi=ECTED LEG
OFF BENCH
WITH BARIlELL
I Fig. 222a. General Fitness Circuit.
~
UNDER ROPE TO STAt-.iJ
UPRIGHT: cONTlN
WITH DUMB-BELLS ON AND
BENCfl PRESSING
INCLINED PRONE
LEGS FORWM.~
~'
~
61~~L~~
WITH WElG~HT DIs('
~
:I, HALF WITH SQUATS
Lf(;
TO
SIT UPS
~vn==!.
BODY BY
~K EXTENSiONS
c.. ........
FIXED CROOK
i=OLDED TOWEL)'
FORWARD AND BACKWARD fIDqt
LEADING
7
ALTERNATE SEf
AND LEG RA1311 TO ROLL ,MEDIC BALL ALONG U
249
PROGRESSIVE CIRCUIT TRAINING
Or 7 Exercises
Specific LeSJ Circuit
, modified to promote IicaI output.
AIMS:To redevelop quadriceps femoris muscle, to restore mobility of hip and knee, and to improve general fitness.
/ CIRCUIT 3
DES.CRIPTION
EMPHASISQN RESISTANCE
IS
TASK
RUN UP JDOWN INCLINED
! BENCHES
SECURED TO
./
WALL BARS
'6
SCORING
~
TOTAL EACh LENGTH COMPLETED
: ;
11'
.... '
r:
BI'O<. E)(TENS10fl.'S
MU~"; J
CU\';PED
COUNT EACH SIT UP
•
TO
OIEST
,
, r--:
FIXED CROOK LYlNG SIT uPS WITH WEIGHT
3 STANDiNG { HANDS
GRASPING ONE END OF INCLINED PJlLANCE BENCH)- SQUATT~ING
O~Zj
TOTAh Ep,cH OOUAT
i
VV'TH FEET FLAT
ON ROaR
AAISED
SQUATTING(HEEL<3 C»I Bi..OCK)-DUMB-BELLS IN El>CH HAND
~t
UASPlNG PLINTH WITH
'TRUNK '3UPI'ORTED
4
5
LEG LIFTING BACKWARDS
INCLINED PRONE: FALUNG- 'wALkiNG' LEGS AND nM'u,,'M'"
TOTAL
E~CH
LEG MOVEMENT
DUCK~NG UNDER LOW ROPE TO STAND CONTINUOUS
COUNT EACI1 DOCK
UNDEP. ROPE
ASTRIDE l\.M!:ING WlTf\ IllJI.4B-BELiS ~AND
i
OFF BCNC;'!
7
BEIOCH PRES\';ING WITH BARBELL
J l n:uit.
----t--~
ALiERNA,"[ SEAT
AND TO
\ S'
TOTAL EACH STEP UP
RA!SING MEDICINE BALL ALONG LEGS
a
c
b~ Fig. 222b. Specific Leg Circuit.
. .-
cruNT EPCH SUCCESSFUL ROLL OF BALL
250
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Function Circuit
N.B. It is imI
The circuit is designed to reinforce the functional skills that may be required at home. The activities are performed at a steady pace.
DESCRIPTION
TASK
t
1. SITTiNG AND RISING MOVING FRO'll TO STOOL ON
u2 u u3 u ..m----""----_.-.+-___m_ __ [,
ALL
FOUR? OVER OBSTACLE TO STAND AT WALL BARS AND RETURN
../ ~ \...~.b.!. ~
.-------.e
! :
:.
iF i!;./1, ~
,-J""':':::"
31 ROLU.i'JG PRONE TO F.F;OM SUPINE
.
..
I
,
4rpUSHlNG LOADED WJ.lELCrlA.lR OR TROLLEY OVER MEASURED DISTANCE OR AROUND OBSTACLE, . _
CliMBIN~-;;-t-
SEAT WITH BACK TO' STAIRS-AND RETURN ! 1t, SAME POSITION I I.
~
W!H\ CARE
CNER RUBBER MATS OR UNEVEN SOFT SURFACES
815TEPPi~;G--UP
AND
n
I
"".
If~1DAREA·B'~
21 PV3HING lOll, ~
TROLLEY BETWEI TWO POINTS-ttl TURNiNG
FILLED WITH BlOC TO CHEST I-jEIGI FROM 'A' TO '8' I THEN 'B' TO 'A'
CLIMBING UP WE
SECURED u:DDE AND RETURN
51 LIFTING PIT W LONG LOG
I
~
~
COUNT EACH SINGLE ' STAIR NEGOTIATED . !
TOTAL BEAN BAGS .},) BUCKET
-----+-A.'J-f)-D-l-A-p.::-O-R--.-..r
I · · · - - - .....
-
FUi
MEDiCINE BALLS IJ,j AREA A, THEN BAI
DISTANCE TRAVEuED
if.
a
1~HOYELLING
4~
J. •
.l
.
,
BE~---
:~:i~;::D
71 WALKiNG
COUNT ('HANGt:SPOSITION '
. ,OTAl OBSTACLES NEGOTIATED HiT OP
~
DESCRIPTK
31 STACKiNG MIUC(]
!~.
I
6[PICKING UP
COUNT EACH l.AP
h···· . ,..
LYING
5rs;IR
COUNT NUMBER OF STOOL CHANGES
rr===i1
fF11
I
2ICRAvvUr\G
SCORING
Ii ,r.rl
c3TEPS
Fig, 222c. Function Circuit.
UNDER 2ND, STEP OVER 3M, AND CLIMBING ntRO m"hH_ _ __
71 CARRY LARGE REINFORCED m; AND DRAG
Cc..~~w
--;J /J ~I~~~:'EROR ~
61 ROLLING UNDER 1 HURDLE, CRAWUI
LINEN FROM '1-\' 1 'B', LOWER 1'0 Fl
-:;, i c,r TI1 ,t;~~ T';;AV·~"\~,;=n
b
FLOOR TO 5fPtJLJ 3URMOUNTI/IIG ' OBSTACLES-AN> III
BPC~
FflON'I 'f,' TO 'A'
81 ROLLI~~ OIL-; SINGlf
BARREL,FILLED II' SAND, UP pUGH' INCLlNE-THEN !) AND RETURN
tAPY
Iit
Pre-worl< Circuit
:e the
N.B. It is important to indicate and mark clearly weight of articles to be lifted.
functional fie. The activities Iv pace.
SCORING
I! I
I ;
1 SHOVELLING
RUBBER MEDICINE BALLS INTO AREA A, THEN BACK INTO AREA '5' -QUICK LY
3 STACKING MILK CRATES FILLED WITf1 BRICKS TO CHEST HEIGHT FROM 'A' TO 'B' THEN 'B' TO 'A'
,
4
: TOTAL OBSTACLES ! NEGOTIATED, HiT OP 'DISTANCE TRAVELLED
A.
D
-
-
§b
,, ; TOTAL BEAN BAGS :, IN BUCKET
! Xli) LAPS OR ",=" :::.sTA>'CE -:-;::':'VClLED
-,b
-~-------
::.J'J~~~
; EACt-l liME . : - ;'EET ARE =:::~
: TOGEThER ,OR SINGLE
; ",,:CPS
6
TOTAL LAPS OR DISTAI'-!CE - - . . TRAVELLED
n
ROLLING UNDER 1ST HURDLE, CRAWLING UNDER 2ND, STEPPING OVER 3,,0, AND CLIMBING THROUGH
COUNT HAZARDS
't-'-I i
REINFORCED OF 7 ~~~R'f LARGE LINEN FROM 'A' TO 8(:¥3
! COMPLETED
COUNT LIFTS AND DRAGS
-
'6', LOWER TO FLOOR
~~g~~ .fo~~WARDS b ~ a b
8 ROLLING OIL DRU~-~ BARREL,FILLED WITH SAND, UP SLIGHT INCLINE-Tf1EN DOWN AND RETURN
TOTAL CRATES STACKED
COUNT ASCENDS PND DESCENDS
CLIMBING UP WELL SECURED LADDER AND RETURN
FLOOR TO SIiOULDER SURMOUNTING OBSTACLES-AND RETURN
, CooNT EACH SINGLE , STAIR NEGOTIATED
L
a
5 LIFTING PIT PROP OR LONG LOG FROM
E
TOTAL LAPS
TURNING
/ : COUNT POSITION ! CHANGES !
b
TROLLEY BETWEEN
TWO POINTS AND
,
,,
COUNT BALLS SHOVELLED
2 PLBHING LOW, LOADED
, COUNT EACH LAP
~
SCORE
TASK
DESCRIPTION
COUNT NUMBER OF ! STOOL Cf1ANGES i
"
251
PROGRESSIVE CIRCUIT TRAINING
-
a
a
--~oi--'--
c=-
,
i TOTc\l
-
__
b
Fig, 222d, Pre-work Circuit.
" ,UPS
AND COv\INS
252
p.
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
works as quickly as possible and then moves on to another exercise station. In this way he completes all the set work for the full circuit of exercises. At the end ofthe first circuit lap the performer has a short rest. The second and third circuit laps are performed in a similar manner to the first. At the third and final lap the performer is working at maximum capacity. Fixing the Repetition Dose. The repetition level or dose of each exercise in the circuit must be established for each performer. A useful method of fixing the dose is to time the maximum number of repetitions achieved by the performer at each activity over a period of 1 minute (with only brief rest intervals being allowed between the various activities). The scores recorded in this way are halved and these become the performer's training doses. The performer's time for three laps at his training doses or levels is recorded. He aims at attempting to reduce this time before re-testing takes place.
TASK 6
Sit up - Chest pass ball to bounce off wallCatch - Lie down
(". ( / - - - .. --G-----~ /\ ..,J
e-.('-'\, "
I
Fig. 223. A numbered circuit guide board. The boards are placed alongside the activity stations and are used to record the scores for individual circuit tasks.
Scoring. The score for individual circuit tasks can be recorded on the circuit guide boards (Fig. 223). A number of different methods of scoring is used. Some examples are given here. 1. Count the number of repetitions performed at an individual task in a set time. Then, taking the lap as a whole, total up all the repetitions performed. This procedure is followed for the three laps.
2. Allocate a set numt time taken to complete tI up all the times. This pi 3. If the performer hi recorded in (a) time tab and measured, and (c) D1I 4. When a pair of pe score totals may be adda followed. This method 01 work together at a circui 5. If a skill element is from the viewpoint of me the number of baskets so to score a number of bal
SETTING STANDAII
Circuit activities must b well within the physical sometimes overlooked. The individual tasks " and physical effort requ the instructor must pert gauge the individual ani In organizing circuits physical ability a simple, colours, is sometimes Circuit (more advanced vities). This colour codD reference to a particular for easy recognition 01 individual performers. Circuit training in ~ performer. Before talciJI completion of a strenuc walking or gentle jOggD after effort. /
METHOD OF TIMfI'I
Accurate timing of a em the instructor. Altemal (positioned so that it CI
HERAPY
I
to another exercise station. In
. full circuit of exercises.
11:1' bas
a short rest. The second Iar manner to the first. At the I maximum capacity. :veJ or dose of each exercise in nero A useful method of fixing f repetitions achieved by the minute (with only brief rest :rivities). The scores recorded lerf'ormer's training doses. is training doses or levels is is time before re-testing takes
6
.s ball to
all
DWn
-----~
are placed alongside the s fOl' individual circuit tasks.
10lUd5
~ can be recorded on the ift'erent methods of scoring is
d at an individual task in a set III the repetitions performed.
PROGRESSIVE CIRCUIT TRAINING
253
2. Allocate a set number of repetitions at each exercise station. Check the time taken to complete the activity. When the first circuit is completed total up all the times. This procedure is followed for the three laps. 3. If the performer has a task involving moving over a distance it can be recorded in (a) time taken to complete distance, (b) actual distance covered and measured, and (c) number of laps completed between the two set points. 4. When a pair of performers work at some tasks separately, individual score totals may be added together. If sharing one task the same procedure is followed. This method of scoring can also be used when a team of performers work together at a circuit. 5. If a skill element is included in the circuit the score can be considered from the viewpoint of movement or time. For example, in basketball shooting the number of baskets scored in a set tirr.e can be recorded, or the time it takes to score a number of baskets.
SETTING STANDARDS Circuit activities must be carefully selected and graduated, so that they are well within the physical capabilities of the performers; unfortunately, this is sometimes overlooked . The individual tasks vary considerably, depending on the degree of mental and physical effort required. In evaluating the performers' repetition levels the instructor must perform the activities himself, so that he can accurately gauge the individual and cumulative effort required. In organizing circuits for a group of performers with varying standards of physical ability a simple three-tier grading system, associated with distinctive colours, is sometimes used, e.g. White Circuit (simple activities), Blue Circuit (more advanced tasks), and Red Circuit (the most strenuous acti vities). This colour coding is carried through to the circuit boards, where any reference to a particular circuit is given in the appropriate colour. This makes for easy recognition of the various modifications to be undertaken by individual performers. Circuit training in any form makes strong physical demands on the performer. Before taking part it is essential to 'warm up' thoroughly. On completion of a strenuous circuit a short period should be spent in relaxed walking or gentle jogging on the spot. This provides a suitable 'run down' after effort.
METHOD OF TIMING CIRCUIT Accurate timing of a circuit can be achieved by the use of a stopwatch held by the instructor. Alternatively, a large-faced clock with second sweep hand (positioned so that it can be seen easily by the performers) can be used.
254
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Timing is best registered by a battery of three Smith-type lever-operated timing clocks, mounted on a wooden base and protected by a metal carrying handle (Fig. 224). Two of the clocks are second-elapsed timers; they are used individually to time two separate performers. The third clock (a second interval timer) is used for overall timing.
Fig. 224. Timing is best registered by a battery of three lever-operated timing clocks. Two of the clocks are second-elapsed timers. The third clock is a second interval timer.
It is a useful practice for the instructor to indicate verbally the progress of time at intervals while the circuit is being worked. When the speed of the activity is relatively slow, repetition counting can be done by the performers. If the pace is fast and demanding, however, it is best for a non-performer to carry out this function.
INTRODUCING THE CIRCUIT When a circuit has been devised and levels of performance set, the performers should tryout the exercise tasks in their own time. This, coupled with good coaching, should develop correct technique of performance--not to be lost when working under pressure. A numbered circuit guide board (Fig. 223), painted matt black with simple diagrams and exercise instructions, is placed alongside each activity station. The direction taken by the performers round the circuit can be indicated by a series of large arrows chalked on the floor. After a session of circuit training it is extremely useful to encourage the performers to give their opinion on the effectiveness of the lay-out and range of activities used.
2. Allowing the cit preference. 3. Changing the ! stituting Press 1 4. Varying the app Press machine.i 5. Allowing the tiD period to each Cl 6. Arranging for repetitions wbill 7. Beat the score. achieved on the· the task endeavc 8. Splitting the ciJ groups-work e: 9. Adding a skill III scoring.
EQUIPMENT
Most conventional gy bars, climbing ft'llIIle and mats. Weight n: calf-machines, squat gym' (which indudt extremely useful. Small equipment 1 weights, basketballs. A wide selection oj crates, barrels, oil dI different sizes, ladde
CLOTHING
The type of clothin employed. StrenuoUl shirts, shorts and gyJ protection for knees Ideally, pre-work act the particular occupl
VARIATIONS OF CIRCUIT TRAINING Some of the most useful practical variations include: 1. Rearranging the circuit tasks in a different order.
REFERENCE
Morgan R. E. and Ada
rBERAPY
aree Smith-type lever-operated I protected by a metal carrying d-elapsed timers; they are used So The third clock (a second-
ci I:Iu= lever-operated timing is a second
~ The third clock
ldicate verbally the progress of orked. When the speed of the ;::an be done by the performers. . is best for a non-performer to
crformance set, the performers lime. This, coupled with good l pcrfonnance--not to be lost
(lllinted matt black with simple Ikmgside each activity station. lie circuit can be indicated by a
:mely useful to encourage the atess of the lay-out and range
Jdude: order.
III
PROGRESSIVE CIRCUIT TRAINING
255
2. Allowing the circuit tasks to be selected by the performers in order of preference. 3. Changing the starting positions of some of the exercises, e.g. sub stituting Press Ups for Bench Pressing. 4. Varying the apparatus while maintaining the same effect, e.g. using Leg Press machine in place of Squats with Weights. 5. Allowing the timing of the circuit to be one of the tasks: this gives a rest period to each of the performers. 6. Arranging for the performers to work in pairs. One counts the repetitions while the other works: the roles are then reversed. 7. Beat the score. On concluding a task the performer chalks the score achieved on the floor and initials it. The next performer who attempts the task endeavours to exceed this score, and so on. S. Splitting the circuit into two sections and the performers into two groups-work each section separately and then change. 9. Adding a skill task, such as basketball shooting: points are included for scoring.
EQUIPMENT Most conventional gymnastic equipment can be used for circuit training: wall bars, climbing frames, balance benches, paranel bars, stools, climbing ropes and mats. Weight resistance apparatus is also used: barbells, dumb-bells, calf-machines, squat stands and leg press machines. The all-purpose 'multi gym' (which includes a selection of weight training equipment) is also extremely useful. Small equipment can be usefully employed: medicine balls of different weights, basketballs, footballs, bean bags, hoops and ash poles. A wide selection of equipment for functional circuits is required: wooden crates, barrels, oil drums, scaffolding and planking, wheelbarrows, tyres of different sizes, ladders, chains, bricks and shovels.
CLOTHING The type of clothing required will depend on the nature of the circuit employed. Strenuous work needs the minimum of clothing: sleeveless T shirts, shor~ and gym shoes. Functional activities are best carried out with protection for knees and elbows, and a light track suit is recommended. Ideally, pre-work activities need to be performed in the protective clothing of the particular occupation simulated.
REFERENCE Morgan R. E. and Adamson G. T. (1961) Circuit Training, 2nd ed. London, Bell.
STEREO EQUIP
24. Exercises to music
..;:,.
In many rehabilitation centres and health clubs morning and afternoon treatment sessions start with a 20-30 minute period of 'warming-up' exercises to music. This provides a lively start to the sessions and presents general exercises in a stimulating and acceptable form. In hospital practice there is rarely time to give properly organized periods of general exercises and this aspect of treatment tends to be neglected. The difficulty can be overcome to some extent by arranging a 5 or 6 minute period of general 'warming-up' exercises to recorded music before the specific exercise period.
STARTING POSITIONS In general, standing and sitting are the best starting positions to use fo!" 'warming-up' exercises; they allow patients to observe the instructor without difficulty. The lying position can be used but coaching and change of exercise are made more difficult. In organizing a class of patients with mixed disabilities it is best for the more able patients to stand and the more disabled to exercise in sitting. The leader, facing the class, performs the movements in time to the music and the class follows his lead. Ideally, there should be no break between individual exercises, and the movements should flow as naturally as possible into each other. To provide an overall balance of activity, and prevent undue fatigue, the instructor should not dwell too long on anyone exercise.
SEQUENCE OF EXERCISES The warming-up programme is arranged in such a way that all parts of the body are exercised in turn. To achieve variety of movement and avoid fatigue of anyone muscle group it is helpful to start with the upper aspect of the body and progress downwards, and then repeat this sequence with different exercises, as indicated in the specimen tables (p. 258). 256
Essential equipmCll taking long and sin For normal class' with the bass vollDll to hear the leader's It is not easy to s the various class me of the movements. used, ranging from instrumental and VI
MUSIC FOR M(]
No attempt has b numbers,ofparticu life and quickly bee suggest the names interpretations haVl Recordings mad! Alpert and his TijUl and his Orchestra, Orchestra. Certain piano ~ interpretations by (
WIDENING INTI
Simple equipment, to great advantage il which form the em partner activities pc facing in walk forwl moving backwards bouncing between I Singing while UK participation in the other occasions it is keep this form of e: disrupt the class aD
EXERCISES TO MUSIC
Ie
morning and afternoon period of 'warming-up' I the sessions and presents form. properly organized periods rends to be neglected. The aing a 5 or 6 minute period music before the specific
IS
uting positions to use fo!"
ave the instructor without
bing and change of exercise
lisabilities it is best for the I to exercise in sitting. The D time to the music and the , break between individual orally as possible into each
prevent undue fatigue, the exercise.
a way that all parts of the oovement and avoid fatigue be upper aspect of the body s sequence with different 258). I
257
STEREO EQUIPMENT AND MUSIC Essential equipment consists of a good, well-sprung record deck capable of taking long and single play records, plus amplifier and two speaker units. For normal class work the volume output should be set at a reasonable level with the bass volume gently obvious. It should be possible for class members to hear the leader's instructions without difficulty. It is not easy to select music which is acceptable to the individual taste of the various class members and which at the same time matches the character of the movements. To overcome this problem a wide selection of music is used, ranging from classical to 'pop', and including synthesized music. Both instrumental and vocal recordings are used.
MUSIC FOR MOVEMENT No attempt has been made to list individual records, with their serial numbers, of particular types of music. Popular records have a relatively short life and quickly become unobtainable. It has been considered more useful to suggest the names of individual band leaders and groups whose music or interpretations have been found of value in matching music to movement. Recordings made by the following artistes are extremely useful: Herb Alpert and his Tijuana Brass, Bert Kaempfert and his Orchestra, Geoff Love and his Orchestra, Kenny Ball and his Jazzmen, and James Last and his Orchestra. Certain piano pieces played in strict tempo are also of value, e.g. interpretations by Charlie Kunz and recordings of Scott Joplin's works.
WIDENING INTEREST Simple equipment, such as sticks, balls, hoops and dumb-bells, can be used to great advantage in widening the interest and scope of some of the activities which form the exercise tables. Equipment of this sort also lends itself to partner activities performed in time to the music. For example, (a) partners facing in walk forwards standing, and grasping ends of sticks, alternate Arm moving backwards and forwards (rhythmical 'piston' action), and (b) ball bouncing between partners facing each other. Singing while moving to music is another way of increasing the patients' participation in the exercise programme. This can occur spontaneously; on other occasions it is initiated by the instructor. At all times it is essential to keep this form of expression under control. If overdone, singing can easily disrupt the class and undermine the authority of the instructor.
258
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
OTHER USES OF MUSIC Certain functional activities, such as crawling, stair climbing, alternate sitting and standing, can be carried out rhythmically to music with considerable advantage. In gait training and walking re-education music can also be used, either as a background to the activity or to emphasize certain aspects of the walking pattern, e.g. heel strike, push off from rear foot, and spacing of stride.
SPECIMEN TABLES 1. General Warming-up Table in Standing Music: 'Eye Level' (Simon Park)-single disc Playing time: 2 min 18 sec.
Suggested repetitions
1. Stride-standing; alternate Shoulder raising and
depressing.
2. Stride-standing; alternate Arm punching forwards. 3. Stride-standing; Trunk bending loosely from
side to side.
4. Standing; alternate high Knee raising. 5. Standing; Heel raising.
16
6. Stride-standing; Head turning from side to side. 7. Stride-standing; Shoulder-girdle circling with
emphasis on backward movement.
8. Stride-standing; alternate Arm punching with
Trunk turning from side to side.
9. Stride-standing; rhythmical Trunk bending from
side to side with alternate Arm swinging
sideways-upwards over the head.
10. Standing; assuming Squat position (90' bend at knees).
8 12
II. Stride-standing; Head bending from side to side. 12. Bend (fingers resting on chest) stride-standing; wide Elbow circling with emphasis on backward movement. 13. Fist bend stride-standing; Trunk bending sideways (to left) with Arm stretching, and return to starting position, and repeat to right. 14. Standing; rhythmical lunging forwards: (al left Leg forwards, (b) right Leg forwards
8 8
8 8 8 8
8 8
8
The patients use cb sound sitting postun Music: 'Rags and Tam Playing time: 2 min 52
1. Sitting; Head bend 2. Sitting; Shoulder r. (,flopping'). 3. Sitting (hands resti emphasizing expinl with pressure from 4. Stride sitting; Tl'1II with loose Arm swi 5. Sitting; alternate F (marching in sittinj
6. Sitting; Head cirdi 7. Sitting; Shoulder II 8. Sitting; rhythmical with cupped hands 9. Stride sitting; Tru 10. Sitting; Knee streU
II. Sitting; Head bend (emphasis on mow: 12. Bend (fingers restil: alternate Elbow em 13. Sitting; Arm raisiDJ the fingers overhe8 14. Stride sitting; Tl'1II to lax stoop positia 15. Sitting; rhythmical position) and renm
8
12
2. General Warming-up Table in Sitting for Chronic Chest Conditions The exercises are arranged for use in the treatment of ambulatory patients suffering from such conditions as bronchitis, emphysema and bronchiectasis.
MUSIC AND MO-' MENTALLY HAN
For some of the me centres regular ses.si provide an excellenl complete change of a these activities are tI: In general, a fairl! music and movemem
L stair climbing, alternate sitting ally to music with considerable ducation music can also be used, emphasize certain aspects of the D rear foot, and spacing of stride.
diDg Suggested repetitions
ad
-ros.
8 8
8
Imm
8
8
!ilk. g; :ani
8 8
Ir:ways
8
12
• for of ambulatory patients emphysema and bronchiectasis.
atment
Music: 'Rags and Tatters' (Geoff Love)-section of LP. Playing time: 2 min 52 sec. 1. Sitting; Head bending fowards and backwards. 2. Sitting; Shoulder raising and dropping
('flopping').
3. Sitting (hands resting on sides of lower ribs);
emphasizing expiratory movements of chest
with pressure from hands,
4. Stride sitting; Trunk turning from side to side
with loose Arm swinging.
5. Sitting; alternate Foot tapping on floor
(marching in sitting).
Suggested repetitions 8 8 8
8 16
6, Sitting; Head circling. 7. Sitting; Shoulder girdle rounding and bracing. 8. Sitting; rhythmical self-percussion of chest
with cupped hands.
9. Stride sitting; Trunk rolling. 10. Sitting; Knee stretching and bending.
8 8
16 8 8
8 12
II
,
The patients use chairs without arms or gymnasium stools which allow a
sound sitting posture.
16
8 8
ide. II
259
EXERCISES TO MUSIC
: TIlERAPY
11. Sitting; Head bending backwards (emphasis on movement of 'looking up'). 12. Bend (fingers resting on chest) sitting; alternate Elbow circling backwards. 13. Sitting; Arm raising sideways-upwards to touch the fingers overhead. 14. Stride sitting; Trunk dropping loosely forwards to lax stoop position, and 'uncurling'. 15. Sitting; rhythmical Leg parting (wide astride position) and returning to starting position.
8 8 8 8 12
MUSIC AND MOVEMENT FOR THE MENTALLY HANDICAPPED For some of the mentally handicapped living in hospital or attending day centres regular sessions of music and movement and game-form activities provide an excellent method of improving physical fitness and giving a complete change of activity. The three groups that benefit particularly from these activities are the profoundly, severely and moderately handicapped. In general, a fairly high staff/patient ratio is needed. Practical details of music and movement programmes for the mentally handicapped, together
260
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
with organizational procedures, are given in the 3rd edition of Progressive Exercise Therapy (1975).
REFERENCE
APPENDIX 1
Starting
pO~
Colson J. H. C. (1975) Progressive Exercise Therapy in Rehabilitation and Physical Education, 3rd ed. Bristol, Wright.
Two types of starting po Positions. The fundamc lying and hanging. The from the fundamental p trunk.
FUNDAMENTAL
P(]
Standing (st.) The be looking forwards. The s easily by the sides with p fingers relaxed. The knc with heels and inner bo legs (not so functionally the same line with the to feet should not exceed 4 There should be no $I Siuing (silt.) The pal height, and width of seal the hips and knees flexed on the floor, toes facing standing. Kneeling (kn.) As stan which are slightly apan position is taken on the plantar flexed; if taken ( edge (a more comfortabl Lying (iy.) The body j together, with the toes}: relaxed. The palms of exercise therapy the pos When lying is used as, palms of the hands usw generally supported by a
APY
3Td edition of Progressive
APPENDIX 1
Starting positions
• Rehabilitation and Physical
,
Two types of starting positions are used: Fundamental Positions and Derived Positions. The fundamental positions consist of standing, sitting, kneeling, lying and hanging. The derived positions are numerous and are obtained from the fundamental positions by altering the position of the arms, legs or trunk.
FUNDAMENTAL POSITIONS Standing (st.) The body is held erect with the chin level and the eyes looking forwards. The shoulders are down and slightly back; the arms hang easily by the sides with palms of the hands facing the outer sides of the thighs: fingers relaxed. The knees are straight and the feet point straight forwards, with heels and inner borders slightly apart. An alternative position for the legs (not so functionally sound) consists of having the heels together and on the same line with the toes pointing slightly outwards. The angle between the feet should not exceed 45~. There should be no suggestion of strain or rigidity about the position. Sitting (silt.) The position is taken on a gymnasium stool or chair. The height, and width of seat, should allow the thighs to be fully supported, with the hips and knees flexed to 90 . The knees are slightly apart and the feet rest on the floor, toes facing forwards. The rest of the body should be held as in standing. Kneeling ( kn.) As standing, but the body-weight is supported on the knees, which are slightly apart (to increase the size of the base) or together. If the position is taken on the floor the lower legs are supported with the ankles plantar flexed; if taken on a thick mattress or plinth, with the feet over the edge (a more comfortable position), the ankles are in mid-position. Lying (ly.) The body is fully supported in the supine position. The feet are together, with the toes pointing upwards, and the arms by the sides: fingers relaxed. The palms of the hands face the outer sides of the thighs. For exercise therapy the position is generally taken on a firm surface. When lying is used as a starting position for various forms of movement the palms of the hands usually rest on the supporting surface. The head is also generally supported by a pillow when the position is used in the treatment of 261
\
262
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
patients confined to bed. The exception to this is when head and neck and certain trunk exercises are performed. Hanging (hg.) The body hangs from a horizontal beam or bar with the feet off the floor. The position ofthe hands varies with the type of hanging, but in over-grasp hanging (the most common type) they are pronated and at least shoulder-width apart. The body hangs at full length between the arms, which are straight, with the head held erect. The legs hang loosely with the feet together, ankles plantar flexed.
POSITIONS DERIVED FROM STANDING a. By Altering Position of Arms Wing standing
wg. st.
Bend standing
bd. st.
Finger-tips are placed well back on shoulders, with elbow joints flexed, shoulder joints rotated laterally, and upper arms vertical and close to trunk.
Fist bend standing
Fist bd. st.
A similar position to the previous one, but the hands are clenched, the wrists are straight, and the arms are not kept so closely to the sides. (Fig. 225.)
Across bend standing
acr. bd. st.
Arms are held sideways at shoulder level, with elbows fully flexed, wrists and fingers straight, and palms facing downwards.
Neck rest standing
N. rst. st.
Arms are held sideways in line with trunk, with shoulder joints laterally rotated and elbow joints flexed, so that fingers are placed behind the neck at junction of head and neck. Palms face forwards; tips of fingers touch each other; wrist and fingers are straight.
Hands rest on iliac crests, with fingers pointing forwards and thumbs behind. The shoulders are dropped and the elbows kept in line with the trunk.
Head rest standing
H. rst. st.
Forehead rest standing
Frh. rst. st.
Lumbar rest standing Heave standing
Lmb. rst. st.
As neck rest, but shoulder joints are rotated medially and hands are placed behind lumbar spine, palms facing backwards.
hv. st.
Upper arms are held sideways at shoulder level, with elbow joints flexed to 90°; palms face inwards.
A. X st.
Forearms are crossed loosely in front of chest at approximately right angles to the upper' arms. Hands make contact with the upper arms. See Fig. 56, p. 64.
Arm cross standing
Similar to previous position, but hands are placed on top of the head, with palms facing downwards. As neck rest, but hands are placed on forehead with the palms facing forwards.
Low arm cross standing Drag standing
IowA
drags
Reach standing
rch. 51
Low reach standing
lown:
High reach standing Forearm reach standing
high
Yard standing
11
FOrelll rch.51 yd. st.
Low yard standing
low yll
High yard standing Stretch standing
high Y'
uTu Fig. 225.
str. 5L
---= Fig. "
Modification of Hand ,
One or both hands ~ and upper part of the I the body is lowered 3DI from side to side, and (6 Knee bending. When one arm is c position, e.g. Half ylm position, e.g. Half will! In addition to the p further by (a) Changin standing; (b) Relaxing hands, e.g. Stretch c~
• is when head and neck and
beam or bar with the feet th the type of hanging, but in iley are pronated and at least 19lh between the arms, which :s hang loosely with the feet
[Ita)
NG
iJiaI;: crests, with fingers
ids and Ihumbs behind. The rropped and the elbows kept , trunk. placed well back on shoulders, 115 flexed, shoulder joints and upper arms vertical and
r.
... to Ihe previous one, but the :bed, Ihe wrists are straight, and Il kept so closely to the sides.
Low arm cross standing Drag standing
IowA. X st. drag st.
Reach standing
reh.
Low reach standing
low rch.
High reach standing Forearm reach standing Yard standing
high rch. st.
Low yard standing
low yd. st.
High yard standing Stretch standing
high yd. st.
S1.
S1.
Forearm reh. st. yd. st.
str. st.
The arms hang loosely in from of, and close to, the body with wrists crossed. The arms are raised backwards as far as possible, with elbow, wrist and fingers straight, and palms facing inwards. The arms are held parallel with each other in from of the body at shoulder level, with palms facing each other. The elbows, wrists and fingers are straight, and the shoulders kept down. (Fig. 226.) As previous position, but the arms are held midway between reach position and the normal position by the sides of Ihe body. As reach position, but the arms are held midway between reach and stretch positions. The elbow joints are flexed to 90 with palms facing each other. (Fig. 227.) The arms are held sideways at shoulder level, with palms facing downwards. The elbows, wrists and fingers are straight. (Fig. 228.) As previous position, but arms are held midway between the yard position and the normal position by the sides of the body. As yard position, but Ihe arms are held midway between yard and stretch positions. The arms, shoulder-width apart, are stretched vertically above the head with palms facing each other. (Fig. 229.) 0
,
lideways at shoulder level, with
sed, wrists and fingers straight,
lIB downwards. sideways in line with trunk, joims laterally rotated and :Rd, so !hat fingers are placed k III junction of head and neck. ards; tips of fingers touch each 1I:6ngers are straight. Pious position, but hands are 1'11: the head, with palms facing _ hands are placed on forehead facing forwards.
_ shoulder joints are rotated
~ are placed behind lumbar
lCiog backwards.
c beld sideways at shoulder
.. joints flexed to 90°; palms
rossed loosely in front of chest
Iy right angles to the upper'
like contact wilh the upper 56, p. 64.
263
STARTING POSITIONS
lERAPY
Fig. 225.
Fig. 226.
.~
---',-
Fig. 227.
Fig. 228.
Fig. 229.
Modification of Hand Position
One or both hands may be used to grasp apparatus, so as to fix the shoulders and upper part of the body, or to give assistance to leg movements in which the body is lowered and raised, e.g. (a) Low grasp sitting (chair); Head bending from side to side, and (b) Low reach grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raisirlg and Knee bending. When one arm is employed the prefix 'half' is placed before the arm position, e.g. Half yard grasp. The free arm is often placed in some suitable position, e.g. Half wing half yard grasp standing (wall bars); Heel raising . In addition to the previous modifications arm positions may be modified further by (a) Changing the position of the palms, e.g. Yard fpalmsforward) standing; (b) Relaxing the arms, e.g. Lax yard standing, and (c) Joining the hands, e.g. Stretch clasp standing.
264
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
b. By Altering Position of Trunk Stoop standing
stp. st.
The trunk is inclined forwards from the hip joints with the spine kept straight. The movement is generally taken as far as the length of the hamstring muscles allows. The hips are inclined backwards by plantar flexion at ankle joints, so that balance of body is maintained.
Lax stoop standing
lax stp. st.
The spine and hip joints are flexed in a completely relaxed manner. The arms hang loosely downwards, and the hips are inclined backwards as in stoop standing.
Lax stoop back lean standing
lax stp. B. lean st.
As previous position, but with heels about 30-38 cm in front of a wall or wall bar upright, and the coccyx region in contact with it. The position is used for trunk uncurling 'vertebra by vertebra'. See Fig. 82, p. 82.
Knee bend standing (squat)
K. bd. st.
Knee full bend standing (full squat)
K. full bd. st.
Instep support standing
Ins. sup.
Fixed standing
fix. st.
"
51
c. By Altering Position of Legs Half standing
!
Balance standing
bal. st.
Balance half standing
bal.
t st.
As previous position, but standing on one leg. The foot of the free leg hangs down by the side of the beam or rib. (Fig. 231.)
Balance across standing
bal. acr. st.
Close standing
cl. st.
Standing on beam or rib of balance bench with feet close together and at right angles to supporting surface. (Fig. 232.) Standing with the feet pointing forwards and inner borders touching.
Stride standing
std. st.
Wide stride standing Walk forwards standing
wd. std. st.
Toe standing
Toe st.
st.
Standing with the weight of the body on one leg. The other leg is either free or supported by apparatus, e.g. Foot support side towards standing (wall bars).
wlk. f. st.
Standing on beam or rib of balance bench with one foot behind the other, body facing lengthwise. (Fig. 230.)
Standing with feet astride, a distance of 2 foot lengths between heels. The feet point out wards at an angle, due to the lateral rotation associated with abduction of the hip joints. As previous position, but a distance of 3 foot lengths between heels. One leg is moved directly forwards, so that there is a distance of 2 foot-lengths between the heels. See Fig. 172, p. 143. Standing on the toes, with ankle joints plantar flexed.
Fig. 230.
j Fig. 233.
Fig. 23
Foot support standing
F. sup. st.
265
STARTING POSITIONS
wards from the hip : straight. The ten as far as the nuscles allows. The m by plantar flexion lance of body is are flexed in a
er. The arms hang
he hips are inclined oding.
with heels about III or wall bar upright, OOIlt3ct with it. The . uncurling 'vertebra p.82.
Knee bend standing
(squat)
K. bd. st.
Standing on the toes with ankle joints plantar flexed and knees flexed to 90 . If feet are pointed forwards in standing position the knees are carried straight forwards over toes. If heels are together and feet pointed outwards in starting position the knees are turned outwards over the toes.
Knee full bend standing (full squat)
K. full bd. st.
As previous position, but knees are fully flexed. (Fig. 233.)
Instep support standing
Ins. sup. st.
Standing on one leg with dorsal surface of foot of other leg supported on stool, so that the knee joint is flexed to about 90 . The thigh is usually carried a little behind the body. The position is used for single knee bending exercises. (Fig. 234.)
Fixed standing
fix. st.
Standing with the body either facing wall bars or sideways on to the bars, with one leg raised so that the foot is fixed between the bars, with ankle joint dorsiflexed, so that the foot acts as a hook. The knee joint of fixed leg is kept extended (Fig. 235).
t of the
body on one free or supported wpport side towards
0'
of balance bench with ~. body facing
[ standing on one leg. IJangs down by the [Fig. 231.) Fig. 230.
of balance bench with [ right angles to 232.) riIlting forwards and
Fig. 231.
a distance of 2 foot be feet point out ~the lateral rotation l of the hip joints. : a distance of 3 foot
I:,
Fig. 233.
, forwards, so that «-lengths between ,_ 143. b ankle joints plantar
Fig. 234.
Foot support standing
F. sup. 8t.
a
Fig. 235.
b
As previous position, but foot of raised leg is supported on a wall bar or the top of a balance bench.
266
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Thigh support standing
Thigh sup, st,
One or both thighs are supported by the beam, which is usually placed midway between the knee and hip joints. Both thighs are supported if the patient faces the apparatus; one thigh is supported if he is sideways on to the apparatus. See Fig. 113, p. 94.
d. By Altering Position of Trunk and Legs Fallout forwards standing
fallout f. st.
One leg is moved forwards to a distance of about 3 foot-lengths, and the knee is bent to about 90 over the toes. The rear leg is straight and the trunk is inclined forwards in line with it. Foot of straight leg is kept in contact with floor. See Fig. 77, p. 77. N.B. The position may be taken with the thigh and buttock of forward leg supported across a gymnasium stool (fallout sitting). The toes of the rear foot rest on floor, with ankle joint plantar flexed. As previous position but the foot of the forward leg is either moved obliquely forwards-outwards or directly sideways, C
Fallout outwards (or sideways) standing
fallout o. (or s.) st.
Lunging. When the trunk is kept erect in fallout positions it is usual to employ the term 'lunge', e.g. lunge forwards standing. It shOUld be noted that in some gymnastic textbooks 'lunge' is used instead of 'fallout', which can be confusing.
High ride sitting Crook sitting
big
sin crk
Cross sitting
Xl
Long sitting
~
Inclined long sitting
inc
,
siD ~
Long sitting (Trunk inclined backwards with Hand support)
(T. w.
Side sitting
S.
POSITIONS DERIVED FROM SITTING a. By Altering Position of Arms As in standing.
c. By Altering P4I
b. By Altering Position of Legs
Stoop sitting
sql
Lax stoop sitting
l3lII sill
Stride sitting
std. sitt.
Half sitting
'2 sm.
Ride sitting
ride sitt.
I
•
The feet and knees are placed apart, so that there is a distance of about 1 foot-length between the heels. The knees are flexed to 90 ~ and the feet point obliquely outwards in line with the legs. Sitting on apparatus, such as a plinth or high bench, with the buttock and thigh of one leg supported; the other leg is free. The position is used to allow a patient with a fixed or stiff hip joint to sit reasonably comfortably. He takes weight on his sound side and places the free limb in whatever posture is required to compensate for the fixed position of the hip. Sitting astride apparatus, such as a chair or balance bench. The legs grip the apparatus if a very steady position is required.
POSITIONS DEI a. By Altering P4 As in standing.
py
STARTING POSITIONS
are supported by the beam, ICed midway between the · Both thighs are supported the apparatus; one thigh is idcways on to the 113, p. 94.
X'WlII'ds to a distance of s,. and the knee is bent to IDeS. The rear leg is . . is inclined forwards in r straight leg is kept in see Fig. 77, p. 77. ID3Y be taken with the f forward leg supported I srool (fallout sitting). The rest on floor, with ankle
l but the foot of the · moved obliquely .. directly
t
positions it is usual to
High ride sitting Crook sitting
high ride
sitt.
crk sitt.
Cross sitting
X sitt.
Long sitting
19. sitt.
Inclined long sitting
incl.lg. sitt.
Long sitting (Trunk inclined backwards with Hand support)
19. sitt. (T. incl. b. w. Hnd. sup.)
Side sitting
S. sitt.
1Dding. It should be noted
II instead of 'fallout', which
As previous position, but taken on a high plinth; the thighs are usually strapped down. Sitting on the floor with knees flexed to about 90 , and the soles of the feet resting on the floor. The knees may be together, without actually touching, or slightly apart. See Fig. 48, p.61. Similar to crook sitting, but ankles are crossed and hips abducted and laterally rotated, so that outer aspect of each knee approaches the floor. See Fig. 49, p. 61. Sitting on the floor with the legs straight, fully supported, and the same distance apart as in standing. The trunk is held erect, with hip joints flexed to about 90 0, and ankle joints plantar flexed to a comfortable degree. The long sitting position is taken on apparatus, such as a balance bench or stool, with heels resting on the floor. A widely used position for certain types of leg exercises, e.g. Quadriceps contractions and single Leg raising. Seldom described in textbooks of gymnastics, probably because of the lengthy description. See Fig. 32a, p. 48. Sitting on the floor on the left or right side, with both legs bent and turned in the opposite direction. The weight of the body rests chiefly on the hip which is nearer the floor. The arm of the same side is vertical and supports the trunk.
c. By Altering Position of Trunk
R placed apart, so that ·about 1 foot-length be knees are flexed to 90 ltiquely outwards in line
, such as a plinth or high
iJdr;
267
and thigh of one leg
leg is free. The position
imt with a fixed or stiff mbly oomfortably. He tIUIld side and places the · posture is required to a:d position of the hip. IUS, such as a chair or :gs grip the apparatus if a s required.
Stoop sitting
stp. sitt.
As stoop standing, but the trunk movement is limited by the apposition of the thighs and abdomen.
Lax stoop sitting
lax stp. sitt.
As lax stoop standing. (Fig. 236 shows lax stoop stride sitting.)
ff1 ~
Fig. 236.
POSITIONS DERIVED FROM KNEELING a. By Altering Position of Arm.s As in standing.
268
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
b. By Altering Position of Legs Stride kneeling Kneel sitting
Half kneeling
Leg stretch half kneeling
std. kn.
kn. sitt.
tkn.
L. str.
Hn.
The knees and feet are placed about a foot length apart. Sitting back on the heels with the trunk held erect. If a thick mattress or mat is available the position may be taken on it with the feet over the edge; this relieves the pressure on the feet and makes the position more comfortable. Kneeling on one knee with the other leg in front of the body with the foot on the floor. Hip, knee and ankle joints of forward leg are bent to 90 . Kneeling on one knee with the other leg stretched in a named direction. Thus: (a) Leg sideways stretch half kneeling. (b) Leg forwards stretch half kneeling.
c. By Altering Position of Trunk Prone kneeling
pro kn.
The trunk is horizontal and supported by the arms and thighs, which are vertical. The hip and knee joints are flexed to 90 . The correct position of spine and head is maintained. (Fig. 237.)
t-L
Fig. 237.
Leg lift lying
L.lifi
Stride lying
std.1y
Half lying
!
Crook half lying
edt.!
Prone lying
pr.1y
Leg prone lying
L. pro
Fixed high Thigh support across prone lying
fix. hi sup. I Iy.
ly.
POSITIONS DERIVED FROM LYING a. By Altering Position of Arms As in standing. b. By Altering Position of Legs Crook lying
cr.ly.
Lying with the soles of the feet resting on the floor. The knees are flexed to varying degrees, but the usual position is about 90 .
Stride crook lying
std. cr. [y.
As previous position, but the legs and feet are placed astride, with the heels about 45 em apart. The feet point obliquely outwards in line with the legs.
Crook lying with Pelvis raised
cr. ly. W. P. rais.
From crook lying position the pelvis is raised until there is a straight line between the trunk and the thighs.
Side-lying
SAy
eet are placed about a foot
!he heels with the trunk held mattress or mat is available , be taken on it with the feet lis relieves the pressure on the be position more comfortable. ~ knee with the other leg in r with the foot on the floor. IIIkle joints of forward leg are
knee with the other leg
med direction. Thus: (a) Leg 'IaIf !meeting. (b) Leg forwards iIg.
izontal and supported by the 'Which are vertical. The hip Ie flexed to 90 c. The correct and bead is maintained.
lies of the feet resting on the
.-e flexed to varying degrees,
ilion is about 90' .
OIl,
269
STARTING POSITIONS
iRAPY
Leg lift lying
L. lift Iy.
Lying with the legs raised; the range of move ment must be indicated, e.g. Vertical lift lying. The legs are kept together, with knees extended and the ankles plantar flexed.
Stride lying
std.ly.
Lying with feet astride as in stride standing.
Half lying
ily.
Crook half lying
crk.ily.
Lying on a plinth or bed with the trunk supported by a back rest or pillows in a position midway between lying and sitting upright. The legs are straight and fully supported. As half lying, but the knees are flexed and the feet rest on the plinth or bed as in crook lying.
Prone lying
pr.ly.
Lying face downwards with the body fully supported. This is an unpleasant position for the face, and so the head is generally turned to one side. Similarly, the arms are often allowed to rest on the supporting surface with the palms turned upwards instead of being held to the sides as in lying.
Leg prone lying
L. pro ly.
Fixed high Thigh support across prone lying
fix. high Th. sup. acr. pr. Iy.
Lying face down on a high plinth. or plinth, in such a manner that only the legs are supported (from the iliac crests downwards), and the trunk lies unsupported in the horizontal plane. The ankles are strapped down to the plinth. The chin is kept in and the arms are by the sides, as in the lying position. A stool is placed under the trunk, so that the hands can rest on it and support the trunk during rest periods. As prone lying, but the thighs rest across apparatus, such as a stool, or two balance benches placed one on top of the other. The feet are fixed by the wall bars or living support. The trunk, head and legs form a straight line with the chin kept in. The arms are by the sides, as in lying. (Fig. 238.) Strong extension exercises for the spine and hips are given from this position.
Side-lying
S.-Iy.
Lying on one side. The under arm is either allowed to rest loosely in front of the body, or is bent up, so that the hand supports the head. As the position is unstable, the under leg is sometimes placed a little in front of the other one. Alternatively, the under leg is flexed at the hip and knee joints.
'.
but the legs and feet are
:b the heels about 45 cm
int obliquely outwards in position the pelvis is raised light line between the trunk Fi!!. 118.
270
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
POSITIONS DERIVED FROM HANGING By Altering Position of Legs Angle hanging
ang. hg.
Fall hanging
fall hg.
Horizontal faU hanging
hor. fall hg.
Reverse hanging
rev. hg.
Prone falling Hanging with the feet resting on the floor. The hips are flexed, the knees extended and the ankles plantar flexed. The arms are straight and shoulder-width apart. (Fig. 239.) Hanging from the beam with the body obliquely forward, and the feet or heels resting on the floor. The legs and trunk should be in a straight line. The arms are generally described as being 'vertical'. In practice, however, when the position is used for arm bending exercises it is better to have the arms at right angles to the trunk. Over-grasp position for the hands is used. (Fig. 240.) As fall hanging, but the feet rest on apparatus, such as a stool, or the ankles are held by living support. In the latter case the legs are parted, the supporter holding the ankles in the same way as the handles of a wheelbarrow. Hanging with the head downwards. The position is generally taken on the wall bars.
Inclined prone falling Horizontal prone falling Side falling
inel fall.
ho£~ fall
S.1i
Inclined side falling Horizontal side falling Horizontal half standing
ind fall bar. fall
Balance hanging
bat
Front rest
fr.l
bar.
"
-i:I~~_~Fig. 239.
Fig. 240.
Grasp Positions used in Hanging Over grasp
over gr.
Under grasp
undo gr.
Alternate grasp Inward grasp
alt. gr. inw. gr.
Grasping apparatus with hands in pronated position. Grasping apparatus with hands in supinated position. Grasping apparatus with one hand supinated and the other pronated. Grasping apparatus with the palms facing inwards.
N.B. When the wall bars are used for hanging positions, it is usual to omit any reference to the grasp. Hanging (wall bars J indicates that the position is taken with the back towards the bars. Towards hanging (wall bars) is used when the body faces the bars.
~ Fig. 241.
ERAPY
271
STARTING POSITIONS
OTHER DERIVED POSITIONS Prone falling
pr. fall.
The body, which is in a straight line from head to heels (and faces the floor), rests on the hands and toes. The arms are vertical and shoulder-width apart, with elbows extended. Hands are generally turned inwards. (Fig. 241.)
Inclined prone falling Horizontal prone falling
incl. pro fall.
As previous position, but the hands are
supported on apparatus: beam, wall bars or
stool. (Fig. 242.)
hor. pro fall.
As prone falling, but the feet are supported on the beam or a stool, so that the body is in the horizontal position. See Fig. 66, p. 72. The body, kept straight, and with one side
turned towards the floor, rests on one hand
and one foot. The supporting arm is vertical
with elbow extended. See Fig. Ill, p. 93.
be feet resting on the floor. The
the knees extended and the bed. The arms are straight idth apart. (Fig. 239.) :be beam with the body ro, and the feet or heels 100£. The legs and trunk Ill'2ight line. r::oerally described as being ICtice, however, when the for arm bending exercises it is lie arms at right angles to the lip position for the hands is
Side falling
S. fall.
Inclined side falling Horizontal side falling
incl. S. fall. hor. S. fall.
Horizontal half standing
hor.
Balance
bal hg.
)
, but the feet rest on apparatus, or the ankles are held by living latter case the legs are parted, oIding the ankles in the same Ik:s of a wheelbarrow.
IiIe head downwards. The
:nlIy taken on the wall bars.
!
hanging
Front rest ~.
240.
lIS
with bands in pronated
lIS
with hands in supinated
st.
As previous position, but the supporting hand
rests on the beam or a stool.
As side falling, but the feet are supported on
the beam or a stool, so that the body is in the
horizontal position. See Fig. 115, p. 94.
Standing on one leg with the body and the
free leg in the horizontal plane. Free leg is
kept straight, in line with the trunk, with ankle
joint plantar flexed. N.B. An arched position
may be assumed.
The bod}, f3cing forwards and supported by hands and thighs, rests across the beam. The body is arched and held as near to the horizontal as possible; the legs are pressed lightly backwards. The arms are straight and parallel. (Fig. 243.)
fro rst.
A similar position to balance hanging, but the body is held in a straight line and the forward leaning is restricted to about 15 c. Apparatus such as the beam, or beam saddle on beam, may be used. (Fig. 244.)
as with one hand supinated -.ed. B with the palms facing
aging positions, it is usual to (mall bars) indicates that the ~ bars. Towards hanging (wall L
Fig. 241.
Fig. 242.
Fig. 243.
272 Crouch sitting
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
crch. sitt.
Fig. 244.
Thc body is supported by the toes and hands, which rest on the floor, with hips and knees flexed as much as possible, and trunk inclined forwards. The arms are vertical and may be outside the thighs (clo~e crouch) or between the thighs (open crouch). (Fig. 245.)
a
4
Fig. 245.
b
Throughout this booI gymnastic movements Ling Physical EdUC21 technical terms used. 1 in this appendix, alODj writing of exercise pn: Gymnastic terminol cularly suitable for c! exercise therapy. It is and complicated. On systems of recording Il and difficult to learn. 1 an elaborate system oj square or frame. Labl based on a system of l
TERMS DENOTINI Bending
bend
Bracing
brae.
Carrying
carry.
Circling (on apparatus)
cird.
* Now the Physical Ed...
THERAPY
s supported by the toes and hands, JIl the floor, with hips and knees och as possible, and trunk inclined De anns are vertical and may be thighs (c1o:;e crouch) or between open crouch). (Fig. 245.)
•
j;P
L Fig. 245.
b
APPENDIX 2
Gymnastic terminology
Throughout this book the terminology used to describe the exercises and gymnastic movements is based on that standardized some years ago by the Ling Physical Education Association. * Thc method of description and technical terms uscd, with some additions and modifications, are given in full in this appendix, along with the various abbreviations used to facilitate the writing of exercise programmes. Gymnastic terminology, being largely descriptive in character, is parti cularly suitable for describing the specific forms of movement used in exercise therapy. It is sometimes criticized, however, as being cumbersome and complicated. On the other hand, it must be emphasized that other systems of recording movement in use today are infinitely more complicated and difficult to learn. Benesh Movement Notation, for example, is based on an elaborate system of signs which are written on a five-line stave within a square or frame. Laban Notation (widely used in movement studies) is also based on a system of signs.
TERMS DENOTING MOVEMENT Bending
bend.
Bracing
brae.
Carrying
carry.
Circling (on apparatus)
circl.
,
Flexion of the part indicated. N.B. Extension of the spine from the neutral position is referred to as 'bending backwards', e.g. Fixed prone lying; Trunk bending back-<1Jards with Ann turning outwards. The term indicates either the stabilization of a joint or the drawing together of two parts. It is used mainly in connection with hyperextension of the knee and adduction of the scapulae, e.g. Ca) Standing; Heel raising and Knee bracing, (b) Sitting; Shoulder bracing. The armes) or leges) is moved in a horizontal direction. Circling over or under apparatus, such as the beam, from which the body is suspended by the hands.
*Now the Physical Education Association of Gt. Britain and N. Ireland.
273
274
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Circling or rolling
eircl. or rolL
The part of the body indicated is moved smoothly in a circular direction. N.B. In rolling in rings the body as a whole is moved, the toes acting as the fixed point.
Closing
clos.
Flinging
fling.
The arm(s) or leges) is moved towards the midline of the body.
A quick elbow extension from the across-bend
position.
Lowering
lower.
Raising or lifting
raise. or lift.
Rebound
reb.
Recoil
recoil
Tilting
tilt.
The part of the body indicated is lowered in a
straight line from its axis of movement.
The part of the body indicated is raised in a
straight line from its axis of movement.
A term used in connection with rhythmical
jumping and hopping. It indicates that a
second, subsidiary jump follows the first main
jump.
A controlled slackening off of a muscle group after a position has been reached, e.g. Forearm reach (lax fingers) sitting; strong Finger bending and slow recoil. A term used in connection with forward backward movement of the pelvis on the femoral heads. Lateral tilting of the pelvis is usually described as 'hip updrawing'.
TERMS DENOTING TYPE OF MOVEMENT Single
Alternate
The term is used when one arm (or leg) is moved in turn with the other arm (or leg), or when one arm Cor leg) is moved several times in succession before the other arm (or leg) is exercised, e.g. Ca) Standing; single Arm raising forwards, (b) Forearm reach sitting; single Forearm turning inwards and outwards cominuously to a given coum. Single is also used when one limb only is to be exercised; the term is then qualified by additional information, e.g. Reach grasp high half standing (beam and block); single (affected) Leg swinging forwards and backwards. alt.
The term is used when one arm (or leg) moves towards one limit of the movement while the other arm (or leg) moves towards the other limit, e.g. Walk forwards standing; alternate Arm swinging forwards and backwards.
TERMSDENO' Across Backwards Behind Downwards Forwards Horizontal
aa b. bel d. f. hoi
TERMS INDICi ~
Bend Close Crook Cross Crouch Grasp Hanging Heave
bd. d.
crk. X crch. gr. hg. hv.
N.B. ] positio syllabi!
PARTSOFTHI Abdomen
Ankle(s)
Arm(s)
Back Chest ElbowCs) Feet Finger(s) Forehead
AbeL Ank..
A. B. Ch. Elb.
F. Fing. Frh.
TERMSREFEi RELATION TO Fixed
Ii
High
1:
Support Living support
HERAl'Y
body indicated is moved circular direction. N.B. In the body as a whole is moved, : as the fixed point.
Ie
leg(s) is moved towards the body.
'e:x:tension from the
275
TERMINOLOGY
across~bend
e body indicated is lowered in a
its axis of movement.
Ie body indicated is raised in a
IlDl its axis of movement.
IlDl
OJIlIlecUon with rhythmical
oopping. It indicates that a
iuy jump follows the first main
I
Ia:1ening off of a muscle group has been reached, e.g. Forearm
TERMS DENOTING DIRECTION OF MOVEMENT Across Backwards Behind Downwards Forwards Horizontal
acr. b. beh. d. f. hor.
Inclined Inwards Lateral Left Medial Oblique
incl. inw. la1. I. med. obI.
Outwards Right Sideways Under Upwards
o. r. s. undo u.
TERMS INDICATING POSITION OF LIMBS AND TRUNK Bend Close Crook Cross Crouch Grasp Hanging Heave
bd. cl. crk. X crch. gr. hg. hv.
Kneeling Long Lying Prone Reach Relaxed Rest Sitting
kn. 19. ly. pro rch. lax, rst.
sitt.
Squatting Standing Stretch Stride Wing Yard
squat.
st.
str.
std.
wg.
yd.
I
Inl
Dlling; slrong Finger bending
OJIlIlecUon with forward of the pelvis on the Lateral tilting of the pelvis is at as 'hip updrawing'.
N.B. In abbreviating terms used to describe movement, rather than position, which end in -ing (bending, stretching, carrying, etc.) the final syllable is omitted. See Terms denoting Movement, p, 273.
I
rmmt
!!NT
011 when one arm (or leg) is Irith the other arm (or leg), or (01' kg) is moved several times !:fore the other arm (or leg) is :41) Slanding; single A rm raising ruum reach silting; single ~ imz:ards and outwards • given count. led when one limb only is to be 111m is then qualified by mation, e.g. Reach grasp high _ and block J; single (affected) ~ds and backwards. d when one arm (or Jeg) moves lit of the movement while the II> moves towards the other jm"C:Jards standing; alrernate rr:lKD'ds and backwards.
PARTS OF THE BODY AND THEIR ABBREVIATIONS Abdomen Ankle(s) Arm(s) Back Chest EIbow(s) Feet Finger(s) Forehead
Abd. Ank. A. B. Ch. EIb. F. Fing. Frh.
Hand(s) Head Heel(s) Hip(s) Instep Knee(s) Leg(s) Neck Palm(s)
Hnd. H. HI. Hp. Ins. K. L. N. Pa.
Pelvis Shoulder(s) Shoulder blades
Side Thigh(s) Tee(s) Trunk Wrist(s)
P.
Sh.
Sh. bl.
S.
Th.
Toe
T.
Wr.
TERMS REFERRING TO THE POSITION OF THE BODY IN RELATION TO APPARATUS OR LIVING SUPPORT Fixed
fix.
High
high
Support
sup.
Living support
(.)
One or both feet are fixed in or under apparatus, such as wall bars, or by a partner. The term is used to indicate that a position is taken on apparatus (e.g. high sitcing); it may also be employed in exercises to indicate that a movement is to be taken as far as possible, e.g. Lying; high Knee raising. The term is also used to modify such positions as yard and reach, e.g. high yard. The part of the body named is supported by apparatus. A partner provides support, e.g. Over-grasp horizontal fall hanging (beam and living sup port J; Arm bending.
( .. ) represents two supporters.
276 Towards
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
tow.
Back towards
B. tow.
Side towards
S. tow.
The body faces apparatus. When grasp positions are used it is not necessary to use the term. The back is turned towards the apparatus. When the hanging position is taken at the wall bars with the back towards the bars, it is usual to dispense with the term 'back towards'.
REFERENCES Laban R. (1975) Modem Et6 Ling Physical Education A Gymnastics. London. McGuiness-Scott J. (1980) B clinical data. PhysiocileriJIIJ
One side of the body is turned towards the apparatus. When a grasp position is used it is not customary to use the term.
"
Bibliogra METHOD OF DESCRIBING EXERCISES IN TERMINOLOGY 1. The name of the starting position is given first; it is followed by a description of the movement to be performed. A semi-colon is used to separate the starting position from the movement, e.g. Lying; high Knee raising. 2. The term half is used to prefix the starting position when one limb only is involved, e.g. Half yard grasp standing (wall bars). 3. In describing the movement, the part of the body moved is mentioned first, and then the type and direction of the movement. When more than one part of the body is involved the following order is usually suggested: Head, Arms, Trunk, Legs, Feet. This sequence is modified, however, when describing exercises where the movement of one part of the body is more important than the other subsidiary movements involved. This part is mentioned first, e.g. (a) Fixed prone lying; Trunk bending backwards with Arm turning outwards and single Leg raising backwards and (b) Standing; Heel raising and Knee full bending with loose Arm swinging forwards-backwards. It is unnecessary to mention the return movement unless it is intended that the return movement shall not be the opposite of the original movement. 4. In describing movements of the limbs the plural is indicated by Arm CA.), Leg (L), Knee (K.) etc. When one limb is to be moved on its own, or in turn with the other limb, the term single (1) is used. See Terms denoting type of Movement, p. 274. 5. When a movement consists of several parts a comma is used to separate each part, e.g. Prone kneeling; single high Knee raising, Leg stretching and raising backwards, and return to starting position. Brackets are used to give information concerning the method of performing the exercise (including counts and beats), type of apparatus and support used, e.g. Towards standing (balance bench); stepping up forwards, affected Leg leading ( 1-2), and stepping down backwards, affected Leg leading (3-4 J. 6. In abbreviating terminology a full stop is used after each abbreviation employed, e.g. Ca) pro kn.; P. tilt. f. and b. W. H. bend. b. andf. Cb) st.; HI. rais. W. A. swing. f. and f.-u. (c) N. rst. fix. pro ly.; T. bend. b. w. turn.
General Surgery
Aird 1. (1957) A CompaniIM Ballinger W. F. and Drapm Bendixen H. H. (1965) Rap Macfarlane D. A. and TboaI Churchill Livingstone.
Orthopaedic Surgery
Adams ]. C. (1980) StarukD Livingstone. Charnley J. (1970) Total hi! 72,7. Duthrie R. B. and FeI'gllS Edinburgh, Churchill Lit Edmonson A. S. and Crensl Vol. 2, 6th ed. St Louis,. Longton E. B. (1973) OrthOl 59, 1l6-119. Muller M. E. (1970) Total] Smillie 1. S. (1978) InjllJ Livingstone.
Physical Education
Knudsen K. A. (1947) Text, Laban R. (1975) Modem Et. Laban R. and Lawrence A. Larson L. A. (1974). Fitne~ Ling Physical Education j Gymnastics. London. Mace R. and Benn B. (\982 Morgan R. E. and AdamSOl Munrow A. D. (1963) Pure Thulin J. G. (1947) GymllQJ Verducci F. M. (1980) M ..~
BIBLIOGRAPHY
IRAPY
apparatus. When grasp ed it is not necessary to use
lied towards the apparatus. log position is taken at the wall d:: towards the bars, it is usual 1 the tenn 'back towards'.
271
REFERENCES Laban R. (1975) Modem Educational Dance. Plymouth, Macdonald & Evans. Ling Physical Education Association (1950) Terminology of Swedish Educational Gymnastics. London. McGuiness-Scott J. (1980) Benesh Movement Notation: an introduction to recording clinical data. Physiotherapy 66, 268-270.
body is turned towards the grasp position is used it is o usc the term.
11 a
Bibliography
; IN TERMINOLOGY
en first; it is followed by a tL A semi-colon is used to Dent, e.g. Lying; high Knee
ling position when one limb 'rDal/ bars}. lie body moved is mentioned
I:menr:. When more than one . is usually suggested: Head, modified, however, when !lie pan of the body is more :DIS involved. This part is ~bDulingbackwards with Arm rd.s and (b) Standing,- Heel forwards-backwards. .:Dt unless it is intended that IIf the original movement. plural is indicated by Arm D be moved on its own, or in i used. See Terms denoting
..m.r
General Surgery Aird I. (1957) A Companion in Surgical Studies, 2nd ed. Edinburgh, Livingstone. Ballinger W. F. and Drapanas T. (1972) Practice of Surgery. St Louis, Mosby. Bendixen H. H. (1965) RespiralOry Care. St Louis, Mosby. Macfarlane D. A. and Thomas L. P. (1977) Textbook of Surgery, 4th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone.
Orthopaedic Surgery Adams J. C. (1980) Standard Orthopaedic Operations, 2nd ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone. Charnley J. (1970) Total hip replacement by low friction arthroplasty. Clirl. Orthop. 72,7. Duthrie R. B. and Ferguson A. B. (1973) Mercer's Orthopaedic Surgery, 7th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone. Edmonson A. S. and Crenshaw A. H. (ed,) (1980) Campbell's Operative Orthopaedics, Vol. 2, 6th ed, St Louis, Mosby. Longton E. B. (1973) Orthopaedic surgery in arthritic lower limb joints. Physiotherapy 59, 116-119. Muller M. E. (1970) Total hip prosthesis. Clin. Orthop. 72, 46. Smillie I. S. (1978) injuries of the Knee Joint, 5th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone.
a comma is used to separate ~
raising, Leg stretching and Brackets are used to give ling the exercise (including 'used, e.g. Towards standing r/eading 11-2), and stepping
I.
Physical Education
!Sed after each abbreviation
Knudsen K. A. (1947) Textbook of Gymnastics, 2nd ed. London, Churchill. Laban R. (1975) Modern Educational Dallcr. Plymouth, Macdonald & Evans, Laban R. and Lawrence A. (1974) EYfort. Plymouth, Macdonald & Evans. Larson L. A, (1974). Fitness, Health, and Work Capacity. New York, Macmillan. Ling Physical Education Association (1950) Terminology of Swedish Educational Gymnastics. London. Mace R. and Benn B. (1982) GYllmastic Skills, London, Batsford. Morgan R. E. and Adamson G. T. (1961) Circuit Training, 2nd cd. London, Bell. Munrow A. D. (1963) Pure alld Applied Gymnastics, 2nd ed. London, Arnold. Thulin J. G. (1947) Gymnastic Handbook. Lund, South Swedish Gymnastic Institute. Verducci F. M. (1980) Measurement Concepts in Physical Educatioll. St. Louis, Mosby.
fill f.
278
PROGRESSIVE EXERCISE THERAPY
Physical Treatment American College of Spons Medicine (1980) Guide Lines for Graded Exercise Testing and Exercise Prescription, 2nd cd. Philadelphia, Lea & Febiger. Basmajian J. V. (cd.) (1980) Therapeutic Exercise. Baltimore, Williams & Wilkins. Butler P. and Kepson G. (1980) Quadriceps strengthening: a comparative study of three types of apparatus for strengthening the quadriceps femoris muscle dynami cally. Physiotherapy 66, 82-85. DeLorme T. L (1945) Restoration of muscle power by heavy resistance exercises. J. Bone Joint Surg. 27, 646-667. DeLorme T. L. and Watkins A. L (1945) Technics of progressive resisrance exercises. Arch. Phys. Med. 29, 263-273. DeLorme T. L and Watkins A. L (1951) Progressive Resistance Exercises: Technique and Medical Application. New York, Appleton-Century-Crofts. Dick F. W. (1968) A review of recent studies pertaining to strength. Br. J. Sports M ed. 4,35-41. Edwards R. H. T. and McDonnell M. (1974) Handheld dynamometer for evaluating voluntary muscle function. Lancet 2, 757. Gardiner D. M. (1981) The Principles of Exercise Therapy, 4th ed. London, Bell & Hyman. Hale G. (cd.) (1979) The Source Book for the Disabled. New York, Paddington Press. Hollis M. (1981) Practical Exercise Therapy, 2nd cd. Oxford, Blackwell Scientific Publications. Hirschberg G. G., Lewis L. and Vaughan P. (1976) Rehabilitation, 2nd ed. Phila delphia, Lippincott. McQueen I. (1954) Recent advances in the techniques of progressive resistance exercises. Br. Med. J. 2, 1193-1198. Nicoll E. A. (1941) Rehabilitation of the injured. Br. Med. J. 1, 501-506. Nicoll E. A. (1943) Principles of exercise therapy. Br. Med. J. 1,747-750. Smith Guthrie O. F. (1943) Rehabilitation, Re-education and Remedial Exercises. London, Bailliere, Tindall & Cox. Vannier M. (1977) Physical Activities for the Handicapped. New Jersey, Prentice-HalL Wells K. F. and Luttgens K. (1982) Kinesiology, 7th ed. Philadelphia, Saunders College Publishers. Westers B. M. (1982) Factors influencing strength testing and exercise prescription. Physiotherapy 68, 42-44. Wynn Parry C. B. (1973) Rehabilitation of the Hand, 3rd ed. London, Butterworths. Zinovieff A. (1951) Heavy resistance exercises: the Oxford Technique. Br. J. Phys. Med. Indus!. Hyg. 14, 129.
Anatomy and Physiology Green J. H. (1975) Basic Clinical Physiology, 2nd ed. London, Oxford University Press. Guyton A. (1979) Physiology of the Human Body, 5th ed. Philadelphia, Saunders. McMinn R. M. H. and Hutchings R. T. (1978) A Colour Atlas of Human Anatomy. London, Wolfe MedicaL Williams P. L and Warwick R. (1980) Gray's Anatomy, 36th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill Livingstone.
"
Abdominal exercisl See also Applied after abdo Aids to daily livq Anal sphincter, elQ 116 Ankle exercises, 1; Apical breathing, I Appendicectomy, I exercise therapy Applied exercise d after abdominal : appendicecton cholecystectOil gastrectomy, J repair of ingu:i femoral hal umbilical" after intervem:b lumbarSl meniscectomy: total hip Arm depressors, c elevators, exera 136
exercises, with b
rep"
III
Arthroplasty, of hi following joint d 230 revision, 230 Axial fixation, 17-:
Back care, after in1 lesions of 218 exercises, dymm static, 76
py
sfur Graded Exercise Testing Febiger.
me, Williams & Wilkins.
1iDg: a comparative study of
:qJS femoris muscle dynami beavy resisrance exercises.
J.
19ttSsive resistance exercises.
'esisla1lC£ Exercises: Technique
INDEX
ry-Crofts.
) strength. Br. J. Sports Med.
dynamometer for evaluating
rpy, 4th ed. London, Bell &
few York, Paddington Press.
Oxford, Blackwell Scientific
r.eIwbiJ.iration, 2nd ed. Phila-
I!S
of progressive resistance
'ed.]. 1,501-506. 'lid.]. 1,747-750. . . and Remedial Exercises.
II.. New Jersey, Prentice-Hall. cd. Philadelphia, Saunders
III!: and exercise prescription.
:I cd. London, Butterworths. iIrd Technique. Br. J. Phys.
Loodoo, Oxford University L Pbiladelphia, Saunders. ~ Atlas of Human Anatomy.
Abdominal exercises, 69, 73
See also Applied exercise therapy,
after abdominal surgery
Aids to daily living, 229
Anal sphincter, exercises using, 115,
ll6
Ankle exercises, 171-173
Apical breathing, 109, Ill, 112
Appendicectomy, 197-201
exercise therapy after, 198-201
Applied exercise therapy, 184-243
after abdominal surgery, 184
appendicectomy, 197
cholecystectomy, 196
gastrectomy, 188
repair of inguinal hernia, 204
femoral hernia, 209
umbilical hernia, 210
after intervertebral disc lesions of
lumbar spine, 213, 215
meniscectomy, 236
total hip replacement, 222, 225
Arm depressors, exercises for, 129
elevators, exercises for, 120, 123, 127,
136
exercises, with breathing, 109, 110,
III
Arthroplasty, of hip, 221-231
following joint disease in childhood,
230
revision, 230
Axial fixation, 17-20
6th ed. Edinburgh, Churchill
Back care, after intervertebral disc
lesions of lumbar spine, 215,
218
exercises, dynamic, 79
static, 76
Balance exercises, 11, 12, 196,209
Bassini operation for inguinal hernia,
203
abdominal exercises after, 204
Battle's pararectal incision, 189, 197,
198
Beam, circling exercises on, 87, 89
introductory exercises, 91, 92
Breathing exercises, 109-114
after abdominal surgery, 185, 186
surgical treatment for intervertebral disc lesions of lumbar spine, 215,216,217 in physical education, 114
practical techniques, 113
starting positions for, 113, 114
to increase range of expiration, III
inspiration, 112
to prevent stagnation of mucous
secretions, 112
when bed rest is used for
intervertebral disc lesions of
lumbar spine, 213, 214
with arm movements, 110, 111
trunk movements, 110
Bronchopneumonia, after abdominal
surgery, 184, 185
Cholecystectomy, 196-197
exercise therapy after, 197
Chronic chest diseases, 'warming up'
exercises for, 258
Circuit training, progressive, 247-255
clothing for, 255
definition of, 247
equipment for, 255
practical application of, 247, 253, 254
setting standards, 253
279
280
INDEX
Circuit training (cont.) specimen circuits, 248-251 types of circuit, 247 variations of, 254 Circulatory complications, after abdominal surgery, 187 minimized by postoperative leg exercises, 187 Class, difference between group and class methods, 181 treatment, 181, 256 Co-axial fixation, 17 Co-ordination, progression of, II Costal breathing, 109-111 unilateral, 110, 111 Cough reflex, diminished after genera) anaesthesia, 185 Cough-Lok, Hawksley, 112, 113, 185
De Lorme and Watkins 'fractional' technique of strengthening muscles, 34 Diaphragm, limitation of movement after abdominal surgery, 184, 186 Diaphragmatic breathing, 109, 110 benefits to normal person, 114 Drainage after cholecystectomy, 196 total hip replacement, 224
Elastic strands, as resistance, 38 Elbow exercises, 139-142 Embolism, postoperative, 187 Epiphysial plates, damage to, by spinal flexion exercises, 88 Equipment, for assisted active exercises, 13 auto-assisted active (tension) exercises, IS, 16 circuit training, 255 exercises to music, 257 free exercises, 7, 61-177 supported movements, 20 suspension exercises, 17, 18, 19 weight resisted exercises, 26--28 weight-and-pulley resisted exercises, 25,26 Exercise(s) assisted active, 13 auto-assisted active (tension), 15 free, 7 See also Progressive exercises, 59--177 general, 245
Exercise(s) (cant.) resisted, 21
manual,41
spring, 36
water, 39
weight, 26
weight-and-pulley, 21
See also resisrance by malleable materials for strengthening grip, 39 specific, 3
supported, 20
suspension, 17
rabies, 181
terminology, 273
Fatigue, avoidance of, in specific exercise rherapy, 182, 256 in assessing muscle strength, 31, 32 in strength progression techniques, 29,30 Femoral hernia, 209, 210 postoperative exercise therapy, 210 Finger and thumb exercises, 151-153 Foot exercises, 173-175 Forearm exercises, 143--146 Free exercises, 7 arranged progressively, 59-177 definition of, 7 methods of progression, 7, 10, II See alsa 'warming up' exercises, 256 Functional manoeuvres on the floor or bed,48-50 movements, in early stages of
mobilization/re-education,
43--58
at floor level, 50-53 in prone lying on bed or mat, 51-53 moving on bed from supine lying, 45-48 from sitting and standing, 54-57 negotiating stairs, 57-58
General exercise then exercises, 3, 181 Gridiron incision, 189 Grip, exercises to SIm 151 Group, difference bet1 class method! treatment, 181 Gymnastic terms, Z11
Haemarthrosis, POSlDl meniscectlXD Hamstring muscles, a shortening oj 'stretching', 88 Hand, exercises for, 1 functional activities exercises, 39, resisted exercise by materials, 39 Head and neck exeni Heavy resistance sysu
stren~
techniques of, 34, :3 Hernia: see Femond" : 203; Umbilil: Hip arthroplasty, sa . replacemeut, exercises for, 15t against spring ra using susperWClIII, with manual assiI Hypothenar and tbID exercises fOl',
Incisions, for abdomi appendicectomy, I~ cholecystectomy, I! gastrectomy, 188 hernia: femoral, 201 203; umbi1ic used in meniscectu Indian clubs, in elbo1
141 Games, in combination wirh specific exercise therapy, 3, 181 remedial, to encourage grip, 39 Gastrectomy, 188-196 exercise therapy after, 190 Gastro-enterostomy, 188
forearm exercises, I shoulder and shoul exercises, 12 wrist exercises, 15Cl Inguinal canal, defCD 201,202 hernia, direct, 203
INDEX
1:(5) (cont.)
m,21 oual,41 iDg,36 115',39
icJn, 26
i&bt-and-pulley, 21
60 resistance by malleable materials for strengthening grip,39
General exercise therapy, 245-260
exercises, 3, 181
Gridiron incision, 189, 197
Grip, exercises to strengthen, 38, 39,
151
Group, difference between group and
class methods, 181
treatment, 181
Gymnastic terms, 273-276
1ic,3
.ud. 20
1IIISion, 17
181
DOIogy,273
I,
• avoidance of, in specific c::u:n:ise therapy, 182, 256
~ing muscle strength, 31, 32
IU'aIgth progression techniques,
,29,30
11lcniia, 209, 210
llipeiative exercise therapy, 210
IDd thumb exercises, 151-153
cn:ises, 173-175
• aercises, 143-146
~7
p:d progressively, 59-177
Iiaa of. 7
Ids of progression, 7, 10, II
... ~ up' exercises, 256
... manoeuvres on the floor or
bat, 48-50
IIII:IItS, in early stages of
DKIbilization/re-education,
Haemarthrosis, postoperative, in
meniscectomy, 235, 236
Hamstring muscles, congenital
shortening of, 88
'stretching', 88
Hand, exercises for, 151-153
functional activities to complement
exercises, 39, 151
resisted exercise by malleable
materials, 39
Head and neck exercises, 61-67
Heavy resistance systems for muscle
strengthening, 33-35
techniques of, 34, 35
Hernia: see Femoral, 209; Inguinal, 202,
203; Umbilical, 210
Hip arthroplasty, see Total hip
replacement, 221
exercises for, 154-163
against spring resistance, 36
using suspension apparatus, 17, 18
with manual assistance, 13
Hypothenar and thenar muscles,
exercises for, 153
281
Inguinal canal (com.)
oblique, 202
operative procedures for, 203
abdominal exercises following,
scope of, 204
exercise therapy after, 204-209
Inspiratory range, exercises to increase,
112
Intervertebral disc(s), damage to, by
spinal flexion exercises, 88
lesions of the lumbar spine, 212-220
conservative treatment of, 212
exercise therapy during, 213-215
surgical treatment of, 212
exercise therapy after, 215-220
Intrinsic muscles of foot, exercises for,
175,176
Joint, hip, surgery to restore movement,
221,222
of knee, 15
using combined circuits, 16
knee, restoring flexion after
meniscectomy, 233, 234, 241,
242,243
restoring mobility by auto-assisted
active (tension) exercises,
15-17
of shoulder, 15
spine, thoracolumbar, promoting
movement after disc lesions,
214, 215, 217-220
zones of movement of stiff joints, 16,
17
4:3-58
.... level, 5(}--53
_ lying on bed or mat,
51-53
• OIl bed from supine lying, ti-48 II silting and standing, 54-57
.mg stairs, 57-58
,
in combination with specific
a-ercise therapy, 3, 181
IiII. to encourage grip, 39
1III1lY, 188-196
lie therapy after, 190
:merostomy,I88
Incisions, for abdominal surgery, 189
appendicectomy, 197, 198
cholecystectomy, 196
gastrectomy, 188
hernia: femoral, 209, 210; inguinal,
203; umbilical, 210
used in meniscectomy, 232
Indian clubs, in elbow exercises, 139,
141
forearm exercises, 146
shoulder and shoulder girdle
exercises, 121, 125, 137, 138
wrist exercises, 150
Inguinal canal, defence mechanism of,
201,202
hernia, direct, 203
Knee exercises, 164-170
for extensors, 164-167
for flexors, 164
to restore range of knee flexion,
168-170
See also Meniscectomy, 232-243
Kocher's subcostal incision, 189, 196
Leg exercises, ankle and foot, 171-177
after abdominal surgery, 187
surgical treatment, intervertebral
disc lesions of lumbar spine,
216, 217
total replacement of hip, 225, 226
282
INDEX
Leg exercises (cont.) during conservative treatment,
intervertebral disc lesions of
lumbar spine, 213, 214
Lifting, education in, after repair of
inguinal hernia, 209
Lung(s), ventilation of, exercises for,
109, 110, 112
Lunging, 266
Lying positions, in functional training,
45-48, 51-53
See also Starting positions, 261, 268,
269
McQueen technique of resistance
training, 35
Manipulation and passive mobilization,
212
Manual resistance, 41
Meniscectomy, 232-243
complications of, 235
essential of treatment, 232-235
exercise therapy for, 236-243
pool therapy after, 241
programmes of treatment, 236-243
regimes of treatment, 233-235
Mobility exercises, for ankle, 173
elbow, 142
fingers, 152
foot, 175
forearm, 146
hip, 155, 158, 159, 161, 163
knee, 168-170
shoulder girdle, 118, 119
shoulder joint and shoulder girdle,
121, 122, 125, 126, 134, 136,
137, 138
spine, cervical, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68
thoracolumbar, 90, 91, 98, 99, 102,
103, 107, 108
wrist, 150
Mobilizing stiff joints, by assisted active
exercises, 13, 14
auto-assisted active (tension)
exercises, 15, 16, 17
free exercises, 10, 11
suspension exercises, 17, 18
Movements, functional, 45-58
Mucous secretions, causing
postoperative complications,
184, 185
prevention of, ll2, 185, 186, 187
Muscle strength, methods of resistance
training, 29-31, 33-35
assessment of, with myometer, 32,
33; with 10 RM test, 31
early and advanced techniques, 29,
30
heavy resistance systems, 33-35
De Lorme and Watkins
'fractional' technique, 34
McQueen technique, 35
Zinovieff (Oxford) technique, 34
Music, exercise to, 256
equipment for, 257
exercise sequence, 256
organization of class, 256
specimen programmes, 258, 259
stereo equipment and suitable
music, 257
use of, 256
and functional activities, 258
gai t training, 258
movement for mentally handicapped,
259
Neck exercises, 61-68
Non-weight-bearing regime after
meniscectomy, 233
Nursing staff, role in exercise therapy
after total hip replacement, 225
Occupational therapy, 3
functional activities provided by, 39
Overhead fixation point(s), in
suspension exercises, 17, 19
Oxford (Zinovieff) technique of
resistance training, 34
Paramedian incision, 189
in appendicectomy, 198
cholecystectomy, 196
gastrectomy, 188, 189
Pclvic floor exercises, 115-117
Pelvis, fixation of, during lateral flexion
of thoracolumbar spine, 99
during spinal rotation, 103
tilting exercises, backwards, 73-75;
forwards, 79, 81, 82
forwards and backwards, 86, 90
Plaster-of-Paris cyliD meniscectoo jacket, in conserval disc lesions
212
Pool therapy, 39-41, 'Portabell' weighted 1 resistance, 2 Postural drainage, 11 after abdominal su repair of inguinll training, after disc spine, 215, : Posture, alteratioo 01 major abdol 185, 186
Pre-work circuit, 24' Progression of free c ordinatioo. II; strengdl principle of, 5
specific exercises, supported move:m suspension exerci! resisted exercises" 39-41
Progressive circuit 1 exercises, free • .,., Prosthesis, low frid replacema Pulmonary congesO 185
Range of movemeD' exercises" . progression of, 11
Raymed 'knee imm after mmi Rehabilitation reot to music, general exercises Repctition dose (J£ training, ,
Resistance trainiDI! progressK 33-35,38 Resisted exercises. Respiratory oompl abdomina prevention of, II Revision arthropla
INDEX ~
strength, methods of resistance
~g,29-31, 33-35
ar:ssment of, with myometer, 32,
33; with 10 RM test, 31
tty and advanced techniques, 29,
30
IVy resistance systems, 33-35
De Lorme and Watkins
'fractional' technique, 34
McQueen technique, 35
Zinovidf (Oxford) technique, 34
cu:rcise to, 256
llipmcnt for, 257.
:rcise sequence, 256
IIIOization of class, 256
:cime:n programmes, 258, 259
neo equipment and suitable
music,257 ~of,256
imaiooal activities, 258
l1IiDing, 258
ment for mentally handicapped,
259
acises, 61-68
_-bearing regime after
UVTri~omy, 233
~ suIf, role in exercise therapy
8ia' toal hip replacement, 225
ionaJ lherapy, 3
. . . activities provided by, 39
d fiDtion point(s), in
suspension exercises, 17, 19
[Zioovieff) technique of
RSistance training, 34
/
!ian incision, 189
lBldicectomy, 198
:ys(eCtomy, 196
ClIlIDy, 188, 189
:101" exercises, 115-117
:arion of, during lateral flexion
of tboracolumbar spine, 99
. . spinal rotation, 103
cu:rcises, backwards, 73-75;
fOrwards, 79, 81, 82
'IUds and backwards, 86, 90
Plaster-of-Paris cylinder, use of, after
meniscectomy, 234, 235
jacket, in conservative treatment of
disc lesions of lumbar spine,
212
Pool therapy, 39-41, 219, 230, 241
'Portabell' weighted bands, as weight
resistance, 28
Postural drainage, 112
after abdominal surgery, 185, 186
repair of inguinal hernia, 207
training, after disc lesions of lumbar
spine, 215, 218
Posture, alteration of, in bed, after
major abdominal operations,
185, 186
Pre-work circuit, 247, 251, 255
Progression of free exercises, in co
ordination, 11, 12; range, 10,
11; strength, 7-10
principle of,S
specific exercises, 3, 5
supported movements, 20
suspension exercises, 20
resisted exercises, 29, 30, 33-35, 38,
39-41
Progressive circuit training, 247-255
exercises, free, 59-177
Prosthesis, low friction, in total hip
replacement, 221, 222
Pulmonary congestion, postoperative,
185
Range of movement, in specific
exercises, 4, 5
progression of, in free exercises, 10,
11
Raymed 'knee immobilizer', use of,
after meniscectomy, 235, 238
Rehabilitation centres, use of exercises
to music, 256
general exercises and games in, 181
Repetition dose or level, in circuit
training, 252
Resistance training, strength
progression techniques, 29, 30,
33-35,38,39-41
Resisted exercises, 21-41
Respiratory complications, after
abdominal surgery, 184
prevention of, 185-187
Revision arthroplasty of hip, 230
283
Rhythm, principle of, in specific
exercises, 4
Rings, circling on, 75, 76, 127, 128, 130
nest hang in, 86, 87, 91
Ropes, circling on, 91,127,128,130
climbing, 128, 130
Self-practice, 'little-and-often', 182,
183,186,187,190,199,205,
213
Shoulder girdle, exercises for, 118, 119
joint and girdle, exercises for,
120-134, 136-138
rotators of shoulder joint, exercises
for, 134-136
Sitting positions, for head and neck
exercises, 61
Skipping, use of, in promoting co
ordination, 12
to redevelop quadriceps femoris after
meniscectomy, 242, 243
Specific exercises, see Exercise(s) Spine, circumductors of, exercises for,
107,108
Spring resistance, 36-38
progression of, 38, 39
Springs, long spiral, 36
other types, 38
Starting positions, importance of, in
specific exercises, 3, 4, 5
listed,261-271
Stereo player, use of, in exercises to
music, 257
Stick exercises, for shoulder and
shoulder girdle, 120-124, 126,
132-135, 137
for elbow, 139, 141, 142
for forearm, wrist and hand, 143-145,
147-149,151
Strength, progression in, of free
exercises, 5, 7-10
See also resistance training
Stress incontinence, pelvic floor
exercises in treatment of, 115
Suture line, and exercise, after
appendicectomy, 198
gastrectomy) 189
inguinal herniotomy, 204
Ten Repetition Maximum, 29-32, 34,
35
284
INDEX
Terminology, gymnastic, 273--276
Vaginal wall, prolapse of, pelvic floor
Thenar and hypothenar muscles,
exercises in treatment of, 115
exercises to strengthen, 153
Vagotomy, with gastro-enterostomy,
Thrombosis, postoperative, 187
188
Toe flexors and extensors, exercises for,
177
Total hip replacement, 221-230
assessment, preoperative, 222
Walking, after meniscectomy, 233, 234,
exercise therapy, preoperative,
235, 240
222-224; postoperative,
surgical treatment of disc lesions of
225-230
lumbar spine, 217
forces passing through replacement
total hip replacement, 226, 228, 229,
joint in walking, 222
230
training in standing and walking,
'Warming up' exercises to music, 256
228-230
Water, exercises in, 39-41
use of tilt table, 227,228
See also Pool therapy
variation of exercise programme by
Weight resistance, 26-28
use of pool therapy, 230
Weight-and-pulley resistance, 21-26
Trunk exercises, 69-108
Weight-bearing, after meniscectomy,
after appendicectomy, 199-201
233--235, 237, 240
gastrectomy, 191, 192, 194, 195
total hip replacement, 226, 227, 228,
operations for inguinal hernia,
229,230
205-208
Wrist exercises, 146-150
with breathing, 110, 112
Umbilical hernia, 210, 211
Zinovieff technique of resistance, 34, 35
/